B \ t D o 33 THE KEDGE-ANCHOE; OR, YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. APPERTAINING TO THE PRACTICAL EVOLUTIONS OF MODERN SEAMANSHIP, RIGGING, KNOTTING, SPLICING, BLOCKS, PURCHASES, RUNNING- RIGGING, AND OTHER MISCELLANEOUS MATTERS, APPLI- CABLE TO SHIPS-OF-WAR AND OTHERS. ILLUSTRATED WITH SEVENTY ENGRA VINGS. TABLES OF RIGGING, SPARS, SAILS, BLOCKS, CANVAS, CORDAGE, CHAIN AND HEMP CABLES, HAWSERS, ETC., RELATIVE TO EVERY CLASS OF VESSELS. BY WILLIAM X. BRADY, SAILING-MASTEE, TT. 8. N. EIGHTEENTH EDITION. * * IMPROVED AND ENLARGED, -WITH ADDITIONAL MATTER, PLATES, AND TABLES. NEW YOEK: D. APPLETON AND COMPANY, 1, 3, AND 5 BOND STEEET. 1882. Wf according to the Act of 'Congress, in the year 1847, By WILLIAM N. BRADY, in me Cleric's Ottice of the District Court lor the Southern District of New Vor o - . ,-./ c ** - - iUn DEDICATED TO THE UNITED STATES' NAVY AND MERCHANT SERVICE. NAUTICAL TUU FK: .,, KS . FOR U. S. , ". : -OKo & c . . H - - s . M36253 BOTTT GIVE UP THE SHIP.' "Ships our cradles, decks our pillows, Lulled by winds and rocked by billowa; Gnily bound we o'er the tide, Hope our anchor, Heaven our guide.** PREFACE. J.N offering the following work to the public, the author joe IBS no apology necessary, as it was written for tue use of the Naval and Mer- chant Service of the United States, as a ready means of introducing Young Sailors to the theory of that art by which they must expect to advance in the profession they have chosen. He natters himself, how- ever, that it will be found useful to many old and experienced seamen, as well as to those who have just entered the sailors', life, and particu- larly to those destined for the Navy. Should it fall into the hands of the learned, they will bear in mind that he is better versed with the marlincspike than the pen, and that it was composed in the hours of relaxation from official duties. He therefore hopes that it may be received for that which it is intended to be, A KEDGE-AXCHOR, for the youthful sailor. The work has been submitted to the inspection of a number of experienced officers, both in the Navy and Merchant Ser- vice, who have given it their decided approbation ; some of whose names are appended to the work. "With these few remarks, he submits it to a discerning public, to stand or fall on its own merits. RECOMMENDATIONS. 1 have examined the manuscript of Mr. Brady and approve cf it, as a very useful Book for young officers and others, in the Naval and Merchant service. JOHN GALLAGHER, Captain U, S. Navy. I fully concur in the above. E. PECK, Commander U. S. Navy. I have examined the within treatise on Seamanship, and other mis- cellaneous matter appertaining to ships and vessels of war (written by William Brady, Master U. S. Navy). It affords me much pleasure to recommend the same to the junior officers of the Navy, and others who may be disposed to learn the profession of Seamanship. TV. C. TVETMORE, Commander U. S. Navy. Examined and approved as a work that will be useful to the Servica J. D. L. SAUNDERS, Commander U. S. Navy. J. MATTISON, Commander U. S. Navy. This I conceive to be a valuable work, and well calculated to be use- ful to the Service, JOSHUA R. SANDS, Commander U. S. Navy. I have closely examined the within work, and think it well calcu- lated for the instruction of young officers and others in the Navy. JAMES RENSHATV, Captain U. S Navy. I fully concur in the above. FRANCIS 0. ELLISON, Master U. S. Navv b RECOMMENDATIONS. I have carefully examined the within work on Seamanship, and think it one well calculated for the instruction of young officeis, and others. C. G. HUNTER, Lieutenant U. S. Navy. We cheerfully recommend this work of William Brady, S. Master U. S. Navy, to the maritime community, and think it well calculated for the instruction of all who may be disposed to learn the profession of Seamanship. ISAAC McKEEVER, Captain U. S. Navy. JAMES McINTOSH, Commander U. S. Navy. WILLIAM L. HUDSON, " HENRY EAGLE, A. G. GORDON, Lieutenant U. S. CADWALDER RINGGOLD, WILLIAM F. LYNCH, HENRY W. MORRIS, FRANCIS B. ELLISON, JAMES H. ROWAN, JOHN COLHOUN, T. TURNER, T. A. HUNT, HENRY MOORE, JOHN J. GLASSON, CHARLES HEYWOOD, CHARLES S. BOGGS, ALEXANDER GIBSON, ALEXANDER M. PENNOCK, MONTGOMERY HUNT, FRANCIS HAGGERTY J. R. McMULLANY, CAPT. HENRY D. HUNTER, Commanding U. S. Rev. Steamer Polk JOHN McGOWAN, 1st Lieutenant U. S. Rev. Marine. WILLIAM H. BROWN, Lieutenant U. S. Rev. Marine. JOSEPH C. NOYES, Lieutenant U. S. Rev. Marine. - 237 436. Man Ropes (side) 235! 437. Spare Dead-eyes, 238 438. Hide Rope, 239 439. Hawse-hole Windsail, 239 440. -Fighting Ladders, ..-- 239 441. Hawse Bucklers, 239 442. Making-fast a Warp to a Vessel, ------ 240 443. Fitting Quarter Boats' Gripes, ------- 240 444. Fitting Gigs' Slings, 240 445. Scrubbing a Boat's bottom on leaving Harbor, - 241 446. Carrying Light Boats on Shore, - - - - - - 241 447. Miscellaneous Notes on Working Boats. ----- 242 448. Duties of Boats' Crews, 243 449. Boats going on Distant Service, ------ 243 450. Boats under Sail. 244 451. Giving a rope to a Boat, -------- 244 452. Crossing a Bar with Surf in Boats, ----- 245 453. Hauling up Boats, 246 454. Lowering Boats. 246 455. Turning up the Hands. - 246 456. Inspection of Rigging, Morning and Evening, - - - 247 457. Inspection of Stowed Anchors, at Sea, - - . - 247 4 53. Inspection of Boats at Sea, - 248 459. Gammoning the Bowsprit, ----- - 248 460. Precaution in Reeving Running-rigging, - - 249 461. Topsail Tyes, "... . 249 462. Precaution in Blacking Rigging, .... . 250 463. Fore and Main Buntlines, - 25C 464. Topgallant Mast Ropes. - 25C 465. Futtock Shrouds, - - C ,V 18 CONTENTS. Number. Page 466. Tops and Half-Tops, - 251 467. Striking or Housing Topmasts, - - - - - -251 68. Swaying up Topmasts, -------- 252 469. Unmooring, 252 470. Reef-lines to the Topsails, 253 471. Reefing Courses, 253 472. Topgallant-Masts struck, 254 473. Hailing aloft, 254 474. Proportions for Cables (Hemp), 254 475. for Anchors, 254 476. What length is necessary to form a Clinch, - 255 477. References to Sketch of Temporary Rudder, - 255 478. To Splice an Old Cable to a new one, 255 479. Strip Ship, 480. Proportions of Spars of Merchant Ships, Length of Spars, &c. 256 481. Thickness of Spars (Masts), - 257 482. Yards, - - 257 483. Distance for Placing Lower Masts, 257 484. Rule for Placing Masts in a Ship, 257 485. Raising Shears on a Wharf, 258 486. To find the Tonnage of a Vessel by U. S. Measurement, - - 259 487. Stepping and Raking Lower Masts, ----- 259 488. Mooring, 260 PART IX. 489. Preparations for Heaving-down, 261 490. A Derrick, ------- - - 269 General Cautions, 270 PART X. 491. Explanation of Sea Terms, 273 PART XL 492. A table showing the weight of Cables and Anchors, used in ships and vessels of war, in the U. S. Navy, - 290 493. A table showin^ the weight of Guns and Carriages, - - 291 494. " " Chain Cables, - - - - 292 495. " how many fathoms make 112 pounds of foui- strand shroud-laid rope, ------- 292 496. Weight of one foot of Bar Iron, 293 497. A Table showing the weight of one hundred fathoms cable- laid rope, from two to twenty-six inches, - 293 198. A Table showing the strength of hemp-cables, their weight, size, and number of yarns in each, ----- 294 499. A Table showing the strength of plain-laid rope, three strand, 295 500. " " " chain cable, as tested in fifteen fathom lengths, 296 CONTENTS 19 Number. Pkge. 501. A Table showing the strength of short round-linked Bobstay, Bowsprit shroud, or crane-chain without studs, such as is used for rigging. &c. -------- 297 502. Weight of Timber in a green and seasoned state, - 298 503. A Table of measures and weights of different substances, - 298 504. A Table of weight of tarred Cordage, ----- 299 505. A Table showing the comparative strength between Iron Chains and Hemp Cables, and the size required agree- ably to the Tonnage, --__-__ 299 506. A Table showing the test required of flax and cotton Canvass, as to quality and strength, before being received for use, in the U. S. Naval service, ------- 300 507. Cordage Table, showing the weight of one fathom of rope, from one to twenty-four inches, plain-laid three strands, &c. 301 508. A Table showing the length of 1st warp of Standing Rigging, 302 509. A Table of Foreign Ordnance, __._._ 303 510. A Table showing the quantity of provisions, slop-clothing, and small stores, for two hundred men for four months, U. S. Navy, 304 511. A Table showing the component parts of the Navy ration, - 305 512. A Table for finding the distance of an object by two bearings, and the distance between them, - - 308 513. Dimensions of masts and spars, of the U. S. ship Princeton, - 309 514. A Table of the size of short-linked chain, when used as rigging, 310 515. A Table showing the dimensions of the masts and yards, of American, English, and French ships, - 312 516. A Table showing the compliment of Officers and Crew, allow- ed to each class vessel in U. S. Navy, - 314 517. A Table of spars, &c., for all classes of vessels, - - - 313 518. A Table showing the dimensions and quality of materials, used in constructing tops, trestle-trees, cross-trees, and caps, in U. S. Navy, -------- 324 519. A Table showing the complement and quality of Boats to each class vessel in U. S. Navy. --____ 326 520. A Table showing the weight, size, length and quality, of an- chors, cables, &c., allowed to the different class vessels in U. S. Navy, - - - - - - - - - 328 521. A Table showing the size, quantity, quality, and number of sails, allowed to each class vessel U. S. Navy, - 332 522. A Table showing the quantity of canvass, rope, &c.. allowed for one suit of sails, for each class of vessel U. S. Navy, - 336 523. A Table showing the length and size of standing and running- rigging, for all classes of vessels in U. S. Navy, with mis- cellaneous articles, ........ 340 524. A Table showing the size, and description, of the different named Blocks, for all classes of vessels in U. S. Navy, - 364 525. A Table showing the projective distances from the spar-deck of U. S. Ship North Carolina. - 3S4 526. A Table showing the weight of armament, stores, ouifits arid provisions, of U. S. sloop of war Albany - 3SG 527. Recipe for blacking Ships' standing-rigging, - 389 528. do for blacking guns, - ....... 339 529. do for blacking hammock-cloths, yards, and bends, - - 389 530. " for making Liquod Blacking, ...... 390 531. " for blacking guns, 2nd., ' 390 532. " Composition for blackinsr guns, ----- 390 533. " for making Black Varnish, No. 1, 390 534. for making Composition for blacking hammock cloths, No. I, 390 20 CONTENTS. Number. Pago 535. Recipe for making Composition for blacking hammock cloths No. 2, 391 536. " " " " " No. 3, 391 537. " " " " " No. 4, 391 538. " for making Black Varnish, No. 2, 391 539. " for making Solder for Copper, - - - - 391 540. " " " for Lead, 392 541. " To make the best drying Oil, 392 542. " for Black Stain, 392 543. " for blacking Guns and Shot, .... - 392 544. French Recipe for blacking Guns, - - T93 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR. We shall first commence with knotting a rope-yarn. 1. TO KNOT ROPE-YARNS. Take the two ends of the yarns, and split them open about two inches from the end ; and if to make a smooth knot, you may scrape down a little with a knife, so as to make the ends lay smooth ; you then crutch them together as you see in Plate rso. 1. Take two opposite ends (leaving the other two dormant), pass one of the ends under, and the other over the standing part of the yarn, connecting them together at the same side you took them from at first ; then jam your knot taut, and see if it will stand test by stretching the yarn from knee to knee, and hauling on it ; if it stands without drawing, you may trim the ends, and go on. 2 TO MAKE A FOX. Take two or three rope-yarns and make them fast to a belay- ing-pin ; stretch them out taut, and twist them together on your knee ; then rub it down smooth with a piece of old tarred par- celling. This is called a Fox, and is used for many purposes, such as making gaskets, mats, plats, temporary seizings, bend- ing studding-sails, &c. 3. TO MAKE A SPANISH FOX. Take a single rope-yarn and make one end fast as before to a belaying-pin, and untwist and twist it up again the contrary way, and rub it smooth. This is used for small seizings, &c. 22 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 4. TO MAKE A KNITTLE. A Knittle is made of two or three rope-yarns laid up togethei by hand, twisting them between the thumb and finger, and lay- ing them up against the twist of the yarn. They are used foi many purposes on board a ship, particularly for hammock clews. 5. OVERHANDED KNOT. To make an overhanded knot, you pass the end of the rope over the staailing part and through the bight. 6. FIGURE OF EIGHT KNOTS. Take the end of your rope round the standing part, under its own part and through the lower bight, and your knot is made. 7._TWO HALF-HITCHES. Pass the end of your rope round the standing part, arid bring it up through the bight this is one half-hitch ; two of these, one above the other, completes it. 8. REEF, OR SQUARE KNOT. First make an overhanded knot round a yard, spar, or any- thing you please ; then bring the end being next to you over the .eft hand and through the bight ; haul both ends taut, and it is made. 9. A BOWLINE KNOT. Take the end of the rope in your right hand, and the standing par*, in the left lay the end over the standing part, then with your left hand turn the bight of the standing part over the end part, so as to form a cuckold's neck on the standing part ; then lead the end through the standing part above, and stick it down thro igh the cuckold's neck, and it will J appear as in the Plate. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 23 10. BOWLINE ON THE BIGHT. Take the bight of the rope m your right hand, and the stand- ing part in the other ; throw a cuckold's neck over the bight with the standing parts, then haul enough of the bight up through the cuckold's neck to go under and over all parts ; jam all taut, and it will appear as in the Plate. 11. A RUNNING BOWLINE. Take the end of the rope round the standing part, through the bight, and make a single bowline upon the running part, and the knot is made. 12. A TIMBER HITCH. Take the end of a rope round a spar ; pass it under and over the standing part then pass several turns round its own part and it is done. 13. A FISHERMAN'S BEND. With the end of a rope tak e two round turns round a spar, or through the ring of a kedge-anchor ; take one half hitch around the standing parts, and under all parts of the turns ; then one half hitch around the standing part above all, and stop the end to the standing part ; or you can dispense with the last half hitch, and tuck the end under one of the round turns, and it be- comes a studding-sail bend. 14. A ROLLING BEND. A rolling bend is something similar to a fisherman's bend. It is two round turns round a spar as you see in the plate, two half hitches around the standing part, and the end stopped back. (See Plate.) . 15 A CARRICK BEND. This bend is more used in bending hawsers together than foi y other purpose. In forming this bend you will take the end 24 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; of the hawser, and form a bight, by laying the end part on the top of the standing part, so as to form a cross ; take the end of the other hawser, and reeve it down through this bight, up and over this cross ; then pass the end down through the bight again on the opposite side, from the other end, for one end must be on the top, and the other underneath, as you see in the plate. If both end parts come out at the top it will be a granny's knot. (Remember this.} 16. A CAT'S-PAW. This is generally used in the ends of lanyards, to hook the tackle to, in setting up rigging : to form it, you first lay the end part of the lanyard across the standing part, which will form a bight ; then lay hold of the bight with one hand on each side ol it, breaking it down, and turning it overborn you two or three times ; clap both bights together, and hook on to both parts. (See Plate.} 17. A SHEET OR BECKET BEND. Pass the end of a rope through the bight of another rope, or through the becket of a block ; then round both parts of the bight, or becket, and take the end under its own part, as you see in the plate. It is sometimes put under twice, and the end stopped back to the standing part. 18. A BLACK-WALL HITCH. This is used with a lanyard, in setting up rigging, to liook a luff tackle to, instead of a cat's paw, where the end of the lan- yard is not long enough to form a paw ; but a strap and toggle is preferable to both. To make a black-wall over a hcok, you form a bight, or rather a kink with the end of the lanyard, having the end part under- neath, and the standing part on the top ; stick the hook through the bight, keeping the bight well up on the back of the hook (as you see in the plate), until you set taut the tackle. Note. You can learn it much better by practice than expla- nation. Bending, Hitching, Splicing, &c. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 25 19. A ROLLING HITCH. With the end of a rope take a half-hitch around the stand ing part ; then take another through the same bight, jaming it in above the first hitch and the upper part of the bight, then haul it taut, and dog your end above the hitch, around the stand- insr part, or you may take a half-hitch around the standing part and stop the end back with a yarn. 2O. A SALVAGES STRAP. To make a salvagee strap, you may get a couple of spike nails, and drive them into an old piece of plank, or whatever you can find convenient to answer the purpose, or get two hooks, lash them to any convenient place, as far apart as the length you intend to make the strap ; take the end of the ball of rope- yarns, and make it fast to one of the spikes or hooks, then take it round the other one, and keep passing the rope-yarn round and round in this manner, hauling every turn taut as you pass it, until it is as stout as you wish it to be. If it is to be a very large strap, marl it down with stout spun- yarn ; if of middling size, marl with two single rope-yarns ; if a small strap, a single rope-yarn. 21. A PUDDING FOR A MAST OR YARD. Take a piece of rope of the required length, and splice an eye In each end ; get it on a stretch, worm it, and then parcel it accord- ing to the shape you want it. They are generally made as you see in the Plate, large in the middle, tapering gradually toward the ends, and made flat on the side that goes next the yard or i^ast. When you have got it the size required, marl it down, commencing in the middle and marling both ways until you come to the eye ; if it is intended for a yard it is generally covered with thick leather or green hide; if for a mast, it is pointed over for neatness 22. A SHORT SPLICE. To splice the two ends of a rope together, you first unlay the rope to a sufficient length, then crutch them together as you see in the plate ; you must then lay hold of the three strands next to you in your left hand, holding them solid around the other part until you stick the three upper ends, or, if it is a large rope, 3 20 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; you may stop the ends with a yarn ; then take the upper or mid- dle end, pass it over the first strand next to it, stick it underneath the second strand, and haul it taut in the lay of the rope ; turn the rope a little towards you, and stick the second end as you did the first; the third in the same manner, hauling them taut along- the lay of the rope ; turn the rope round, stick the other three ends in the same manner, and it will appear as in the plate. Note. If you intend to serve over the ends, you need not stick them but once ; but if not you must stick them twice, and cross- whip them across the strands so as to make them more secure. If the ends are to be served, take a few of the underneath yarns, enough to fill up the lay of the rope for worming, then scrape or trim the outside ends, and marl them down ready for serving. 23. A LONG SPLICE. To make a long splice, unlay the ends of two ropes to a suffi- cient length, crutch them together in the same manner as a short splice; unlay one strand for a considerable length, and fill up the space which it leaves with the opposite strand next to it ; then turn the rope round and lay hold of the two next strands that will come opposite their respective lays, unlay one and fill up with the other as before ; then cut off the long strands, and it will appear as in the Plate. To complete this splice, you will split the strands equally in two, then take the two opposite half strands and knot them together, so as to fill up the vacant lay ; then you stick the ends twice under two strands with all six o*f the half strands, leaving the other six neutral ; then stretch the splice well before you cut the ends off, and it is finished. 24 EYE-SPLICE. An eye-splice is made by opening the end of a rope, and laying the strands at any distance upon the standing part of the rope, according to the size of the eye-splice you intend to make ; you then divide your strands by putting one strand on the top and one underneath the standing part, then take the middle strand, (having previously opened the lay with a marlinespike,) and stick it under its respective strand, as you see in the Plate. Your next end is taken over the first strand and under the second ; the third and last end is taken through the third strand on the othe/ side. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 25. A CUT SPLICE. Cut a rope in two, and according to the size you intend to make the splice or collar lay the end of one rope on the standing part of the other, and stick the end through between the strands, in the same manner as an eye-splice, and it will appear as in the plate. This forms a collar in the bight of a rope, and is used for pendants, jib-guys, breast-backstays, odd shrouds, &c. 26. A FLEMISH EYE. Unlay the end of a rope, open the strands and separate every yarn, divide them in two halves, then take a piece of round wood the size you intend to make the eye, and half-knot about one-half of the inside yarns over the piece of wood ; scrape the remainder down over the others ; marl, parcel, and serve, or if preferable, hitch it with hambro-line. This makes a snug eye for the collars Df stays. (See Plate.} 27. AN ARTIFICIAL EYE. Take the end of a rope and unlay one strand to a certain dis- tance, and form the eye by placing the two strands along the standing part of the rope and stopping them fast to it ; then take the odd strand and cross it over the standing part, and lay it into the vacant place you took it from at first; work around the eye, filling up the vacant strand until it comes out at the crutch again, and lies under the other two strands; the ends are tapered, scraped down, marled, and served over with spun-yarn. 28. TO WORM AND SERVE A ROPE. Worming a rope, is to fill up the vacant space between the strands of the rope with spun-yarn ; this is done in order to strengthen it, and to render the surface smooth and round for parceling. Parceling a rope is wrapping old canvass round it, cut in strips from two to three inches wide, according to the size of the rope ; the strips of canvass to be well tarred and rolled up in rolls before you commence to lay it on the rope. The service is of spun- yarn, clapped on by a wooden mallet such as you see in the piate, called a serving mallet; it has a large score cut in the under part of it, so as to fay on the rope, arid a handle about a foot long, OT 28 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; according to the size of the mallet. The service is always laid on against the lay of the rope ; a boy passes the ball of spun-yarn at some distance from the man that is serving the rope, and passes it round as he turns the mallet ; when the required length of service is put on, the end is put under the three or four la?* turns of the service and hauled taut. Note. It has always been customary to put on parceling wit! the lay of the rope in all cases ; but rigging that you do not intend to serve over, the parceling ought to be put on the contrary way, 29. TO CLAP ON A THROAT AND QUARTER SEIZING. Splice an eye in one end of the seizing, and take the other end round both parts of the rope that the seizing is to be put on ; then reeve it through the eye, pass a couple of turns and heave them hand-taut ; then make a inarlinespike-liitch on the seizing, by taking a turn with the seizing over the marlinespike, and laying the end over the standing part ; push the marlinespike down through, then under the standing part and up through the bight again. Heave taut the two turns of the seizing with the spike ; pass the rest and heave them taut in the same manner, making six, eight, or ten turns, according to the size of the rope ; then pass the end through the last turn, and pass the riding turns, fiv 7 e, seven, or nine, always laying one less of the riding than of the first turns ; these should not be hove too taut the end is now passed up through the seizing, and two cross-turns taken between the two parts of the rope, and round the seizing ; take the end under the last turn and heave it taut ; make an overhanded knot on the end of the seizing, and cut off close to the knot. Note. When this is put on the end of a rope, and round the standing part, it is called an end-seizing ; if on the two parts below the end, a middle or quarter-seizing. A throat-seizing is passed the same way, but is not crossed with the end of the seizing. 3O. TO MAKE A TURK'S HEAD. Turk's heads are made on man-ropes, and sometimes on the foot-ropes of jib-booms in place of an overhanded knot, as the Turk's head is much neater than the knot, and considered by some an ornament. It is generally made of small white line. Take a round turn round the rope you intend to make the Turk : s head on, cross the bights on each side of the round turn, and stick one end under one cross, and the other under the other cross ; it will then be formed like the middle figure in the plate, Buoy Rope Knot. Knotting, Serving, Worm 111; &c. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 29 after which follow the lead until it shows three parts all round, and it is completed. 31 TO SHEEPSHANK A ROPE OR BACKSTAY. This is intended for shortening a backstay ; the rope is doubled in three parts, as you see in the Plate, and a hitch taken over each bight with the standing part of the backstay and jamed & taut. 32. TO PUT A STRAND IN A ROPE. This is done in case of one strand of a rope getting chafed or magged, and the other two remaining good. To perform this, you take your knife and cut the strand at the place where it is chafed, and unlay it about a couple of feet each way ; then take a strand of a rope as near the size as possible, and lay it in the vacancy of the rope, (as you see in the Plate,) and stick the ends the same as a long splice. 33. TO WALL AND CROWN. Unlay the end of a rope, and with the three strands form a wall knot, by taking the first strand and forming a bight ; take the next strand, and bring it round the end of the first, the third strand round the second, and up through the bight of the first this is a wall. (See Plate.) To crown this, lay one end over the top of the knot, which call the first, then lay the second over it, the third over the second, and through the bight of the first. It will then appear as you see in Plate No. 3. 34. TO MAKE A MATHEW WALKER. A Mathew Walker is made by opening the end of a rope, and taking the first strand round the rope and through its own bight; then take the second end round the rope underneath, through the bight of the first, and through its own bight; the third end take round the same way, underneath and through the bights of all three. Haul the ends well taut, and it will appear as in the Plate. This is a good lanyard knot, if well made. 30 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 35. A SPRITSAIL SHEET KNOT. Unlay two ends of a rope, and place the two parts which aie unlaid together ; form a bight with one strand, and wall the six together against the lay of the rope, (which is hawser-laid,) the same as you would a single wall with three ends ; after you have walled with the six ends, haul them taut ; you must then crown with the six ends, and it will appear as in the Plate. To com- plete it, you must follow the lead of the parts, and double wall and crown it. This knot is frequently used in old-fashioned ships as a stop- per knot. 36. A SHROUD KNOT. Unlay the ends of two ropes and place them one within the other, the same as you commence to make a short splice ; then single wall the ends of one rope round the standing part of the other, and then wall the other three ends in the same manner ; the ends are opened out, tapered down, and served over with spun-yarn. This knot is used when a shroud is either shot or carried away. 37. A FRENCH SHROUD KNOT. Place the ends of two ropes as before, drawing them close together ; then lay the first three ends back upon their own part, and single wall the other three ends round the bights of the other three and the standing part ; it will then appear like the figure in the Plate. The ends are tapered as the other. This knot is much neater than the common shroud knot. 38. SINGLE DIAMOND KNOT. Unlay the end of a rope a sufficient length to make the knot, and with the three strands form three bights, holding the ends fast down the side of the rope in your left hand, with the stand- ing part of the rope ; then take the first strand over the bight of the second strand and through the bight of the third ; then take the second over the third and through the bight of the first ; then the third, over the first and through the second. Haul these taut and lay the ends of the strands up again, and it will appear as in the Plate. This knot is used for jib-boom foot-ropes, man-ror^, &C. OR. YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT 39. DOUBLE DIAMOND KNOT. To make this, you make a single one as before ; then take a marlhiespike and open the strands, and follow the lead through two single bights, the ends coming out at the top of the knot; lay the ends of the strands up as before, and it will appear as in the Plate. 40. A STOPPER KNOT Is made by double -walling and crowning, which has been described before on another page. The ends, if very short, are whipped without being laid up; but if long they are laid up and stopped. 41 A BUOY-ROPE KNOT. Unlay the strands of a cable-laid rope, take one strand out of the large ones, and then lay the three large ones up again aa before ; take the three small ones which were left out, single and double them round the standing part of the rope ; then take youi spare ends, worm them along the lay and stop them. 42. COMMON SENNIT. Sennit is made by plaiting rope-yarns together. (See Plate No. 4.) 43. A SEA GASKET. A sea gasket is made by taking three or four foxes, according to the size you intend to make the gasket. Middle them over a belaying-pin, and plait three or four together, long enough to make the eye ; then clasp both parts together to form the eye j then plait it by bringing the outside foxes on each side alternately over to the middle ; the outside one is laid with the right hand, and the remainder held steadily work the whole together, add- ing a fox when necessary. When you have got it a sufficient length, diminish by dropping a fox at proper intervals. To finish it, you must lay one end up, leaving its bight down ; then plait the others through this bight about one Inch ; haul the bight taut to secure all parts cut the ends off, whip it, and it is completed. 32 riJE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 44. A PANCH, OK WROUGHT MAT. A piece of six or nine-thread stuff is stretched in a horizontal direction, and the foxes (according to the breadth you intend to make the mat) are middled and hung over it ; then take the fox nearest the left hand and twist a turn in the two parts, and one part give to the man opposite (two men being employed to work the mat) ; the next fox has a turn twisted in its two parts, and one part given back to your partner ; the remainder are twisted round the first which are given back, and then again round its own part, and so on with the remainder of the foxes, until you get it the breadth you wish. At the bottom of the mat selvedge it by taking a piece of nine-thread stuff, the same as you used for the top. The two parts of the foxes which are twisted to- gether at the bottom are divided, and the nine-thread put between them ; the foxes are hitched round it, and the end put through its own lay with a marlinespike ; trim the ends off, and thrum it with pieces of old strands of rope, cut in pieces about three or four inches long ; open the lays of the foxes with a marlinespike. push the thrums through the lays, and open the ends out. 45. HARBOR GASKET, OR FRENCH SENNIT. A harbor gasket is made w r ith foxes, something similar to the common sea gasket, but instead of taking the outside fox over all the rest, and bringing it into the middle, you interweave it bet\veen them by taking the outside fox of both sides, and taking it over one and under the other, working it towards the middle, the same as common sennit. 46. POINTING A ROPE. Unlay the end of the rope a sufficient length for pointing, and stop it ; open the strands out into yarns, and take out as many as you think it will require to make the knittles, by splitting the yarns and making one knittle out of every outside yarn ; when they are made, stop them back on the standing part of the rope ; then form the point with the rest of the yarns, by trimming and scraping them down to a proper size, and marl it dow r n with twine divide the knittles, taking every other one up and every other one down ; then take a piece of twine, called the warp, and with it pass these turns very taut, taking a hitch with the last turn every time you pass the w r arp, or filling. Then take the knittles which are up and bring them down, and the ones which are down, up ; hauling them taut, and passing the warp every OR YO'JNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 33 nine over the lower knittles ; proceed in this manner until you get almost to the end, reserving enough of the knittles to finish it with ; leave out every other bight of the knittles of the last lay, and pass the warp through the bight, haul them taut and cut them off. A becket is sometimes worked in the end. Note. Knittles are made by laying rope-yarns together, with your finger and thumb, against the twist of the yarn. Snaking is for the better securing of a seizing, which is passed round the single part of the rope and therefore cannot be crossed. It is done by tucking the end part of the seizing under and over the lower and upper turns of the seizing. 47. TO MAKE A GROMMET. A grommet is made by unlaying a strand of a rope and placing one part over the other ; with the long end follow the lay, until it forms a ring, with three parts of the strand all round ; finish it by knotting and sticking the ends the same as a long splice. (Set, plate No. 4.) 48. TO PASS A ROSE LASHING. It is used in lashing a strap or pudding round a mast or yard or the parral lashing of a top-gallant yard ; this lashing is passed cross way s over and under one eye, then under and over the other ; the end part is afterwards taken in a circular form round the crossing, and the end tucked under the last part. Note. This circular part is done to expend the end > instead of cutting it off, so that it will answer again for the same purpose. 49. TO WEAVE A SWORD MAT. A piece of wood called a sword is used ; this is put alternately between the parts of the spun-yarn or sennit, stretched over two round iron bolts (as you see in the figure) ; the warp of marline is placed through the parts which the sword has opened, and jamed by it close to the head ; a piece of spun-yarn is put slack through the same division at the opposite end and left there ; the sword is taken out. passed under and over the parts as before, and each end of the warp passed and jamed taut. The piece of spun-yarn which was left at the opposite end, is now lifted up, and brings the parts as they were first divided by the sword ; the warp is passed as before, and so on until the mat is coniDleted. 34 s THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 5O. A LASHING CLEAT Is shaped like the figure in the Plate, having scores for the seizings which are marked, and a groove cut in the part that fits next to the shroud. BLOCKS. 51. A SHELL, PIN, AND SHEAVE. Blocks are of different kinds, shapes, and sizes, according to the several purposes for which they are intended. A block consists of a shell, sheave, and pin ; and from the num- ber of these sheaves it derives its name, viz. : a block with one sheave is called single ; with two sheaves, double ; with three, treble ; and with four sheaves it is called a four-fold block. The shell of a block is made of ash, and has one or two scores cut at each end, according to its size ; these scores are for the purpose of admitting a strap, which goes round the block, in the centre of which is a hole for the pin ; the shell is hollow inside to ad- mit the sheave. The sheave is a solid wheel, made of lignum vitse, iron, or brass ; in the centre is a hole for the pin, on which it turns. The lignum vitae sheave is bushed with brass or iron ; round the circumference a groove is cut, that the rope which goes over it may play with ease. The sheave is placed in the shell, and the pin is put through both shell and sheave, which consti- tute a block. 52. SINGLE, DOUBLE, AND TREBLE BLOCKS. What is termed a single block has but one sheave, and if in- tended for a double strap there are two scores on the outside of the shell. Single blocks are more used than any other kind on board of a ship. A double block has an additional sheave ; it is otherwise the same as a single block. A treble block is made in the same manner as a double, with one more sheave. Treble blocks are generally used as purchase blocks, and strapped in the manner you see in the Plate. 53. A SHOULDER BLOCK. A shoulder block is the same as a single block, with the ex- ception that it has a projection at the bottom of the shell, called Gaskets, Mats, Blocks, &c. Oil YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 35 a shoulder, to prevent the rope that reeves through it from jam- ing between the block and the yard. These blocks are mostly used for bumkin or lift blocks on lower vards. 54. A FIDDLE BLOCK Is made like two single blocks one above the other, the uppei one being the largest so as to allow the rope which is rove in the upper sheave, to play clear of the rope in the under one. These blocks are used in places where there is not space enough for a double one, or where it (the double block) would be liable to split by not canting fair, or having room to play. These blocks are used for top burtons, &c. c. 55 A SHOE BLOCK Is also made like two single blocks, but the sheave of the up- per one lies in a contrary direction to that of the lower one. They are generally used as buntline blocks to courses ; the bunt- line reeving in the upper sheave, and the whip in the lower one. 56. A SISTER BLOCK Has two sheave-holes one above the other, three scores for seizings, one at each end, and one between both sheaves ; they are hollowed out on each side of the shell, to take the shroud. These blocks are used as topsail-lift and reef-tackle blocks, and are seized-in between the two forward, shrouds of the topmast rigging, above the futtock stave. The lift reeves through the lower sheave, and the topsail reef-tackle through the upper one. 57 A DEAD-EYE Is a large round piece of wood with three holes in it, (as you see in the Plate,) and a groove cut round it for the shroud to lie in. It is used to turn in the ends of shrouds and backstays; the three holes are used to reeve the lanyard through, when set- ting up the shroud or backstay. A bull's-eye is a kind of thick wooden thimble, with a hole in the centre, and a groove cut round the outside for the rope or seizing to lay in. 36 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; 58. A HEART Is a block of wood with a large hole in the centie, at the bot torn of which are four or five scores, and round the outside is a groove cut to admit a rope called a stay ; there are other hearts called collar-hearts, which are open at the lower ends, opposite to which the lanyard is passed. This heart has a double score cut v ound the outside, and two grooves cut on each side for the seiz ings to lay in, which keeps the collar in the scores of the heart. Hearts intended for bobstays should be made of lignum vitap, those made of ash being liable to split. 59. A BELAYING-PIN RACK Is a piece of wood with a number of holes through it, in whicft belaying-pins are stuck ; on the back part are several scores for the shrouds to lie in to which it is seized. GO. A EUPHROE Is a long piece of wood, having a number of holes, through which the legs of the crowfoot is rove, a score is cut round it to admit of a strap. This is used for the ridge of an awning. 61. A HORN CLEAT. Horn cleats are used for different purposes ; some are made to seize on to the shrouds; they are called lashing cleats ; others are made to nail on to different parts of the bulwarks. They are of different shape and size, and used to belay various ropes to, in all parts of the ship. 62 A 33-CLEAT Is a piece of wood scored out inside, something like the letter B, and rounded off outside ; they are used for leading a rope through, or for keeping it in its place on the masts, bowsprit, dec. 63. A STRAP FOR A BLOCK. Straps are fitted in various ways, according to the ase they are intended for, and according to the size of the block. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 37 A common strap is fitted in the following manner : First, cut the rope once-and-a-half the round of the block, then get it on a stretch, worm, parcel, and serve as near the end aa possible, not to interfere with splicing; then splice the ends together with a short splice, and finish serving snug up to the splice. Stretch it and cut the ends off, or you may serve over the ends, and it will appear as in the Plate. If there is a num- ber of those straps required, it would be best to get the rope on a stretch, and serve off the required number before cutting. 64 A TAIL BLOCK Is strapped with an eye-splice, snug round the block ; the ends are stuck but once ; then scraped down, and served over w r ith spun-yarn. Clap on a stout whipping about six inches from the splice ; open the ends out, twist them into foxes, and plait them together, as mentioned for gaskets ; or, the strands may be opened out and marled down salvagee fashion ; tapering it a little towards the end of the tail. Note. Blocks used for jiggers, have a double tail made in the same manner. 65. A PURCHASE BLOCK Is double strapped, having two scores in the shell for that pur- pose; the strap is wormed, parceled, and served, (sometimes only wormed and parceled,) and spliced together. It is then doubled so as to bring the splice at the bottom of the block. The seizing is put on the same as any other ; the only difference is, that it ia crossed both ways, through the double parts of the strap. These block-straps are so large and stiff, that it requires a pur- chase to set them securely in the scores of the block, and bring them into their proper place. 66. A TOP BLOCK Is a single iron-bound hook-block, with (generally) a brass sheave ; it hooks to an eye-bolt in the cap. The top-pendants are rove through the top-blocks when swaying up topmasts. 4 38 fHE KEDGE- ANCHOR , 67. A CAT BLOCK. The cat block is three-fold, iron-bound, with a large iron hook attached to it, for the purpose of hooking the ring of the anchot when catting it. On the forward side of the shell of this block are two small eye-bolts, for the purpose of fitting a small rope, called the back- rope bridle, used in hooking the cat. 68. A SNATCH BLOCK Is generally iron-bound, with a swivel hook ; an iron clasp is fitted on the iron band, or strap, with a hinge to go over the snatch, and toggles on the opposite side, as you see in the Plate. The bight of a hawser or large rope is placed in this block, when warping the ship, &c. Note. There has been of late years several different improve- ments made on these blocks. Blocks of this description, and of a large size, are generally termed " viol, or rouse-about blocks." 69 A NUN BUOY. Buoys are used when a ship is riding at anchor, to denote the position of the anchor. They are a kind of a cask, large in the middle, and small at both ends ; hooped close with iron hoops, and strapped with rope well served. A buoy-strap is cut nine times the length of the buoy ; this is sufficient to make the slings and hoops ; l,he slings have an eye spliced in each end, the hoops are rove through these eyes, spliced together, and fitted on the buoy, as you see in the Plate. TO. TO BEND A BUOY-ROPE. The buoy rope is made fast with a clove-hitch round the arms of the anchor, close up to the crown, and the end part stopped along the shank, with one or two stops. Some are fitted with a running eye, and when used this way the running eye is rove round one arm, a hitch taken over the Mher, and seized in the cross. Blocks, Purchases, &c. &c. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 39 111 large ships they are fitted with pendants and slip buoy- -opes ; the pendants have a large thimble spliced in one end, .arge enough to receive a stout hawser, in case you should want to purchase the anchor by the buoy-rope. The size for the slip buoy-rope is one- third the size of the proper buoy-rope. 71 TO PUDDING THE RING OF AN ANCHOR. The ring of the anchor is well tarred, and parceled w r ith tarred canvass ; then a number of lengths of old rope are cut three times the diameter of the ring ; these are laid on the ring, and stopped by a temporary seizing in the middle ; they are then placed fair by hand round the rings, as you see in the Plate. When one or "two turns of rattling-stuff is taken round all parts, and a heaver put through it, it is hove well round, which stretches all parts snug round the ring. After it is all hove on neatly, put on the seizings, four in number. (See Plate.) 72. A JACOB : S LADDER. These ladders are used in many different parts of a ship of \var ; they are used for stern ladders, rigging ladders, and on the swinging booms in harbor, &c. There are several different ways of making them ; some are made salvagee fashion, and covered ; others are made of four-stranded rope, and have the rounds put through between the strands of the rope. But the most general way of making these ladders, is to take some small rope, (about two-inch stuff,) and make two straps the length you intend to make the ladder, and splice them together with a short- long-splice. The straps being made, get them on a stretch both together, and see if they bear an equal strain ; if not, shorten one strap, so as to make both alike. Take a piece of chalk and mark off where you intend the rounds to go, about fifteen inches apart. .The rounds are pieces of round wood, about two inches in diameter, of the length required, with a score on each end, for the rope to lay in. Put the rounds in between both parts of the rope, exactly at the chalk mark ; having got them all placed, com- mence and seize them in, by putting on a snug seizing of mar- line on each side of the round ; you may parcel, leather, or serve in the nips, just as may be preferred. 40 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 73. CAN HOOKS Are broad Hat iron hooks, in the eyes of which thimbles aie inserted. What is termed a pair of can hooks, is a piece of rope four or five feet long, or long enough to span a cask from chime to chime. When fitted, one of these hooks are spliced into the end of this rope ; it is then got on a stretch, wormed, parceled and served, and a thimble is sometimes seized in the bight, to hook on to, when lifting a cask. Note. Some are fitted with chain, with a large iron ring in 'he middle. 74. HOGSHEAD SLINGS Is a piece of rope about five fathoms long, and from five to six inches in circumference, with a large thimble spliced in one end, and the other end well whipped. They are used to sling large casks, being more secure than can hooks. They are put on in this manner: pass the bight over one end of the cask, reeve the end through the thimble, and haul it well taut; then take the end round the other end of the cask, and take two half-hitches round the standing part, and it is done. (See Plate.} 75. BARREL SLINGS Are generally made of three inch rope, and of sufficient length to go round the barrel. They are similar to a long strap, spliced together with a short splice ; it is passed round the barrel and one bight rove through the other. They are sometimes made long enough to sling two or three barrels at a time. 76. A SINGLE WHIP. A single whip is the smallest and most simple purchase in use. It is made by reeving a rope through a single block, as you see in the Plate. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 41 77. A GUN-TACKLE PURCHASE i Is made by reeving a rope through a single block, then through another single block, and make the end fast to the one it was first rove through, or splice it into the bottom of the block for neatness. (See Plate.} 7 8. -A LUFF-TACKLE PURCHASE Consists of a double and single block ; the rope is rove through one of the sheave holes of the double block, then through the single one, through the double one again, and the end made fast to the single block, with a becket bend, to a becket in the bottom of the block. (See Plate.} 79. A TOP BURTON Is rove in the same manner as a luff-tackle purchase ; the only difference is, that the upper block of the burton is a fiddle block, Hiile that of the luff is a double one. (See Plate.} SO WHIP AND RUNNER. If a rope is rove through a single block, it is called a whip, as before mentioned ; and if the fall of this whip be spliced round the block of another whip, it becomes whip on whip, or whip and runner. (See Plate.} 81. A RUNNER AND TACKLE Is the same purchase as a luff-tackle applied to a runner. A runner is a large rope rove through a single block, with a hook spliced in one end. (See Plate.} 82 A TWO-FOLD PURCHASE Consists of two double blocks ; the fall is first rove through one sheave of the upper block, then through one of the lower ones ; through the upper one again, then through the lower one, and make the end fast to the upper block. 42 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 83. A THREE-FOLD PURCHASE A three-fold purchase is rove in this way, the blocks having one more sheave, only that you commence to reeve the fall in the middle sheave first, instead of one of the side ones, wnich brings a cross in the fall. The reason of its being rove in this manner, is, that the heaviest strain comes first on the fall part, and if it was rove in the side sheave, it would have a tendency to cant the block in the strap , split the shell of the block, and cut the fall ; but when it is in the middle sheave it draws all down square alike. 84. NAMES OF ROPES. The different kinds of ropes are designated as follows . Hawser-laid and cable-laid rope is all the same ; it is composed of nine strands, each strand having an equal number of yarns. These nine strands are laid into three, by twisting three small ones into one large one ; then the three large ones are laid up, or twisted together left-handed, which makes the nine strands ; this is a hawser-laid, or cabled, rope. A common or plain rope is composed of three strands, of an equal number of yarns twisted together. Shroud-laid rope is made in the same manner, only that it con- sists of four strands instead of three, and a small strand which runs through the middle, termed the heart of the rope. When plain-laid rope is laid up left-handed, it is called back-laid rope. There is also four stranded hawser-laid rope, which is used foj stays, &c. &c. PART II 85. LAUNCHING A SHIP. After the carpenters have completed the hull of the vessel, the necessary preparations for launching are commenced as follows : Get an anchor on each bow ; get the cables on board and bend them to the anchors ; range and bitt the cables ; bend the buoy ropes, and see everything clear for letting go the anchors. It will then be necessary to get four stout hawsers on the spar deck, two on each side ; bend one to the other, and have them coiled down clear for running. This being done, pass the ends of two hawsers out forward, through the warping chocks on eacli bow ; pass the ends aft, one on each side, and make them fast to some secure place, on their respective sides of the launching slip, as clear of the ways as possible. Stop the bights of the hawsers with a single rope-yarn up along the ship's sides, so as not to in- terfere with the ways, or interrupt the progress of the carpenters while knocking away the shores previous to launching. Have men stationed to attend to veering" the hawsers and cables when the ship is off the ways, and also to letting go the anchors, if necessary. Have a few buckets of water ready to throw on the bitts, to prevent any danger that might occur from fire while veering the hawsers and cables. The ways being well greased, and the necessary preparations for launching completed, all the blocks and wedges by which the ship was formerly supported, are driven out from under her keel, until the whole weight gradually subsides upon the sliding ways, or cradle ; a few shores, or stanchions, remain, by which she is retained on the stocks until the period for launching arrives, which is generally at high water ; they are then cut away, and all obstructions removed, with the exception of the dogshore (a representation of which is given in the Plate). The word is given " to launch" the dogshore is then knocked away, which causes her to advance down the inclined plane into the water. If the ship should hang after the dogshore is removed, it will be necessary to af nl-v screws under tlu fore-foot, which will 14 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; her to move immediately along the ways. The ways generally extend a sufficient depth under the surface of the water to float the vessel when she arrives at the extreme ends. When the ship is off the stocks " veer away roundly," and do not attempt to check her until she begins to deaden her way, then check her " handsomely " with the hawsers so as not to part them ; if, however, they should part, let go an anchor immedi- ately; if that should not bring her up, let go the other anchor, and veer gradually on both cables until she is brought up. Note. When a ship is to be launched it is always customary to hoist the ensign, jack, and pennant ; the jack forward, ensign aft, and the pennant amidships. FlagstafFs are erected for that purpose previous to launching, as represented in the Plate, where you see a ship of war ready to be launched from the stocks. 86. CUTTING OUT STANDING RIGGING. Lower Rigging. Measure the distance from the larboard side of the mast-head to the foremost dead-eye in the starboard chan- nels, which distance set off on the floor of the rigging loft and stick in a marlinespike at each extremity. The shroud stuff being stretched, stop one end to one of the marlinespikes ; take the bight round the other and back again : this is the first pair of shrouds ; pass it round again, outside at each end, for the second pair, and continue in this manner until one gang of rigging is completed. Mark the length of the eyes straight across at the opposite end, to the one stopped to the marlinespike ; cut at the latter in an angular direction (so that the after-legs will be a little longer than the forward ones), and the inside pair will be the first pair of shrouds. Hitch a piece of spun-yarn round each shroud, in the centre of the eye, making knots on it according to the number of the shroud, commencing the inside pair with one knot. The mark for the length of the eye gives the place for the eye-seizing; the round of the rope giving their place on the mast-head. (Old fashion.) The proportion for the eye is the round of the mast-head above the bolsters ; I have also seen the breadth of the seizing added (some allow five squares of the mast-head, which is the best rule), supposing it would lay fairer on the side of the bolsters than too close to the mast-head. This precaution is hardly necessary, a? the rigging will stretch sufficiently in pulling up to bring the seizing down, no matter how much it may have been stretched before being warped round for cutting. Rigging cut on the above old plan, causes great waste in squaring off the ends, after fitting the eves, previous to lurmng- in the dead-eyes. I would therefore recoimnena (if not In a great Sketch ot a Draft for cutting rigging. Oil YOUSG- SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 43 hurry) a more economical plan. Get the shroud-warp on a stretch, or rather one end of it, long enough for one pair oi shrouds ; mark off the distance for the required service, and when completed being wormed, parceled, and served, while on a tan*, stretch measure the length with a tape-line, from draft of first pair of shrouds, No. 1 starboard; when measured and chalked the required length, " come up the stretch," and cut at the chalk- mark ; middle the shroud at the centre of the service, and lay it on the loft floor. Continue fitting, and cutting, in this way until you get the number of shrouds required for the gang, allowing each pair of shrouds to lap over the diameter of the rope at the eye, as they are laid on the loft floor ; alternately making due allowance at the ends, before cutting, for the carry aft, or the jump of a port, if required. (See Plate.} Note. In measuring the length of the shrouds, some prefer the distance from the opposite side of the mast-head to the part- ners, added to half the breadth of the deck, from the mast to the side. In parceling, begin at each end where the service is to leave off, and parcel upwards to the middle of the eye, where com- mence serving downwards on each leg. The eye seizings are round ones, and when put on, the whole eye is neatly covered with parceling. A half-sister block is sometimes put between the two forward shrouds, for the lower boom topping lift to lead through. 87. TOPMAST AND TOP-GALLANT RIGGING Is cut in the same manner. In fitting the topmast rigging, always seize-in a sister-block between the two forward shrouds, for the topsail lift and reef tackles. The swifters are generally served the whole length. The eyes of the top-gallant rigging are made to fit exactly around the cylinder; if there is an odd topmast, or top-gallant shroud, on each side, they are either fitted with a horse-shoe eye, or go together with a cut splice. 8 8. -BREAST AND STANDING BACKSTAYS. These may be cut by the same rule ; the eyes of the breast backstays are fitted in different ways. They are sometimes spanned together, making a square, the size of the mast-head ; sometimes they have an eye like the shrouds, made to fit close and others have a srna!! eye seized in the bigtii, and lashed 46 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; round the mast-head. The eyes of the standing backstays are fitted like those of the shrouds. 89. CAT HARPEN LEGS, AND FUTTOCK SHROUDS. Take one-third the breadth of the top, and lay of that distance from the eye-seizing, down upon the shrouds, each side ; draw a line across which will represent the cat harpens, and measured on the scale, will give their length ; splice in eyes at each end ; worm, parcel, serve, and leather them. The distance from the extremity of the top and this line upon the shroud, will give the length of the futtock shrouds, which must have a hook and thim- ble in their upper ends, and a thimble in their lower ends. 9O. FORE-AND-AFT STAYS. Measure from the after parts of the mast-head to where the stays set up, and to this distance add the length of the mast- head, for collars. Collars for stays are the length of their respective mast-heads. The mousings are raised once-and-a-half the size of the stays, and at a distance equal to twice the length of the mast-head from the mousing. A Flemish eye is worked on the end, and the stay rove through it ; or they may be fitted with lashing eyes, in which case each leg is the length of the mast-head ; the service is con- tinued the length of the eye below the mousing, the collars leathered, and the hearts turned in with the lay of the rope. Stays are wormed, parcelled, served, and leathered in the wake of all nipps, such as the bees, bullock-blocks, and sheave-holes. 91. CUTTING LOWER MAST HEAD-PENDANTS. The forward pair should be twice the length of the mast-head the after pair twice-and-a-half; thimbles are spliced in the ends, and they are wormed or spanned together, so as to form a span to fit the mast-head. 92. BOBSTAYS. The bobstays are cut twice the length from the collars, on the oowsprit, to their respective holes on the cutwater. They arr OR YOUJNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 47 wormed, parceled, and served the whole length, and leathered in the nipp, after which they are rove through the holes, spliced to- gether, and the dead eyes turned in, in the wake of a splice. 93. BOWSPRIT SHROUDS. The length from the bowsprit to the eye-bolts in the bows ; a dead-eye or heart is spliced into one end, and a hook and thimble in the other. 94. JIB AND FLYING JIB GUYS. Take the distance from the boom-end to the bows, making a small allowance for reeving through the straps on the spritsail yard. They are generally fitted with a cuckold's neck over the boom end, and set up with dead-eyes to the bows. The cuck- old's neck is served or covered with canvass. The guys in the wake of the spritsail yard are leathered. The martingales must be cut, and fitted to the manner in which they are rove. 95. CUTTING RUNNING RIGGING. The greater part of the running rigging may be cut as it is rove, making due allowance for the hands to clap on. The length and size may also be got from the rigging table for all classes in the navy (see rigging tables). The most proper way to ascertain the length of a rope is from the draft, or rigging plan of the vessel you are employed upon, making the proper allowance for leading out, &c., &c. 9G RIGGING SHEERS, AND TAKING IN MASTS AND BOWSPRIT. In cases where there is neither sheers nor wharf to have re- course to, in order to get the lower masts on board, it becomes necessary to get such spars as can be procured, and erect a pair of sheers on board for that purpose. In doing this proceed as follows : Take in a sufficiency of ballast to steady the ship, and shore the decks from the skin up, 5 48 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; particularly abreast of the partners. Sling skids up and down the sides : reeve the parbuckles, and bring the sheer legs along- side, with their small ends aft ; parbuckle them on board, raise one leg over the capstan, and their heads or after ends resting either on the taffrail, the break of the poop, or a spar placed in the most convenient spot, the more elevated the better. Square the heels exactly one with the other, so that when they come to be raised the legs may be found of equal height. As near the after ends of the spars as may be considered necessary, when crossed, put on the head-lashing of new, well-stretched rope (jlgure-of-S fashioii), similar to a racking seizing, and cross with the ends. Open out the heels, carrying one over to each gangway, and placing it on a solid piece of oak or shoe, previously prepared for the purpose. Clap stout tackles on the heels, two on each, one leading forward, the other aft ; set taut the after ones, and belay them. Lash a three or four-fold block, as the upper one of the main purchase, over the main lashing (so that it will hang plumb under the cross), with can- vass underneath to prevent chafing ; and in such a manner that one-half the turns of the lashing may go over each horn of the sheers, and divide the strain equally ; also sufficiently long to secure the free action of the block. Lash the small purchase block on the after horn of the sheers, sufficiently high for the ."alls to play clear of each other, and a girtline block above all. Middle a couple of hawsers, and clove-hitch them over the sheer heads having two ends leading forward, ond two abaft, led through viol blocks, and stout luffs clapped on them. These should be sufficiently strong to secure the sheers while lifting the masts. The lower purchase block is lashed forward (perhaps round the cut-water), and the fall being rove, the sheers are raised by heaving upon it, and preventing the heels from slipping forward, by means of the heel tackles previously mentioned. Sometimes a small pair of sheers are erected for the purpose of raising the heads of the large ones ; in which case care must be taken to place them so as to allow the heads or horns of the other pair to pass through. When the sheers are up, or nearly perpendicular, cleat the shoes, so as to confine the heels to their places upon them. They can then be transported along the deck by means of the heel- tackles and guys to the situation required, taking care to make them rest upon a beam, and to have the deck properly shored up below. Finally, give the sheers the necessary rake by means of the guys, and set taut all the guys and heel-tackles. Also, five or six feet above the deck, on each leg, put two cleats, for the pur- pose of applying two stout lashings from them above, to the dead- eyes in the channels below, in order to give greater security; this being done, the sheers may be considered ready. (See Plate). FIG. 1. na. 3. Method of formins .Sheers, and remov- ing a Ma inmost, by means ol'2Topm 'at Masting and Dismasting. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 49 Note. The skids which are slung up and down the sides, are for the purpose of keeping the sheer-legs clear of the channels, and from thence to the plank shear. Mats should also be placed over the quarter galleys to prevent injury. Parbuckles are hawsers which are middled ; the ends of which are taken through two ports which are about five or si A ports apart, from outside, in ; down over the rail, under the sheer legs: up again through snatch blocks, in the opposite water-way?, and luffs clapped on them. The counter parbuckles are usea to ease the sheer legs down on deck, and are rove through the pun-deck ports. Mats should be placed in the wake of the chale, where the parbuckle leads over the rail, or up through the un-cler.k ports. The parbuckling on board of heavy spars for sheers may be much facilitated at times, and injury to the ship avoided, by at- tending to circumstances, and getting them in at slack water, or over the bows or stem. When a ship is confined to her own resources, the lower yards are the best spars for sheers ; the heels (or yard-arms lasting on the deck) being strengthened where they taper by a temporary fish, woolded on, and the woolding set up by wedges. In a brig, the main yard and main boom are the best spars for sheers (if other spars are not available). The shoes are made of either stout oak plank or beam Limbers of pine, and long enough to extend over at least thr^e beams, with a saucer in them for the heels to rest in ; likewise, mortices or bolts in each end for lashing. The spare caps will je found veiy handy for placing the heels of the spars in, and ihe eye- bolts in them convenient for hooking the heel-tackles, and trans- porting alcng the decks. 50 THE KEDGE-ANCHOfi; *J7. TO TAKE IN THE MIZEN-MAST. Tow the mizen-mast alongside, with the head aft, and the gar- land* lashed on to the forward part of the mast, at the distance from the tennon to just above the spar deck partners ; lash a pan of girtline blocks on the mast-head, and reeve the girtlines ; bend the sheer-head girtline to the mast below the bibbs to cant it. Overhaul the main purchase down abaft, thrust the strap through the eyes of the garland, toggle it, and secure the toggle by a back- lashing. Take the fall to the capstan and " heave round ;" when the heel rises near the rail, hook on a heel-tackle to ease it in- board. Get the mast fair for lowering by means of the girtlines, have carpenters attending below, wipe the tennon dry, and white lead both it and the step, "lower away," and step the mast. Pass a couple of straps around the mast ; to each of these hook the double blocks of the pendant tackles the single ones * Garlands are made of new rope, well stretched (salvagee fashion), marled together and parceled. They are laid on the forward part of the mast, a stout jashing put on over all, and crossed between the garland and the mast ; a good clogging also, if necessary, passed downward. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 5] to the sides, and ha iled taut ; wedge the mast temporarily, "come up" the purchases, man the guy and heel tackles, wet the decks, and transport the sheers forward for taking in the main-mast. The object of taking in the mizen-mast first is, because the breadth of beam is less aft than forward ; and the heels of the sheers being spread more as they go forward, the head lashing consequently becomes tauter ; moreover, if the mizen-mast was taken in last, the bowsprit must be got in first, and thus the ad- cantage of securing the sheers to the foremast-head, when get- ting in the bowsprit, would be lost. 98. TO TAKE IN THE MAIN AND FOREMAST. Proceed in the same manner as in getting in the mizen mast. The garland for the small purchase should be lashed about the diameter of the mast, above the main purchase. In taking in either of the masts, if the sheers should be found to be a few inches short, the difficulty may be remedied by man- ning the forward guy-falls, and bringing the sheers perpendicu- lar to the deck. Some distance may also be saved by using no garlands and having the purchase blocks lashed to the mast. If in lowering there should still be a difficulty, chocks might be placed on the kelson until the tennon rested on them ; then steady the mast by means of the small purchase and sheer-head girt- lines, while the main purchase is unlashed, and lashed again on the mast sufficiently high to step it. If the ship has a top-gallant forecastle, it would be well to step the mast forward of the sheer legs, for the brake of the forecas- tle comes abreast of the partners ; and, in a case of this kind, it would be well to take in the foremast first. 99. TO TAKE IN THE BOWSPRIT. Transport the sheers as far forward as possible, or as the bows will permit ; send a hand to the sheer-head, bend on the girtlines to the small purchase block to light it up, unlash it, and lash it again to the forward fork or horns of the sheers, pass a strap round the foremast-head, to which hook a large tackle, carry it well aft, and haul it taut, for the purpose of staying the mast. Lash a couple of large single blocks to the foremast-head, middle a hawser, and clove-hitch it over the sheer-head ; reeve the ends through the blocks at the mast-head, down on deck, carry them well aft, and take a turn. Hook the after heel-tackles forward, 52 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR, and take the after-guys aft ; pass a bulwark lashing round eacn heel, rake the sheers over the bows sufficiently for the main pur- chase to hang directly over the gammoning scuttle, and make all fast. The bowsprit being brought under the bows, with the head forward, and the garlands lashed on, the main one a little more than one-third from the heel, the smaller one between the cap and bees, having guys leading from the bowsprit to the cat-heads, and a couple of straps round the heel for hooking the bedding tackles. Overhaul down the purchases and toggle them ; " sw r ay away," attending it by the guys, until nearly perpendicular ; hook on the bedding tackles, which are taken from the bitts on the main deck, and led up through the partners ; wipe the tennon dry, and white-lead both it and the mortice ; " lower away," bouse upon the bedding tackles, and bring it into its place ; come up purchases, guys, unlash garlands, and proceed to dismantle the sheers. If the ship has a topgallant forecastle, you will be unable to take in the bowsprit with the sheers without the assistance of a derrick* on account of the brake of the forecastle, it not being prudent to step sheers on the top of it. When the ship is masted, and alongside the yard, commence getting on board and stowing ballast and tanks ; fit the rudder, gammon the bowsprit, fit and set up the bob stays and bowsprit shrouds ; fit fore stay collars ; get on board tops, caps, cross-trees, topmasts and topgallant masts, placing lower yards athwart ships, topsail and topgallant yards amidships ; also, have ready tackles and luffs for setting up the rigging and staying the masts, top- blocks with lashings for top-ropes, and all the rigging at hand and in order. 1OO. GAMMONING THE BOWSPRIT. in rigging a stage under the bowsprit for this purpose, make use of two small spars, such as topgallant studding-sail booms, with their heels lashed to the head-rail, their heads frapped toge- ther, and slung from the bowsprit end, and boards laid across from one to the other. The gammoning is of new, well-stretched rope, generally water-laid. One end of the gammoning being whipt, is passed through the hole in the cutwater, and over the bowsprit with a round turn, then clenched round the bowsprit close against the stop or cleats ; the other end passes through the forepart of the hole in the cutwater, again round the bowsprit (but before the * See Derrick, in Miscellaneous Articles. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 53 clinch), and again through the hole in the cutwater, abaft the first turn. All the succeeding turns go in the same way, laying forward on the bowsprit and aft in the cutwater, and all are passed inside of the first turns ; by which means the outer turns on the bowsprit which bear the most strain are more preserved from chafing than the inner ones. The turns are then hove taut as follows : A leading block is made fast to the holes for the bobstays by a strap long enough to admit of the pendant, which is then rove through it, leading straight through the hawse-hole to the capstan. In one end of this pendant an eye is spliced, through which a bight of the gammoning is passed, and retained by means of a toggle, while to the other end is hooked a long tackle, and the fall led to the capstan. As each turn is hove taut, it is, by some, nailed to the bowsprit, and by others, racked in several places, which is pre- ferable to nailing.* When all the turns are passed and hove taut, they are frapped together by as many crossturns as are passed on the bowsprit. The end is then whipped and seized to one of the turns. In ships with two gammonings, the outer one is hove taut first, as it w r ould otherwise slack the inner one. Note. Iron gammoning is now allowed for vessels of all classes in the service. (See Rigging Table.} 101. FITTING RIGGING. The shroud is hove well taut, with a tackle clapped on one end, and the other secured to a sampson post. It is wormed, parceled, and served a third down from the seizing ; the swifter or foremost shroud all the way, except where the dead-eye is turned in. A sword mat is sometimes laced on the foremost shroud, which, I think, answers much better, as it can be taken off and the rope dried ; and, from the different ropes I have seen rotted under the service, I feel convinced, the less on rigging, unless where absolutely necessary, the better. In parceling the eyes, commence from each end of the service and finish in the centre, and pass several riding parts, as in breaking the shroud to form the eye, the service gets opened, which allows the wet to get in ; and if the service is begun in the centre, dojbled, and then passed toward each end, it will prevent the wet getting to the rope. In forming the eye, take a good strand, knot both ends toge- ther, and lay it across both parts of the shroud ; having brought them as close together as possible, pass both bights of the strand * See Gammoning the Bowsprit, in Miscellaneous Articles. 54 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; under the shroud clear of each other ; then place a long- bell across, close to the strand on the upper side ; take a round turn round the bolt with each bight of the strand on each side of the shroud, put a smaller bolt through each eye in the strand, and heave it round the long bolt, and as the turns accumulate on the bolt, both parts of the shroud come together ; when quite close pass the eye seizing, the shroud being previously parceled in the way of it. When there is an odd on each side, it is fitted horse-shce fash- ion to fit the mast-head ; parceled, and served over a third down the same as the other shrouds. I have seen the odd shroud put on the mast-head first (after the pendants), instead of last ; and then the others put on in rotation : No. 1 starboard, No. 2 lar- board, No. 3 starboard, &c. &c. 1 02. FITTING MAST-HEAD PENDANTS. The long leg, when two, should be a third of the shroud. The eye is formed the same as the shroud : wormed, parceled, &c. A thimble is spliced in each end, the ends put in once and a- half, marled down, and served over. The formost leg is once and a-half the round of the rope shorter than the after one. The thimbles are well parceled before being spliced in. Small ships have only one pendant on each side ; when this is the case, the rope is cut to the proper length, the starboard pen- dant is spliced into the larboard, and the larboard into the star- board, with a cut splice forming an eye, or span, to fit the square of the mast-head ; a thimble is spliced into each end, and they are wormed, parceled and served ; they are the same length as a long leg, when a pair on each side. 103. LOWER AND TOPMAST STAYS. Stays are four stranded, and are now both the same size, and lashed abaft the mast-heads. The legs are made for the collar in laying up. When sufficient length is laid up for the stay, from whence the collar commences to the end for setting up, two strands, one for each, are left sufficiently long to double back, and are then laid up as four strands, forming the lashing eyes and legs. The ends of the strands are then unlaid, the inside ones wormed into the lay of the rope ; the other strands are divi- ded, laid up, and worked in alongside the first strands ; then some more yarns are twisted smaller and used as backing; some in- side yarns from each strand should be wormed into the stay theii OR YOUNG SAILORS* ASSISTANT. 55 ivhole length, below the crotch ; the legs are then wormed so as io completely fill the rope, commencing from the centre of the eyes for lashing, which should be well opened with a large set- ing fid, and worming carried into the stay as far down as the worming of the legs. The outside yarns of the legs are then marled down, over all, round the stay, tapering the ends. The legs are well parceled and served, and likewise the stay, sufficiently far down to take the lower yards, and covered with tanned hide. The stays should be hove well out with purchases, and allowed to hang, pulling up occasionally. I have known a line-of-battle ship's stays (cable laid rope) to stretch out twelve feet, and after a two month's cruise were long enough to allow nearly two feet to be taken off the fore-stays. Stays fitted with lashing eyes are decidedly preferable, as they are easier shifted ; the collars not being so long the yards can be slung higher up, and consequently braced further forward. In the merchant service the stays are also fitted on the bight, or two in one, as follows : the bight is put over the mast-head and both ends taken forward and set up in their respective places. Others again put the bight under the bowsprit and set them up abaft the mast head, with lashing eyes, putting on a seizing at the proper place to form the collar. This last plan would not answer for a ship of war. 1O4 TO RIG THE FOREMAST. White-lead the mast-head in the wake of the trestle-trees, over haul down the girtlines, bend on the trestle-trees and sway them on board; take out the after chock, wipe them dry, bend the girtlines to the forward part and stop the girtlines to the after part ; bend the main girtline to the after part also ; " sway away," having a steadying-line forward to keep the trestle-trees from catching under the bibbs, for if they should be heavy, one man aloft will not be able to bear them off; when above the bibbs, send a hand aloft to slip the stops, one at a time, so as to let them come down gradually. " Lower away," bouse on the after girtlines, and get the trestle-trees in their places ; send aloft the after chock, ship and bolt it. Tar the mast-head in the way of the rigging ; overhaul down the girtlines for the bolsters, which are tarred and parceled ; sway them aloft and stop them ; lash the girtline blocks to the after part of trestle-trees. The rigging is then sent up by the girtlines in the following manner : Mast head pendants. Foremost pair of shrouds, starboard side; foremost pair of shrouds, larboard side; second pair of shrouds, starboard side ; second pair of shrouds, larboard side, 56 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; and so on until all the shrouds are over, after which send up the stay, and last of all the preventer or spring-stay. Placing the rigging. The girtlines being overhauled down send aloft the lower pendants, which have got a long and short leg, fitted together with a span, or square, the size of the mast-head ; the long leg is placed abaft, so that in case of the forestay being shot away, the pendant tackles can be hooked in them without being in the way of the fore-yard in bracing ; while the leg being abaft, the mast affords them good security. As soon as the mast-head pendants are placed they ought to be lashed abaft, the tackles hooked, and the mast stayed by them. Overhaul down the girtlines, bend the mast-head one on the shroud, with a timber-hitch, or toggle, four or five feet below the seizing, and stop it to the centre of the eye ; take the girtline from the after trestle-tree, and bend it half way down the shroud ; "sway away," on the lower girtline, and lift the weight of the shroud. When high enough, the stop in the eye is cut, and it will fall over the mast-head ; the nien on the trestle-tress placing it fair on the bolsters, beating it well down, with commanders, and observing to have the eye-seizing come as near the centre of the mast-head as possible. The larboard pair is got up in the same manner, and so on until all are placed. Reeve the lan- yards, if prepared with a knot on the end ; a double-wall and crowned is preferable, a mathew-walker being liable to capsize ; the lanyard should be rove through the hole under the end of the shroud, because in setting it up, the strain comes on the shroud first, and keeps the dead-eye in its place ; if put under the standing part, the strain coming on the end first, the dead- eye would slue round. Setting up the lower rigging. The rigging is often placed and then set up, but I would prefer (if time would permit) having it pulled up as placed. When the first pair on each side are over and placed, and the lanyards rove through both dead-eyes, clap a selvagee strap on each shroud well up ; to this hook the single block of a luff tackle ; the double, to a blackwall hitch in the lanyard ; then take the lower blocks of the pendant tackles and hook them to both the falls of the luffs on each side ; reeve the tackle falls through the leading blocks, and pull up, setting up both pair of shrouds at the same time, the men on the trestle-trees beating the shroud down as pulled up ; when well up, place two pair more, and proceed in this manner until the mast is rigged/ The advantage of pulling up a pair at each side, instead of singly, is evident from the fact that pulling up singly injures the seizing ; as it is first dragged forward and then aft by the after * See note on lowei rigging. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 57 leg-, it is liable to slack the seizing, and perhaps snap the inside turns. In rigging the lower masts, I have seen the after swifter go over first ; a plan that is now adopted in small vessels. In stay- ing the mast these swifters should be set taut, the mast being previously wedged, and the stays set steadily up. I have heard some old sailors dispute this plan, it being new, but for my own part I think \vell of it. Note. The trestle-trees might be got over without knocking out the after-chocks, by running up a derrick abaft the mast, well lashed abaft below the bibbs, having chocks placed between it and the mast, sufficient to admit of the free passage of the after chock of the trestle-trees. They are sometimes got on before getting in the mast, but they then bring in an additional and unnecessary weight upon the mast-head, and moreover, in low- ering, catch over the shear-head. N. B. The blocks for topmast stays should be put on after the second pair of shrouds (on foremast). 1O5. FUTTOCK SHROUDS Are now fitted, and hooked to the futtock plates in the top, aid eet up to an iron band round the mast. In small vessels these are iron, and set up with turnbuckles, or screws. Cat-harpens are seldom used, being considered unnecessary lumber aloft. Note. The futtock shrouds are hooked to their respective plates, with the points of the hooks in. 58 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR , 1O6. TO RIG THE MAIN AND MIZEN-MAST. Proceed in the same manner as directed for the foremast The mainmast of a frigate has one more pair of shouds than the foremast, and the mizen-mast three less. The mizen-mast has only one pendant on each side, fitted with a cut-splice, and thimble spliced in each end. The rigging is placed the same as the fore or main ; the mast is steadied into its place with a couple of long burtons, one to each pendant, and hooked to straps round the bitts, or to ring-bolts in the fore part of the quarter- deck bulwarks. If the stays are not ready for going up, the tackles can be hooked to a lashing round the mast, the pendants being wanted to pull up the rigging (for placing) ; the rigging is the same as the fore. In setting up the main-stays, pass one under, the other over, around the cross-piece in the four bitts, for the purpose ; clap the selvagee straps well up the stay, and two more near the ends ; to these hook two luffs ; to the falls of the luffs hook the lower blocks of main tackles ; reeve their falls through leading blocks, in as direct a line with the stay as possible, and grease the bitts in the way of the stay. In placing the main stays, in the manner mentioned above, there is sufficient space between the stays for a shot to pass through, which often prevents their being both cut aw r ay at the same time. When the rigging is to be set up for a full due, the stays in the way of the bitts are well wormed, parceled, served, and covered with hide ; and the ends of the stays, and all the lower rigging whipped, and covered with canvass caps (neatly fitted). 1O7. TO RIG THE BOWSPRIT. Bobstays. The rope should be well stretched, wormed, par- celed, and served, and in the way of the cutwater covered with leather ; when none is to be had, pass two parts of parceling, the first against, the second with the lay of the rope ; and serve with good stout spun-yarn, or four-yarn plait ; then reeve them through the cutwater, splice both ends together, put the strands in once each way, marl down, and serve over. The hearts are then se- cured in their place (keeping the splice on the upper side) with a round seizing, with parceling under it. They are sometimes fit- ted to shackle to the cutwater, with iron plates let in flush with the wood, a bolt going through both plates, which is very snug and strong. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 59 Bowsprit Shrouds are single pieces of rope When cut the required length (a hook and thim- ble), the latter parceled, is spliced into one end, put in once-and-a-half, marled down and served over ; a heart is spliced into the other. After being hooked to eye-bolts in the bows for the purpose, they are set up to their collars on the bowsprit. A celebrated master (now a commander) in the navy, and a first rate seaman, never served the bowsprit rigging all over ; it is, certainly. in my opinion, better not to do so, as the water can never lodge, which it may do, by getting in from broken service, which can not be repaired at sea. They are now fitted one-third chain, on account of the chain cable chafing against them. It is not unusual, in small vessels, to insert thimbles instead of hearts in the bobstays. bowsprit shrouds, and collars ; covering the lanyards neatly afterwards, with canvass. Placing the rigging. Tar well the bowsprit ; then put on the first forestay collar, first pair bowsprit shroud collars, first bobstay collar ; second bobstay collar ; second pair of shroud collars ; spring-stay collar ; and cap bobstay collar ; then heave them close up, pass and heave well on with a rose-lashing. The man-ropes are spliced, or hooked into bolts in the bowsprit cap, and in the other end an eye is spliced ; ends put in once-and- a-half, and set up with a lanyard to an eye-bolt in knight-heads or stanchions, for the purpose ; splices served over, and leathered in the nip. The goblines* are either clove-hitched, or may be fitted with a cuckold's neck around the end of the dolphin-striker, and set up to the bows, one on each side. 1 OS. GETTING THE TOPS OVER Whole tops. Overhaul the girtlines for the cross-trees, white- lead the squares in the trestle-trees, and ship them. The girt- lines being on each side of the mast-head are then overhauled down for the tops ; one end is passed from underneath, and up through the hole for futtock plate and hitched to the standing part ; the girtline can be rove down through one of the holes in the edge of lubber's hole ; the girtline stopped to the foremost edge, to holes bored for the purpose. A girtline is taken from * Called back-ropes by some. 60 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; the mizen-mast-head, and bent to the foremost part of maintop bend on a tripping line to the pigeon hole leading from the fore mast-head. Man the girtlines and "sway away;" when suf- ficiently high to allow the foremost edge of lubber's hole to clear the mast-head, cut the stops and cant it over by the trip- ping line, and the top will hang in the girtlines, when it can be lowered, placed, and bolted. I have seen girtlines bent from the foremost part of the fore-top to the bowsprit end ; and from foremast to the forward part of the maintop ; and from mainmast to foremost part of mizen-top, to assist in getting the tops over ; but if they are properly slung it is not necessary. The dead-eyes for the topmast rigging can now be hauled up, and put in their places in the top-rims : and also ship the top-rail, and stanchions in their respective places. 1O9. GETTING HALF-TOPS OVER. Unlash the girtline blocks from each side of the mast-head, and lash them on the foremost and after sides ; send the end of the foremost girtline down abaft all, the other between the cross- trees. If the starboard half is to be got over, place it on the deck with its upper side up, or on its edge with the upper side aft. Take the foremost girtline, reeve it down through the foremost hole, by lubber's hole for the purpose, (or from aft forward, if on its edge,) take it underneath the top, and if the hole for the futtock plate will take it, reeve it up, (or from forward, aft, if on its edge,) and half-hitch it to the mast-head, or standing part ; then take the mast-head part under the top, (if on its edge, to the foremost side,) and seize it well to the foremost corner with a piece of small rope, through a hole bored for the purpose. Take the after girt- line, reeve it the same way through the after hole bored for the purpose in the after part of lubber's hole ; pass, and half-hitch it the same way as the fore one, and secure it with a good seizing of small rope, through another hole bored in the foremost corner. If the futtock holes will not take the girtlines, stop them with spun-yarn. The top should be so balanced in the girtlines, as to hang fair when the stops are cut. Reeve the other ends of the girtlines through the leading blocks ; man them, and sway up the top with the after girtline ; at the same time taking in the slack of the fore one. Have men stationed at the trestle-trees to bear off, cut the stops, and place. When the edge is clear of the cross-trees, cut the after stop and sway on both girtlines ; and when the foremost corner is well up, cut the stops ; the top then hang in the girtlines, and can be easily place*!. Shift OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. fj i the girtlines for the larboard half, get it up the same way, bolt and secure the top. Shift the girtlines on each side of the mast head, as they were before. A girtline from the mizenmast-head is sometimes bent to the foremost ed^e of the main-top, to assist in bearing off; (it can be dispensed with ;) a rope's end bent to the top and hauled well aft, will answer the same purpose. Half- tops may be swayed up, before the cross trees are sent aloft, and hung to the mast-head, one half on each side, swayed chock up; then send up the cross-trees, and bolt them to. the trestle- trees ; lower the half tops down on the cross-trees ; place and secure them as before. Note. In cold weather it would be best to get the tops over before rigging the masts, in order to give the men a more secure place for standing while placing the rigging ; and in this case a derrick rigged on the top would be the best way to get the rig- ing over in a heavy ship. (If the topmast is pointed and swayed about six feet above the lower mast-head, it will make a good derrick for getting the lower rigging over.) 110. GETTING UP TOP-BLOCKS, &c. Top-blocks are large single blocks, having iron straps, which are formed after being put round the block, into a large hook. Overhaul down the girtlines through lubber's hole ; bend one part through the sheave hole of the block, and stop it to the back part of the hook ; hoist it up, and lash it to the mast-head around the hook, with a lashing long enough to allow the block to hang half-mast-head high. Through this block reeve a hawser ; send the foremost end down through the square hole in the foremost part of the trestle-trees ; the after end through the lubber's hole through a leading block on deck, and round the capstan. 111. GETTING UP THE TOPMAST. Take two half-hitches through the fid-hole, with the foremost end of the hawser, and stop the hawser well round the hounds of the topmast with a good lashing. Man the capstan, and heave the mast up and down. Unbend the hawser, reeve it through the sheave-hole in the topmast; send a hauling line down '.hrouffh the trestle-trees for the end of the hawser, which haul THE KEDGE- ANCHOR , up and clinch round the lower mast-head over the block. Over- haul the girtlines down before all, and get the cap into the top Note. Pendant tackles may be used to a greater advantage than a hawser in pointing a topmast, when light handed. 112. GETTING THE CAP INTO THE TOP. Bend the foremost end of the girtlines, which were sent dawn before all, through the round hole in the cap, and stop them along to the after part of the square hole, keeping the bolts in the cap up* Man the girtlines and " sway away," bearing well off the fore part of the top. When high enough, low r er, and place the round hole over the square hole in the trestle-trees. Sway the topmast well through and lash it securely to the cap ; put a capstan bar in the fid-hole with a hauling line on the end, and heave the topmast up ; when the cap is clear of the lower mast-head, haul on the line from the bar in the heel of the topmast, and it will slue the mast and bring the square hole of the cap over the lower masthead ; ship the cap-shore, then lower the hawser, or tackle, and place the cap, beating it into its place. Land the mast, unreeve the hawser, unlash the top blocks, and hook them to their proper bolts on each side of the cap ; reeve the hawser through one block, through the trestle-trees, through the sheave in the top-mast up through trestle-trees again, and reeve the end through the foremost bolt in the cap on the opposite side of the block ; before reeving it through, parcel it well ; take two half-hitches on its own, or standing part, and secure the end with a round seiz- ing of spun-yarn. Bring the hawser to the capstan, heave the topmast up and try the fit ; (then lower away, get the topmast or deck, and try the other set) ; and then lower the mast for rigging Secure the girtline blocks to eye-bolts in the cap, or to the top mast cross-trees. Note. The stop should be taken off the hounds of the topmast directly it is pointed through the trestle-trees ; and when getting or deck, after it is landed, single the hawser the same as when get ting up and down, and stop it to the hounds ; then have sli{ ropes on the heel to haul it forward or aft, whether fore or main and place it on the chocks, for stowing on the booms. A fore- topmast is generally stowed with the head forward ; a main witl the head aft ; both heads are sometimes stowed forward, a prac- tice that is frequently adopted at the present day. * The object of keeping Mie bolts up in getting the cap into the top, is, that they may not catch on the top rim and cause delay, and perhaps injurj (It is no intended to be shipped so.) OR YOCJJNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 53 113. TURNING IN DEAD-EYES. If in the loft, get the length from the mast-head to the deck, from the draft, if the masts are not stepped, and place the dead- eye to that length, making due allowance for stretching in set- ting up. Turn the dead-eye in as near the end as possible, so that all parts of the shroud may be equally stretched, which will prevent its having a gouty end. The principal caution is to keep the lay in the rope, as it pre- vents the wet getting in. If the shroud is to be wormed, and served in the wake of the dead-eye, the worming should not be hove in too taut, as breaking the shroud round the dead-eye would probably snap it. The score being well tarred, the end of the shroud is taken un- derneath, round the dead-eye, inside standing, or mast-heaoVpart ; a bolt is put in a hole of the dead-eye. Take a good strand, knot both ends together ; it is then middled and crossed round the end of the shroud ; both bights are taken round the bolt, one on each side of the dead-eye, and a smaller bolt put in each bight, which are hove round the large bolt in the dead-eye. As the turns ac- cumulate, it heaves the shroud taut round. The dead-eye should be secured through one of the holes with spun yarn to the shroud before heaving, where the shroud is marked, for the lower part. When the dead-eye is turned in, in a loft, the shroud is hove in with a jigger, (or dead-eye machine). When the shroud is hove well round, pass a good throat-seiz- ing. When secured, take out the bolts, get a small jigger, hook one end to a strap round the end of the shroud, and the other t.o the mast-head part ; take a good strand, knot both ends together, take it round the end and standing or masthead part ; put a bolt in both bights, and heave it round, pulling up the jigger at the same time ; this will bring the end taut up, as heaving on the strap brings both parts close together; then pass a round, or quarter seizing, and a smaller one on the end. If the rigging is turned in on shore, keep the lay in the rope, and when sent out of the loft, to be placed on the mast-head, keep the ends inside, the shrouds being marked with a knot or a piece of spun-yarn, according to the number. The ends will lay aft on one side, and forward on the other ; this is of importance and should be remembered. Turning in dead-eyes, termed Cutter stay-fashion. The lead-eye being placed to the mark, the end is passed round it as before, but instead of being secured with a throat-seizing, the end is passed round the standing-part and seized to the part round the dead-eye with a round-seizing, and another on the end, further round the dead-eye. The same precaution as in the other way, keep the lay in the rope and end inside. 64 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Note. Worming and serving shrouds in the wake of the dead- eyes is not a common practice in all ships, but I would recom- mend it as a great preservative to the shrouds, if they were served at least six feet above the dead-eyes. I have known of many gangs of rigging condemned on account of the shrouds being magged and chafed in the wake of the dead-eyes and throat-seiz- ing, for want of service, when all other parts of the shrouds were found to be good. 114. GETTING TOPMAST CROSSTREES OVER. Overhaul a girtline through the round hole in the cap ; and if they are to go up from the starboard side, overhaul and send it down, and the after girtline outside the top ; hitch that through the round hole in the cap, well out on the starboard foremost horns underneath, and secure the end with a good seizing of spun-yarn ; the after one bend on in the same way, to the after starboard horn ; then stop both girtlines well with spun-yarn, close to the trestle-trees, and also with two stops, on the larboard horns ; " sway away ;" having a guy from the deck to clear it of the top, as it goes aloft. When the upper, or larboard horns are well clear of the cap, take two rope's ends from the larboard side of the top, and bend them to the larboard horns, and man them in the top these are called " steadying lines," and are used to prevent the crosstrees falling back, if a stop is cut too soon, and to assist in getting the crosstrees on the cap, and over the mast-head. " Sway higher," cutting the stops, and hauling on the steadying lines. When the trestle-trees are as high up as possible on the cap, haul on the steadying lines, and cut the stops close to the trestle-trees on the starboard side, and the crosstrees will fall across the cap ; then place the after hole between the trestle-trees, over the round hole in the cap cast off the girtlines and steadying lines white-lead the mast-head in the wake of the crosstrees, and sw r ay the topmast through ; beat the crosstrees well down on the mast-head ; and when placed, sway the top- mast a few feet higher for rigging. Pass a lashing through the fid-hole, and round the lower mast, to steady it. The topmasts are sometimes fidded before rigging, to avoid the greater strain upon the top tackles. If a topmast has only one sheave (like a mizen topmast), it is a good precaution to reeve a hawser through the fid-hole, and haul it taut, as the mast goes aloft ; unreeving it only when the mast is high enough for fid- ding, or previous to the squares entering the trestle-trees. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT 65 115. PLACING TOPMAST RIGGING. Tar the masthead in the wake of the rigging ; send the bol- sters aloft, and stop .them. After the bolsters are on, put over first the mast-head pendants then the span for ginn blocks ; then follows the straps, with thimble in for standing part of the tyes next, first pair of shrouds on the starboard side, then the larboard ; and so on, until all are over ; then lash the breast backstay (if single) ; if a pair, put them over the same as a shroud ; next the after backstays ; lash the stays, if fitted for it, if not, put them over the same as lower stays, with mousings, The collars of the stays go between the cross-trees, and lash over the after one. Some prefer chain spans. The most approved method is an iron plate, with a hook on each end, which lays across the trestle-trees. 116 TO SEIZE-IN THE SISTER-BLOCKS. There is a score on each side to take the shroud, and three scores for seizing one on each end, and one between both sheaves. They are seized-in the length of the hanging block, from the eye-seizing, to prevent any risk of the reef-tackle and lift being jammed between the hanging blocks and the rigging 56 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; one seizing is passed round the shrouds, above the block, anothei below the block ; and a small seizing put on each score, round the block and shrouds. The topsail-lift leads through the lower sheave, and reef tackle through the upper one. The larboard block should be seized-in once the diameter of the shroud lower than the other, as, if both are seized alike (the starboard shroud goiag over first) they would not be square when the rigging is placed. 117 .BACKSTAYS, (BREAST,) When in pairs, are fitted with eyes, the same as the shrouds, and served sufficiently far down to be square with the service of the topmast shrouds. They are also parceled and served in the way of the lower yards, when braced up. When there is only one backstay it is secured round the mast-head with a lashing passed iound it, through an eye spliced in ;* they are set up to a treble block in the channels. Through these blocks a fall is rove, the standing part being spliced into the strap of the double block, and then led from the treble block through a fair leader in the side, in on deck. Note. I have seen ships without breast backstays on any mast, and they carried sail equally well with those who had them ; one was the Independence razee : her breast backstays were con- verted into standing ones, and set up a little further aft, or imme- diately forward of the proper standing backstays. Breast backstays are generally pulled up in stays when the ship is head to wind, having a quarter-watch of topmen stationed by them. If they should be set up too taut, whch may be the case, especially when the rigging is slack, they are likely to snap and endanger the mast by the sudden jerk ; if not set up enough, they can be of no use, and are only an additional weight on the mast-heads, and a useless expenditure of rope. Their being set up to bear an equal strain with the rigging, will not occur with the greatest care once in a year, and I consider them particularly injurious on top-gallant-masts. A good stout standing' backstay is the main support. * Some are fitted with a cut splice. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 67 1 18. STANDING AFTER-BACKSTAYS, h When in pairs, are fitted with an eye the same as topmost rigging. When an odd one on each side, they are fitted with a horse shoe. They are now fitted the same size as lower rigging. The backstays are set up with a lanyard rove through dead-eyes, the same as shrouds, having service in the wake of the lower yards and tops. 119 MAIN TOPMAST STAY Is fitted of the same size as the standing back - stay. A large clump block is strapped round the foremast head, over the eyes of the rigging, and immediately over the square hole in the after part of the trestle-trees. Through this block the main topmast stay is rove down, through the trestle-trees has a thimble turned in the end, lanyard spliced and rove through it, and set up to a span shackle in the deck, abaft the foremast, for the purpose ; or a large bull's-eye hooked to an eye-bolt, and set up on the end. The spring stay leads through a block strap- ped round the foremast above the cat-harpens, and sets up in the fore-top. 12O. MIZEN TOPMAST STAY Is rove through a thimble strapped round the mainmast-head, over the eyes of the rigging ; and when set up, is secured to its own part with round seizings. If preferred, it can be set up with a thimble turned into the end, and a lanyard rove through it; but this is not necessary. When the stays are w r ell stretched, the thimbles can be spliced in, but it is not a good plan ; for, should it be necessary to unreeve, the splice must be drawn, which will injure the rope. I have seen them fitted in this way, and pointed ovei (38 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; for neatness, but prefer their being turned in, and the end pointed or capped. Note. There is no mizen topmast spring-stay. 121. GETTING THE TOPMAST CAPS ON. The girtline blocks should be lashed well up to the topmast head. Overhaul down before all the foremost ends, and secure them to the foremost bolts in the cap ; stop them to the centre ones, and also to the square hole in the after part ; sway the cap up ; when well up, cut the after stops, sway higher, and the cap can be easily placed by the man aloft, and girtlines cast off. If the cap should be very heavy, use a derrick ; a capstan bai will answer the purpose. Note. Ship the capshore the same time you place the cap. 122. MAST-HEAD MAN HOPES, &c. &c. A piece of rope has an eye spliced in one end, and several over- handed knots made on the bight, at equal distances from each other. They should be long enough to reach a third down the topmast rigging, and seized round the mast-head close to the cap ; one on each side is sufficient. They are absolutely necessary in large ships, and should be on all. I have seen them in some very neat ships ; and, when it is re- collected the small space the men have for their feet when they get near the crosstrees, and the long mast-head, to get on the cap, it is certainly worth while to sacrifice something in the way of ap- pearance to ensure the safety of a man's life. Some large ships have ladders with two steps, set up to the eyes of the topmast rigging, from the cap ; also, spans and grab- ropes fitted, to go from the swifters abreast of the cap, which will be found very convenient for the topmen, when exercising sails. These may appear trifling matters to some, but ships fitted with them are generally ahead, when exercising in a squadron. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 123. TOP TACKLE PENDANTS, &c. When cut to the required length, a thimble, well parceled, is spliced into one end, and the other pointed, with a becket in it. There are two to the fore, and tw T o to the main topmasts. In the heel of each topmast there is a dumb sheave ; take one pendant and reeve it through the top block, hooked to the cap, through the trestle-trees, through the dumb sheave, or heel-block, through an eye-bolt in the foremost part of the cap, on the opposite side to the block ; take two half-hitches, and secure the end to its own part, with a spun-yam seizing ; hook the top tackle block to the thimble in the pendant, and the lower one, to a bolt in the deck for the purpose ; reeve the fall through a leader, and bring it to the capstan ; heave well taut, and unreeve the hawser by which the mast was formerly hove up for rigging. The other pendant reeves through the other top-block, through the sheave hole in the topmast, and clenched to the other eye- bolt in the fore corner of the cap ; hook the blocks, reeve and bring the fall to the capstan, taking the other off, and manning it well. When no capstan, both falls must be well-manned by hand. Top Tackle Falls and Blocks. The upper block is double, strapped, which is made into a hook ; the lower is also double^, and should be iron-strapped, having a swivel ; a single one is hooked near the double as a leading block ; the fall is rove ; the standing part hitched, or clenched, over the block ; they are some- times spliced in, and some have beckets. To hook the double block, clap a single tail-block well up on the pendant, reeve a whip through it, hitch one end of the whip through one of the sheaves of the double block, hoist it up, and hook it to the pendant. 124. PREP ARING TO FID THE TOPMASTS. Capshores should be stepped and secured, luff tackles clapped on all the stays and backstays. Lower blocks should not be hook- ed on to the lanyards, but to bolts in the deck, and eye-bolts or straps in the chains ; capstans and falls manned, topmast rigging quite clear, and hove over the sides of the tops, and the topmasts hove up and ridded, mast stayed, rigging set up fyc. 70 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 1 25. RATTLING THE LOWER AND TOPMAST RIG GING. Cat-harpen legs and futtock shrouds are seized-on and set up ; topmast stayed, rigging and backstays set up, lanyards secured as lower rigging, then commence rattling down. Girt the rigging with three fore and aft swifters one by the shear rail, and the others at equal distances, as follows : Make one end of a small rope fast round the foremost shroud, take a turn round the next, then the third, and so on, until all are taken in ; then back the same way, and half-hitch it round the first. The swifter should be just taut, and not so as to bring the shrouds together, the object being to make the ratlines a little tauter w T hen let go. Sometimes sw T ifters are not used, but the rat- lines are never so square, or look well. Care should be taken that they are not too taut, for, when let go, all the strain will come on the seizing in the eyes of the ratlines, and they will be con- stantly snapping. TW T O swifters on each side are sufficient for the topmast rigging. Spar the rigging' down, w r ith spare spars, such as studding-sail yards, boat's oars, boat's masts, handspikes, or anything light that will answer, and seize them to the shrouds on the outside, at equal distances, leaving sufficient space for three or four rat- lines between each spar. A coil of small well-stretched rope is placed on each side of the deck, two or three on a side when required to be done quick. Splice an eye in one end of the rattling stuff, seize it to the first shroud, and then commence clove-hitching on the second, and so on to the after, but one ; then measure the distance from that to the last, cut it off, and splice an eye in the end. Beat the hitches well round each shroud, seize the end to the foremost one, and also the other eye to the after one, and rattle up, taking the sheai of the rails. The hitches are formed on the outside, and at equal distances ; in three or four places take a ratline to the after swift- er j these are called shear ratlines. When it is necessary to rattle quick, take three ends up at a time. Fifteen inches is a good distance between the ratlines, and their places should be chalked off all the way up and down before commencing. Each man employed should have a measure within his reach, and care should be taken to make the ratlines on one side correspond in a parallel direction with those of the other. This can only be seen from the outside of the ship. Make the hitches neat, and the eyes small ; few things tend more to a snu- appearance. If the rigging is to be blacked, after rattling down, it is best tc leave the spars on until that is done, taking them off as you black down OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 126. FUTTOCK-STAVES IN TOPMAST RIGGING Are iron bolts parceled and served ; are seized to the shrouds Jie length of the hounds, down on the inside ; seizings passed as in lower rigging. Cat-harpen leg's on topmast rigging. Take the length from the starboard foremost shroud round the mast, and to the after one on the same side ; get a piece of rope this length, splice an eye in each end, worm, parcel, and serve it. There are two on each mast. Seize the foremost end to the foremost shroud and futtock stave, take it round the mast and seize it to the after one ; secure one to the larboard side in the same manner. I have seen them go from the foremost starboard shroud, straight to the after larboard one, crossing abaft the mast. They are also fitted to set up with thimbles and a lanyard, abaft the mast. When this is done, both eyes are seized to the futtock staves on the starboard side, a thimble seized in the bight, and set up abaft the mast to the larboard one, with a lanyard fitted in the same way. (Vessels with chain topsail ties are fitted with iron bands, to go round the mast, with eyes for the topgallant rigging to lead through.) 127. TO RIG THE JIB-BOOM. Hoist the jib-boom on board by the hawser or tackle, which was left at the foremast head when getting on board the fore topmast, run the end out on the bowsprit, pointing it through the stays and bowsprit cap. Reeve the heel-rope, and sway the jib-boom out a foot or two beyond the cap. Reeve the jib-stay through the hanks, traveller if required, and then through the inner sheave-hole, in the boom end, martingale and necklace, and turn a double block in the inner end; reeve the lanyard or fall through this, and a single block bolted to the bows. To the traveler seize the jib downhaul blocks and traveling guys ; tar the boom end, put a grommet over, to which seize the fore top gallant bowline blocks, one on each side. Foot ropes. There is one on each side of the jib-boom. They should be long enough when in their place to allow a man to stand navel-high along the boom, and are fitted as follows : take a piece of rope long enough to make both ; cut it in the centre and splice one end into the other with a cut splice, forming an eye to fit the jib-boom end. Four or five overhand knots are taken at equal distances on the rope, from the eye, according tc 72 I'HE KEDGE- ANCHOR; the length of the foot-rope ; the knots are for the purpose of pre venting the men from slipping. In each end splice a small eye. large enough to take a lashing, by which they are set up to bolts in the bowsprit cap. An eye is sometimes made by taking a round turn round the boom end, and two seizings passed. Also with a span, horse-shoe fashion, and neatly covered with canvass. Note. Turk's-heads worked through the strands, may be sub- stituted for knots on the foot-ropes, if time will permit. 128. JIB-BOOM MARTINGALE STAY Is a short rope, with an eye in each end to fit the jib-boom, and end of the dolphin-striker. The eyes are well served, and cov- ered with canvass or leather. The martingale is wormed, and a small twine seizing (snaked) put on round the worming at equal distances between the eyes; three, or four, according to the length, which must depend on the way the dolphin-striker is intended to stand, or rake. It looks best when perpendiculai to cap or jackstaff. Chain is sometimes used for the purpose, as also for back-ropes ; and is found to answer well, it not being liable to stretch. 129. JIB-BOOM GUYS. There is one pair on each side ; an eye is made to fit the boom end by passing a round seizing, when in their place ; both ends are rove through thimbles on each yard-arm of spritsail yard (when crossed). Then brought in and both ends set up to bull's eyes in the bow, or fitted with tackles. Placing the rigging on the jib-boom.. First, the foot-ropes ; next, the martingale stay, and guys. In some ships, an iron grummet is fitted with an eye on top and one underneath, neatly leathered, and put over the boom-end first. The martingale stay is hooked to the underneath eye, the jib-tack and downhaul to the upper one. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 73 130. MARTINGALE BACK-ROPES Are pendants, middled and served in the centre, the round of the dolphin striker, both parts crossed and secured with a throat seizing. The service should be long enough to take in the seiz- ing. In the ends splice a single or double block ; another single one is strapped into a bolt in the bow for the purpose, or fitted in a strap with a hook and thimble (hook moused). A gun tackle, or luff-purchase, is then rove, the standing part of the fall spliced round the pendant, in after end of the block, rove through the one in the bow, over the head rails, back through the one in the pen- dant, and through a fair leading sheave, in the forecastle bulwark. These falls, after being pulled up, are racked together outside the bulwark. If belayed on the forecastle, they should be seized to their next part, so as not to to let go by mistake. 131. PLACING THE RIGGING ON A DOLPHIN- STRIKER. Back-ropes first, and next the martingale ; below this rigging, in the end of the dolphin-striker, are two or three sheaves, and one close above it, large enough to admit the jib-stay, which is rove through it ; flying jib-stay in the next sheave, and flying martingale stay under all, which will show two ropes leading from each boom end, to the dolphin-striker. 132. GETTING THE JIB-BOOM OUT. The flying jib-boom iron is driven on ; the heel rope manned (if rigged), and the boom hauled out. The heel strap is placed in a score in the heel for the purpose, and both bights lashed to- gether; then another lashing passed round the strap, between the boom and the bowsprit, and the strap well frapped together The heel being well secured, set up the back ropes and guys. Note. Rigging to be placed same as jib-boom. 74 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 133. SENDING UP TOPGALLANT MASTS. The topgallant top blocks being hooked, we will suppose the long mast rope is to be rove, from the starboard side of the top- mast-cap ; take the end through the square hole in the fore part of the trestle-trees, half-hitch it through the fid-hole, and stop it round the hounds , and the royal mast-head ; send the hauling part through lubber's hde, and through a leading block or sheave on deck. The topgallant rigging is fitted on a sheet-iron cylindei or funnel, attached to the jack cross-trees (by an order from the former Navy Commissioners), leathered and painted on the outside, and tarred on the inside ; put on the grommet or strap for the main royal stay* to reeve through, then put on the topgallant and flying jib-stays, starboard and larboard shrouds, breast and stand- ing backstays, and secure them over the funnel ; overhaul the girt- lines down on deck, and bend them on to the rigging, around all parts, about the length of the mast-head below the jack, and a good stop through the funnel ; hoist the funnel up and place it, with the rigging on, over the hole in the cap, and take the stays forward and reeve them. Man the mast-ropes and " sway away," having men stationed to bear off and place the rigging or funnel. When pointed through the funnel, place the royal rigging and truck, reeve the signal halyards, and attach the conductor ; " sway higher," land the mast on the top or forepart of lower mast-cap, and, if required, reeve the short mast rope ; reeve the pointed end through a block hooked to the cap on the larboard side, or the sheave, then through the trestle-trees, through the sheave-hole in the topgallant-mast, up through the trestle-trees, and secure the end to the foremost bolt in the cap, with two half-hitches, and seize the end ; to the thimble in the other end, hook the double block of a burton ; hook the single one to a strap round the trestle-trees ; send the burton fall on deck through lubber's hole, and lead it through a single leading block, and haul it taut ; unreeve the long mast rope, and fid the mast ; when the fid is in, the mast rope can be unrove, if wished. Reeve the ends of the shrouds through the horns of the cross- trees, between the topmast rigging, over the futtock staves, and turn a thimble in each end ; strap another round a futtock plate, inside the dead-eyes of top-mast rigging ; if there is none placed in the top, splice a lanyard into that in each shroud, and take two or three turns through each, stay the mast, and set the rigging and backstays up. In setting up the backstays the single block of the jigger, which is hooked to the thimble, is hooked to a blackwall hitch, in the lan- * Suppose this to be the fore topgallant-mast. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. % 75 yard, and when set up, expend the lanyard through the thimbles and seize the ends. On both shrouds on each side clap on small jiggers, hook the double blocks to straps on the shrouds, the sin- gle to Blackwall hitches in the lanyards, and set up and secure the same as the backstays. The fore topgallant stay reeves through the outer sheave-hole in the jib-boom, and through a bull's-eye hooked to the bows and when set up, is seized to its own part. The main topgallant stay is rove through the middle sheave in the after chock of the fore topmast crosstress, or through a block strapped around the fore mast-head, and set up in the fore top. The mizen topgallant stay is rove through a bull's-eye in the after part of the main cap, and set up in the main top. 134. ROYAL RIGGING. There is one breast, and after backstay on each side, seized as the after backstays on topgallant masts. The breast backstay or shroud, is pulled up with a gun tackle purchase ;* the after leg has a thimble turned in, and sets up in the after part of the chains, with a lanyard. Royal stays. As there is no funnel (although it would be a great advantage to have one), splice an eye in the stay to fit the mast-head, cover it, and serve over the splice. It goes on next to the grommet, then the shroud and backstays, spanned together. The fore royal stay is rove through the outer sheave-hole in the flying jib-boom end, and pulled up through a fair leader on the forecastle. The main royal stay is rove through a thimble stopped around the foretop gallant mast-head, through another strapped round the eye of a shroud, and when set up is seized to its own part. Mizen royal stay reeves through a sheave in the after part of the main topmast trestle-trees, through a thimble strapped round the eye of a main shroud, and seized to its own part. * Royal-backstays are set up with a jigger to their respective places in channels. The shrouds are set up in the top(breast-backstay-fashion. 7 76 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 135. SHORT AND LONG TOPGALLANT MAST ROPES Short mast ropes have a thimble spliced in one end, and the other end pointed. They are rove when the mast is rigged, ind are used for ridding. They should be sufficiently long (when the mast is landed on the top or cap), after being rove through the block and sheave in the heel of the mast, and clenched to the cap, to allow the thimble to hang clear of the cat-harpen legs. If the topsail-yard is crossed, the mast is landed on it, for rig ^ing ; if the topgallant-mast should be too long to allow its be- ing landed on the yard, the mast rope must be lengthened ac- cordingly. Long mast ropes. Ropes are often fitted for the purpose ; but the topgallant yard rope is generally used. I have seen them fitted as follows, and they answered very well : The rope is rove, and stopped to the topgallant-masthead, and royal sheave-hole, leaving a long end over the upper stop, to hitch to the bolt, before cutting the stops. To prevent the rope slipping, rack both parts together above the sheave-hole in the heel of the mast. 136. TO RIG THE FLYING JIB-BOOM. Sway it on board and point it through the iron at the jib-boom end. A tail block is put on the neck of the iron, or on the jib- stay, close down to the boom. Through this block reeve the heel rope, one end taken in on the forecastle, and the other bent to the heel of the boom. A rope is bent to the heel of the boom to serve as a guy ; sway the boom out a foot or two for rigging. Put over the foot ropes, fitted as the jib-boom, the inner ends seized to the jib-boom end, inside the iron. The martingale, when single, is secured round the boom end, clenched, spliced, or with a running eye, rove through a sheave in the dolphin-striker, and in on the forecastle, on the opposite side to the royal stay] When double, a single block is strapped round the boom end, and the standing part spliced round the dolphin-striker ; hauling part as when single. Guys. One on each side spliced into each other, forming a cut-splice to fit the boom end. The other end rove through thimbles, strapped round the spritsaii yard, through fair leaders in the bulwarks, and pulled up on the forecastle, or set up on the bows. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 77 Man the heel rope and get the boom out ; the heel is placed in a step formed on the fore side of the bowsprit cap, for the purpose, and secured with a lashing, rove through the end, and passed round the jib-boom. Set up the martingale, stay the fore topgal- lant and royal mast, (fore and aft,) by the stays and backstays ; and if the spritsail yard is crossed, reeve the guys, turn in thim bles, and set them up. 137. SPRITS AIL LIFTS Are single ; have an eye spliced in one end to fit the yard-arm ; splices served over are taken over the jib guys, rove through the bull's-eye in the cap, and set up on the forecastle. Blocks are sometimes strapped into the bolts, but it is quite unnecessary. Bolts are often driven into the fore side of the cap, and the lifts led through ; when this is done, they are generally set up there with lanyards and thimbles, spliced into the end, which answers every purpose. 138. SPRITSAIL BRACES. A single block is strapped in toa bolt in the cheek of the fore- mast on each side. The brace has an eye in one end, to fit the yard arm ; the other is rove through the single block, on collar of fore-stay, and another single block is spliced into the end ; a luff tackle purchase is rove with it, and a double block on the deck, one sheave answering for a leading one. They are sometimes rove double, but the practice is getting out of date. 139. STRAPPING THIMBLES FOR GUYS ON SPRIT- SAIL YARDS. The thimbles are double-strapped and secured, after being placed round the yard, and in the score of the thimbles, with a round seizing passed between the thimble and the yard ; the splices laying in the upper side of the score in the thimbles 7tf THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Some fit grummet straps, or a short-long splice, in the strap ioi neatness. The use of double straps is to allow the thimbles to lay fair with the yard for the jib guys to lead through ; if single, they would stand fore and aft. 14O. CROSSING A SPBITSAIL YARD. The yard being rigged, prepare for crossing as follows : Clap a good selvagee strap well up, on the fore topmast stay ; to it hook a snatch or leading block large enough to take a haw ser ; reeve it and timber-hitch it round the starboard quarter of the spritsail yard, (if got out on the starboard side,) stop it along to the larboard quarter, and half way out on the larboard yard- arm. Overhaul down the lifts and braces, and sway out, keeping the larboard yard-arm under the bowsprit ; when clear on the larboard side, put over the brace, or block, and lift, and haul out ; when nearly out, or before clear of the head rails, put over the starboard brace or block and lift ; haul on the hawser, starboard lift, and brace, and cast off the stops. When sufficiently out, pass the parrel, take a turn or hold well on the end ; hook the tye, and square the yard. Cast off the hawser and unreeve it; reeve the jib-guys through their thimbles on the spritsail yard, turn in dead-eyes or blocks, and set them up to others on the bows ; set all up taut and square the yard. 141. TWO HALF SPRITSAIL YARDS. Two half spritsail yards, made like dolphin-strikers, are se- cured to the bowsprit with jaws, (or an iron band fitted round the bowsprit, with a double goose-neck hinge,) to cant or turn in any required direction. When the half spiritsail yard is carried it is rigged as follows : The fore guys are made of well stretched rope, and equal in strength to the jib guys together, each fitted with an artificial eye to fit the jib-boom end and half yard-arm. They should be wormed with small rope, parceled and served, or covered in the eyes ; four stranded rope is preferable, it being not so liable to stretch as three. The after guys are fitted with an artificial eye in one end, to fit the yard arm, and a thimble spliced into the other. They are the same size as the fore guys, and wormed in the same manner OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 79 If made on purpose, and four-stranded, the thimble is kept in the bight with a round seizing-. The jumper, or lower guy, is fitted the same as the after, only shorter ; the length of this depends on the drop intended to be given to the yard arm, which should never be less than the sprit- sail yard, when well braced up, or, in other words, canted. The jumper is put on the yard arm first, then the after one, next, the foremost, and over the jib-boom. The after one is set up to a bolt by the cat-head, well down ; the lower, to an eye- bolt in each side of the cutwater, w T ell out. For a frigate, the guys are eight-and-a-half-inch, and wormed with twenty-one thread stuff. Four-stranded rope, if made on purpose, can have the eyes formed when laying up in the rope walk. Some fit forward and after guys all in one. 142. WHISKERS. Whiskers are iron outriggers from the cathead, with sheaves m them for the guys to reeve through, and set up to the fore chains, the same as when rove through the spritsail yard. This plan is much in use in small vessels, but the boom is supported almost entirely by the martingale, as the guys being considerably above the boom, and its always topping up, when the sail is set on a wind, the more wind the greater the strain on the martin- gale ; and should the guys be not carefully pulled up, .the boom must depend on the martingale entirely for support. . TO GET ON BOARD AND RIG LOWER YARDS. Overhaul the hawser from the lower mast-head, bend on to the slings of the yard, and get them nearly up and down ; clap sel- vagees on the quarters, to which hook the pendant tackles. As it comes on board, cut the stops, easing away on the pendant tackle, and bousing on the other, until the yard is athwart-ships place chocks in the hammock nettings for the yard to rest on slue them fair, and lash them ; come up the tackles, cast off the hawsers, and place a shore under the middle of the yard to prevent its springing. Measure the yard, tar and leather the slings, fit a saddle for the D thimble, which lash on with a piece of well stretched rope, heaving each turn taut with a Spanish windlass, and fitting the score of the D thimble. Cover all with leather, and fit the straps for the preventer slings, &c., &c., (fee. Note. The iron sling-bands are nov used instead of the old fashioned D thimble. 80 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; Chain is now generally used, and allowed lo all ships in the service for the slings (proper), rope ones being used as preventers. (See Rigging Table.) 144. rilUSS STRAPS. A large thimble with the score well parceled, is seized into a double strap, which is made by splicing both ends together, and served over ; the thimble secured in the strap with a round seizing, the splice laying in the score. The strap should be long enough to go round the yard in the quarter, both eyes lashing together on the fore side. There are two on each yard. One thimble is seized inside the truss pendant, the other outside ; and one in the round of the pendant higher up than the other. 145. TRUSS PENDANTS* Are wormed, parceled, and served ; an eye is spliced in one end large enough to take the pendant when rove through it ; in the other an artificial eye is made, large enough to take the single block for truss fall. The pendant should be rove through the small eye before the artificial one is made, boused well taut round the yard, the eye being kept underneath, and one pendant higher than the other. Reeve the upper pendant through the upper thimble, and lower pendant through lower thimble. Being rove in this manner, they will lead perfectly clear of each other. Hide rope is preferable for pendants, but the iron patent truss is now allowed to all vessels, up to a second class frigate inclu- sive. (New regulation}. 146. QUARTER BLOCKS LOWER YARDS. Quarter or topsail sheet blocks are large single blocks, with double straps ; the block seized in with a round seizing, and se- cured round the yard, (inside the cleat, one on each side.) with a rose-lashing passed through both bights on the top of the yard * For length and size, see Rigging Table. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. g] Before the lashing is passed, the block should be hove up with heavers, and the eyes of the strap brought as close together as possible. This is done with a good strand passed through both, and hove up with a Spanish windlass. Vessels carrying chain top- sail sheets, have iron blocks fitted to the iron bands in the slings of the yard for that purpose. (See Rigging Table). 147. CLEW GARNET BLOCKS Are single ; seized into a single strap, with an eye spliced in each end, and are secured round the yard with a rose-lashing, the same as the topsail sheet blocks, just outside the cleats. Some ships have all the rigging inside the cleats, which is much neater. Note. Iron bound blocks are allowed to all classes of vessels in the navy, by the new regulation, for this purpose. 148. LIFT BLOCKS LOWER fARDS Are single, seized into a single strap, with a round seizing ; the strap being long enough to go over the yard arm, after the clock is seized in. If both ends are spliced together, the splice should lay in the score of the block, or upper side ; but a grum- met will answer equally as well, and look snugger. 149. FOOT ROPES AND STIRRUPS. The foot ropes are cut once-and-a-half the length of the yard, ^excepting lower yards). An eye, to fit the yard arm, is spliced In one end ; and a small one, to take a seizing, in the other. The splicing served in the way of chafing (one-third) midship part. Stirrups are short pieces of rope spliced round the foot rope ; eyes spliced in the opposite ends, to go over the jackstay-bolts ; splices served over. They are sometimes unlaid at one end and made into plait, and secured to the yard with flat-headed nails, having a small piece of hide or leather placed under their heads before being driven into the yard. Going over the jackstay bolts g2 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR: is preferable; and some seize it to the neck of the bolt, or staple They hang on the after side of all yards. Some vessels have their foot ropes fitted to go abaft the mast^ and seized to the parrel, which answers a very good purpose, es- pecially in vessels with raking masts, as it gives the men a better opportunity to stand. 15O JACKSTAYS. BENDING AND REEFING. Take a piece of rope of the proper size,* cut off the length of the yard, splice an eye in each end, to fit the yard arm, sufficiently taut to require being driven on. Cut in the centre, and splice a thimble in each end ; put the strands for splicing in once-and-a- half, marl down, and serve over. If two jackstays on each arm, (which should always be the case when the sail is reefed to one), the large one, before splicing the thimbles in, is rove through the eye-bolts on the yard for the purpose ; this is the reefing jackstay. The bending one is fitted the same way, and after being put over the yard arm, is seized to the neck of the bolts on the after side. This plan has been generally adopted, as it was found much easier to reef, than when fitted with only one jackstay ; there be- ing always difficulty and delay in getting the points between the jackstay and the yard, when the sail was bent to it. When only one jackstay, it is rove through the eye-bolts. Note. Iron bending jackstays are now allowed for all vessels in the navy. 151. BRACE BLOCKS. LOWER YARDS. The straps should be fitted sufficiently taut to require being being driven on the yard arm. Two thimbles are fitted, one within the other, called lock thimbles. Take a piece of rope, of the proper size, and cut it long enough to go round one thimble and the yard, when spliced together ; worm, parcel and serve it, and pass a round seizing round this strap, close to the thimble. Grommet straps are preferable, if time will permit. The block is a large single one, with two scores. For the strap take a piece of rope the required length, and splice both ends to- * For the length air 3 size of rope, see Rigging Table OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 83 Cether ; worm, parcel, and serve it ; reeve it through the thimble already strapped, and pass both parts round the score of the other thimble ; then place both bights in the scores in the brace block, keeping the splice in the after end of the block ; pass a round seizing between the block and thimble, crossing it both ways, as in a double strap. Cross-jack brace-blocks are single, and strapped the same as lower ones. A double block is secured to the after shrouds in the main rigging, the same as main preventer brace blocks. When reeving the cross-jack braces, one end of the brace is clinched, spliced, or half-hitched, and the end seized, just below the block ; then rove through the block on the yard, through the inside sheave in double block, and through a fair leading sheave in a rack, in the side or a leading block. I have seen blocks strapped into bolts on the main-mast, fcr the brace and bowline, which answered well. The brace block should be put on the yard, sufficiently far in to be inside the topmast backstays, when braced up. Note. These braces should be well below the yard, as it al- ways tops up on the wind, which slacks the weather leech ; this is partly the reason a mizen-topsail never stands well. 152. PLACING THE RIGGING OX LOWER YARDS. Sling bands in the centre, and also on both sides, close to the topsail sheet block, the truss pendants, then truss straps ; if the rigging is all within the cleats, a clue garnet block is lashed on each side ; if not, they are lashed one on each side, close outside. I have seen them both ways, but inside is preferable. Tar well the yard arm, close to the cleats and slings, in the wake of the rigging, first jackstay ; if two, the bending one, and set it up amidships with a lanyard. Then the foot ropes; after going over the yard arm, and rove through the stirrups, they are lashed together, with a lanyard rove through both thimbles, and are secured with a good seizing to the strap of quarter block. Then the brace, and lift blocks. Rolling tackle straps on the inner quarter of yard, with the eye abaft burton straps on the outer quarter yard-ana, eye on top of yard. If the stirrups go o\ er the jackstay bolts, they should be put over before the jackstay is rove. The cross jack-yard Las no jackstay, head earings, or yard tackle straps; and the brace blocks, instead of going over the yard-arm, are put on some distance inside of the sheave hole foi the mizen-topsail sheets, on the forward side of the yard. 84 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR: 153. GETTING UP JEER-BLOCKS, AND REEVTKG JEERS. Secure two single whip blocks to the after bolts in lower cap Send the two foremost ends through lubber's hole down on deck ; bend them through the shell of the block, with two half-hitches, and seize the end. Stop them along each leg of the strap, the larboard whip to the larboard leg, and the starboard whip to the starboard leg; then stop both legs together with a seizing oi spun-yarn in the bights the hauling part of the whips being through lubber's hole and through a leading block ou deck ; man them and hoist the blocks into their places. When clear of the top, cut the stop in the bights, haul on the whips, and they will bring the strap into its place, on each side of the mast-head. Then cut the upper stops, on the whips ; take a turn and pass the lashing in the bight, securing each end to their next part. When secured, let go, and take off the whips. Reeving jeers. The standing part is clenched round the strap of the upper block, rove through the one on the yard, up through another sheave in upper block, and so on, until all rove full. The hauling part is rove through a leading sheave, in fore or main bitts, or through leading blocks. When heaving up, the\ are either brought to the capstan, or manned by hand. The jeer blocks are now generally fitted with hooks, as they can be got up and down much quicker. At the present day, fe\v ships are seen to carry their jeers up in their proper places. 154 LOWER LIFT BLOCKS Are double ; an iron plate is bolted across the upper side of the main or fore cap ; it is in the form of a crescent, with the hollow side toward the topmast. In each end of the crescent, or horn, an eye is turned and a thimble put in it. Instead of the eyes being turned, I have seen two eye-bolts driven through the cres- cent and cap, and secured underneath with a nut ; a thimble id also put in the eye-bolt, and the blocks strapped in. The cross-jack lift blocks are single, one on each side, and caii be fitted as the fore or main, or (a chalk) abaft the mast-head, if preferred, for neatness. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 155. REEVING LOWER LIFTS. Clench one end round the yard outside all, then take the othei end up and reeve it through the foremast sheave in the double block in the fore or main cap, then through the block on the ) ard, through the other sheave in the double block, and through lubber's hole on deck ; well up this part, splice a lizard for jigger tackle, or use tails selvageed on the end. The upper block of the jigger can be spliced or turned in to the lift, if preferred. The cross jack lifts go over the yard arms with an eye spliced in the end to fit them. The other end is rove through the block at the cap, and is set up with two thimbles and a lan- yard in the top ; one thimble being turned into the end, the other strapped to the eye of one of the lower shrouds. 156. MAIN BRACES ON BUMKIN, jtc. A single block is seized into a double strap, with a round seiz- ing crossed both ways; the strap is then put over an iron out- rigger, or bumkin on the quarters, fitted for the purpose. The standing part of the brace being parceled, is rove through anothei bolt in the bumkin, and spliced into it or clenched ; the other end rove through the block on the yard arm, from out, in through the block in the bumkin, and through a sheave in the bulwarks (abaft), for the purpose. Double blocks are sometimes put on the bumpkin, instead of single ones, and also two sheaves inserted in the bulwarks instead of one, both ends of the brace rove, and led in-board a great facility in working ship. 157. FORE BRACES Are clove-hitched, and the end seized aft on the collar of the main stay, below the splice ; the other end taken forward and rove from in, out, through the block on the yard, through a single block strapped into a bolt in the cheek of the main-mast, with a thimble in it, close up to the trestle-trees ; then rove from forward aft, through a sheave in the main fife-rail. The brace is often middled, and clove-hitched in the bight on the main stay, and both ends taken forward and rove as before. Some have a hole bored in the bibs, or cheeks of the mast, instead of clove-hitching it around the main stay. 80 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 158. CROSSING THE LOWER YARDS. The jeers being rove, reeve the pendants and falls, hitch the pendants around the quarters of the yard, splice in the lanyard of the D thimble, and take the yard tackles forward to keep the yard clear of the mast. The lifts and braces being rove, man the lifts and jeer falls, "sway away," and when the yard comes abreast of the futtock staves, pass the lashing of the D thimble, parcel it well, over all, frap all parts together, and cover all with canvass; reeve the truss pendants, turn in the blocks, reeve the falls, haul taut the tresses, and square the yard by the Hfts and braces. 159. TO GET ON BOARD THE TOPSAIL YARDS. A large single block is lashed to the topmast-head, through which a hawser is rove ; overhaul it down forward and hitch it to the slings of the yard, stop it along the yard arm, and sway it on board. Cast off the hawser, middle the yard, and prepare it for rigging. 1 60. RIGGING TOPSAIL YARDS. (FORE AND MAIN.) The jackstays, after going over the yard arm, are rove through the eye-bolts or staples, and set up a-midships with a lanyard and thimble spliced in. Foot ropes round the yard abaft, on their opposite quarters, as follows : splice the lanyard into the eye in the end ; take it over the yard, and round on the fore side, underneath through the OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. fctf eye; again back round the yard on the fore side, through the eye, and back the same way, until sufficient turns are taken to secure it. Then take a half-hitch from the lower edge of the eye, round all parts of the lashing ; pass it round before ; reeve through the eye on the upper side, take two half-hitches round all, and secure the end. Tye blocks are now generally iron-strapped, and bolted into straps round the yard for the purpose. If fitted with rope, they must have double straps, and secured round the yard, on the upper foremost quarter, with a rose-lashing. If they are single blocks, two on each yard. Quarter blocks are double blocks, iron strapped, and secured in the same way as tye blocks. Much time is saved by having them fitted in this manner, as in shifting yards, the topgallant sheets, and topsail clewlines need not be unrove, which must be the case if rope-strapped. If rope-strapped they are seized into a single strap, and lashed on top of the yard with a rose-lashing. Parrel. Take two pieces of rope, one longer than the other ; the long one of sufficient length to go round the mast and yard on each side ; the short leg to go round the mast, and lash to the long leg on each side. An eye is spliced in each end, are worm- ed, parceled, and served ; both marled together and covered with leather. A round seizing is passed around both, close to the eye of the short leg, on each side. The long leg is taken round the yard, brought round on the fore side, and secured to the short leg with a lashing of small rope, passed through both eyes. The other eyes are lashed together when the yard is across. Brace blocks are strapped in the same way as fore or main yard. Flemish horse is a short piece of rope spliced round a thimble, which is on the neck of the pacific-iron,* it has an eye spliced in the other end, and when the yard is rigged, is secured the same as a foot rope, just inside the brace block, two or three feet, according to the length of the yard. They should be long enough to allow a man to stand on them to pass an earing, -ors ; then bend the buoys and buoy-ropes. 196. TO RANGE AND STOPPER THE CABLES. Before ranging the cables, they should be bitted, which is done as follows : When the cables are bent, haul up sufficient slack to form a bight abaft the bitts ; throw the bight which is thus formed, over the head of the bitts (and in case it is to be weather bitted, take another turn round the cavil). In ranging, get a tail-block over the hatchway, through which reeve a rope; over- THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; haul down, and hitch to the cable. Take the running part clost. out to the side, bouse on the rope, and flake the cable fore and aft the deck. Clap on deck and bitt-stoppers, before and abaft the bitts ; put on rounding at the range, if hemp, which is in- tended to veer, and also have cable mats in readiness, to be used as may be required. If a hemp-cable, a small range forward of the part bitted ; if chain-cable it merely requires bitting ; ranging is unnecessary. Note. When the anchor is let go, veer from the locker through the compressor (i. e., supposing it to be a chain.) 197. STOPPERS, &c., &c. The trip-stoppers. Both ends are made fast to eye-boity under the after part of the fore-channels. The score in the end of the waist-anchor stock rests in the bight, and is used to trip the anchor clear of the ship's side, when let go. Deck-stoppers are hooked to bolts in the deck. They have a knot worked in the end, with a lanyard fast to it. The lanyard is passed round both the stopper and cable, abaft the knot, and then wormed along the cable, forward of it. (See claw-stopper). Ring-stoppers are ropes middled ; the bights are passed through the deck-bolts, the ends rove through the bight, and dogged along the cable. Bitt-stoppers are tailed and rove through the sampson-knee forward of the bitts, then taken over the cable abaft the bitts, under again, and wormed along the cable forward. A tackle may be hooked to this, and used for veering. Dog-stoppers are very long, and are used in the tiers. One end is clenched round the main-mast, and the other wormed along the cable. The wing-stoppers are similar, but are clenched around the orlop-deck beams in the wings. 198. COMPRESSORS, OR COMBING STOPPERS For hemp-cables they are very long, and are tailed. T\vo holes are bored through the deck, abaft the after beam of the natch ; one end of the stopper is rove downwards through one of the holes, passed under the cable, and rove up again, through the OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. Ill other hole. Both ends are then dogged round the cable taut, sc as to nip it against the beam. The compressor for chain-cables is an iron elbow, one end of which is bolted to the forward beam of the hatch underneath, and intended to work on the bolt. The elbow goes round the cable, having an eye in the other end, to which a luff-tackle is hooked ; which being hauled on, stoppers the cable effectually. 199. PUTTING ON NIPPERS. Nippers should be from three to five fathoms in length, and made of the best rope-yarns. They are used when heaving up the anchor, and are passed as follows : Lay the messenger on the cable, and begin two or three fathoms abaft the hawse-hole ; two round turns are first taken with the end of the nipper, round the messenger, and held by a boy, then round both. The other end is wormed round the cable, as the first was round the mes- senger. When the strain becomes heavy, racking, and even round turns may be used, having also small heavers, and selva- gees to secure the ends ; taking care to have dry ones to use when the anchor is up and down. Note. Some ships have done away with the nippers alto gether, and use nothing but the selvagee and heaver. Each nipper-man provides two selvagees, and one heaver ; also an iron pin of proper size to put through the links of the chain-cable, to prevent the muddy chain from slipping through the strap. 2OO. IRON CLAW-STOPPERS, AND CLEAR-HAWSE SHACKLES. These are used for chain-cables, instead of rope-stoppers, and are found very convenient, and more durable than rope. They are allowed to every ship in the service by the new regulation, and are fitted as follows : A piece of chain four feet long, is fit- ted with a devil's-claw in one end, and a slip-hook in the other; a slip-ring also in the long link in the chain, for the end of the slip-hook. 112 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 201. TO CUT, AND PASS A MESSENGER. The length should be equal to twice the distance from the after part of the capstan, to the roller in the manger, and add four times the circumference of the capstan-band ; this is suffi cient for splicing in the eyes and taking turns. The messenger is passed with three round turns, and then the eyes lashed with the lanyard, figure-of-eight fashion. The part which is brought to the cable is undermost. Note. Some messengers are fitted with a strap and toggle in- stead of a lashing ; this plan is much quicker than the old way. The size of the strap, ought to be one half the size of the mes- senger ; in length it should be once the circumference of the cap- stan on the bight. Instead of splicing the two ends of the strap together, make a spritsail-sheet knot with the six strands, reeve one bight of the strap through one eye of the messenger, the other bight through the other eye, and toggle them together. To dip a messenger. Cast off the lashing, slack up the turns, and pass the eye up or down, as necessary, between the turns and capstan. Render the turns through each other, and pass 'he lashing again. 202. SPLICING ROPE-CABLES. Cut off the ropemaker's fag-end, and unlay the cable suffi- ciently far for splicing. Take the inside yarns and lay them up into three strands, equal to the piece of rope intended for the tails, and splice these small strands and tails together. Take the out- side yarns and make them into three-yarn plaits or knittles, then marl the remaining yarn down over the splice and tail, and point over all with the plaits or knittles. The cable is then open- ed with setting fids and commanders, and the splice made, each strand boused through with jiggers ; the ends are put in twice on the tier, and once on the anchor part. Take a good piece of small-rope, and pass it as a round-seizing, close to the splice, and cross it on all sides. When finished it will look square; and pass another, with smaller stuff, close to the ends. Worm the ends into the lay of the cable, and pass three or four spun-yarn seizings, at equal distances round them and the cable, to keep them in the lay make the seizings, and whip the ends of the tails. The size of the seizing, and number of turns, depend on the size of the cable. Temporary Rudder, Bi'ting- a Cabie. &c. &c. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 113 Bends. The small rope used as seizings in clinching, are sc jailed. The end of the cable for clinching to the anchor should be wormed with good strands, and backed with good spun-yarn, and the end capped. The worming should be long enough to 'orm the clinch, and the cable well tarred before and after its being done. The lay of the cable opens in clinching, and being wormed, it prevents the wet getting into the heart of the rope, or lodging. To pass the bends, have a good piece of rope of the length and size required ; bring both parts together, leaving one end a third longer than the other ; then pass it round both parts of the cable, and put both ends through the bight. Pass the under turns with the short end, the upper or riding-turns with the long one. Stop both ends well with spun-yarn to their next parts, and cross the whole seizing or bend, with sennit ; pass the sennit on the bight, and secure both together with a reef-knot 203. TO SHIP, AND UNSHIP A RUDDEK. Have the rudder brought under the stern, hung to a scow. Bore a hole through the beam or carling over the rudder case drive an eyebolt up through it, and fit a washer and forelock. Strap a large single block* with hook and thimble, and hook it to the eye-bolt ; reeve a top-pendant through the single block, down through the rudder-case, and hitch it to an eye-bolt, which is temporarily fitted into the rudder-head. Clap a deck-tackle on to the other end of the pendant; have heel-ropes leading forward on each side, after being rove through their respective holes in the rudder. Man the deck-tackle fall, and hoist away. When the rudder is high enough, guy it fair with the heel-ropes ; see the pintles fair for entering the gudgeons, lower away, and fit in the wood-lock. Come up the pendant, unreeve the heel-ropes take the bolt from the rudder-head, also the one from the beam or carling afoove ship the tiller, and reeve the wheel-ropes. To unship it. Fit the bolts, single block, pendant and deck- tackle as before, unreeve the wheel-ropes, unship the tiller, knock out the wood-lock, and " sway away." When the pintles are clear of the gudgeons, lower away, and secure it to the scow or lighter tow it on shore, and parbuckle, or hoist it out of the water or scow. * If a top-block can be procured, it will answer best, as the neck of the hoc.i being shorter, it will give more hoist. 114 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; 2O4. GETTING THE GUNS ON BOARD. The gun-car- riages and all the equipments be- longing to the guns are brought alongside in lighters, and hoisted in with the yard & stay. Get them on their respective decks, and reeve the purchase for get- ting the guns on board. Securing the main-yard. To the bolts in the lower cap, hook the double blocks of two burtons. The single ones are hooked to selvagee - straps, round the yard, close to the lifts, and the falls sent on deck, through leading - blocks. Bouse well taut the main-lifts and burtons together, and belay. Then pass a good lashing round the main-yard in the slings, and main-mast, to keep the yard steady, and support the trusses, they being previously boused well taut. Take the top tackle-pendant, and reeve it through a top-block, secured well to the yard with a good lashing, passed round the hook, on the outside quarter ; take the pointed end over the cap, pass it between the head of the mast and heel of the topmast, take two half-hitches on its own part, or that from the yard, anc* secure the end with a round-seizing of spun-yarn. Get a single whip upon the main-yard, close to the lashing, bend one end to the hook of the top-tackle fall-block; hoist the block up and hook it to the thimble in the pendant. Through this and the other top-tackle fall-block, reeve a fall; clench one end (the standing part), round the main yard close to th^ block; the othe- OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. U5 end, when rove full, through a leading block on deck, by the hitts. The garnet-purchase is a pendant, with a thimble in the upper end, which is hooked to the main-pendant-tackle; the other end is rove down through holes bored in the deck for the purpose, and a stout hook and thimble spliced or turned into the end. The garnet should be long enough to go on the lower- .leck, and the holes bored perpendicular to the centre of the port through which the guns are to be got on board. The slings are made of breaching-stuff, twice the length of the gun, the ends spliced together, and the strands put in twice each way ; seize an eye on the bight, large enough to go over the breach of the ^un ; put over the eye, and put the slings along the upper part of the gun, lashing them with a piece of rope round all, just for- ward of the trunnion ; put the other end over the muzzle, and in toggle. Lash the purchase-block to the bight of the slings, and also bend on a hawser to weigh the gun, in the event of parting 'lie purchase. " Sway away ;" drop the lighter from under the gun, and when the breach is as high as the port, hook the gar- net and alsoana-thwartship-tackle to the breech-ring ; haul on the tackle and bring the gun in through the port run a carriage un- der lower away ; place the trunnions fair, and clamp them ; come up the purchases, and transport the gun to its port. The lower and main-deck guns are got in in the same way. The can- nonades are taken over the rail ; a toggle is put in the muzzle, one bight of the slings over the cascable, the other over the muz- zle, and back-lashed to the toggle ; the stay or purchase-block is lashed on midships of the slings, and the stay or pendant-tackle to the same place; consequently the gun will coma in square. Have the bed and slide ready, place it fair, and drive in the naval- bolt. Ship the screws, beds, and coins ; reeve the breeching, hook side and train-tackles ; see the guns square in the ports, and secure them. The main-deck guns might be taken in over the rail and struck down the main-hatch ; but I prefer their being taken in through the port, if plenty of men. Note. The reason for having additional security on the main- yard is, because in getting in the guns, the strain is altogether on the yard ; while in getting up the anchors, the strain is di- vided between two yards. The burtons are sometimes frapped in with the main-lift, between the yard and cap ; but I prefer their not being done so. as they will all render fairer, when the strain comes on them. It is customary to top the main-yard up ; but I saw a line-of-battle ship's guns got in without it, and as it orings a greater strain on the slings and trusses, it should not be .lone to so great an extent as is the practice. Cautirti. When the garnet-purchase is raising the breech tc HG THE KEDGE- ANCHOR, the level required to place the gun in its carriage, care must be taken that the main-purchase be not lowered by a turn, but that the men on the fall " walk back " with a steady step. When the gun is lodged in its carriage, it is removed to its proper port, and another carriage is rolled to the receiving port, 'eady for the reception of the next gun, and so on. 205. FITTING SHACKLE-BREECHINGS. If it be required to fit the breechings on this recently improved plan, it will be necessary to taper and point both ends of the rope preparatory to splicing or turning-in a shackle on each ex- tremity. The shackle should be turned-in and secured to each end of the breeching by two separate seizings, one close to the shackle, and the other towards the pointed end of the rope. They are frequently spliced into a thimble and then shackled, which I think is much neater.* By this simple and serviceable method, the breeching may be shifted in a few seconds, it being no longer necessary to reeve it through the ring at the breech. An opening is now made in the cascable, which admits the introduction of the breeching on the bight ; and the cascable fitted with a hinge or snatch, and some- times a bolt going through the cascable, confines the breeching and prevents it jumping out on the recoil of the gun. 206. TRIATIC STAYS. A double block is strapped into a pendant, a hook and thimble spliced into one end ; a single block is strapped with a hook and thimble, a fall is rove, the standing-part bent into a becket in the strap of the single block ; sometimes the double block is strapped, and the pendant spliced in over the seizing. A good strap with a thimble seized into it, is fitted to the strap of the lower block. A piece of rope is spliced round the strap of the fore-stay block, and the other end, when cut to the required length; spliced round the strap of the main-stay block, and seized. This is called the span, and is generally the length between the fore and main- * This last improvement was introduced by FRANCIS GRICE, Esq., chief Nava Constructor, U. S. N. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 1 17 hatchways. The main-stay hooks to a strap with a thimble in it, from round the main-mast-head on the fore side ; the fore from one abaft, fitted in the same manner. The main one gen- erally comes down alongside the slings, the fore one between the trestle-trees, abaft. The pendant and tackle are sometimes fitted separate, to hook, and are easier stowed away. Note. In case of emergency, these pendants may be taken round the mast-head, and hooked to their own parts. I have known some ships to use them this way altogether. 207 HOISTING IN SPARS. Overhaul down the fore and main-yard tackles, fore and main- ntays, and lead their falls to the opposite side of the deck the spars come in at. Hook burtons to the lower caps (double blocks), single ones to selvagees round the lower yard-arm, close inside the lifts. Send the falls on deck, and pull up the lifts and burtons together, and trusses ; brace the fore-yard in, and hook on to the spars. They should be always hoisted in as stowed.* If the spars are too long to come in abreast, between the fore and main-masts, such as topmasts, hook the main-stay to the strap round the foremost end, and fore-stay to the after one ; then hook the yards to separate straps made of pieces of stout "rope knotted together, or good selvagees, according to the weight of the spar. Man the yards and walk them up; when clear of hammock-nettings, haul on the main-stay, ease the fore and main-yards, keeping the spar square, and get the foremost end inside the rigging ; then ease the main-stay, and get the spar in its place on the booms. Small spars can be got in with the main-yard, a double whip on main-stay, or single guy if required. 208. STOWING BOOMS. The spars on the starboard side are stowed as follows, viz. : Main-topmast, head aft; main-topgallant, (mast-fishes) half-yard, main topmast studding-sail booms, and jib-boom. On the lar- * The spars intended to be stowed underneath, should be Hoisted in first ; such a.s topmasts, half-yards, and jib-boom, for the lower tier, and round off with the maller spars on the top. [18 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR 5 board side fore-topmast, head forward: fore-topgallant-mast> mast-fish, half-yard, fore topmast studding-sail booms, flying-jib- boom, &c. There are several small spars which are equally divided, to make the booms as snug and neat as possible. A great deal of room can be gained by stowing them amidships in one pile, and the boats on each side. As the spars are stowed, they should be numbered on each end, also a list taken, and painted on the fore- side of the boom-boards ; by so doing it will save much time and trouble to find any spar that may be required ; as I have seen all the booms unlashed before a spar was found. The booms are lashed to span-shackles in the deck for the purpose! A few small spars should be kept out, to drive under the lashing, to set all taut. When stowed they are covered with tarpaulins, or matting made for the purpose. When the spars are all in, square the yards. Note. It is becoming the general practice, to stow both top- masts with their heads forward. Many ships stow all their spars amidships in one pile, with the exception of the fore and main- topmasts, which are stowed outside of the boats ; spare main-top sail yard on the larboard-quarter, the fore on the starboard- quarter, in the chains, and spare jib-boom across the stern, secured underneath the stern-davits.* * Some ships stow topmasts and all amidships ; but this is a bad plan, as il would be necessary to take out all, to get a topmast if required, it being under- aeath. PART III. REEVING RUNNING RIGGING. 2O9 FORE BOWLINES. The fore bowlines have an eye in one end, to go over the tog- gle, and are rove through a single block, seized into a single strap, and secured to the fore-stay collar with a seizing passed through an eye left in the strap, and the other end led in on the forecastle. The fore and main clue-garnets are hitched to the yards, then rove through a block lashed in the clews of the sail, up through a block on the quarter of the yard, down to the fife-rail. 21O. POKE-TOPS AIL CLEWLINES. Topsail clewlines are fitted the same as clew-garnets, and sometimes with a whip ; they come on deck through lubber's hole. When fitted with a whip, a piece of rope nearly equal to the double clewline, is rove through the quarter-block, and an eye spliced in one end, which is secured with a seizing round the clew, when the sail is bent. In the other end, splice a single block, and reeve a fall through it ; one end splice into a bolt in the deck, and the other reeve through a leading-block, well apart from the standing-part. Note. The disadvantage of double clewlines, is, the points getting in the clew-blocks when clewing up, or sheeting home. 120 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; 211. TOPSAIL BUNTLINflS Are toggled to the foot of the sails, and rove thiough single blocks at the mast-head, underneath the rigging, and through lubber's hole on deck. Cheeks or sheaves set in the foremost end of the trestle-trees are best, as they keep the buntlines clear of /he belly of the sails. Blocks in bolts will do equally as well, but do not look so r. eat. I would recommend fitting a shoe- block underneath the eyes of the rigging, on each side, in prefer- ence. Buntline-spans are short pieces of rope, with a thimble in one end, and the other end whipped ; the buntlines are rove through these thimbles, before being bent to the sail, or rove at the mast- head. At sea these spans are knotted together, abaft the tye- blocks on the yard, and stopped to them. When in harbor, they are let go, to allow the sails being triced well-up to furl, or hauled 5ut to dry, by the bowlines, when toggled to the foot of the sail. 212. FORETOP BOWLINES Have an eye spliced in one end to go over the toggle on the Bridle ; the other is rove through a block at the bowsprit-cap, strapped into a bolt, or a sheave cut in the after end of the bees and led in on the forecastle. 213. MAIN BUNTLINES. There are two on each quarter, and reeve on the bights. Reeve first through the large sheave in a shoe-block, then reeve both ends, from forward, through the double block under the fore part of the main-top, and bend or clinch both ends to the holes in the foot of the sail for the purpose. Sometimes toggles are fitted into the holes, with double straps, and an eye spliced into each end of the buntlines. If no shoe-block is to be got, seize two single ones into one strap. Through the other sheave of shoe-block, reeve a fall ; clinch one end to the main-stay by the foremast, or splice an eye and seize it round it. The other end reeve through a leading block, seized into a single strap, leaving an eye to seize it to the stay, or through a sheave or leading block in the fore-bitts. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 14. FORE BUNTLINES Generally toggle to the foot of the sail, and are sometimes :linched ; then rove through a double block under the fore part of the fore-top, and through fair leading sheaves in the racks to the bulwarks^ The buntline should be long enough to allow the sail to belly. The outside leg of the buntline is sometimes rove through a thimble strapped into the foot of the sail, and clenched into a cringle put into the bolt-rope, a few feet above the clew. 215. MAIN BOWLINE Is a runner and tackle, and is rove and unrove as required. It is rove through the thimble seized on the bowline bridle ; the end of the runner is secured round the fore-bitts, or to a cleat. The lower block of the gun-tackle purchase is fitted with a hook, and hooked to a strap close to the end of the runner, for the pur- pose. I have seen the main-bowline boused up to the weather- forecastle bulwarks, which I think preferable, not seeing any very great advantage from its being hauled amidships ; partic- ularly when it is considered that the main-topsail yard, on a wind, is braced abaft the main-yard. 216. TOPGALLANT SHEETS Are rove through the sheave in the topsail-yard, then through the after sheave in the double block in the quarter of the topsail- yard, and through a leading sheave or block on deck. The up- per end is bent to the clew of the topgallant-sail ; sometimes a long-eye is spliced, which goes over a toggle in the clew of the sail. They are also fitted with sister-hooks, which is the latest and most improved plan. 122 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 2 17. -TOPGALLANT CLEWLINES Are bent through the clew of the sail, and secured with a sheet- bend ; it is then rove through the foremost sheave on the quarter- block on the yard and sent down through lubber's hole on deck. 218. FORE TOPGALLANT BOWLINES Are toggled to the bridle of the sail. The fore one is rove through a single block at the jib-boom end, one on each side, and led in on the forecastle through fair leaders. These blocks are strapped like span-blocks, and lashed together on the upper side with two lashing-eyes ; they are sometimes strapped singly, and go over the boom-end, or seized to the guys. Double blocks are also sometimes put in these straps, and the two inner sheaves used as jib-brail-leaders. MAIN TOPGALLANT BOWLINES Are toggled to the bridle of the sail, then rove through sheaves cut in the after part of the fore-topmast-crosstrees, and through lubber's hole, through fair leading sheaves on deck. Single tail- blocks are sometimes used, clove-hitched round the after shroud in the fore-topmast rigging, close up to the futtock-stave, or seized. 22O. MIZEN TOPGALLANT BOWLINES Are toggled to the bridle of the sail, and rove through single blocks on each side of the main-mast head, and through fair leading blocks on deck. A double block is often used instead of two single ones on each side, one sheave for the brace, the other for the bowline. They should be led from lubber's hole abaft all, between the cat-harpen legs, or futtock-shrouds. OR VOTING SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 133 221. TOPGALLANT BUNTLINES Are seldom used in light weather, although very necessary in taking in sail, when blowing fresh, as they save much time, and in some instances a man's life. On a wind it spills the sail, and prevents its getting over the lee yard-arm ; and going free ena- bles the men to furl it much easier. A strong proof of their utility may be inferred from the fact that merchant vessels, who have as little rope rove as possible, and are generally weak-hand- ed, have their sails fitted with buntliues. They are fitted as follows : A piece of rope with a thimble on it, is spliced into two eyelet-holes, worked in the foot of the sail, about a third from eacli clew.* Splice the end of the buntline round the thimble ; reeve the other end through a single block, seized into a single strap, and secured round the topgallant mast- head by a lashing passed over all ; send the end of the buntline through lubber's hole, on deck before all to the fife-rail. 222 ROYAL BOWLINES. The fore royal-bowline is rove through a block at the flying- jib-boom end, and led in on the forecastle, through a fair leader, the same as the topgallant-bowline, and the main-royal bowlines through the chock at fore-topmast head. 223. REEF-TACKLES Are sometimes double, and also fitted with a whip, as clew- lines, or pendant and burton. When double, a single block is seized into a single strap, having a thimble in it. and the seizing passed between the block and thimble. This block goes on the bridle, or cringle, in the leech of the topsails. One end of the reef-tackle is clinched round the neck of the boom-iron, the other rove through the block, up through the sheave in the yard-arm, and through the upper sheave in the sister-block, through lul> oer's hole, and through a leading block or sheave on deck. This piece of rope is called a span. 124 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; When single, an eye is spliced in the end of the pendant, to gc over a toggle fitted to a bridle, as above ; the other end rove through the yard and sister-block, a single block spliced into the end, and a whip rove, as on the clewline. Note. The generality of naval ships use their top-burtons with its ; some object to thi short hide-pendants ; some object to this, as the top-burtons may be wanted, when they are in use as reef-tackles. 224. LEECH-LINES. The forward leech-lines are rove through the upper sheave-hole of a shoe-block ; both parts are then rove through a double block, hooked with a pendant to the lower cap, then through two single blocks seized to the jackstays on the yards, and are clinched to the leeches of the courses, forward of the sail. The lower legs are rove through the other sheave-hole in the shoe-block, and the standing-part made fast to the fife-rail ; the other end being used to haul up the sails. The after leech-lines are rove through blocks on the under- neath part of the yard, and clinched to the courses abaft the sail, to the same places as the forward ones. Note. Shoe-blocks are now pretty much out of fashion when they are not used, both parts of the leech-lines are led on deck and the whip-purchase dispensed with. 225. SLAB-LINES Are bent to the middle of a span at the foot of the sail, led up abaft, and rove through a block lashed to the grommet or span, around the straps of the quarter-blocks of the lower yards, and down on deck. These are very necessary in light weather, and in rough weather, may be converted into spilling-lines. 226. KOYAL CLEW-LINES Are bent to the clews of the sail, rove through the quarter- olocks on the yard, and led either in the tops, or on deck. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 135 2 2 7. FITTING TACKS AND SHEETS, BUMKIN- GEAR, &c. A single block is seized into a single strap, leaving an eye to fit. the bumkin ; this block is made with a shoulder, which lays on the bumkin when the block is on. Bumkin-braces are now generally chain ; one is hooked to the bow, and two to the cutwater ; and set up with a lanyard rove through span-shackles in their ends, and others on the bumkin, or with a turnbuckle. Reeving the tack. Clinch the large end round the oumkin, outside the block, having been well wormed, parceled, and served, far enough towards the small end to take the block on the bum- kin, when the sail is reefed. Reeve the small end through the block in the sail, then through that on the bumkin, and in on the forecastle through a hole in the bulwarks, for the purpose. Fore sheet. The large end is served the same as the tack, and is hooked into a bolt in the side for the purpose ; the small end is rove through the block in the sail, and through a sheave in the side, or gangway bulwarks. Large ships generally work the fore-sheet in the waist (main-deck), but it is often worked on the gangway, (spar-deck). 228. YARD TACKLE TRICING-LINES. If no cheek on the yard, take the pendants taut along from the yard-arm, and then secure a single tail-block. On the fore- most shroud, well up, seize another single block, fitted with a single strap, leaving room when seized-in, for the seizing with which it is secured to the shroud. Round the fiddle-block in the pendant, between both sheaves, secure the tricing-line with a running-eye ; then reeve the other end through the cheek, or tail- block, and then through the single block on the shroud, and on deck. 229. TO REEYE AND TOGGLE ROYAL-HALLIARDS. Take a round-turn with the yard-rope, well up round the strap of the block, with the long-eye ; reeve the bight through the eye and put the toggle in it; then bring the end up from the block 126 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; seized to the eye of the shroud, and reeve it through the one on the yard-rope, send the end on deck, and reeve it through a lead- ing block. When half-hitched, the lower block is fitted as described, and secured ; the upper one is strapped with a thimble in the strap reeve the yard-rope through the thimble, and then through the lower block, up through the upper one, and on deck through a leader. 23O. FORE STORM-STAYSAIL GEAR. To fit the stay. Take a piece of good rope of proportionable size to the sail ; fit one end with two legs as a stay, and lash them abaft the foremast-head, the legs being placed underneath those of the standing-stay. Take a piece of rope the round of the bowsprit, inside the fore-stay collar ; splice an eye in each end, and seize a thimble in the bight splice a lashing in one eye, and secure the strap round the bowsprit, by passing it through both eyes, until sufficient turns are taken to secure it. Reeve the end of this stay through the hanks for the sail, then reeve it through the thimble in the strap, and set it well up with a luff-purchase ; the double block hooked to a strap well up the stay, the single one to another strap on the end ; then pass a round-seizing round both parts, close to the thimble come up the luff, and pass another seizing between it and the end, but not at too great a distance, as it will prevent the sail from coming close down. Halliards. Have a good strap to go round the foremast-head, close to the stay. It can be fitted with two lashing-eyes, and when so fitted can be easier taken off, and put on. When the sail is to be set, hook the double block of a luff-tackle to this strap, and the single one to the head of the sail ; the hauling- part being sent down abaft the fore-yard, and through a leading block on deck. Downhaul. A single block is secured to the parts of the strap round the bowsprit the downhaul is spliced to the head of the sail, then rove through the hanks, through the single block, and led in on the forecastle. When a stay is fitted, the downhaul block is seized to the strap round the bowsprit. The downhaul is often double ; if so, a single block is secured to the head of the sail, the standing-part of the downhaul secur- ed to the strap on the bowsprit, and the hauling-part led in as before. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 127 Sheets. Deck-tackles are generally used, one on each side : .hey are hooked to the clew of the sail, and the hooks well moused. When the sheet is aft, the weather one is overhauled. The after blocks are hooked to eye or ring-bolts, as convenient, and should not be too high or too low ; if too much up and down, they slack the foot of the sail ; if too high, the after leech. The falls are rove through leading blocks, and the all hooks should be well moused. Note. These stays when set up, may be secured cutter-stay- fashion, instead of seizing the end up, which will allow the sail to haul close down on the bowsprit. 231. MAIN STAYSAIL GEAR. The stay is fitted the same as the fore, and sets up round the cross-piece in the fore bitts, after being rove through the hanks. The halliards are fitted the same as the fore. The downhaul is rove through a block strapped round the bitts for the purpose. If rove double they are fitted in the same manner. Instead of iron hanks, I have seen grommets used, made of pieces of rope, with a wall-knot worked on one end, and an eye spliced in the other ; these are long enough to go round the stay and becket. They are secured to eyelet-holes in the sail with a seizing, and are always kept to it. I have seen the sails set on the spring-stays, when fitted in this way, but prefer separate stays. There are also other ways of setting storm-staysails, but those I have mentioned are in most general use. When a main-trysail can be got, mizen-staysails should never be drawn, as a ship will keep much better to windward with trysails and fore-staysail, than under the staysails alone. 232 MIZEX-STAYSAIL GEAR. The halliards are hitched to the collar of the staysail-stay, rovr through a block in the head of the sail, then through a. leader, and led down on deck. The downhaul is clinched to the head of the sail, and rove 128 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; ^ through the hanks down the mizen-stay. The mizen staysail- sheet is a runner, leading through a snatch-block and thimble. A gun-tackle purchase is most commonly used, which answers all purposes. 233. TOPMAST STAYSAILS, &c., &c. Fore. The standing part of the halliards is seized or hitched to the fore topmast spring-stay, then rove through a block in the head of the sail, up through a leading block under the eyes of the topmast rigging, then down on the larboard side of the deck abaft the foremast. The down haul is hitched to the head of the sail, rove through the hanks, then through a block seized to the tack of the sail, and led in on the forecastle, through a fair leader. The tack is a simple lashing. The fore topmast staysail and jib-sheets are pendants lashed to the clew of the sail, with a block in the end, through which the sheets are rove; the standing part is hooked to an eyebolt in the bows, and the running part is led in on the forecastle. Main. The standing part of the halliards is hitched to the collar of the main-topmast spring-stay, reeving through a block at the head of the sail, then through a block at the main- top- mast head, and led down on deck. The downhaul is fitted the same as the fore, and led down by the fore-mast. The tack is rove through a block in the weather fore-rigging, or top. The main topmast staysail-brails are seized to the leech of the sail, led up through the hanks to a block seized to the upper hank, and can also be used as a downhaul. The middle, lower, and upper topgallant-staysails and jack- stays, may be fitted in one. In this case a double block is turn- ed in, and lashed to the after part of the fore-topmast crosstrees, or mast-head ; the lower part is set up in the fore- top, and the upper part at the fore-topgallant mast-head. The middle staysail-stays are rove through a single block, strapped to the topmast, down on the cap. The lower and upper topgallant staysail-stays, are rove through blocks fitted to traverse the jackstay, with lock-thimbles, the former being rove through the other sheave of the double block at the topmast cross-trees ; the latter through a block at the fore-topgallant mast-head, and both led on deck. The downhaul blocks are single, and are seized to the straps of the tricing-line blocks, The halliards are whips hitched to the collars of the stays, rove through blocks in the head of the sail, OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 129 ihrough leading blocks at the mast-head, and down on deck. The tacks are single and led in the fore-top; the sheets are also single, leading in the gangways. Note. The principle object to be attended to, in reeving run- ning-rigging, is to avoid the ropes being too much crowded in one place, crossing or chafing each other, or any part of the stand- ing rigging, as it not only destroys it, but also decreases the de sired purchase to be obtained by their running clear of each other. 234. SETTING UP KIGGING FOR A FULL-DUE Have all the luffs on deck ; fore, main, and mizen pen dant-tackles hooked, and tackle-falls laid along for pulling up; new lanyards ready for reeving, seizings, marling- spikes, levers, mallets, grease, small spars for ratling-down, triangles rigged ready for hoisting up the mast, to secure the futtock-shrouds and cat-harpen legs, (if used;) burton- falls sent on deck and rove all the temporary ratlines cast- off spars got up underneath the bowsprit with the gra- tings for the men to work on topgallant-masts and flying jib-boom housed; and also men stationed at the dead-eyes to turn in if required. Let everything go abaft the masts, commence turning in the dead-eyes, and reeve the lan- yards set up the bowsprit-rigging and secure it. Then man the pendant-tackles, set taut the after-swifters (if wedges in) get the mast well forward in its place, and se- cure the stays. Cast off the cat-harpen legs (if fitted), and futtock-shrouds.* Set up the rigging for a full-due, observing the same precautions as when it was first set up. The lanyard is now rove full, and when racked, take the end and form a clove-hitch above the dead-eye, then rack the surplus- end to the inside parts of the lanyard, until the end is expended. The hitch is formed between the dead-eye and shroud, around both parts, in the space left by stretching some use a half-hitch taken over all round the shroud, hove well back, the lanyard ex- pended, and the end seized. The ends of the shrouds are then cut square and capped, and the mats laced on. Rigging-mats are made with small rope, three-quarter-inch. Vessels having their futtock-rigging set up to bands round the mast, use no cat-harpen legs, and have therefore no occasion of coming up either of the above 30 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; and are called sword-mats. They are generally the breadth oi the dead-eye, and long enough to take in both the lanyards are laced inside. They are hardly ever used on topmast rigging ; they look heavy, and are of no use, except on the forward dhrouds and backstays. 235. STAYING MASTS. The practice of " staying masts with the wedges in/' has been already denounced as contrary to every received system of sea- manship. The stays may be set taut with the wedges in, but the masts should be always free in the partners, whenever there is occasion to alter the position of their standing ; because it is impossible but that the precise situation of the mast must be al- tered a little, rendering necessary corresponding alterations in the wedges. When these are made and the wedges firmly fixed there can be no inequalities of play or pressure the whole be- comes a solid mass, yielding naturally and uniformly to the motion of the ship. Whereas, if in setting up the rigging the wedges be kept fast, the mast pressing unequally against them, having too much play in one part, and too little in another, it must inevitably get crippled. In preparing to set up the rigging, though the stays may not appear to require a pull, it is well to have the luffs and tackle ready ; for after lifting the wedges, there is great probability of its being found necessary. 236. BLACKING RIGGING. The most convenient method of blacking rigging, is with the topgallant masts on deck, but royal and topgallant rigging placed at the mast-heads ; for then men who ride down and black the topmast-stays, can then at the same time easily black the topgal- lant and royal-stays ; or, what is handier still let the men at the mast-head haul over and black these small stays, and pay them down forward when done. The men also who black down the topmast-backstays, can carry on at the same time with the topgallant and royal-backstays. By this method the masts are kept clean. If, on the other hand, topgallant-masts be kept up when black- ing, the small stays and backstays must be let go, in order that OR YOUXG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. they may be got at by the men on the topmast-stays and back- stays; consequently the masts must be adrift, are likely to be daubed over with blacking, and if it should come on to blow fresh, so as to render it necessary to get the topgallant-masts on deck, much injury must result to the blacking. The topsail and lower lifts should be blackened first, the men having to stand on the yards to do them. Previous to commencing, the decks should be well sanded, and the paint-work and head covered with old canvass. The quarter- tackle should be clapped on one side of the main-yard, and also a burton hooked, ready for clearing boats. The finer and warmer the day, the better the blacking will lay on so much the smoother and thinner ; but commencement should be delayed until the dew is well dried off. A dry calm day is the best ; for the blacking will not take effect, unless the surface it is laid upon be dry. 237. STATIONING THE CREW. In dividing the crew into watches, care should be taken that the physical force is as equally distributed as possible, and that there be as many seamen, ordinary seamen, boys, and marines, in one watch as in another. Petty officers should be chosen from among the seamen, and 'hose selected who have been long in the service, and have proved faithful. Forecastle men should be middle-aged seamen, with a few ordinary seamen and landsmen. Young active sea- men should be selected for topmen, also a few ordinary seamen, landsmen and boys. After-guard, a few elderly seamen, w T ith ordinary seamen and landsmen. Waisters are chiefly landsmen, with a few ordinary seamen; in single-decked vessels, where there are no waisters, more men should be stationed on the fore- castle and in the after-guard, in proportion to the number of the crew of the different classes of vessels. Idlers are excused from keeping watch they are officers' servants, cooks, &c., &c. Divide each watch into first and second parts, and appoint a captain to each part ; number the men belonging to the fore- castle, having all the larboard watch even, as two, four, six, and the starboard odd ; have the numbers painted on canvass, and let each man sew it on his bag and hammock ; having also for greater distinction, the larboard painted red, and the starboard black. The men should be below alternately, so that when one watch is below, there should be an equal number of the other watch on deck. 11 '32 THE KEDGE-ANCHOK: 238o STATIONING THE CREW AT QUARTERS, Captains of the guns should be chosen from among the sea men who have been long accustomed to them, steady, with good sight, and quick motion. The largest and stoutest men should be chosen to man the long guns, the others the cannon - ades. The boarders should be stout men the firemen and sail trimmers, active young men. Be particular to station them at? near where they are accustomed to do their duty as possible, in order to prevent confusion. Let alt the first part of the gun'u crew be in one watch, and the second part in the other, so that in the event of going to quarters in the night, the watch on deck can clear away the guns, while the watch below will clear away the hammocks. To a twelve-pounder cannonade are stationed four men and one boy. All the men stationed at the long guns of a double- decked ship, should be armed with cutlasses, and called "board- ers" the first of the gun's crew to be called second boarders, and vice, versa. They are only to be called on when required to "board," or in a case of great emergency to "repel boarders," and then every man will repair to the upper-deck, except the firemen, quarter-gunners, and powder boys, who will remain below to pro- tect the ports, or to assist in extinguishing a fire. All the men stationed at the cannonades should be boarders and sail-trimmers. As boarders, the first part should be armed with pikes; the second part with small-arms, who are to repel the boarders, but not to quit the ship. In a single-decked ship, all the men stationed are boarders ; the first part to be armed with cutlasses, and the second with pikes. The battery being manned, distribute the rest of the crew as follows: have a quarter-master at the signals, when in a squad- OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 133 ion topmen and marines in the tops, to repair damages, and act as small-arm-men a quarter-master and two men at the re- lieving tackles men stationed at the passages, to pass full and empty boxes; also others at the shot-lockers. Mastmen to see the rigging clear cook, and armorer at the galley the carpen- ter and his mates at the pumps and wings the master-at-arms, and ship's corporal in the light-room the gunner, his mates, quarter-gunners, and cooper, in the magazine, and the surgeon and assistants in the cock-pit. 239. STATIONING THE CREW FOR MOORING AND UNMOORING. In stationing the men, place the same number of men, of each watch, to perform a piece of duty. When in a squadron, have quarter-masters at the signals, and also in the chains men at the wheel quarter-gunners to overhaul the fish, and grapple the buoys men to overhaul and hook the cat, and attend the back- ropes ; also others at the mast, to see the rigging clear. Boat- swain's mates in the gangways ; carpenter's mates to ship and unship the capstan bars, and attend the stanchions, with the music at the capstan some fore-topmen to put on nippers, or sel- vagees, some main-topmen to take them off, and boys to carry them forward. Hands to rouse up and veer away the cable, to attend the stoppers, and light forward the messenger. The yeo- man in the store-room master-at-arms, and ship's corporal on I he berth-deck, and cook at the galley tierces in each tier, or ,hain-locker, and the remainder of the men at the capstan. 2 4O. LOOSING AND FURLING. Take the same number of men from each w r atch, and station them at the same rope, &c. The topmen are to man their re- spective yards hands are to attend the boom-jiggers and tricing- lines forecastle men to attend head-sails, trysail and foresail main-yard men to look out for the main-sail after-guard, for the spanker and main-trysail for the main-topmast staysail, the fore-top-men for the main-staysail, the gunner's crew hand stationed to sheet home, and hoist the topsails, and when coming to an anchor, the same men to man the clew-lines, bunt-lines, and weather-braces ; and when loosing sails to dry, to man bow- ]34 THE KEUGE- ANCHOR; lines, or buntlines. In furling, the captains are to be in the bunt, in reefing, at the earings. 241. STATIONING THE CREW FOR TACKING AND VEERING. Station the men from the "watch bill" have hands at the fib-boom end, to overhaul the jib-brails, and light over flying-jib sheets. On the bowsprit end to light over jib-pendants hands on the bumkins, and in the chains, to overhaul tacks and sheets, and backstay-falls. On deck, at the wheel, spritsail-braces, jib- sheets, jib-brails, braces, bow-lines, clew-garnets, tacks and sheets, backstay-falls, lifts, trusses, spanker-sheets, guys, vangs, and top- ping-lifts. Aloft, to overhaul lifts and trusses attend outriggers, and bear the backstays abaft and abreast the mast-men to see the rigging clear, &c., &c. For reefing. The men are stationed as in furling, with the exception of the captains, who are stationed at the earings. When the yards are down, the men from the clew-lines and bunt-lines will haul out the reef-tackles. 242. GETTING READY TO BEND SAILS. It is customary to bend the light sails first, such as jibs, span- kers, and trysails. Overhaul the jib and flying-jib stay, and hal- liards, in on the forecastle. Have the lashing spliced into the sheets ready for passing, and seizings to the hanks. Overhaul down into the top the reef-tackles, and stop the blocks to the foremost shrouds, (or the end if single.) Overhaul the topsail-sheets from the yard-arm, and half-hitch them round a dead-eye, or foremost futtock-plate. Bunt-lines into the top, and stop them to the foremost shroud, above the topsail-yard, or to the tye-blocks clew-lines into the top, and stop them to the eye of a shroud, and get the harbor-gaskets on the yards. A rope-yarn stop will be quite sufficient for all these purposes. Both burtons should be overhauled on deck before all. Overhaul down the leech-lines, slab-lines, bunt-lines and clew- garnets, and stop them so as to prevent their flying about. Take two selvagee-straps, put them round the neck of the boom-irons, and to them hook the double-block of a long jigger; OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 135 the single one overhaul down, and hook to a ring or eye-bolt in the bulwarks, and the fall led through a leading block a-m id- ships. Lower down the gaffs overhaul the brails, and have seizings of two-yarn spun-yarn ready, to secure them to the sails. If hoops, seizings should also be put on them, w r ith both ends rove through the bight. Topgallant yards should be got out of the rigging, and laid on deck out of the way, ready for bending the sails. Top-burtons overhauled down forward of all, for the topsails. Note. When the preparations above stated are made, it is in tended to bend all the sails together. 243. BENDING SAILS. Call all hands to bend sails get the courses, jib, topsails, and spanker, on deck. Open them out, and see that they are whole and complete; with the bowline-bridles, head and reef-earings, rope-bands, reef-points, sheet, clew-line, and reef-tackle blocks all in their proper places. Bight the topsails down in their re- spective places forward of the masts, with the clews out. Hook the lower block of the burton to the slings passed round the centre of the sail, and mouse the hook reeve the fall through a snatch-block or leader, and keep the sail clear of the top as it goes up. Overhaul the courses athwart the deck, shackle on the sheet, and also the tack, and clew-garnet blocks reeve and bend the gear stop the head of the sail to the bunt-lines, use the clew- jiggers for yard-ropes, hooking to the first reef-cringle, and stop the head earings to the block. The end of the jib-stay having been brought in on the fore- castle, reeve in the hanks, and stop the luff of the jib hook on the halliards reeve the downhauls fit the brail-block and reeve the brails hook on the sheet-blocks, or pendants, and reeve the sheets. Lower the spanker-gaffpass the throat and peak-earings, and lace the head to the gaff seize on the brails, and reeve them and the outhauler. All being ready, To man the gear. First, man the top-burtons and sway the topsails clear of the deck man the jib-halliards and downhaul yard-ropes, clew-garnets, clew-lines, bunt-lines, reef-tackles, and gaff-halliards : at the word run out the jib, reeve and set up the stay, and seize the tack. Sway the topsails and courses up to the yards, where some hands are ready to receive them. Bend 136 THE KEDGE ANCHOR; the gear and haul out; then take a turn with the earings lidt down the heads and pass the earings exactly ; make fast the rope- bands, fit the leech-line block of the courses seize on and reeve the leech line. In the mean-time some hands are employed in seizing on the hoops of the trysails and spanker, as they go aloft. After the sails are all bent, it would be well to let them fall, to see that all the gear is bent clear, if so, clew up and furl the courses and topsails, and stow the jib, spanker and trysails. The topgallant-sails, royals, and studding-sails are bent on deck. Send the staysails into the tops, fit the jackstays and tricing- line blocks, seize the head of the luff; reeve the halliards, down- hauls, and brails, bend the tacks and sheets ; stow the staysails and haul all taut. Note. The staysails are not all allowed by the new Book of Allowances. 244. BENDING SMALL SAILS. By small sails are meant topgallant-sails, royals, flying-jib, ytudding-sails and staysails. It is only in ships in good order where the men go through this manoeuvre with smartness and method, after being exercised, and having become familiar with the ship and their stations. First, all the yards, topgallant, royal, and studding-sail, should be got out of the rigging, and down on deck at the same time. Next, a proportion of hands should be sent to each sail, and all bent together, including flying-jib and staysails. When the topgallant-sails, royals, and studding-sails, are all bent, they should be swayed into the rigging all together, and not one after another. If the topgallant-yards happen to be across, the best plan, if circumstances will permit, is to bend all the other small sails iirst, except the flying-jib, and then to wait until the yards are sent dow r n at sunset, to bend topgallant-sails and flying-jib. Topgallant sails ought not to be bent while the yards are across, because the earings must then be hauled out, and passed over the lifts and braces, which precludes the possibility of un- rigging the yard afterwards, without unbending the sail. Some- times one of the two sets of topgallant-yards are appropriated in harbor to exercise, (sending up and down) while the other is kept below, with the sail bent, ready for crossing. (JK YOUISG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 137 In bending topgallant-sails, the earings are passed the same as the topsail, and the sail seized to the jackstay, the yard-rope bent, the sails furled, and the yard got into the lower rigging. In furling, bring the leeches taut along the yard, and keep the clews in the bunt, then roll the sail up from the yard-arm, and pass the gaskets. Put the grommet over the yard-arm, man the yard- rope and sway the yard up and down ; put the lower yard-arm into the snotter, over the foremost dead-eye; secure the upper yard-arm with a lanyard spliced round the shroud for the pur pose ; it is called a stop. The lizard should be singled, ready for going aloft, by reeving it once through the thimble on the yard- arm, and half-hitch round the yard-rope with the bight. Trysails and storm-staysails should be bent at this time, if they are to be bent at all before leaving harbor. Note. Good rope-yarns answer very well for robins for topgal lant-sails and royals. You are never at a loss for them in bend- ing, and in unbending they are easily cut. 245. BENDING A SPANKER. Overhaul the brails well, and pass the sail through their bights. Haul the earing in the jaws out first; then the outer one. Splice the lacing into the outer eyelet-hole, lacing, and secure the lacing in the jaws. Bring the after-leech taut, along the gaff, and within a few inches of the blocks ; mark the place for the throat-brails, also for the peak, opposite their respective cheeks on the gaff, and seize the brails to the leech-rope, by pass- ing the seizing between the strands and round the brails. Eye let-holes, worked close to the leech-rope, are far preferable for seiz ing the brails to. The throat-earing is generally passed through an eye-bolt in the lower part of the jaws ; but this never brings the sail close to the mast, and looks very bad. In preference, I would recommend having a score cut under the leather in the jaws, and the earing passed from the cringle through this score, and an eye-bolt on the upper side of the jaws, back through the cringle, and so on, until sufficient turns are taken to secure the sail. Large staples also are fitted to the jaws for the purpose, and keys on top, which answer better, and are more secure ; also bending battens, instead of lacing round the gaff. The outer earing is passed round a cleat on the upper side of the gaff, for the purpose. Take the earing from the cringle, pass it round outside the cleat, back through the cringle, and round the cleat, until sufficient t irns are taken ; then take several inner [38 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; turns round the gaff and cringle ; frap all the outer turns togetnei with the remaining part of the earing, to bring the parts close^ and prevent any chance of their slipping over the cleat ; take two half-hitches, expend, and seize the end. To haul out this earing, and stretch the head of the sail well, use a small jigger ; secure the double block to an eye-bolt in the end of the gaff, pass three turns of the earing, cat's-paw the end, to which hook the other block, and pull the earing well out. I have frequently seen only one earing used ; but would prefer two. as all inner turns, when much strain is on them, should have a separate earing. If a new sail, and requires much stretching, it is hauled well out before passing the earing, by hooking the in- ner block of the jigger to the cringle. Man the throat and peak- halliards, hoist the sail up gradually, seize the hoops, and reeve the lacing. Note. Trysails are bent in the same manner. Some fit them to haul in and out on the gaff, with hoops. 246. FITTING SEA-GASKETS. Gaskets are made with foxes, or small spun-yarn, and platted, like making sennit. The spun-yarn is middled over the bolt, and platted together, the bight forming the eye ; sometimes a piece is platted for the eye, then all worked together; if not. the eye is served over afterwards. Sea-gaskets are long enough to have only two on each yard-arm, and to furl the sail over booms and all, when close-reefed, as there will be no more sail on the yard-arms than at any other time. They are secured round the jackstay, by reeving the end through the eye ; sometimes round the yard. 247. -FITTING HARBOR-GASKETS. In making, the eye is left large enough to take a small thim- ble, then platted broader in the centre, and tapered to a small end. The broad part should be long enough to make the sail in when furled with two reefs. They may be (to look well) about two-and-a-half inches wide, but this is quite a matter of taste. When put on the yard, the thimble is put underneath the jack stay from forward, and secured to it by a seizing passed round the neck of the gasket and jackstay, close to the thimble, and when the sail is ready for their being passed, it is taken up and rove OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 139 through the thimble, and the sail tossed well up ; the end then shoved underneath between the sail and gasket, once or twice. These always look better than any other, are easier passed and secured, and keep the sail well up. There is generally one har bor-gasket to every other seam. 248. BUNT-GASKETS. These are always, as to fitting, a matter of taste, but at present they are generally made of wove mat, two or three inches wide, with the two legs crossed, and an eye in each end. I have seen them made of rope, in the following manner : Take the dis- tance between the two quarter blocks, and measure it off on deck : drive a nail slightly into the deck at each end ; then measure from the centre the height the bunt is intended to be, and there drive another nail. Take a piece of rope, from two and a half to three-inch, and measure off sufficient to go over these nails, form- ing a triangle ; splice both ends together, and seize a thimble in each corner ; put these thimbles over the nails again, and fill the space in diamonds or squares, according to fancy. The thimbles in each end are secured by the quarter-blocks to the jack- stay, and also in the centre. It is not necessary to have thim- bles in each end, as an eye will answer every purpose. A long sennit-gasket is middled and seized by the upper thimble; it should be sufficiently long to go round the mast, when the gas- ket is boused up, to secure it and the bunt well into the mast. 249. HAMMOCK GIRTLINES. Whips are rove at the yard-arms. If rope is not used on purpose for girtlines, the studding-sail halliards will answer ; they are rove as follows : A tail block is put on each side of the jib-boom end, and another on the spanker-boom. Overhaul down the whips, and bend them round the girtlines with a bowline knot, allowing room for their rendering through. Belay the foremost ends of the girtlines and trice up ; haul upon the after-part, and get all taut. A man lays out on each yard-arm, and marks the girt- line with rope-yarns where the tricing line, or a whip, should be bent ; then lower away, cast off the bowline knot, and bend the tricing lines round the girtlines with a rolling hitch. The whips are led from the lower yards to the lower caps, through blocks hooked to the bolts, aiid on deck. The lower L4(J Ttte KEDGE- ANCHOR; end of the tricing-line is often bent to the girt-line as an inhau. or downhaul ; but it is best to have them separate, as it prevents walking the hammocks up, and laying across the deck; and there are plenty of other ropes' ends w lich will answer the same purpose. When one girt-line of a side is not enough, others are rove in- side in the same manner. The generality of ships reeve them inside of the lower rigging, as they are much easier got down, and the hammocks are not so likely to get dirty, or overboard. 250. STOPPING ON HAMMOCKS. Every man should be obliged to have three knittle-stops at the head, and two at the foot of his hammock. When stopping on. they should overlay at each side about two or three inches, and be stopped together at the foot numbers up and in. The forecastle-men should stop their hammocks on forward, next foretop-men, next maintop-men, next mizentop-men, next after-guard, idlers, and boys. Boatswain's mates abreast of each hatchway. 251. FUELING OR STOWING THE BUNT OF A SAIL. When the sail is nearly rolled up, hook the bunt-jigger, bouse it well up, lower the buntlines, and shove the sail well into the skin, taking pains to keep the bunt square ; pass and secure the bunt-gasket take off the jigger lower and square the studding- sail booms, and pass the heel-lashings. 252. FURLING COURSES. The leeches are handed in along the yard, then the sail rolled up snug, with the ends of the points passed in towards the bunt, to give the sail a gradual increase in that direction. Pass the gaskets, lower the booms, and, if required, stop up the gear. Bowlines are stopped to the slings close down, and hauled taui on the forecastle. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 141 The bowline-bridles of all sails, in furling, are laid with the toggle towards the bunt, and bridles taut along the yard. When a sail is neatly furled, it appears neither above nor be- low the yard earings well slewed up sail smooth under the gas- kets, bunt square, and a taut skin. The heels of the booms should be square, and every thing necessary completed, previous o squaring the yards. 253. MAKING UP SAILS. In making up a course, stretch the head of the sail well taut along the deck or loft ; bring up to the head the belly-band, then the foot, leaving the clew-blocks out at each end ; also the bow- line-bridles, and roll taut up ; pass the head-earing round the sail close inside the bolt-rope, and put a stop of good spun-yarn to every seam. The reef earings are made up in the sail. In making up a topsail, stretch the head of the sail taut along . ':ring the second reef up to the head, and lay all the points and earings snugly along ; then bring up the belly-band, and then thcj foot. The clew-blocks, bowline-bridles, reef-tackles, and toggles or span, should be left out, so that when the sail is sent aloft for bending, the sheets can be rove, reef- tackles and bowlines toggled, without loosing the sail, which will be found of great advantage when blowing fresh. Roll well up, stop with spun-yarn at each seam, and expend the head-earings round the ends of the sail. Topgallant-sails are made up with the clews out, and bowline- bridles, (if wished,) but they are always bent to the yards on deck ; so the neater, they can be made up the better. Note. The reef-earings of the topsails should be secured to the cringles, before rolling up ; bowline-hitch the end of the first reef-earing to the head, second to the first, third to the second, and fourth to the third reef cringles ; as there is sometimes much trouble in getting hold of an earing when it is not secured as above. All spare sails should be tallied, before being stowed in the sail- room, as it will prevent all mistakes ; but if a sail is properly stowed, and the master and sailmaker take a list when they ar stowing, there never can be any difficulty in finding what ma] be wanted. Royals are made up the same as topgallant-sails. |42 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 254. TO MAKE UP A TOPMAST STUDDING-SAIL. Stretch the sail taut along, and overhaul the downhaul through the thimble and block, and bight it along the whole length of the leech. Then roll up towards the inner leech, lay the sheets along the whole length of the sail, roll up over all, and stop the sail well up with spun-yarn or foxes. The earings are expended round the head of the sail when bent to the yard. Note. The topgallant studding-sail is also made up in the same manner. 255. FURLING FORE AND AFT SAILS, (WITH CLOTHS OR COVERS.) The jib is hauled close down, and the sea-gasket passed round it The cloth is then placed over, and the stops tied. Eyelet- holes are made in each edge for the stops. Jib-sheets and hal- liards stopped, and hauled taut. Furling Spanker. It is also furled best with a cover ; it can be furled in the two after cloths, the same as a jib, but it never looks so well, takes time, and in most instances has to be loosed two or three times before it gives satisfaction. In furling with a cover, the sail is brailed close up, and the cover stopped round, commencing from the end of the gaff, and working in to the mast, and down on deck. Trysails are stowed in the same manner as spankers. The fore-topmast staysail is stowed as a jib, in the netting.* Note. Stowing fore and aft sails requires more handy-work than seamanship, the principal thing being to furl them in the smallest compass, and in the after cloths, as it brings the seams up and down. I have seen staysails admired for their neatness from the deck, when the greater part of the sails were lying loose in the top. This should be avoided as much as possible, as something should be sacrificed in appearance, to preserve a sail from injury. Taking a little trouble will get all the sail in the skin ; and although it may be larger, it can be made to look neat. Jibs require more pains laken in stowing, than any of the other fore and aft sails. There is no necessity of stowing them in their own cloths, when furling cloths are allowed. (See allowance). * Canvass bottoms are used instead of nettings, for staysails OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 143 256. REEFING COURSES TO JACKSTAYS. When this plan is adopted there is only one point requisite, and that on the fore side of the sail; some use two, hut it is un- necessary. Reeve the point through the eyelet-hole from the after side, the points being made with eyes. Through the eyes reeve a small sized rope ; this is called the jack-line. Between every four eyelet-holes, stitch the rope well to the sail, on each yard- arm, leaving three points out. Take a piece of small rope, splice one end to the eyelet-hole in the head of the sail, reeve it through that left in the reef, and splice the other end into the same eye let hole in the head, leaving about two feet slack. This will be found of much use in gathering the sail up for reefing it is called a grab-rope, or reef-line. 257 . REEF-E ARINGS Are fitted the same as the head an eyelet-hole is worked be- low the cringle, large enough to take the earing; through this put the earing, reeve the end through the long-eye, and haul it taut through. The earings are sometimes put in the cringles, but the cringle cannot be so well hauled up on the yard, and consequently will not be so well secured for carrying sail ; and it not only puts more strain on the yard-arm points, but also injures the sail. They are also fitted on the bight, and passed on both ends ; one end for the outer turns, and the other the inner turns. To pass a reef-earing. For the first, second, and third reef, take it from the sail, on the foreside of the yard, round the cleat for the purpose, through the cringle, round the yard and through the cringle, until three or four outer turns are passed ; then reeve the bight through the cringle from aft forward take a round turn in the cringle ; then take the end from the latter under the yard up abaft over, and through the bight ; then back over the yard on the foreside, through the cringle, from underneath the yard ; slew the cringle well up, and leech off the sail, and pass sufficient turns to secure ; then expend the end round the yard and half-hitch round all, or a clove-hitch to the lift. A close reef-earing is passed the same way, but hauled out on the after side of the yard. Being hauled out abaft, it covers all the other reefs, and there being so much sail on the fore-side, it would never keep up. [44 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; In passing the outer turns for each reef, take two for the first; three for the second and third, and four for the fourth. For the inner turns, expend the earing, except your earings are fitted on the bight. 258. BENDING STUDDING-SAILS. All are bent to the yard alike, and the same precautions used as in other sails, keeping the rope next the yard. The earings are rove through the holes in the yard-arms, and cringle in the head of the sails ; two or three outer turns are taken, and the earing nearly expended in inner turns, then frap the outer turns together with the end, and half-hitch, if the sail is laced to the yard the lacing is spliced into one eyelet-hole, rove through the other, and passed round the yard. They are sometimes bent by half-hitching the lacing, which plan keeps the sail up, and much closer to the yard. A round turn is also used, by being passed round the yard-arm anil through the eyelet-hole twice, and from the latter through the next eyelet-hole, round the yard. They are then made up tha topmast studding-sail to the foremost shrouds of fore and main rigging ; topgallant, in foremost part of the topmast rigging ; and lower, on the booms. The topmast studding-sail is also some- times kept on the booms, and tarpaulin covers fitted for them. These sails are sometimes bent with long rope-bands, and un- bent when taken in and stowed away, if dry. In making up a topmast studding- sail, when bent, overhaul the down- haul the length of the luff or outer leech ; then take the foot up to the yard, and place the tack block out. Bight the down- haul along the yard, also the sheets ; roll the sail snugly up, and stop it with yarn^. Lower studding- sails are bent and made up in the same manner as topmast studding-sails, with the sheet in. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 145 1 have seen these sails when placed in the rigging ready foi letting, with the sheets and down haul left out and stopped to the yards ; the tack stopped from the lower yard, up and down the foremost shroud and bent to the sail. This was done with the idea that the sail could be set much quicker; but it was found that the sail on the opposite side (which was set in the general way), was set with less trouble, and in less time. There will be plenty of time to bend the tack and halliards (when the order is given to get ready), while getting burtons up, jiggers on topsail- lift, weather-braces taut, and rigging the booms out. Note. The topgallant studding-sail tack is generally kept bent, and slacked when bracing the yards up. It has frequently occurred to me, when I have heard the order from the quarter-deck, in the event of setting studding-sails, " to rig out and hoist away;" how can it be possible to rig out the fore-topmast studding-sail booms, when probably there may be fifty men clapped on the lower studding-sail halliards, hauling the booms in, and seldom more than six or eight men at the most, on the in-and-out jigger, trying to get the boom out. I should recommend to rig-out and secure first, then hoist a\vay. 259. PREPARATIONS FOR LEAVING THE WHARF AND HAULING OUT IN THE STREAM. To haul off and moor ship. Before hauling off, all the spare spars should be hoisted in and secured, boat's chocks placed, all the stores, provisions, and water got on board ; it would be also well to see that there is a sufficient quantity of brooms, bath- brick for cleaning bright-work, lime and size for whitewash, and everything that is allowed and requisite for the ship. The complement of men from the receiving ship should be got on iioard, and the boats provided with crews, oars, and sails. When everything necessary is completed, make preparations for hauling ofT. Get up kedges and hawsers ready for instant service ; have the ends of the hawsers pointed up each hatchway, ready for handing out if wanted. Run out a kedge, and drop it where the first, or weather-anchor is to be planted ; have lines from the ship to the shore single the fasts hang over fenders and out- riggers man the hawser, cast off the fasts, and warp off; check- ing her as may be necessary by the lines. When warped out to the kedge, run it up to the bows, and let go the weather anchor ; veer as fast as she will take it, assisting her in going astern by the mizen-topsail, if necessary. If to shoot her to either side, use the helm, jib, or spanker, and in case there is no wind, use kedges and hawsers. 12 [46 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; When a double scope is out, stopper the cable, and let go the second anchor furl the mizen-topsail bring-to on the weather cable, and heave in to the moorings ; moor a little taut, to allow for veering. If a hemp-cable, clap on the service, and veer to the hawse-hole. 260. CARRYING OUT AN ANCHOR WITH A BOAT. Hang the anchor to the stern of the boat by good stoppers, and have the buoy and buoy-rope attached to it ; pass the end of the cable or hawser out through the hawse-hole, and coil away enough of it in the bows of the boat, to reach the bottom. Now capsize the coil in the stern sheets, and then the end will be uppermost ; bend on to the anchor. There should also be a sufficient length of the hawser coiled away in the boat to reach the place destined for the anchor. When in the right place, heave over the buoy, and see that the buoy-rope is clear stand clear of the cable, and slip the stoppers. In case of making a guess-warp, vice versa. 261. MARKING THE LEAD-LINE. At two fathoms, two strips of leather ; at three fathoms, three strips of leather ; at five fathoms, a white rag ; at seven fathoms, a red rag ; at ten fathoms, a piece of leather with a hole in it ; at thirteen, the same as three ; at fifteen, the same as five ; at seventeen, the same as seven ; at twenty fathoms, two knots. Deep-sea lead-lines are marked the same, as far as twenty fa thorns, then add one knot for every ten fathoms, and a strip of eather for every five fathoms. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 147 262. HEAVING THE LEAD A hole is made in the upper part of the lead, a piece of rope rove through it, and both ends spliced together ;* an eye is spliced in the end of the line, put through this strap, the lead shoved through the bight, and hauled taut. Breast ropes are fitted in the chains, for the men to lean against when heav- ing the lead. They are made as sword- mats, tapered at each end, and secured to two shrouds, with seizings passed round them, and through the eyes in each. Heaving the lead is generally per- formed by a man who stands in the main chains to windward. Having the line all ready to run out, without inter- ruption, he holds it at a distance of nearly a fathom from the lead, and hav- ing swung it backwards and forwards three or four times, in order to acquire a, greater velocity with the swing, he then swings it over his head, and thence as far forward as is necessary ; so that by the lead sinking whilst the ship advances, the line may be almost perpen- dicular when it reaches the bottom. The person sounding then proclaims the depth of water, in a kind of singing manner. Thus : if the mark of five fathoms is close to the surface of the water, he sings out, " by the mark 5 !" and, as there are no marks at 4, 6, 8, &c., he estimates those numbers, and sings, "by the deep 4 !" &c. If he considers it to be a quarter, or a half, more than any particular number he sings out, " and a quarter 5 !" " and a half 4 !" &c. If he conceives the depth to be three quar- ters more than a particular number, he calls it a quarter less than the next ; thus, at four fathoms and three-quarters, he calls, " a quarter less 5 !" and so on. according to the depth of the water. * A leather becket may be used for light leads, insead of a rope strap. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR-, 263. MARKING A LOG-LINE Allow twelve fathoms for stray line, where stick in a white rag ; then at every forty-seven feet and six-tenths, mark the line as follows, viz.: at one, one leather ; at two, two knots ; at three, three knots ; and also having* a mark at every half-knot. The glasses should be proved with a good watch, having a second- hand. The principle of the log-line is, that a knot is the same part of a sea-mile, that half-a-minute is of an hour; therefore the length of a knot should be one-hundred-and-twentieth the length of a sea mile, or fifty-one feet ; but as it is more convenient to have the knot divided into eight parts, of six feet each, the pro- portional reduction is necessary in the glass. Therefore as 51 feet : 30 seconds : : 48 feet : 28, 4.17 seconds; but as the frac- tion can be more easily allowed in the line than the glass, another proportion is necessary, viz., as 28, 4.17 seconds : 48 feet : : 28 seconds to 47.6 feet, or the length of a knot. Note. Log-lines are kept on reels for the purpose. The length of the stray-line is regulated by the size of the ship. 264. GETTING READY FOR SEA. Observe and note the exact line of flotation. See that all the rigging is properly up, alow and aloft. See that the preventer- gear is on, as well as breast-ropes for leadsmen, and leads and lines in the chains. If requisite, grease the masts, jib and stay- sail-stays, lifts and trusses, and reef-pendants sheet-anchor stowed guns secured boats hoisted in and secured. Care should be taken that the harness-casks are lashed chests and OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. tables properly cleated, and binnacles secured. Let the armorer examine the slip-stoppers, and see that they are oiled, and in proper condition get the swinging-booms fore and aft awnings below, and awning ridge-ropes down down jack-staff see that the tiller-ropes are all clear, and that the tiller moves freely ; also that the relieving- tackles and spare tiller-ropes are at hand. Cross topgallant yards, bend the gear ; take the covers off the jibs, staysail, spanker, and trysails, and coil every rope down clear, for running have the studding-sails stopped, ready for going aloft, and the royal-halliards down on the weather side. Cat and fish overhauled down. Timenoguys in their respective places. Life-buoys in order. Accommodation-ladder unshipped and stowed away. Pendants and ladders taken off the swinging- booms head-cranes unshipped chafing-gear on its respective places. It would also be well to see that there is a sufficiency of sand on board. 265 CLEAR HAWSE. Call all hands to " clear hawse." Lash a stout single-block tc the bowsprit, through which reeve the clear hawse-pendant; haul the launch under the bows, or if there is too much sea on, or she is not out, send a hand down in a bowline, and hook the pendant to the riding-cable, below the turn ; bouse them up clear of the water, after which pass a stout lashing round both cables. If there should be a heavy sea on, or the wind flawey and variable, it would be well to pass the end of a hawser out of the hawse-hole, and hitch it to the cable,* to relieve the lashing. Reeve ropes through blocks on each side of the bowsprit end, for bow-lines, and pass them in at the hawse-hole, so as to take out an elbow ; for instance suppose the starboard was the clearing cable, take the larboard bow-line down under the cable, up into the starboard hawse-hole, and the starboard one over to the lar board side of the cable ; then follow the lead of the la- board bow- line, bend on several fathoms inside, and stop along to the hawse * See ck ar hawse-shackle and pendant J5U THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; hole; draw the splice, or unshackle, bend on the hawse-iope, off- stoppers, and run out ; hang the bights to the bowsprit (if hemp- cable), with slip-ropes, and send in the bow-lines again, the same way as before. When the end is out, " cast off," dip it fair, and bend on again to the cable ; rouse in, slack down the slip-ropes, and splice or shackle the cable ; haul it taut with a deck-tackle, and bitt, and stopper as before. Cast off the hawser, unlash the cable, unreeve the clear hawse-pendant, unlash the block from the bowsprit end, and clear up the deck. Note. If there is a round turn and an elbow in the hawse after rousing the cable, repeat the operation as before; it is always well to prevent confusion, by taking out one elbow at a time. A cross, is when the cables lay across each other, or when the ship has swung foul once ; an elbow is two crosses, and a round turn is three crosses ; a round turn and elbow is five cross- es. It can readily be seen thus, in clearing hawse with a round turn, a cross will be left in the cables. The anchor is fouled in the very operation of letting it go ; the weight of the chain-cable causing the running out part to fall over and foul the stock. To avoid this, some officers pursue the practice of "letting go" the anchor with the cable bitted, which plan is strongly recommended. From the weight of the chain-cable, compared with that of the hempen, the former is less liable than the latter to foul the an- chor ; but no speculation should induce an officer to depart from that practice which can alone ensure a clear anchor. 266. WEIGHING AN ANCHOR WITH THE LAUNCH. This may be done by under-running, when the ship has slip- ped the cable, or weighing by the buoy-rope, when the anchor is lying in too shoal water for the ship to be hove up to it. Ship the roller on the stern of the launch, have strong tackles with a jigger also, and some good rope for stoppers. Get the end of the cable over the roller ; pass a strap round it, to which hook the double block of the tackle, and the single one to a bolt in the bows ; man the fall, and as the cable comes in, French-flake it along the thwarts; when the tackle comes two blocks, "stopper and fleet;" when the cable is "up and down," clap the jigger on the fall of the tackle, and heave the boat's stern well down in the water, and stopper securely. Send all the men in the bows of the boat ; jump the boat and break the anchor out of the ground; then man the fall again, off stopper, and heave up; when the ring of the anchor is above water, pass a short ring- stopper, haul the buoy on board, and bring the boat to the ship; OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 161 \vhen alongside, hook the cat, and cat the anchor. Get the end of the cable unclinched, passed into the hawse, and the remain- der hauled out of the launch. (If chain-cable, unshackle.) 267. WEIGHING AN ANCHOR WITH A BUOY-ROPK Get the buoy-rope over the roller, clap on a tackle, and weigh the anchor as before. When it is secured, man the capstan, heave the launch in under the bows, and cat the anchor. Anchors are generally weighed with the buoy-rope when the cable has parted, and the end cannot be grappled ; when this is the case, the anchor may be weighed with launch, brought un- der the bows and catted, and the cable imclmched and hove in ; or the ship might be warped over the buoy, and the cat-fall taken to the buoy-rope. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 268. BOATING AN ANCHOR. Place the flukes perpendicularly over the stern, and the stock a-thwart-ships in the stern sheets, resting horizontally upon a loose thwart, placed there previously for the purpose, and steady all by one or two lashings. In letting go, nothing more is required than to cant the anchor over the quarter, by means of the thwart, taking care previously that the buoy, buoy-rope, and cable, be perfectly clear. Light anchors should be boated contrary to this, i. e., flukes inboard, and stock out. 269. TAKING IN A LAUNCH. Brace and secure the yards the same as when getting up the anchors, and also rig the same purchases ; place the chocks, pass everything out of the launch, and hook the purchases to spans ; have a few hands in the boat to keep her clear of the ship's side. Man the yard tackle falls ; have some hands to take in the slack of the stay fall ; " walk away ;" when the boat leaves the water, take out the plug. When high enough to clear the waist anchor stock, haul over on the main stay, easing away the fore and main yards ; when the stern is over the deck, haul over the fore stay, lower, and place her in the chocks. The other boats may be got on board by the same purchases. The launch is stowed on the larboard side ; the first cutter on the starboard side;* the second cutter, inside the launch, and the third cutter inside the first. When all are in, unrig the purchases, square the yards, and set up the gripes. The quarter and stern boats are hoisted up to their davits, and secured to them by stoppers, and the gripes set up. * i. e., if the ship be a frigate or larger. Single-deck ships have but one nest of boats. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 153 27O. TAKING IN BOATS BOTH SIDES AT ONCE. The yards are kept square, and secured on both sides by the lifts, burtons, and quarter lifts. Use the winding and stay tackles for the heaviest boats, and the yard tackles for the lightest ones ; the topsail halliards forward, and the main pendant tackle aft, acting as stays to bring them on board. It may be necessary to come up the forward backstays, as they would be likely to inter- fere with the bows of the boats : after which proceed as before. Taking in a boat at sea. Back the mam-topsail, get the boat to leeward, secure the lower yards as before directed, and hoist her in. The boat coming in to leeward, tackles will be neces- sary to get her to windward sufficiently to lower away. When before the wind, a boat might be got in by securing the yards as before, arid taking a hawser from aft to the stern of the boat, to keep her from sending or pitching forward when leaving the water, and thereby endangering the yards. Note. Some of our large vessels have two sets of yard and stay tackles, for the purpose of taking in boats both sides at once ; but the above mentioned gear will answer all purposes in any case of emergency, where the manoauvre is not considered as ex- ercising. PART IV. 271. GETTING UNDER-WEIGH. See that the hawse is clear ; overhaul a range of the weather cable get up nippers pass the messenger knock up the stan- chions ship the gratings ship, and swifter-in the capstan bars rig the fish-davit overhaul cat and fish ; and call " all hands unmoor ship." When the cable grows with the angle of the main-stay, the ship is said to ride at a "long stay;" when it grows with the angle of the fore-stay, the ship is said to be at a " short-stay.' 7 When perpendicular, the phrase is " up and down." From one or other of the two last mentioned positions, sail is generally made in getting under-weigh. If from the nature of the ground, or strength of the wind, there should be any probability of dragging the anchor, sail is generally made from a " short stay." In such a case, particular attention ought to be paid that the head yards be- not braced too sharp a-box; for the object being to cant the ship with the least possible sternway, the sooner the head sails lift or fill the better. The jibs are hoisted the instant they will take. If, after all, the ship drags her anchor, you can pall the capstan stopper over all. brace round the head yards, and force her a-head by the sails, as far as may be necessary ; then back the head yards, lay-to, and get the anchor up. If there should be so much wind and sea, as to make it a matter of difficulty to get the anchor, but plenty of sea-room, brace the yards a-box, according to the tack you wish to go upon, and get the anchor up and secured before making sail. In moderate weather, and ordinary circumstances, sail is generally made when the cable is " up and down." Sometimes a stern-board is neces- sary, with the anchor dragging on the ground ; at other times, a tack must be made in that position. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 155 If ridiiig by the starboard cable, and no impediment to port, it will be the most eligible method, to cast her on the starboard tack, as the cable will then be clear of the cutwater, and the ship being to leeward of the anchor, it can be more easily catted and fished. If there should be much sea on, this would be the best plan. Having determined to cast on the starboard tack, overhaul the lifts, trusses, and backstay-falls. The fore-topsail being put aback, by the starboard braces ; the main and mizen by the wind, with larboard after braces, heaving around briskly, and before breaking ground, give her a shear with the starboard helm ; when up, hoist the jib, keeping the helm a-starboard, until the stern-board ex- ceeds the velocity of the tide, when shift it, grapple the buoy, and cat the anchor. When she has fallen off, so as to fill the after sails, let flow the jib-sheet, haul out the spanker, set top- gallant sails and courses, and trim the yards and sails properly. To cast off on the larboard tack, put the helm a-port, and brace the yards the contrary way. 272. WHEN THE MESSENGER STRANDS, OR IS LIKELY TO PART. If the messenger is likely to part, from the great strain upon it, stopper immediately, and either pass a new one, or reeve a viol purchase, assisting it with the cat-fall. Lash the viol block to the cable near the hawse-hole ; clinch one end of the hawser to the main-mast, snatch the bite in the block, and take the other end to the capstan. To assist the viol, pass a strap round the cable, close down to the water, to which hook the cat-fall, and heave up on both purchases. If the messenger should strand, stopper immediately, cut it, cind then knot or splice it. 156 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 273. TO GET UNDER-WEIGH AND STAND BEFORE THE WIND. Make all preparations for getting under-weigh, heave-in, and make sail as before. Lay the main and mizen topsails square aback ; the fore one sharp aback, according to the side it is in- tended to cast heave-in, cant her the right way with the helm before tripping, and as soon as the velocity of the stern-board is greater than that of the tide, shift the helm, grapple the buoy, run up the jib as soon as it will take, and haul aft the weather- sheet. While falling off, cat and fish the anchor ; as she gathers head-way, shift the helm ; when before the wind, right it square the head yards, and brail up the jib set topgallant sails, royals, and foresail haul taut the lifts, trusses, backstay-falls, a,nd if necessary, set the studding-sails. OR YOUJSG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 157 274. IN GETTING UNDER-WEIGH, TO BACK AST ERJS AND AVOID DANGER. Make all preparations as before. If required to cast on the starboard tack, sheer her with the starboard helm ; to bring the wind on the starboard bow, brace the yards aback, about half- way up with the larboard braces ; haul out the spanker and keep the boom nearly amid-ships. Heave up briskly, grapple the buoy, and as soon as the anchor is up, put the helm hard a-weather to keep her to cat and fish the anchor. Having made sufficient stern-board, shift the helm, brace the after yards, ease off the spanker sheet, and run up the jib. When full aft, brace up the nead yards, and as she gathers headway, right the helm and make sail. To cast on the larboard tack, sheer her with the port helm, brace all sharp aback, and proceed as before. 275. GETTING UNDER-WEIGH- EACH BEAM. -A SHOAL ON It becomes necessary to proceed to sea, and is impossible to weather either of tb jse a-beam; but there is just room to pass between a shoal astern, and either of those a-beam, with the wind blowing fresh. Pass the stream cable out of one of the quarter ports ; bend on one end to the cable, and secure the other to the topsail sheet- THE KEDGE-ANCHOU; bitts ; draw the splice* of the cable, bend a slip-buoy to it, and heave it overboard. See the stoppers clear for slipping ; stop the topsails to the yards with spun-yarn, casting off the gaskets. Loose the courses, jib, and spanker mast-head the topsail-yards man the jib-halliards sheer her from the cable with the helm slip and run up the jib keep fast the stream-cable, and let her swing round. When she heads for the passage, slip the stream-cable, right the helm, sheet home the topsails, set the the courses, passage and other sails if necessary ; then stand through 276. GETTING UNDER-WEIGH IN A NARROW CHANNEL. At anchor in a narrow channel, riding to a strong leeward tide, and blowing fresh ; a ship astern, and also one on each quarter, so near that there is not room to wear, for casting ; it is ne- cessary to put to sea, and to do so a passage must be ef- fected between the two ships. Make all preparations for getting under-weigh, and heave-in as described before. Loose the topsails ; if riding %y the star-board cable, give her a rank sheer with the starboard helm : set up the starboard back- stays, and bear aft the larboard ones ; overhaul lifts and trusses ; haul out the spanker, and get the boom over on the larboard quarter ; lead along the main tack and sheet ; run up the jib, and haul aft the weather sheet ; " Heave round cheerily ;" run the anchor up, grapple the buoy, and as soon as she fills, meet her with the helm ; board the main tack to catch her; trim the jib and spanker sheets, set the foresail, and trim sharp ; haul taut the bowlines ; stand on as far as may be necessary. Note. A good deal of uncertainty attends this manoeuvre ; if there is room, it would be the best plan to lay the yards aback. ft is confidently asserted by old experienced seamen, that the above method is perfectly practicable. * If chain cable, unshackle. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT 159 277. HEAD TO WIND, CAST ON STARBOARD TACK. Everything having been previously prepared, heave in and make sail as before. Sheer her with a starboard helm ; brace the head yards sharp up with the starboard braces, and counter brace the after ones ; haul out the spanker, and get the boom on the larboard quarter ; heave in, and up anchor ; up jib as soon as it will take ; and when the stern-board exceeds the velocity of the tide, shift the helm. When the after sails are full, trim the spanker, let flow the jib sheet, cat and fish the anchor, haul aft the jib sheet, brace round the head-yards, and make sail 278. WINDWARD TIDE GET UNDER-WEIGH AND STAND BEFORE THE WIND. Make all preparation for getting under-weigh, heave in, loose jib, up anchor, grapple the buoy, run up the jib, cat and fish the anchor, and make sail with expedition. If it is necessary to have the ship under greater command, as might be the case in a narrow channel, or crowded harbor : t would be better to proceed as follows : Heave in to a " short stay," loose the courses, topsails, jib arid spanker. If riding by the starboard cable, sheer her with the 13 160 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; starboard helm, and bring the wind on the larboard quarter orace the yards to, by the larboard braces, and keep them shiver- ing- by the helm. "Heave up ;" fill the after yards, and square the head ones ; haul aft jib sheet on starboard tack ; cat and fish the anchor ; up helm; fill the head yards, shiver the after ones, get her before the wind, and make sail. 279. TO GET UNDER-WEIGH, AND STAND OUT ON A WIND. Make all preparations commence heaving in ; loose jib and spanker ; top up and bear over the boom on the right quarter, and the helm to the side which it is intended to cast ; " heave up ;" get the buoy ; haul out on the spanker as soon as it will take. When the wind gets abeam, run up the jib, and meet hp.r with the helm ; cat and fish the anchor ; loose, sheet home, ami hoist the topsails, brace up, bring by and make sail. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSIST AN1. jgj RIDING HEAD TO TIDE, WIND ON THE STAR- BOARD QUARTER, TO GET UNDER-WEIGH ON THE STARBOARD TACK. Make all preparations, heave short, loose sails, sheet home and hoist the topsails, bracing them to with the starboard braces ; keep them shivering, by the assistance of the topsails and helm, " heave round," break ground put the helm a-starboard brace full the head yards run up the jib, and let her pay round to port ; heave up the anchor, and grapple the buoy. Haul out the spanker as soon as it will take shift over the head sheets, and square the head yards trim aft the jib-sheet, and meet her with the helm. Cat and fish the anchor, and make sail as neces- sary. 281. GETTING UNDER-WEIGH WIND ACROSS THE TIDE. In getting under-weigh, say ebb-tide, make all preparations, loose, sheet home, and hoist the topsails ; brace up the fore and mizen topsails, and lay the main yard to the mast. Give her a spoke or two of the lee wheel, so as to take the main -topsail well aback. " Heave up," cat and fish the anchor, and grapple the buoy ; at the same time, set the jib and spanker fill the main yard, stand on to a convenient place, and then tack or veer. The evolution is determined by the circumstance of there being more room to windward or to leeward. Flood-Tide. Proceed as before, until the anchor is catted and fished ; then hoiet the jib, haul out the spanker, fill the main- topsail, and stand out, making whatever sail may be judged necessary. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 282. TO BACK AND FILL IN A TIDE-WAY. This manoeuvre is only executed when a ship is to proceed up or down a rapid river against the wind, which is sup- posed to be light, and may be done by two methods, viz., driving before the wind, or broadside to it. When the channel is broad enough, the latter method is preferable, as the ship will be more under the command of her helm. 283. DRIVING BEFORE THE WIND. , This is only done in a very narrow channel. Heave up the anchor, and get her before the wind, with just sail enough to keep her so. Suppose her under top- sails, and as she drops with the tide, it becomes necessary for her to remain sta- tionary, to allow a ship to pass her stern, set topgallant-sails, and if required to shoot ahead, drop the foresail. If to avoid a rock, or ship astern, put the helm up or down haul out the spanker brace up, and haul aft the jib-sheet, as she comes too ; shoot across until clear of danger, when put the helm up, brail up the spanker, shiver the after yards, and when before the wind, brail up the jib. If in standing across, she should get too near the shore get heron the other tack, by wearing or box-hauling. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 284. DRIVING BROADSIDE-TO. Get under- weigh, and oring her by the wind under the jib, topsails, and spanker ; shiver the topsails ; when filled, stand on to the middle of the channel ; brail up the jib and spanker, and let her drift in this situation until she falls off, which she will soon do, owing to her greater immersion aft than forward, which will drift her stem farther to windward. Haul out the spanker, and if this is insufficient, back the mizen-topsail ; if she still falls off, back the main also, both square aback, and if she should get a stern-board, put the helm hard a- weather ; should she come-to again, shiver the topsails, and brail up the spanker, letting her drift as before. 285. SECURING THE SHIP FOR SEA. Take the departure, give the course, and make sail. Beat to quarters examine the magazine load, shot, and secure the guns see that all the gear of the guns is ready for service, and secured. Fill the shot-boxes, rack, and wad-nets get the anchors on the bows, and lash them unbend the cable and buoy-ropes ; if clean and dry, pay them below; also the messenger, hawsers, i toppers and nippers, and cable-mats, put in the buckles unreeve, (.at and fish, and coil them away below. Get chafing-mats on the yards and rigging see the booms and boats secured, pumps in good order, and the gratings and tarpaulins ready for putting on. Overhaul the storm-staysail gear, see everything read}' for service, and stow it below again. 286. STOWING THE ANCHORS FOR SEA. The anchors being catted and fished, clap a stout tackle on them and cat-head stoppers ; pass a good lashing through the ring and over the cat-head expend the stopper in the same way. Hook the pendant-tackle to a strap around the shank weigh the crown, and bouse the fluke into the bill-port by a thwartship tackle ; having another tackle clapt on the end of the anchor-stock which is uppermost, getting it as close to the side as the stock will permit ; pass stout shank-lashings also around the stock and cat-bead. Unbend the cable and buoy-rope. |fj4 THE KEDGE-AJNCHOR; Note. The waist-anchors are securely stowed when they are first got on board. Some ships use preventer lashings and junip- ers in bad weather, when the ship is lurching in a heavy sea, or when liable to ship seas in the waist. 287. SETTING TOPGALLANT SAILS BLOWING FRESH. Point the yards to the wind, and loose the sails ; sheet home first to leeward, and then to wind- ward having a hand to leeward to light the foot over the topmast stay ; hoist away, trim the yards, and haul taut the bow-lines. Note. In setting topgallant sails over single-reefed topsails, see that the sheets are out square alike. 288. SETTING COURSES. Moderate weather. Man the fore and main-tacks and sheets attend the rigging have hands on the lower yards to overhaul it haul aboard check the top bow-lines, weather lower lifts, and UR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 165 a little of the lee-main-brace avast the sheets; get Jie tacks close down, and then haul aft the sheets haul taut the main- brace, lifts, trusses, and bowlines. Blowing fresh. Man well the sheets, overhaul the leech-lines and lee-bunt-lines ; ease dovn the lee-clew-garnet, slack top bowlines, lower lifts, and lee-main-braces, until the tacks are down ; then haul aft the sheets, haul taut the lee-main-brace, weather lifts and bow-lines, and, if necessary, hook and haul taut the rolling-tackle, to ease the trusses. 289. SETTING THE SPANKER. Top-up the boom, overhaul lee-topping-lifts, attend the sheets and weather-guy ; haul over the lee-guy, and trim the boom man the outhaul and attend the brails and vangs let go the brails, haul out and steady the gaff by the vangs. Note. The weather-vang should never be hauled, or boused too taut, as it may be the means of carrying away the gaff, especially when using trysails as storm-sails. 29O. SETTING THE JIB Cant the spritsail- yard to steady the boom ; man the hal- liards and sheet see the down- haul and brails clear, take in the slack of the sheet to steady the sail; "hoist away;" and as the sail goes up, ease off the sheet when taut up, haul aft the sheet 16(5 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 291. SETTING LOWER STUDDING-SAILS. When the boom is out or a-thwartships, and trimmed with the fore yard, the outer halliards and outhauler are to be well man- ned, taking in the slack of the inner halliards, as the sail goea over the gunwale, and ultimately reaches its destined height. In running away with the lower halliards, care must be taken that the yard be not brought up with a^'er&, against the topmast studding-sail boom ; by this sudden jerk booms are liable to be sprung. 292. SHIFTING A COURSE AT SEA. Moderate weather. In shifting a course at sea, with th watch, and with time to prepare everything for a smart and pretty evolution get the spare sail up from below, and first o.f all stretched across the deck. Then, the course being set, stopt per the (tack and sheet) clews, and unbend tacks, sheets, clew- garnets, and leech-lines, bending them forthwith to the spare sail ; and, when done, untoggle the bowlines, and send the hands aloft trice up, lay out, cast off robins and earings, and make the two midship robins last to the bunt-lines ease in the earinga together, and make them also fast to the buntlines a-midships. Lower the sail by the bunt-lines, and gather it in by hand. Un- bend the bunt-lines, bend them to the spare sail, and take out the yard-ropes. Divide the watch to the yard-ropes, bunt-lines and clew-gar- nets, and haul taut ; haul out and up all together hands aloft bring-to, and when brought-to, haul on board. Blowing fresh. First haul the sail up and furl it ; then pro- ceed to make fast the midship robins and earings (when cast ofTj to the bunt-lines, and to lower the sail down by the clew-garnets, as well as buntlines. Note. In this case the weather-tack and sheet is of much use in hauling the sail in as it comes down. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 293. TAKING IN A COURSE IN A GALE OF WIND Steady the yard as securely as possible, man .he clew-garnets, bunt-lines, and leech-lines ; ease away the tack and bow-line haul up to windward, ease off the sheet, haul up, get the sail close to the yard, and furl it. It is a common practice in clewing-up a course, to let go the bowline upon starting the tack. Neither the tack nor the bow- line should be let go, but each eased off handsomely by hand. By the adoption of this plan, the sail will bag less to leeward, and the weather-clew can be hauled up with greater ease; but both buntlines should be well manned, and even better manned, than the weather clew-garnet. When the latter gear is well up, walk away with the clew-garnet, easing steadily the sheet. But all these precautions will be of little avail, unless there be a good preventer-brace upon the lower yard; or else the yard tackle be hooked to act as such, and brought sufficiently aft to prevent the tackle bringing too great a strain in an up-and-down position upon the upper yard-arms. 294. TAKING IN A TOPSAIL IN A GALE OF WIN]) Steady well the topsail and lower yards, rounding in the wea- ther topsail brace as much as possible. Man the clewlines and buntlines ; attend the sheets and bowlines ; clew up the lee-sheet, and haul up the buntline. If to save the yard, haul up to lee- ward first, point the yard to the wind, and steady it again ; lay out and furl the sail. There appears to be still a dispute among seamen as to the preferable method of effecting this service. When the mast is not considered in danger, and the object be to save the sail, or to ease the ship, the weather clew may be first lifted. But before starting the weather sheet, it would be well to ease first a few feet of the lee-sheet, in order to lessen the labor of rounding in the weather brace. So soon as the lee-sheet be suffi- ciently eased to admit of the yard coming hi with the weather brace, and both buntlines be as well manned as the weather clewline, the weather sheet may be then eased off, and the wea- ther clewline hauled up, with every prospect of saving the sail. If there be plenty of sea room, and the ship can be kept away, some officers recommend the practice of bringing the wind abaft the beam, and then hauling up the lee-clewline first taking the precaution to have both buntlines well manned. When this operation is effected, the weather clewline may be hauled up. tGS "I'HE KEDGE- ANCHOR; rounding the brace in, as the ship is again gradually brought to the wind. It will require particular attention to the helm when hauling up the weather clewline, though with judicious manage- ment, the helm alone is sufficient to spill the sail. 295. TAKING IN TOP-GALLANT SAILS. Man the topgallant clewlines ; lay aloft, and stand by to furl the sail ; attend the braces, bowlines, sheets, and halliards ; round in the weather braces, ease away the lee-sheet arid hal- liards ; " lower away ;" ease away the weather sheet, clew up, haul up the buntlines : steady the yard, lay out and furl the sail. 296. TAKING IN A SPANKER. Have the brails and weather vang well manned; attend the outhaul and lee vang ; ease away the outhaul ; haul over on the v/eather vang ; brail up to leeward ; ease off the sheet ; haul taut the weather brails ; pass the foot gaskets ; steady the gaff, ond crutch the boom. 297. SETTING A CLOSE-REEFED TOPSAIL. Point the yard to the wind, and brace the lower yard a little sharper than the topsail yard. Man the sheets, attend the bunt- lines, and loose the sail; overhaul the lee-buntline, ease down t he lee-clewlines, and haul home the lee-sheet ; ease off the weather buntline ; at the same time slack down the weather clewline, and haul home the weather sheet. Hoist the yard up clear of the cap ; brace up, and haul the bowline ; steady the lower and top- sail yards with the braces and rolling-tackles. Note. It must be remembered that a close reefed topsail will not sheet close home, as the yard is to hoist clear of the cap. 298. A CLOSE-REEFED TOPSAIL SPLITS. Clew up the sail and steady the yard ; cast off some of the rope- bands, so as to pass stops around the sail to secure it. Unbend die sheets, bowlines, and lee-buntlines ; unreeve lee-clewline and OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 169 reef-tackle ; bend the weather buntline round the sail, and make the lee-earing fast to the buntline ; hook a burton to a strap ound the sail, cast off all the rope-bands, and lower away ; ease away the weather earing and lower the sail on deck. Stretch along the new sail, overhaul it, then reef the sail at the foot, com- mencing at the close reef, and taking in each of the three lower reefs separately ; then bight it down, and send it aloft, as describ- ed before, observing to use the burtons before all. Reeve and bend the gear, stopping the head of the sail to the buntlines ; have yard-jiggers hooked to bring the sail to the yard pass the earings and rope-bands, in the same manner ; bring the first reef to the yard, cast out the other reef, haul up the sail; then bring the reefs to the yard alternately, after which set the sail as 299. A JIB SPLITS. Mind the weather helm, haul the sail down, and hoist the fore- topmast-staysail. Hitch the downhaul around the body of the sail, and also pass stops around it take the end of a rope from the forcastle, and bend it on to haul in by. Turn out the jib- stays, bend a line on to the end and unreeve it haul taut the halliards ease off the downhaul, and haul in. Get up, and overhaul the spare sails ; seize on the sheet, bend the halliards and downhaul stop the sail, and haul out by the downhaul and halliards reeve the jib-stay, turn it in, and set it up ; pass the tack-lashings, reeve the brails, set the jib, and haul down the staysail. 3OO. TO WEAR SHIP UNDER CLOSE-REEFED MAIN- TOPSAIL AND STORM-STAYSAILS. Call all hands" wear ship," and station them ; have lifts, trusses, and rolling-tackles attended, so the yard and topmast may be well supported in the heavy rolling which they are likely to experi- ence. Haul down the mizen storm-staysail, and when she falls off, up helm ; ease off the main storm-staysail sheet, and brace in the main and cross-jack yards ; at the same time taking care to keep the maintopsail full, to preserve the head-way, and to keep her a-head of the sea ; also to keep it from splitting. When the wind is on the quarter, haul down the main storm-staysail, and shift over the sheet ; when before the wind, right the helm, and square the head yards; shift over the fore storm-staysail watch for a smooth time to bring-her-to ; then ease down 170 1'HE KEDGE- ANCHOR; the helm, hoist the mizen storm-staysail, and when the wind is> on the quarter, brace up the yards, hoist the main storm-staysail, haul aft the fore storm-staysail sheet, meet her with the helm, trim the sails, and haul the maintop-bowline. 3O1. WEARING UNDER A MAINSAIL. Make fast a hawser to the slings of the main yard, take it down forward of the sail, haul it well taut, and belay it to the topsail sheet bitts. Call all hands and station them as in the last case ; take advantage of her falling off to put the helm up. Ease off the main sheet, and gather in the lee tack, using the yards as in ordinary cases. Should she not go off, send down the cross-jack yard, and mizentopsail yard ; house the topmast, and get a drag over the lee quarter, after which proceed as before in bracing the yards, and bring by the wind. 3O2._ WEARING UNDER BARE POLES. Send down the after yards and mizen topmast, and bend a hawser to it in-board. Send men in the weather fore rigging with tarpaulins ; up helm, and make use of the yards as usual. If she should not go off, it will be necessary, as a last resort, to cut away the mizen mast, veer away the hawser, and use the mizen topmast as a drag to assist in wearing. 3O3. CUTTING- AWAY THE MASTS. Clear away all the running rigging attached to the mast, cut away the lanyards of the lee rigging ; then the lanyards of the stays and weather rigging. 3O4. LAYING-TO UNDER LOWER STAYSAILS, WEAR SHIP. If it does not blow too fresh, the close-reefed mainsail may be set, as some lofty sail is necessary, to prevent the ship from being pooped ; then proceed as in veering under bare poles. If she should not go off, clap a lashing round the bunt of the foresail, and set the weather goose- wing. Should she still not go off, send down the after yards and mizen topmast, making a drag of them. If they have no effect, cut away the mizen mast. PART V, 3O5. PRECAUTIONS FOR SCUDDING. When scudding in a heavy gale of wind, care should be taken that sufficient of lofty sail be carried on the vessel, to keep her freely and fairly before the sea. A ship will scud better with the sea right aft, than quartering. With a heavy sea, the danger to oe apprehended is, that the wave traveling faster than the ship, may overtake and break over her. To avoid this, and diminish its danger, some such sail as a close-reefed topsail or foresail is generally kept set as long as possible ; but there are times wnen the foresail is not the best suited, nor the safest for scudding. Some ships that steer badly, and manifest an inclination to yaw, will be more steadily steered, and easier managed when scudding under the fore-topsail and fore-staysail. Should the ship happen to broach-to, the foresail, in such a perilous situation, is an un- wieldy and unmanageable sail to clew up ; and when the sea strikes the ship on the quarter, and causes her head to round-tc in the direction ot the wind, the main-topsail tends to assist the sea in producing this dangerous movement ; whereas, the fore- staysail, together with the fore-topsail, produces the contrary effect It is deeply laden ships that are most liable to get pooped ; in which circumstance, a skilful foresight must be exercised in lightening them. Reheving-tackles should be hooked, and hands stationed to at- tend them ; spare tiller and rudder-chocks at hand, and perfectly ready for use ; for, if the ship should get pooped with a heavy sea, the tiller is likely to get snapped, the ship to broach-to, and the rudder, if not quickly secured, to be unhung, and aftei damaging the stern, to be lost. Wreck then almost immediately follows. When using the foresail, a tackle hooked to the lee fore -tack would be of service in filling the sail. 172 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 306. SCUDDING. A SHIP BROACHES-TO. Meet her with the helm, and lee head braces, if necessary : shiver the after yards ; should she still come-tc, and the sails are taken aback, brace about the head yards, and if necessary, use the helm. If she should get too much stern-board in falling off, haul up the foresail, and pay her off with the fore storm-staysail : fill the after yards as soon as possible, to gather headway, and when she has fallen off sufficiently, brace about the head yards, and trim as before. Note. As in scudding, the safety of the ship depends entirely upon the steering, the greatest care should be taken that a steady and expert helmsman is stationed at the wheel, and that when his "trick" is out, and his "relief" arrives to take his place, that he resigns not his hand at the helm, until his successor is in full possession of the easiest method of steering the ship. The officer of the deck should also direct a compass to be placed in the gun-room, and be cautious that a competent seaman h there to attend the relieving tackles, and watch closely the steer a.ge of the ship by the compass-card. In frigates, and particularly flushed-decked vessels, whose bin- nacle-lights are liable to be extinguished by the wind, precaution should be taken that lighted lanterns are kept in readiness to supply the place of the blown-out lights. On dark and starless nights, when the steersman has no other guide to govern his steer- age than the compass-card, it is of the utmost importance that attention should be paid to this particular ; as in a number of in- stances the accident of broaching-to may be traced to the " blow- i'ng out" of the binnacle lights, and carelessness of the helms- man. It requires a quick, small helm to steer a ship when scud- uing. 3O7. SCUDDING. BROUGHT BY THE LEE. A ship is said to be " brought by the lee" when struck aback by a change of wind. If she has headway, which will probably be the case, put the helm a-weather, but if she has stern way, the contrary. Brace round the after yards, and when they are full, the head ones. This is the principle of tacking, but it is not thought as well when scudding in a gale, as the ship might get too rapid sternway, which would be dangerous in a heavy sea. As the object is to preserve the headway, the yards are braced round as soon as possible. If scudding under the main-topsail, and it becomes necessary to reduce sail, take in the fore-topsail OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 173 for the main being nearer the centre of gravity, has less tendency to bury the ship, and she is consequently more easily steered. When scudding under the main-topsail and foresail, the ship is to be brought by the wind, and she should have a tendency to gripe, keep the foresail on her ; but if otherwise, take in the fore- sail, and set the fore storm-staysail ; brace up the head yards, then the after ones. Watch for a smooth time, and ease down 'he helm, taking care to meet her in due time. The reason for bracing up the head yards before luffing, is, in pcudding the ship has a rapid headway, and will mind the helm very quickly ; moreover, the sea acting with violence on the quarter, will throw her up into the wind, and unless the head yards are braced up so as to prevent that, she will be in the same situation as if she had broached-to. 3O8. HEAVING-TO. Having determined from the known quality of the ship, what sail would be best to heave-to under ; bring by the wind as in the previous subject. If intending to lay-to under a main-topsail, when by the wind, haul up and furl the foresail, down foretop- mast-staysail ; if under lower-staysails, hoist them ; at the same time taking in the foresail and main-topsail. The helm is kept a-lee while laying-to, but not lashed down, it being considered best to have a little steerage-way on. Note. It is best to bring by the wind under the square-sails, a? the shin is more under command than she would be if they were furled. " 309. TAKING IN A LOWER STUDDING-SAIL BLOW- ING FRESH. This is a much nicer operation than young officers generally are inclined to admit, and unless executed with caution and skill on the part of the officer " carrying on the duty" on deck, the proba- oility is, the topmast studding-sail boom will snap short in the iron, and the sail, swinging-boom gear and all, will have to be recorded in the log as " expended." When not sailing in a squadron, and the yawing of the ship be a matter of minor im- portance, the officer of the watch is recommended to proceed as follows : Place a steady helmsman at the wheel, and stand close to him man well the sheet, and lead it well aft along the deck ; also see 14 174 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; that steady hands attend the tack and guys. When perfectly prepared, direct the helmsman with a " small helm," to bring the wind gradually on the opposite quarter, and the moment the body of the sail begins to lose the breeze, and the canvass in- clines to shiver, lower the outer halliards, ease the tack, and haul in on the sheet as rapidly as possible, lowering the inner halliards at the same time. Note. More booms are sprung, and even snapped short in the j-on, from the sudden jerk produced by lowering the lower hal- liards, when the sail is straining and bellying to the breeze, than by even carrying a powerful press of canvass. And here it may be well to impress upon the mind of the young seaman, that a judicious management of the helm, in almost every situation in which it can be placed, will not only aid the physical strength employed, but also greatly facilitate the service sought. 310. TO UNBEND A TOPSAIL IN A GALE OF WIND. Those who know the value of minutes to men perched aloft in a perilous position, will adopt that method which will event- ually cost the least time and trouble. The sail should be first furled, then detached from the yard, and sent down on deck (slung amidships) by the long tackle* hooked at the topmast-head, and steadied forward clear of the top-rim by the weather or lee bowline, according to the side on which the sail is to be sent down. (See 298). Should the ship be rolling or pitching to any extent, and it is not deemed prudent to lower the furled sail " before all, " the sail may be sent down through lubber's hole. This method will de- pend entirely upon the motion of the ship. 311. SECURING IN A GALE. See that the yards which have sails set upon them are not un- necessarily sharp up ; that the yards whose sails are furled are hoisted clear of the caps ; that the runners and tackles are up in good time ; that all unnecessary strain is taken off the rigging ; and that mats are carefully placed wherever a chafe is likely to occur, such as at the bunts of the furled sails, and at the lee quarters of the yards, which are braced up against the rigging. See also that the fore and main sheets, if set, be checked a Generally called the top-burton. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 175 ittle ; the weather lifts and trusses well up and taut; jiggers on topsail lifts, and studding-sails out of the rigging ; anchors and guns properly secured ; and in a small vessel, the hatches bat- fened down, extra on boats, spare spars. &c., &c. 312. PREP AKATIONS FOR A HURRICANE AT SEA. Endeavor to get sea room ; if you have it, run before the wind. The captain and first officer to cunn the ship ; two or three of the best men to steer ; the master to keep the time, and the courses steered, and have the ship's place kept worked up. Previous to its coming on, have a life-line set up on each side of the deck. Furl all sails, and secure them with studding-sail tacks as well as long gaskets ; batten down the hatches, and have the relieving tackles on the tiller ; down topgallant-yards, and send topgallant-masts on deck, and flying jib-boom in. Clear the tops ; gaffs down ; rudder-chocks and spare tiller at hand ; axes and haw r sers at hand ; scuppers clear ; pumps ready. Let each man wear a belt to secure himself if required to the most convenient place ; keep the after yards square ; head yards thrown forward, and have the fore-staysail set with double sheets. 313. PREPARATIONS FOR A HURRICANE AT AN ANCHOR, (with notes on the Barometer.) The ship should be moored with a whole cable each way if in narbor, or if in an open roadstead, veer to a hundred fathoms on each anchor. The more your berth is out of the way of other ships, the bet- ter, as vessels driving, or getting adrift, occasion much damage to those who might otherwise have held on. If moored, the sheet cable to be bent and ranged, and the an- chor let go, and veer on the bowers to the clinches. All the ground tackle you have should be used. Have a shackle abaft the foremost stopper, on each cable, ready for slipping if ab- solutely necessary, to prevent swamping, or from other causes. Batter down fore and aft. Down topgallant yards and masts. If time, unbend sails (topsails and courses, I mean). Strike lower-yards and topmasts. Get yards as mrch fore and aft as possible. 176 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Jib-boom eased in. Keep try-sails and fore stay-sail bent, and the former reefed. Unreeve the running rigging, that nothing may be aloft to hold the wind. Clear the tops. No boats to be above the gunwale. Axes and hawsers up ready. If anchors drag, cut away lower masts the rigging being first cut and cleared. Remember the stays. Notes and remarks on the Barometer. SCALE OP BAROMETER AT PRESENT. As the force of the wind is what is requir- ed for service at sea, the following would be better understood. Inchw. 31.0 30.5 30.0 29.5 29.0 28.5 28.0 Inches. 30.5 30.0 29.7 29.5 29.2 29.0 28.5 Qpf f*o-||* ....-._ Fair - TTrmpftlpH . fi-olo Rain ----- Storm. When the mercury falls in the Barometer, it announces rain, or wind, jr in general what is called bad weather ; and, on the contrary, when il rises, it announces fair weather. When the mercury falls in frosty weather, either snow, or a thaw maj' be expected ; but if it rises in the winter with a north or east wind, it gei; erally forebodes a frost If the mercury sinks slowly, we may expect rain, which will probably be of some continuance ; but if it rises gradually, we may expect fine weather that will be lasting. When the Barometer is fluctuating, rising and falling suddenly, the weather may be expected to be like it changeable. When the mercury falls very low, there will be much rain ; but if ita fall is low and sudden, a high wind frequently follows. When an extraordinary fall of the mercury happens, without any re- markable change near at hand, there is some probability of a storm at a distance. In very warm weather the fall of the mercury indicates thunder. The Barometer will descend sometimes as an indication of wind only find sometimes rise when the wind is to the north or east OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. A north-east wind generally causes the Barometer to rise, and it is gen- erally low with a south-west wind. An extraordinary fall of the mercury will sometimes take place in sum- mer previous to heavy showers, attended with thunder ; but in spring, au- tumn, and winter, it indicates violent winds. The mercury is higher in cold than in warm weather, and lower at noon and midnight than at any other period of the day. The mercury generally falls at the approach of new and full moon, and rises at the quadratures. Before high tides, there is almost always a great fall of the mercury; this takes place ol'tener at the full than at the new moon. The greatest changes of the Barometer commonly take place during clear weather with a north wind, and the smallest risings during cloudy, rainy, or windy weather, with a south or nearly south wind. The words generally engraved on the plate of the Barometer, rathei serve to mislead, than to inform ; for the changes of weather depend rather on the rising and falling of the mercury, than on its standing at any par- ticular height. When the mercury is as high as " fair," and the surface of it is concave, (which is the case when it begins to descend,) it very often rains ; and on the contrary, when the mercury is opposite " rain," and the surface of it is convex, (which is the case when it begins to ascend,) fair weather may be expected. These circumstances not being duly attended to, is the princi- pal cause that many people have not a proper confidence in this instru- ment. For sea-service, it would be as well to read the Barometer off three rimes a day at least at 8 A. M., noon, and 8 p. M. and oftener if bad weather. In Europe, if the alteration in the quicksilver should be in as great a Eroportion as six-tenths of an inch to twenty-four hours, sudden but not isting changes of weather may be expected. If the alteration should be gradual, probably in the proportion of two or three-tenths to twenty-four hours, the weather indicated will be likely to .ask One-fifth of the variation of the Barometer, in any climate, in twenty- four hours, may be considered as an indication of sudden change. If wind should follow rain, the wind may be expected to increase. Ram following wind is likely to lull it, and the wind may be expected to abate. 178 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR. 314. THE FOREMAST IS CARRIED AWAY. Hard up the helm, brace in the after yards, hoist the mam- staysail, take in after sail, and endeavor to get before the wind ; if successful, keep her so, by veering a range of cable over the stern, and lashing it amidships ; if not, which is most likely to be the case, and should carry away the main-topmast also, lay her to under the main-staysail. If the main-topmast should stand, clew-up the main-topsail immediately, get the breast back- stays over the topsail-yard, and set them up as far forward as possible, by means of tackles. Bend hawsers on the wreck, clear it away, especially the lanyards of the lee-rigging, so as to pre- serve the channels and chain-bolts, and endeavor to haul it aboard. Send down the after yards and spars, and save as much of the wreck as possible. Rig a jury-foremast, fitting spars and sails to the best advantage ; when the jury-mast is rigged, reeve a main-topmast stay, of a hawser, and take the breast-backstays aft again, after which cut clear of the wreck, if not required 315. TO RIG A JURY-MAST. Take a spare spar, the largest on board, a main-topmast for instance, and launch the head over the night-heads, the heel resting against the stump of the old mast ; put on the cross-trees and bolsters, fit the rigging and stays from hawsers, and hook a couple of tackles from the jury-mast head which take to the sides and haul taut ; hook another, which take well aft ; lash the heel of the stump to prevent slipping, and raise the mast with the after purchase, tending the stays and pendant-tackles ; when up, reeve the lanyards, set up the rigging and stays. Gleet and lash the heel securely. Ship the cap, send up a topgallant-mast for a topmast, fit a topsail yard for a lower yard, and a topgal- .ant yard for a topsail yard, and so on. 3 16. ACCIDENTS TO TILLER. In the event of losing a mast. Should the tiller break in the rudder head, the rudder must immediately be chocked, that its stump may be taken out and the spare tiller fitted, which, together with the chock, should al ways be placed in readiness for immediate use. While the rud- der is useless, the ship must be hove-to till it is repaired, or some contrivance prepared to supply its place. OR YOITNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 179 317. THE MAIN-MAST IS CARRIED AWAY. Hard-up the helm, secure the mizen topmast if it still stands, dear the wreck, save as much as possible, and rig a jury main- mast, as above. 318. THE BOWSPRIT IS CARRIED AWAY. Hard-up the helm, shiver the after yards, take in after sail, and get the ship before the wind ; take the fore-topmast breast- backstays forward over the top-sail yard, hook the pendant tack- les and set them up to the cat-heads ; unreeve the main-topmast and spring-stays, and set them up to the foretopsaii sheet bitts ; hitch a hawser to the foretopmast head, take this in through one of the hawse-holes, and set it up on the gun-deck. While this is performing, let some hands be reducing sail, sending down top- gallant yards and masts if they are aloft, and clearing the wreck; rig a jury-bowsprit of a spare main-topmast or a jib-boom. 319. A TOPMAST IS CARRIED AWAY. Get the ship before the wind immediately, and reduce sail ; hook the top-blocks and reeve hawsers through them ; bend the lee one to the topsail-yard, which is probably hanging to leeward of the topmast, with the wreck. Clew up the topsail if practica- ble, and cut the parrel if it can be got at. The yard now hangs clear of the topmast ; bend the weather hawser to the wreck of the topmast ; have guys from the weather side of the deck clear away the lanyards of the rigging and stays, also the rigging lead- ing to the topmast head, and send it down on deck ; hook the yard-tackles, slack the braces and trusses, bouse the lower yards forward, and send down the stump ; get the topsail-yard down in the lee-gangway, and repair its damages while the spare topmast is got aloft and secured by the old rigging ; send aloft the yard, ?et the topsails, and bring her to her course again. 32O. THE JIB-BOOM IS CARRIED AWAY. Mind the weather helm, hoist the foretopmast-staysail, and get in the wreck by the fore pendant-tackles, hooked to the fore- stay ; reeve a heel-rope and get in the stump ; point another boom, and rig it with the old rigging, if sound, if not, with spare ropea or hawsers. 180 THE KEDGE-AJNCHOR; 321. THE FOREMAST IS SPRUNG NEAR THE HOUNDS OR BIBBS. Get the ship before the wind immediately, reduce sail, and get all the strain off the foremast ; secure the main-topmast. Send down topgallant yards and masts ; hook the jeers, and settle the fore yard ; hook top-blocks, reeve top-pendanta and house topmasts, allowing the heel to come considerably below the defect ; fish the foremast with side fishes, and the heel of the topmast, wedging the lashings. Clap a lashing around the doublings of the mast-head, having chocks between ; keep the pendant-tackles rove, turn in the rigging afresh, and set it up ; wedge the topmast in the cap, and sway the fore yard close up to the heel of the topmast ; reef the head sails to diminish the strain if required. 322. THE FOREMAST AND BOWSPRIT CARRIED AWAY. Proceed as in 314, the remarks being applied to the present case ; lay-to under the main-staysail, to leeward of the wreck, and repair damages on board, in the best possible manner ; rig a jury foremast and bowsprit, and then cut clear, having saved as many spars and sails, and as much rigging as possible ; if the ship lay a easily by the wreck, it would probably be well to ride by it, until the gale abates. If it is absolutely necessary to veer, it might be done as before mentioned, with the assistance of the mainsail, making use of the wreck as a drag, by taking the hawser a.s a spring to the quarter. 323. THE BOWSPRIT IS SPRUNG. Up helm, shiver the after yards, take in after sail, and get the ship before the wind ; haul down the head sails, come up the main topmast stays, and set them up on deck ; get the fore-topmast breast-backstays forward, hook the fore pendant tackles, and set them up to the cat-head ; come up all the head stays, and rig in the head booms ; send down upper yards and masts, take the fore- topmast stays through the hawse-hole, and set them up. Note. All strain now being off the bowsprit, fish it with the regular fishes ; if there are none on board, use the jib-boom ; if thought sufficiently strong to bear the strain of the head stays, get them in their proper places, but if not, get stays out merely to make sail. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 324. A TOPMAST IS SPRUNG NEAR THE LOWER CAP. Get the ship before the wind and reduce sail ; if a spare topmas! is not to be had, the old one may be housed far enough to allow the spring to come some feet below the cap, setting the lower yard as in the last case ; fit a larger chock between the topmast and lowermast head, and clap stout lashings around, above, and below the defect part, w r edging them well ; reef the foresail so that it can be set with the yard in its present place, and also the top- sail, to lessen the strain on the weak spar. Note. Sheep-shank the rigging, if required, before setting up. 325. TO SEND ALOFT A TOPMAST, AND A HEAVY SEA ON. After the topmast is pointed and rigged, hook the burtons to stout strops, at the rim of the top on each side ; hitch hawsers to the mast-head, leading one through a larger block at the fore- topmast head, and another aft through one at the mizen ; haul the burtons and hawsers taut ; sway aloft the topmast, slacking up as it goes aloft ; when ridded, steady the topmast until the rigging and stays are set up. 326. THE GAMMONING CARRIED AWAY. Proceed as in 323, until all strain is off the bowsprit ; put a stout chock on the bowsprit, and pass the end of the messenger out of a hawse-hole, over the chock, in through the other hawse- hole, and bitt it ; take the other end to the capstan, and get the bowsprit well down in its bed by the messenger and bob-stays ; come up the old gammoning, and pass a new one. Note. Iron gammonings are used for all vessels, by new regu- lation. (See Rigging Table.} 327. A LOWER CAP SPLITS. Take all sail off the mast, pass a stout lashing around the topmast and lower mast-head, which wedge ; after which woold and wedge the cap. 182 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 328. THE TRESTLE-TREES ARE SPRUNG Get the ship before the wind, take all sail off the mast, send down topgallant yards and masts, housing 1 the others ; hook the top-blocks, reeve top-pendants, hook top-tackles, and bouse them well taut, taking all strain off the fid ; pass several stout lash- ings around the heel of the topmast and lower mast-head, cleating them to prevent their slipping ; make sail as the mast will bear. 329. A LOWER YARD IS CARRIED AWAY IN THE SLINGS. If the fore-yard, get the ship before the wind, haul up th-s foresail, clew up the topsail, take in all sail on the mizen-mas% unreeve the foretopsail sheets and board them on deck; bring her on your course again, and haul the bowlines. If a main-yard, keep on the course, haul up the mainsail, clew up the topsail, unreeve the sheets, board them on deck, and haul the bowlines well out ; having proceeded thus far, get stout strops around the inner quarter of the yard, and hook the pendant- tackles to bolts in the lower cap, and these strops ; if the pendant- tackles are not at hand, use the burtons. Lash the j ear-blocks, reeve the jears, and send the yard down by the jears, lifts, and pendant-tackles ; fish the lower yards im- mediately, if it can be done ; if it cannot, rig a topsail yard for a lower yard. 330. A TOPSAIL YARD IS CARRIED AAV AY. If it is the fore, reduce after sail ; mind the weather helm, and keep the ship on her course. If it is the main, stand on, clew up the sail, unbend it, and get it into the top the best manner possi- ble. Get a strop around the topmast-head, above the eyes of the rigging, to which hook a large single block, and reeve a hawser through it. If the yard is completely broken off, bend the haw- ser which is not secured by the parrel, bend on guys, and send it down ; then send down the other piece. If it still remains together, bend on the slings, stop out to leeward, have a tripping line and rolling ropes, and get it fore and aft on deck ; take off all the old rigging, which put on to the spare yard in the chains ; then bend OR YOUNG SAILORS ASSISTANT. on the hawser, sway aloft, and cross it as in fitting the ship out, have rolling ropes around it as it goes aloft ; bend the topsail, and set it. 331. THE SHIP LEAKS FASTER THAN THE PUMPS CAN FREE HER. Find out where the leak is ; thrum an old sail very thickly, and have stout ropes attached to each leech ; make it up, take it under the bowsprit, and get the ropes on their respective sides ; heave the ship too ; when her headway eases, drop the sail over- board ; after it has sunk beneath the keel, break the stops, haul aft on the ropes attached to each clew ; when the body of the sail is over the leak, haul well taut all the ropes attached to the leeches and the head, which will prevent the sail from going aJ't when going ahead ; make sail, and continue pumping. 332. THE PUMPS ARE CHOKED Hoist them out, and clear them. 333. A SHOT GETS LOOSE IN A GUN SECURED FOB A GALE. Prick the cartridge well down, and pour vinegar enough in the touch-hole to drown it. 184 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; 334. TO THROW A LOWER DECK GUN OVERBOARD Fit a chock in the port-sill, and over the pomelion of the gun, to which, from the housing-bolt, hook a stout tackle ; unlash the muzzle, heave up the breech, and put in the bed and coin ; un- reeve the breeching, throw back the cap squares, and place cap- stan bars under the breech to ease it, and prevent the gun from slipping back into the carriage again; man the side and port tackles, watch the roll, trice up the port briskly, run out, and throw the gun clear of the carriage, by the breech-tackles and capstan- bars ; shut in the port immediately PART VI. 335. TO TURN REEFS OUT OF THE TOPSAILS AND COURSES. Haul taut the reef-pendants, and set taut the lower lifts ; ease off the bowlines ; ease a little of the tacks and sheets of the courses, and settle a few feet of the topsail halliards ; haul taut the reef tackles and buntlines, round in a little of the weath- er braces, to clear the points of the lee-rigging ; commence Cast- ing off the points of the bunt, taking care to leave none tied, and taming one reef out at a time ; ease away both earings together ; overhaul the rigging, get the tacks on board ; sheet home, hoist the topsails up to a taut leech, out bowlines and make sail. 336 THE RUDDER IS CARRIED AWAY TO FIT ANOTHER. Man the braces immediatly ; take in after sails, and let the ship run a little free ; rouse up a cable, clove-hitch a hawser over the cable, and then pay it overboard ; veer away about twenty fathoms, and lash it amidships on the taffrail ; lead the ends of the hawsers through large blocks, lashed to the quarters, and clap tackles on them ; steer the ship by this contrivance, until a rudder can be constructed. (See Plate.) Take a spare topmast, cut it the length of the rudder, enlarge the fid-hole to receive the tiller, if not already large enough ; take a spare cap and cut away the after part, so as to fit the stern post at the waters' edge, or a little below ; pass the topmast through the round hole in the cap ; take a spare jib-boom and cut 186 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; it in two ; the pieces are to be bolted on abaft the topmast, pftei squaring the edges which will come in contact with each other, and cutting a score in the forward part of the jib-boom, next to the topmast, to allow the cap to have room to play in ; plank the whole over with stout oak plank, and bolt in a fish abaft all ; drive an eye-bolt into the heel of the topmast (now the head of the rudder), and have kentledge attached to the other end to sink t ; take an anchor-stock and square two of the edges ; cut away a circular score in each, for them to join together around the top mast, below the squares, and thus serve as an upper gudgeon ; drive the anchor-stock hoops on the rudder-head, to prevent split- ting. Place the rudder on a stage, near the taffrail ; pass a couple of hawsers aft through the hawse-holes, and secure them to the heel of the rudder ; have tackles on their inner ends ; have two more hawsers or parts of hawsers passed from forward aft, under everything, one each side, and clinch them to the quarter eye-boltu in me cap ; have a pendant round as described in another place ; launch overboard and rouse up on the head rope ; heave in upon the hawsers, and bring the rudder to the stern post, perpendic- ularly ; secure the cap to the stern post and the anchor-stock, around the rudder head ; ship the tiller, reeve the wheel-ropes, and rouse in the cable. The kentledge may remain to keep the rudder perpendicular, or may be taken off*, as the case may re- quire. Note. See improved sketch or plan of temporary rudder. 337. A SHIP ON FIRE AT SEA. Hard up the helm, haul up the courses, up spanker, get the ship before the wind, and reduce sail to topsails; beat to quarters, close all the ports, muster the men at their stations, call away the firemen, under charge of their proper officers ; let a part fill the engine and wet the sails, while the other part finds out where the fire is, and endeavor to extinguish it if possible for which purpose use bedding ; putting over the gratings and tarpaulins. The gunner and his mates should be in the magazine, ready to drown the powder at a moment's notice ; let the carpenters rig and fetch the pumps, and the spar-deck divison clear away the boats, equip them, and get them ready for hoisting out ; in the above case, the fire is supposed to be below, and the helm is put up, because wind is less felt the ports are shut in, and the tar- paulins put on, as they would afford air to the fire; and the cour- ses hauled up, because they strike a current of air down the OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 137 hatchways, and are also liable to catch. If the fire is on deck, and forward, keep before the wind ; if aft, haul close on a wind. 338. A SHIP ON HER BEAM ENDS. When the severity of the squall is felt, hard up the helm and let fly everything; but if she goes on her beam ends before she can be got off sufficiently to diminish the effects of the wind, the best way will be to cut away the mizen-mast before the headway ceases, which falling over the lee quarter, will act as a drag, to pay her off; should she not right when before the wind, if there De an anchorage, and the cable is bent, get the drag to the lee- bow, by means of a spring, and rouse in ; the wind acting on the flat deck, and under side of the sails, will probably right her, As a last resort, cut away the masts great decision and rapidity of execution is necessary, as the ship must go down a short time after she goes over. 339. WIND FREE, ALL SAIL SET, STRUCK BY A SQUALL. Up helm, let fly the main-sheets, spanker-outhaul, staysail-sheets and halliards, royal and topgallant studding-sail-halliards, royal and topgallant-sheets, and halliards ; haul up the mainsail, brail up the spanker, down staysails, and order the topmen to haul in the studding-sails and stow them. When before the wind, right the helm, clew down the topsails, haul up the buntlines, and out reef- tackles, and reef if necessary ; clear up the decks as fast as pos- sible. Note. In ordinary cases, sheets and tacks should be eased off, for if they should get foul when running through their blocks fast, spars might be endangered ; but when struck by a severe squall, the effect of the sails must be diminished as soon as possible, to save the masts, and pre/ent her from going over. 340. STRUCK BY A SQUALL ON A LEE SHORE. If sail cannot be reduced, luff-too and shake her ; fill away again, gather headway^ and luff again. 15 [gg THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 341 STRUCK BY A SQUALL UNDER WHOLE TOP- SAILS AND COURSERS. Up helm, let fly the topsail halliards, main-sheet, spanker out- haul, and lee-topsail sheets ; haul up the mainsail, brail up the spanker, clew up the topsails to leeward, then to windward ; right the helm, and reef if necessary. 312. ON A WIND, UNDER WHOLE TOPSAILS PART THE WEATHER MAIN-TOPSAIL BRACE. Haul up the mainsail, let go the lee main-brace, haul forward on the lee-maintop-bowline, and aft on the weather main-brace ; luff-too, and when the main-topsail shivers, clew it down, haul up the buntlines, out reef tackles, and steady the yard by the bow- line, until a new brace can be rove ; a burton might be hooked to steady the yard. 343. THE JIB-DO WNHAUL PARTS. Un toggle the fore-topgallarit-bowlines, and knot them together, above the first hank, between the stay and jib-halliards, which use for a downhaul, until you reeve a new one. 344, TO CHASE. A vessel that chases another should have the advantage in point of sailing, because if the ship chased is as good a sailer as the chaser, the latter can never come up to her, if she manoeu- vred equally as well. In order to determine whether your ship sails faster than your adversary, get upon the same tack, under the same sail, and keep upon the same course with her ; set her exactly with a compass, and if your ship sails best, the sail will soon draw a point more aft; if she has the advantage she will in a short time draw more forward, and if both sail equally well, she will remain at the same point UK YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. J$g 345. TO CHASE TO WINDWARD. To chase to windward, run upon the same course with the enemy, until he is brought perpendicularly to the same course ; when tack and continue the second board, until he is again brought perpendicularly to the same course; always continue this manoeuvre by tacking every time the chase is a-beam, on either board, and she will come in the shortest method by your superiority of sailing. Should the chase pass the point, when the chase bears a-beam, he must go about with all dispatch. Note. The chase goes about as soon as the chase is exactly a-beam, because at that time, the distance between them is the east possible upon the different boards they hold. 3 4G. OBSERVATIONS FOR A SHIP TO WINDWARD, WHICH IS CHASED. The weather ship will always be joined, since it is granted that she does not sail as well as the pursuer, it will be then to her advantage to keep constantly on the same tack, without losing time to heave about, for tacking cannot be so favora- ble to her as to her adversary, whose sailing is superior. 190 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; If the chaser mistakingly stands on and tacks in the wake of the chase, the best course for the latter to pursue is to heave about and pass to windward of him on the other tack, unless you sup- pose your vessel would have a superiority in going large ; for ii the chaser persists in tacking in the wake of the other ship, the chase will be much prolonged. 347. TO CHASE TO LEEWARD. If the chaser keeps away to cut the chase off, and keeps contin- ually on that course, they will eventually come together where the two courses inter- sect. This will be exactly executed by the ship in chase, if in the course she has taken, she keeps the chase continually up- on the same degree of the compass as at the beginning of the pur- suit. This principle applies equally to all the courses which the retreating ship pursues, for if overtaken, it can only be accom- plished by keeping in a straight line, if the chase takes another course than that which keeps the two ships upon the same point. These are the only considerations to be made, and they may !e corrected, by observing the bearings by an azimuth com- pos. 348.TO WINDWARD OF AN ENEMY, WITHIN PISTOL SHOT. The weather main rigging is shot away both ships with main topsails to the mast. Up helm, fill away, and run the enemy on board, before she gets headvvaj- to prevent it. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. ]9| 349. WIND ON THE QUARTER, ALL SAIL SET- BRING BY UNDER DOUBLE-REEFED TOPSAILS. Reduce sail regularly, and clew down the topsails ; luff enough to reef, hoist the topsails, and haul close on a wind. 350. WIND ON THE QUARTER, ALL SAIL SET BRING-TO ON THE OTHER TACK, UNDER DOUBLE REEFED TOPSAILS. Reduce sail to topsails, station the crew forward, with one watch of top- men aloft to reef; brail up the spanker, up helm, brace in, and when before the wind, clew down the topsails, haul out reef-tackles, and up buntlines ; let the men lay out and reef; wind on the quarter, brace up cross-jack yard, and haul out the spanker ; as she comes-too. brace up the fore yard, and meet her with the helm and jib-sheet when coming- too, a good opportunity will be offered for reefing ; when reefed, hoist away the topsails, letting the main go a-back, the others fill. Note. Having a dismasted ship in tow, heave-to, make fast the stream cable to the mainmast of the ship, and take it in at the weather gangway, clinching it around the mainmast ; then make fast a stout hawser as a spring, and snatch it to a block lashed amidships on the taffrail, so that the ship may either ride on the weather quarter, or be roused astern. In case of veering, rouse in upon the spring, and the manoeuvre will be performed with more ( ertainty. After it is executed, the tow-rope must be shifted to the opposite gangway, by means of a spring, (fee. 351. HOW TO GET THE ANCHORS OFF THE BOWS. Hook the fore pendant-tackle ; single the shank-painters, and cet them taut with the pendant-tackles ; come up the shank-lash- ings, put the shoes between the bills and bows, by capstan-bars, and then by the shank-painters as far as necessary. Single and set taut cat-head stoppers, and then unlash the rings. [92 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 352. TO ANCHOR HEAD TO WIND WIND FREE See that the officers and men are at their stations, and the strictest silence preserved, as the ship nears her berth ; take in all the studding sails, get the burtons off the yards, and the jiggero off the topgallant yards ; send the booms and sails down from aloft ; man the fore clew-garnets, buntlines and leechlines ; the mainsail is hauled up as the ship is going free ; topgallant and royal clewlines ; lay aloft and stand by to furl the sails snug, and square the yards by the lifts and braces ; have hands by the fore tack and sheet, topgallant and royal sheets, halliards, weather braces, and bowlines ; up foresail, in topgallant-sails and royals : furl the sails snug, and square the yards by the lifts and braces, hauling taut the halliards. Man the topsail-clewlines and bunt- lines, weather braces, jib-downhaul, and spanker-outhaul ; attend the sheets, halliards, and spanker-brails, ease down the helm, haul down the jib, haul out the spanker, and when the topsail lifts, clear away the sheets, and clew them up ; then let go tho halliards, clew down, and square away the yards immediately j haul aft the spanker-sheet, and when the headway ceases, stream the buoy, stand clear of the cable ; when she begins to go astern, let go the anchor, brail up the spanker, crotch the boom, haul taut the guys, light-to the cable, as fast as she will take it, until a sufficient scope is out, when stopper. Furl sails, haul taut and stop in the rigging, send the boats' crews aft, to lower the -boats down. Let the boatswain go ahead to square the yards clear up the decks. Note. If in going to moor, veer out double the mooring scopti. and then let go the anchor ; then furl sails and heave in. 353. TO ANCHOR ON A LEE SHORE. The ship being on a lee shore, and no room to veer, recourse must be had to letting go all the anchors. For this purpose all the cables are bent and ranged, and all the anchors got ready for letting go ; the weather sheet is bitted to the forward bitts. and the weather bower to the after bitts, to windward ; the lee bower to the forward bitts, and the lee sheet to the after ones to leeward ; no buoy rope is bent except to the weather sheet ; tho weather sheet is backed by the stream, and the other anchors with kedges ; see all the tiers clear, get the ship under storm-staysails, and furl all the square sails ; hook the yard tackles ; get the lower yards forward, and house topmast; when all is ready, keep her a little olf, to get headway. Let go the weather sheet and stream an OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 193 chord and veer away, then the weather bower and kedge ; down helm ; haul down fore and main storm stay-sails, and the drift to leeward will carry her to the berth of the last anchor, which let go ; haul down the mizen storm stay-sail, and veer away an equal scope on all four cables ; observe that they will bear an equal strain, and veer to a long scope, reserving sufficient to freshen the nip with ;* see that the cables are well rounded, and watch them carefully. If she should drag, sling the guns with the stoutest spare rigging on board, having a round turn around all these cables, and heave them over ; if she should still drag, cut away the masts, and if there be no possibility of pre- venting her from going on shore, take a stout spring to one of the quarters, slip the cables, let her veer round ind go on shore end on.f Note In weighing these anchors, bring-to first on the cable which has got the least scope out, taking in the slack of the others with deck-tackles. 354. SCUDDING UNDER A FORESAIL TO COME TO AN ANCHOR. Get both bowers ready for letting go ; haul up the ioresai I, making a due allowance for headway, and run in under bai poles; when near the berth, down helm, out with the span- ker, and haul aft mizen storm stay-sail sheet ; when by the wind, let go the weather anchor and veer away briskly ; when head to wind, let go the lee anchor, and haul down the staysail ; veer-to 1 , and bring equal strain on both cables. If necessary, let go more anchors. 355 TO MAKE A FLYING MOOR. Make ail necessary preparations for coming-to ; overhaul and oitt a double range of the weather cable, and bitt the lee one at the range to which she is to be moored. When approaching the anchorage, reduce sail to topsails, jib and spanker, if moderate, but if fresh, to jib and spanker only ; when near the berth of the first anchor, luff-to, stream the buoy, and when the headway has * If they are hemp cables ; if chain, it is unnecessary. t See wrecked in a gale. 94 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; nearly ceased, let go the weather anchor, up helm, stand on and veer away roundly, to prevent the range from checking her; when the full range is nearly out, hard down the helm, down jib, clew up the topsails, out spanker, and let her lay the range out taut ; when taut, let go the lee anchor, furl sails, bring-to on the weather-cable, reeving away on the lee one, and heave into the moorings. Moor taut, to allow for veering ; clap on service, and veer it ; if hemp cable, square the yards, stop in the rigging, and clear up the decks. 356. TO MOOR WITH A LONG SCOPE OF CHAIN. Shackle the ends of both chains together, and veer away near- ly the whole of the two cables ; then let go the other anchor, bring-to on the first cable, heave in, veering away on the other ; when into the mooring mark or shackle, stopper and bitt, un- shackle the chains, and secure all ; clear up the decks, and pay the chain below. (See Unmooring and Mooring.) 357. BLOWING FRESH IN PORT. Range the cables, see the anchor clear, and an anchor watch set ; have leads-men in the chains send down the upper yards, if not already down; house top-gallant masts, and point the vards to the wind. 358. SEND DOWN LOWER YARDS. Send aloft the jeer-blocks, lash them, and reeve the jeers ; see the gear of the courses clear, trusses unrove, and lifts clear for unreeving ; hook the yard-tackles and take them forward, heave taut the jeers, unreeve the lanyard of the slings, attend the braces and yard-tackles, lower away by the ;eers and liflA When down make all fa?t. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 195 359. TO HOUSE TOPMASTS. Hook top-blocks, reeve pendants and falls, dee the ringing clear that leads to the topmast heads, man the top tackle-falls, slack the lanyards of the rigging, stays and backstays ; sway up, out fid, lower away, and haul down on the rigging; when low enough, pass heel-lashings around the lower masts, having can- vass in the wake ; set taut the ringing and stays. Sheep-shank the backstays, haul taut the running-rigging, and make all snug. Note. The topmasts may be housed with the lower yards aloft, by taking the yard-tackles forward and bousing upon them, slacking the braces and trusses at the same time (if not patent trusses). The patent truss has been so improved that the mast can be housed by unclamping one side and bracing sharp up. 360. TO BACK A BOWER BY A STREAM. Bend a stream-cable to the flukes of the bower-anchor, observ- ing to let go the stream first ; and when the cable is taut, let go the bower. If the bower is already down and dragging, form a clinch w r ith the stream, around the cable, and let her drag until she brings the stream ahead. 361. TO SWEEP FOR AN ANCHOR. Make use of long stout running-rigging ; middle it, and attach some sinker to the middle, also along the bight, to confine it to the bottom. Coil it away in two boats, and pull to windward of where the anohor is supposed to lie ; then pull in an opposite direction, veering away on the bight from both boats ; now pull in the direction of the anchor, and when the bight catches, cross the boats, and get a round turn with the rope ; make a running bowline on the end of a hawser around the rope, and slip it down ; when fast, weigh with the launch. Note. A section of small sized chain, with a rope bent to each end, is the best means that can be used to sweep for an anchor. Cross and bring both part's together, after which put on a shackle on both parts, and let it run down to the anchor ; then heave up on both parts. 196 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 362.- PREPARATIONS FOR LEAVING HARBOR. Inspect the tiller-ropes, shift hard over the helm, once or twice each way, in order to see that the tiller is not obstructed in its sweep in the gun-room. Place lead-lines in both channels, Point the ends of the hawsers up the hatchways, ready for pay- ing out in any direction. Range both bower cables ; see stoppers placed in readiness (bitt and ring). Examine cat-head stop- pers, and shank-painters of both bower-anchors. Should the shank-painters be fitted slip-shackle fashion, care should be taken to place men by them who are acquainted with the method of disengaging the anchors, &c. 363. WEIGHING ANCHOR IN A HEAD-SEA. In weighing anchor with a head-sea, precaution should be; taken to have previously prepared a good deck-tackle or other purchase, which affix to the messenger (if required), to assist the action of the capstan. There should also be had in readiness an imple quantity of nippers. (See Passing- Nippers.) 364. CASTING, OR CUTTING THE CABLE. When at single anchor in a roadstead, and if it be apprehended that from the direction of the wind, and the local position of the ship with the shore, it may be necessary to have recourse to cut- ting the cable, and that casting the wrong way would endanger the safety of the vessel, timely precaution should be taken to ensure the ships casting in the right direction. To effect this purpose, the stream cable should be bent to that of the riding bower, brought through the after part, and taken round the capstan, in readiness to act as a spring, to cant the ship previously to cutting. Axes should be placed abaft in the vicinity of the stream cable, for the purpose of cutting it, after the bower has been severed, and the ship's head cast the desired way. Note. A slip or ouoy-rope should be brought over f: head," so that when the cable is cut, a buoy may be left in the roadstead to denote the position of the anchor. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 365. CLINCHING CABLES. Whatever be the number of hemp cables which are bent to the anchors, the officer in charge is particularly cautioned to clap on a clinch rounding, towards the inner extremity of each cable, keep- ing three sheaves in the tier ; upon receiving the cables on board, and clinching their respective ends, the officer may proceed as given in the note below. Chain-cables should never be clinched in a manner which will not admit of their ends being immediately disengaged, in the event of it becoming necessary to slip, or extricate the ship from her anchors ; it may be said, that the cable may be unshackled on deck, but it may so happen, that the last shackle is without the hawse a circumstance which will preclude the possibility o f having recourse to this expedient. Note. Pay down three sheaves into the tier, and then clap on a racking lashing to the fore beam, previously worming and parceling in the wake of the lashing ; measure then, allowing the cable bitted, and clap on a rounding in the wake, where the cable would bring up in the hawse, and chafe in the cutwater. This method leaves room to freshen hawse, in the event of having to veer to the clinch. Few ships adopt the precaution of clapping upon their cables a clinch service ; when too late, the necessity of the prac- tice is discovered. 366. FITTING BUOY-BOPES. Buoy-ropes are always proportioned to the depth of water. One end is unlaid, and a buoy rope-knot made ; it is then laid up igain, and whipped. A clove hitch is made, one half of the hitch being on each side of the crown. The end with the knot is seized on the shank, one seizing put on close to the crown, and one close to the end. The other is bent to the buoy. Some orefer the running eye. Put over one arm, and a half-hitch ovei the other arm, and seized in the cross. 367. JIB-HALLIARDS WITH A WHIP. A piece of rope, nearly equal to the double halliards, is rove o the head of other a single *v^j-rvj KAWVAAf 1 1 -* v *' i vw WV \JL\J \JLM1\S 11 UL11 through the block at the" mast-head, and hooked to the head of the jib, a hook being spliced in the end ; in the o 198 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR ; block is spliced high enough from the deck to allow the jib being hauled close down. Through this block reeve a fall, and send Loth ends down through lubber's-hole ; splice a hook in one end, and hook into a bolt ; reeve the other through a leading-block. Objections have been made to whips, but if the standing part is put a good distance from the hauling, it is impossible that it can take turns in they can lead abaft the top if necessary. I should recommend their being brought down immediately forward of topsail halliards. 368. JIB SHEETS, DOUBLE. Two single blocks are seized into one strap, as span blocks, and the strap secured to the clew* of the sail, with a lashing pass- ed through it, and an eye formed in the strap by crossing both parts together, and passing a throat seizing. One end of the sheet is clinched or spliced into an eye-bolt in the bulwarks, the other end rove through the block in the sail, from out, in and through a fair-leader or sheave in the bulwarks. With pendants, a piece of rope of sufficient size and length is middled, crossed, and a throat seizing passed round both parUi, having an eye in the bight large enough to take a lashing. Li each of these pendants, splice a single block ; reeve a whip the same as in the double sheets. The pendants should be long enough to allow the weather one to hang slack on the fore-top- mast stay, when the sheet is aft. (See Sail Table for iron clews.) 369. WRECKED IN A GALE. When this sad fate appears inevitable, it would be well to make choice (if choice can be made), of what appears the best part of the coast, and the clearest from rocks, for beaching her. The manner in which the boatmen beach their boats, is by laying them, with the assistance of the helm, half-broadside on, or rather bow and quarter on, having previously given the vessel a heel, or list in shore. This may be done either by trimming, or by the sallying of the crew, before the time that the vessel takes the ground. Such a position will offer the best means of saving the crew, who may also be materially assisted by cutting * Ircn clews being fitted to all sails, the strap would be likely to chafe. I would recommend snug clump sister-hooks, or shackles, fitted to the clews OR YOUNG SULORS' ASSISTANT. 199 away the masts, so as to fall towards the shore, which may be the means of assisting those on board to reach the shore. In establishing a communication with the shore, if it be by a boat, the end of the deep sea-lead line should be taken in her, or if it be by some good swimmer, with a cork jacket on, the end of the log line will serve the same purpose ; by either of these, haw- sers, or other large ropes may afterwards be got on shore. The means of getting on shore from a wreck are by life boats, rafts, parts of the wreck, or life preservers. A canvass cot, with large holes at the bottom, to admit the water to pass through freely, and having cross bars of thick rope, should also be kept in readiness for such an occasion. Raw-hide rope will be the best for traveling grommets. Some other expedients might be mentioned, which are for the consider ation of officers in charge of vessels. 370. SETTING UP RIGGING AT SEA. Whenever it is required to set up the lower shrouds, at sea, the topmast shrouds should be all let go ; this practice is recom- mended upon the presumption that the lower rigging will not be cast loose, or set up on the occasion of a swell, or that the ship be rolling or pitching. It has been \vell observed, that by letting go two topmast shrouds at a time, an uneven strain has been brought upon the futtock ;* which prevents the shrouds of the lower rigging being equally drawn down. Upon all occasions of setting up the lower rigging at sea, it is always advisable to have ready prepared as many luffs as possi- ble, so that the shrouds may be set up at a time, and that there may be no delay in shifting the tackles from shroud to shroud. When the lower rigging is up, the futtock plates should be beaten down to the top, and the shrouds set tautly up by means of tackles, ready hooked to there respective lanyards. The method of em- ploying the Spanish windlass, for the purpose of setting up these shrouds, is not to be recommended. It occupies too much time, and often creates unnecessary delay before the topmast rigging can be set up. In staying the topmasts, the boatswain is not recommended to bouse too far forward the heads of the mast, and he should recollect that the angle formed by the main topmast stay, with the fore top, is considerably greater than that of the fore topmast with the bowsprit ; and consequently that the leve? of the former is more powerful than that of the latter. This is only applicable to vessels having their futtock-rigging set up to their lower rigging. 200 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Note. Vessels not having catharpen legs, need not come up the topmast rigging for the purpose of setting up lower rigging, as the futtock-shrouds set up to the mast. 371. SLACKING THE JIB-STAY, IN BAD WEATHER The jib-stay is always set up as taut as a bar of iron ; conse- quently, when it comes to a blow, both the spray of the sea and the rain tend to tauten it more ; in pitching, too, it must assist to spring the boom, work the bowsprit, and cause unnecessary strain upon the rope itself. Whenever it blows so fresh that the jib is not likely to be set, the jib-stay should be slacked. If it be required subsequently to setting the sail, nothing can be easier than to set the stay up, while the jib is loosing. (Bear this in mind.} 17 2. STOPPING OUT TOPGALLANT YARD ROPES. The practice of permitting the topmen to stop the topgallant y ard ropes out at their own convenience, and consequently at unstated periods, is at variance with that order and regularity which should ever characterize the duties and discipline of a ves- 3! of war. In well regulated ships, the officer of the watch, following the movements of the senior officers, directs the boatswain or his mates to pipe " out yard ropes ;" if tripping-lines are tolerated, the yard rope and tripping-line men should lay out together: by pur- suing this system the yards will be kept square, and will not ^as is of constant occurrence), be seen for an hour and a half be- fore sunset, topping in different directions. The same rule should be observed when placing on whips for hammock-girtlines. or clothes-lines. 373. PREVENTER BRACES. It is desirable to establish a general rule, that w r hen the top- sails are treble-reefed, the preventer braces are to be placed on th yards, and that the relieving tackles in the gun room be placed at hand ready for use. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 20 1 374. KEEPING A CLEAR ANCHOR. That part of seamanship which relates to the method of tend- ing a ship to the tide, or in other words of keeping the cable cleai of the anchor, may not be inaptly termed the blind branch of the mariner's art the buoy floating on the surface being the only possible guide that the seaman possesses to point to the po- sition of the anchor hidden under water. From being little understood, and by young officers it is seldom put in practice, the art of keeping a clear anchor is by many con- sidered a difficult task ; but, were officers to give more attention to the matter, and to place less dependence on the master or pilot, they would soon attain every necessary knowledge to meet the most difficult tide case. 375. ANCHOR TURNING IN THE GROUND. In order to ensure the certainty of an anchor turning in the ground, with the tending or swinging of the ship, it is recom- mended (whenever it is possible), to resort to this practice : To shoot the ship on the same side of her anchor, at each change of tide ; for if the anchor should not turn in the ground, the cable will get foul, either about the stock or upper fluke, and trip it out of ground. (Remember this). 376. TO TEND TO A WEATHER-TIDE Let it be supposed that a ship is riding at single anchor, upon a lee-tide, with the wind in the same direction as the tide, and that it be required, upon the tide setting to windward, to tend the ship clear of the anchor. To effect this, as soon as the ship 202 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; begins to feel the turn of the weather- tide, and that the vessel brings the wind broad on the weather-bow, the head sails should be hoisted, and the lee-sheets hauled aft. in order to shoot the ship from her anchor, on a taut cable. The helm must be put "a-lee," and kept in that position until the tide sets the ship over to windward of her cable, and the buoy appears on the same side with the helm. If from light winds the buoy bears nearly a-beam, her head sails may be hauled down ; but if the breeze be strong, and it causes the ship to shoot in a direction nearly end-on with that of the cable, bringing the buoy on her quarter it will be necessary to keep the fore-topmast-staysail set, in order to check the vessel, should she be disposed to break her shear against the action of her helm, or be inclined to drop to wind- ward and " go over" her anchor, in a broadside or lateral direc- tion. 377. A MAN OVERBOARD, AT SEA. If the ship be going free, and particularly if fast through the water, it is recommended to bring-to with the head-yards a-back, for it is obvious if the main-yard be left square, the ship will be longer coming-to, will shoot farther, increase the distance from the man, and add materially to the delay of succor. It will however require judgment, especially if blowing fresh, to be careful and right the helm in time, or the ship will fly-to too much, gain sternway, and risk the boat in lowering down. The best authority recommends, that if possible, the ship should not only be hove a-back when a man falls overboard, but she ought to.be brought around on the other tack; of course sail ought to be shortened in stays, and the main-yard kept square. This implies the ship being on a wind, or from the position of having the wind not above two points abaft the beam. The great merit of such a method of proceeding, is, that if the evolution succeeds, the ship when round will drift towards the man, and although there may be some small risk in lowering the boat in stays from the ship, having at one period sternway, there will in fact be little time lost, if the boat be not lowered until the ship be well round, and the sternway at an end. There is more mischief done generally, by lowering the boat too soon, than by waiting until the fittest moment arrives far doing it coolly. It cannot be too often repeated, that almost the whole depends upon the self-possession of the officer of the deck. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 2Q3 378. JIB AND STAYSAIL-HALLIARD (Blocks at mast-head.) For various reasons it is advisable to dispense with the cheek- blocks, which are usually fitted to the fore topmast-head, for the Duroose of reeving the above two ropes, together with the fore topmast staysail-halliards. In the first place, if the fore-topmast be sprung, or carried away in chase, and it be required to shift the mast with all possible speed, considerable time is taken up in removing and replacing cheek-blocks at the mast-head (See allow ance-table. Blocks.) Note. In some ships the jib and fore-topmast staysail-halliards are rove through gins fitted for the purpose. Gins, however, are not supplied in all ships, but you can always fit fiddle-blocks under the eyes of your rigging ; your jib and staysail-halliards reeve in the upper sheaves, and the topsail-buntlines in the lowe\ ones. Cheek-blocks answer well on the trestle-trees. 379. TO KEEP THE HAWSE CLEAR WHEN MOORED. When it is nearly slack water, cant her with the helm the right way, and if necessary, make use of jib, spanker, and yards. 380. TO TEND TO WINDWARD SINGLE ANCHOR. When the tide slacks, sheer her with the helm, run up the jib and fore-topmast staysail, with weather-sheets aft ; when canted the right way, the lee-sheets may be hauled aft, and and the yards filled, thus setting her abreast to a taut cable ; when the buoy is on the lee-quarter, brace the head-yards to the wind, and fill the after ones ; when the tide swings her head around so as to shake the sails, haul down and stow them. 381. TO TEND TO LEEWARD. As the tide slackens, sheer her to the* same side of the buoy on winch she came to windward, and fill the yards, wnich will sei 16 204 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; her end-on over the cable ; she Avill now by the effect of the wind, bring her stern over the cable, and bring the buoy on her weather-quarter ; put the helm " a-weather," and she will shoot ahead, tautening tne cable, by sheering her head from the wind. When the wind gets a little aft the beam, hoist the jib, to pi event the cable from drawing her head to wind. Let her lay in this position until she falls off; when the nead- ails shake, haul down and stow them. 382. TO BACK SHIP (AT ANCHOR). As the tide slacks, sheer her to windward, sheet-home and set the mizen-topsail; thus she will back round to leeward as soon as the tide sets up ; clew up and furl the mizen-topsaiL 383. TO BREAK THE SHEAR. When tending to the tide, and the ship comes over her anchor she may break her shear by canting her stern the wrong wayj vhen this is the case put the helm "a-weather," run the jib up, fill the head-yards, and the after-yards kept-to. Everything is now arranged to bring her round again, when she must be man- aged as before mentioned. 384. ON GETTING TO SEA. Unship the man-ropes, stow them away, secure the gangways, pay down the messenger, and secure anchors and boats. The anchors ought to be se- cured with preventer stoppers, and painters, particularly where they work with a slip-shackle or tricker, which a rope catching, may drag or drive out. In fact the jib-sheet is apt to do this if not looked to. Wash and dry the nippers, then stow them away ; wash down the anchors and buoys, and black 01? YOUNG SA1LOKS' ASSISTANT. 205 them us soon as possible; when clear of the land, unbend cables buoys, and buoy-ropes, and ship the blind-buckles, unless prevent- ed by peculiar circumstances. Take off the harbor-gaskets and have them repaired and blackened afresh, when convenient. If the bunt-gaskets, however, are retained on the yards, roll them up snug and secure tnem. Put the sea-gaskets on, make them up in cheises, and keep them before the yards. Place bunt-line spans to their respective yards. Have the boats' sails and awnings dried and put below. Quarter-boats clear for lowering. Besides these, the watch on deck, when not employed in more pressing duties, may bo occupied to much advantage as fol- lows, viz. : 1st. Exercising small-arms, cutlasses and guns ; 2d. Pointing all ropes requiring it ; 3d. Working up a sufficient quantity of junk, into seizing- stuff, mats, swabs, foxes, thumb-lines, knittles, gaskets, reef points, nippers, salvagees, straps, &c., &c. 385. OX FIRE REGULATIONS IN THE MERCHANT SERVICE. We now come to the most important of all the regulations i'i a ship, namely, those which operate against the fatal and shock - ing eiiects of fire. Whatever good results from stationing people in ordinary cases, cannot be put in competition with this, whicii provides against the most dreadful catastrophe incident to a ship. From the number of unfortunate accidents of this nature we surely ought to be prepared to our utmost for such an event. First, by internal precautions ; and Secondly, by the means to be used against the danger. Let there be great attention in the use of fire and lights. The regulations on these subjects which exist in men of war are still more required in merchant vessels. Fires should be put out at eight P. M., and all lights at nine p. M., except those required for the binnacle, and on deck. The officer of the last dog-watch ought to report the fire extin- guished to the captain. As each man is relieved from the wheel, he should examine below, and report " all well " to the officer of the watch. No naked light whatever ought to be permitted ; let eithei lanterns or lamps be used. Spirits should be drawn off by day ; a naked light shuuld on no account be permitted near a spirit cask. 206 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; Smoking should not be allowed below. I have known more than one ship set on fire by a man's pipe ; and by segars, I have no doubt many have been burnt. In stowing a hold, do not allcw naked lights to be used, nor any person to smoke there when so employed. On receiving cotton as a cargo, both those who ship as well as those who receive it, ought to ascertain that it is in a safe state before it be put on board. I have known instances of its being sold and moved away, when, in a few hours, if it had not been moved, it would have ignited. 1 am acquainted with the particulars of a ship that was burn some years since, where oil had been stowed in the hold with cotton over it, with what was considered safe and secure dunnage between. The cotton, notwithstanding, absorbed a quantity of oil. became heated, and ignited. The crew with difficulty saved themselves in the boats before the flames burst forth, and the vessel was entirely consumed. Chests containing bottles of inflammable substances, such as vitriol, &c., cannot be too well secured. A medicine chest upset in a gale may set fire to a ship. Friction matches should never be allowed on board a ship. The coals in steamers have frequently taken fire, and in many cases with the most fatal consequences. Too much care cannot be taken in the selection of coals ; a strict examination ought to be made as to their state when received and stowed, and no sus- picious circumstances should be then overlooked. When receiv- ing coals, avoid throwing the fresh ones on the old, which ought to be kept uppermost, and^rs^ for use. When once they become ignited, I can hardly offer a remedy for the evil. When coals take fire, some people throw water upon them, and smother the fire by wet beds. Hot water, or steam, if they can be used, are more expeditious than cold water in extinguish- ing fire, I believe. To attempt to discharge the coals, would al- low the air freer access, and would be certain to increase the power of the fire. A few canvass buckets, with long lanyards, should be alway prepared and ready on deck for drawing water. When a fire is first discovered, shorten all low sails directly, courses up, stay-sails and wind-sails down, boat-covers taken off. If the sails should take fire from lightning, or any other cause, cutting away the mast appears the most likely method of saving the ship. At first, endeavor if possible, to stifle the fire ; which may be best done by shutting off any draught of air, and smothering it with wet bedding, small sails, &c., until a good supply of waier can be applied. If the fire is forward, put before the wind until it is necessary to " out boats," then bring- to. If the fire is aft, or a-midships, keep to the wind. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 207 386. STATION BILL FOR FIRE, IN THE MER- CHANT SERVICE.* Coolness and steadiness in any misfortune by fire are essential to arrest it If a fire break out below, the hatchways should be immediately covered, to prevent a draught of air. Ring the ship's beil to call the men to their stations. MEN'3 NAMES. DUTIES. A very steady man --- To the helm. r First, to cover hatchways \\ith gratings and The carpenter, and I S ^^^ rig pumps and lead hoses . and Thirdly, get the tools ready for cutting: away, *- if required. The chief mate, boat- ^ To attend where the fire is, and pass water to swain, and ship's cook. \ it, &c. A man of each watch ^ To the pumps, and to draw water as for wash- or more. \ ing decks. . , ^ To collect all the buckets to the part where the I water is being drawn. {First duty to haul up courses, brail up trysails and spanker. Second duty, draw and pass water with the fire buckets ; then for third duty see below. {First duty, to haul up courses, brail up trysaila Se^ondTuty* tosoak small sails and bedding to throw over and smother the fire ; then for third duty see below. r k- ar/i A l"lf an y powder or other combustibles are on cablnTo 1 board ' to throw ^ em overboard if Possible, (_ or drown them. Second mate to direct p lf tfae fregh water jg in ^ turn fire hose, and the sup- 1 ^^ of twQ of them for > ft firgt , I the p um p' and then go to direct fire ho ^ ("Third duties of the crew, the yard and stay- The crew. < tackles to be got up ready for getting oat l_ boats. * This bill ought to be written out or printed, and hung up for every one's in- spection. r The mate ough to have the key of the valves of the water tanks in his own fceepin?. THE KEDGE-ANCHOR ; MEN'S NAMES. DUTIES. {Fourth duties of the crew, it' the fire appears tn increase, out boats, and lower down the quarter boats ; let them lay off in a string to windward, with a man and a boy as keepers ready for the rest of the crew if required. The captain To attend at all the stations as he deems best If the ship cannot be saved, the passengers and crew are the first objects, with some fresh water and biscuit ; a compass, quad- rant and Bowditch. Unless there is sufficient time, and it can be done without endangering the sea-worthiness of the boats, nothing should be taken that is not essential to the mere preser- vation of life, and necessary for navigating the boats. 3 8 7. TAKING TO THE BOATS. The captain should in his own mind, and by a private memo randum, station the passengers and crew to the boats on board, and likewise make the persons here specified be responsible fo having the following articles put into the boats. f Compass, Maury on Navigation, sextant, spj . N glass, Nautical Almanac, pencils and writing i paper, general chart, pocket watch, pair oi v. compasses, &c. ,. ( Oars, masts, sails, boat-hooks, bolt of canvass, I boat's compass, Bowditch's chart, ensign. , Two or three bags of biscuits, some breakers of a j \ water, quadrant, pencils and writing paper lte ' J half-gill measure, a musket, box of cartridges, * and flints or caps. Surgeon ...... - Pocket instruments. ( Hammer, nails, sheet-lead, grease, fearnoiig?^t, Carpenter. ? oakum, saw, chisel, turn-screw, cold chisel., a ^ vial of sweet oil, any small iron rod. Third mate, or boat- ( Coil of inch rope, long reel, deep-sea reel, paint swain. ^ ed canvass, marling-spikes, spun-yarn, &c. ^ii ( Palm, needles, twine, fishing-lines, hooks, paint- I ed canvass, boat's awning. ~ , , ( Tinder-box, flints and tinder, small box, lantern Cock, and steward. | &nd candlegj cheesCj cabm > bigcuitj c] { oc ^^ OR YOUtfG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. . (A tin pot, a pocket knife, a change of f.annela and stockings. With a scarcity of food, savages attempt to lessen the cravings ol hunger by tightening a belt around the waist ; and by sucking a pebble they in some degree alleviate thirst. Chewing tobacco may also be serviceable under such circumstances. In such emergencies all must fare alike. 388 -LOSING A RUDDER AT A CRITICAL MOMENT, (such as crossing a Bar^ A ship might lose her rudder at a critical moment in crossing the bar of a river, when a few minutes more might run her aground, if she were unmanageable ; and in this case, what tem- porary rudder is best becomes a question for which a few moments only are given to decide. The plan of steering by the stream- cable payed out astern, or by the stern-boat lowered instantly, with the plug out, and towed astern by a hawser, with guys leading up to each quarter, would perhaps then be adopted ; while a ship losing her rudder at sea would have leisure to adopt any other plan. It might be an advantage, if every vessel would take some op- portunity of tryibg how she could steer with a stern-boat in the manner described, and what length of tow-line was required to enable her to steer the most easily, so as to avoid wild yawing. The experiment might be made in moderate weather with the wind on the quarter, and also right aft, under top-sails, top-gal- l int-sails and fore-sail, running five or six knots. Nothing gives jonfidence so much as practice. 389. STEAMERS GETTING AGROUND. As steamers would probably do so with very fresh way on, they ought at once to stop their engines, but on no account to attempt to reverse them, until the extent of the injury be ascer tained ; otherwise they may go down in deep water. Their first duty is to out boats, and pla:e the passengers in safety in them ; the crew might then ascertain the state of the vessel ; if she is likely to float, and can be got off, the attempt to do so should be made ; but if not, the crew ca i take to the boats. 210 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 390. ON THE DUTY OF REMAINING BY A DAMAGED VESSEL When two vessels have run foul of each other, the one which is the least injured is bound, by every sense of justice and hu- manity, to stay by the other to render every assistance in her power ; a contrary proceeding ought to make the guilty party liable to some punishment. If one appears likely to sink, the the boat lashings should be cut, that the boat or boats may be got out or float off. When freshly blows the northern gales, Then under courses snug we fly ; When lighter breezes swell the sails, Then royals proudly sweep the sky. PART VII. MISCELLANEOUS SUBJECTS. 391 OX SQUARING YARDS. Simple as may seem the process of squaring yards, it is nevei - iheless a piece of duty which requires considerable precision, and this precision can never be obtained without a knowledge of the principle upon which the yards should be squared. A boatswain, ignorant of this principle, will generally proceed thus : he first bouses taut the lower trusses, squares the yards by the braces, and, quite regardless of the distance of the topsail-yards from their respective caps, or looking to see if the yards are a-midships, directs the chief boatswain's mate to take his station on the end of the jib-boom, whilst he himself proceeds in the boat ahead of the ship to square the yards by the lifts. Should the fore-yard be required to be topped to starboard, the boatswain will top away upon the yard-arm until, by chance, he discovers he has topped it too high ; to remedy this eye sore, he sings out " Fore- yard to port" and tops until he raises the larboard arm as high us the starboard ; producing by this system of topping, and never settling, a most unsightly bow in the yard. He then squares the fore-topsail yard by the bowed fore-yard, and of course treats the fore-topsail yard to a bit of a bend likewise. He then takes the main yard in hand, which, though probably square by the lifts, can no longer look so in his eye, because the yard arms are not made to cock up like those of the fore yard. "Mai?i yard to starboard? he sings out, with an audible voice ; the lift is topped several feet to starboard, and then to port, until the yard assumes the desired cock the boatswain has in his eye in squaring the loftier yards by the lifts. Boatswains seldom take the precaution to place hands to tend the top-gallant braces. It should be re- membered that the topping of the lifts alter and disturb the square position of the yards by the braces. These may appear minute 214 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR ; matters, but unless they be strictly observed, yards never can be properly squared. In squaring yards by the lifts, the lanyards should always be unrove to two or three turns, the jigger hooked to them and hauled taut ; and when topping on one lift always ease the op- posite lanyard with the jigger ; if not, the lanyard will render with jerks, and the yard will probably have to be topped the op posite way. The lanyards should be rocked when sufficiently up, the plan of nipping with hands being a lazy, bad practice ; and after much time spent in getting the yards nicely squared, the lanyards have come up in securing. The ropes should be all hauled taut before the boat comes on board ; all the ropes coiled neatly and low in the tops ; nothing allowed to hang over the bows, which should be kept quite clear ; and everything done tc make the ship appear in every respect what a man-of-war ought to be. Being particular in one part and not in another, has almost a worse appearance than slovenly altogether. As the ship is con- sidered a would-be man-of-war, and is the cause of many re- marks, which, if heard by the commanding officer, would not be at all complimentary to his nautical knowledge, if anything should be studied more than another, it is the standing rigging and position of the masts and yards, &c., &c. Note. Before squaring the yards, the boatswain is recommend- ed to see that the masts, and particularly the lofty spars, are up- right and all in one. It frequently happens that after the boat- swain has squared all the yards, fore and aft, he detects an awkward inclination in one of the topgallant-masts ; he never- theless returns on board, and reports to the senior lieutenant, yards squared and ropes taut, but afterwards desires the captain of the top to get a pull on the starboard or larboard top-gallant breast-backstay, forgetting that this very pull affects the top-gal- lant lifts, and consequently alters the position of the yards. The first thing after the masts are all in one, or upright, as you choose to term it, is to get your yards exactly amidships by rolling- tackles ; then get them snugly trussed to the mast, and square them by the braces, before proceeding ahead of the ship. 392. UP TOP-GALLANT MASTS AND YARDS (The Masts, fyc. being on deck.) One watch of topmen aloft, to get jack or tail blocks on, tor yard ropes, as also for flying jib and staysail halliards ; if the sails are about to be loosed, have jiggers on the topgallant stays, ready for setting up, and burtons overhauled, ready for clapping OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 215 on the mast ropes; in fielding, the other watch see everything clear, and get tackles on the backstays, ready for setting up the instant the mast is stayed. WORDS OF COMMAND. * All hands, up topgallant-masts and yards" and loose sails if requisite. "Sway away" let the masts wait for each other, after placing the topgallant rigging, so that they may afterwards ascend uniformly, and be fielded together. Instantly the fids are in, stay topgallant-masts, and set up the quarter, or standing backstays ; then without waiting for more of the rigging, proceed to cross topgallant-yards alone, along with the loosing of the sails, as may be requisite, and as is described in 394. Remarks. The mast-heads and eyes of the rigging, or fun nels, should be greased. If topgallant-sails are unbent, and royal yard-ropes good, it will make the work of crossing topgallant-yards all the easier, to use royal in place of topgallant-yard ropes. If there be no capshore, the topmast cap is apt to droop for- ward, and by catching and jaming the topgallant-masts, to in- terfere materially in the attempt to send them up smartly ; the caps ought therefore to be well looked after. If the topgallant, loyal, and skysail masts, be all in one, it is generally found necessary to let fall the bunts of the topsails, in order to get the masts up ; at sea the yards must be braced up, the topsails low- ered two-thirds down, and the mast sent up to windward 393. DOWN TOPGALLANT-MASTS AND YARDS. One watch, or part of a watch of topmen, aloft, to clear away the topgallant rigging, unreeve flying-jib and staysail-halliards, get jack or tail-blocks on, for royal and topgallant yard-ropesr and burtons on the mast-ropes. The other watch of topmen on deck, unlace the backstay-mats, and slack the oackstay lanyards. When ready, "sway away" two hands at the mast-head look- ing out for the fids, the lanyards of which they should be cau- tioned to see fast ; and two on topsail-yard to bear the heel clear, and make fast heel-rope. When the fids are out, hang the backstays to the tops, lower all the masts together, and get heel-ropes on, which should be in readiness, from the deck to the fid-holes. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR: If the rigging does not start easily, sway and surge without delay; clap on the lizard through the royal-halliard sheave-hole, as soon as it can be got at ; then lower the masts on deck, eithei placing them fore and aft, or up and down the lower masts. Haul the rigging and backstays taut down from the mast- heads, and stop them down along the topmast rigging, coiling away the slack bights snug in the tops; also haul taut the stays and all the small ropes. See that the trucks are fairly placed, so that the signal-hal- liards may traverse freely. If the masts are only housed, haul the topgallant rigging and backstays taut, as above, but stay the royal-masts, and sheep- shank and set up the royal backstays and shrouds, if there be any, or what is preferable, stop the slack part in bights, and then set up ; also steady the heels of the topgallant-masts to the topmast by a heel-rope. Remarks. The yards, according to circumstances, may be either sent down at the moment you begin to lower the mast?, or at that when you begin to sway the masts, in order to take out the fid. The former has the best effect, but in that case it is essential to have picked hands to lower, and not to commence lowering until the lower yard-arm is unrigged. 394. CROSSING TOPGALLANT AND ROYAL-YARDS, AND LOOSING SAIL. That all the squadron may be prepared to cross yards anrl loose sail at eight, or for any other manoeuvre, deemed proper at the hoisting of the colors, the flag ship sometimes makes it a rule to designate seven bells, that is 7 H. 30 M., by giving the prepar- atory signal. The squadron have then an opportunity of regu lating their time by the Commodore's, and making such prepara lions for eight as may be necessary. If this be done, and another very proper rule enforced, viz. : the allowing no one, on any account, to be aloft between five minutes before eight, and the time of making the signal, every ship will be upon an equal footing in the keen competition which immediately ensues. PREPARATIONS. Send the hands aloft to overhaul the lifts and braces ; prepare studding-sail-booms for tricing up, bend the top bowlines to the auntline toggles, overhaul the gear of the courses, coiling it UK YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 21? down on the lower yards, and take the cloths and half the gas- kets off the fore and aft sail ; also stretch along and reeve the yard-ropes. WORDS OF COMMAND. " Ail hands, cross yards and loose sails ;" " Aloft, topmen ;" "Aloft, sail loosers ;" Sway out of the chains viz. : upper topgallant yard-arms slear of top-rims, or lubber's-hole ; royal yard-arms clear of cross trees. " Sway away ;" trice up, lay out. "Sway across let fall," the men at the same time hoisting jibs and staysails, hauling out the bowlines, getting down the squaring-marks of topgallant and royal lifts and braces, and hoisting ensign, jack, and pendant. A boat should then be manned without delay, for the boat- swain to go ahead, look at the yards, see the head-sails taut up, the bowline properly out, and everything ready for shortening sail. If the bowlines are not to be hauled out, and, in consequence, the jibs and staysails not hoisted, nor the sheets of trysail and spanker hauled aft, proceed as follows, viz. : Keep fast, the topsail clewlines, and haul up the buntJmes ; throw the jibs out off the booms without touching the halliards, and slack off the trysail and spanker-brails ; overhaul the brails on one side and haul them up on the other loose the small sails enough for the wind to blow through, which will prevent their heating, and even should it rain slightly, will avert much harm. Remark. The frequent loosing of the sails is essential, to prevent them from mildewing, particularly when new, and before the gum has been shaken out. 395. TOPMAST CARRIED AWAY. I would recommend vessels to use curb-chain, for parrels for topsail-yards ; let it be wormed, parceled and covered with leather; the seizings must be frequently examined. Carrying away a parrel may occasion a serious loss of life, should there happen to be any men on the yard at the time, and even if there are not, this accident is veiy likely to carry away the topmast. The funnels used for top-gallant rigging, are frequently used for topmast rigging; they are also very serviceable, and if a topmast ia 218 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; carried away, the funnel is then invaluable, as the topmast ma$ be shifted so much more quickly, the rigging remaining properly placed. 396. CLEARING THE WRECK OF A TOPMAST. Watch on deck to secure the wreck, and prevent its doing in- jury watch below to shorten sail. Hook top-blocks, reeve in them two hawsers ; the stoutest to leeward, for passing round and securing the wreck, in order to get the rigging &c. in-board. Hook luff-tackles in the lower pendants let the other topgal- lant yards be sent down, and the topgallant masts housed until the topmast is shifted. If it be a fore-topmast that is carried away, ease in the jib-boom cut the lanyards of the topmast rig- ging, securing the dead-eyes by studding-sail-halliards. The weather-hawser may be employed to unfid the stump. 397. CARRYING AWAY A JIB-BOOM. Send down the fore-topgallant-yard, and house the fore-topgal- lant-mast; use the fore-topmast staysail-halliards, and lee-fore- bowline, for securing and getting in the wreck. 398. TO FISH A LOWER YARD IN THE SHORTEST TIME. Incalculable are the evils which may result to a vessel from the springing or snapping of a lower yard, especially the fore one. If the yard be severed, get both pieces down on deck, and place them together, to assume, as near as possible, their original posi- tion. Hollow out, so as to fit the cylindrical surface of the yard, two spare anchor-stock pieces, (or two proper fishes always fitted, and to be kept as spare stores), in doing which, a depth of two 01 three inches will suffice ; place one piece on the top, and the other secured to the under part of the yard, towards the extrem- ities ; dub down the superfluous wood, and round the edges, ready to receive the requisite wooldings. Previous to boring holes for the bolts, set close-to the anchor- stock pieces, with wedge upon wedge ; introduce then eight bolts, OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 219 Dl three-quarter inch diameter, which must be severally clinched. Cut scores for eight wooldings, and woold away with well-stretch- ed rope, of two-and-a-half inch. The yard may then be replaced aloft. There will be found no necessity for studding-sail booms, or other spare spars. 399. EXPECTATION OF LOSING A LOWER MAST. Every vessel should have a spare lower cap on board ; it should be in two parts (for the convenience of stowing), with bolts for securing it together. In the event of losing a lower mast, the cap put on the spare topmasts, and then raised on the stump of the lower mast (hav- ing been previously fitted for it), at once enables a jury mast to be stopped and secured ; clap on a good heel lashing. Those vessels which have lower dead-eyes secured to the side, are enabled to get clear of the wreck of a lower mast more read- ily than those with the old channels and chain plates. Those which are fitted in the last mentioned manner, when likely to lose a lower mast, should reeve a hawser through the lanyards of the rigging on each side, and have it well secured ; they will then be enabled to disengage the lanyards from the channels, and get clear of the wreck, whose thumping might otherwise injure either the ship's bottom or rudder. 4OO. LYING-TO IN A GALE, AFTER THE LOSS OP MASTS. Put a stout span on a spare topmast or other large spar, and veer a long scope on a hawser, or stream chain-cable, from the bow, by a spring on it from aft ; it may be used for wearing. The wreck of a mast would answer well for lying-to with, and when the weather became fine, the spars and rigging would ma- terially assist in refitting jury masts. 4O1. SPARS TO CONVERT IN CASE OF NEED. Officers will do well to consider what spars they have on board which can be the most readily and efficiently converted, so as to supply the place of any which may be lost. 220 THE KEDGE-A.NCHOR; A spare topmast, or if in a brig, a main-boom, are the spare that could be the most, quickly converted into a jury lower mast, or bowsprit ; a mizen-mast would be still better, if the weather would permit its being shifted. A topmast studding-sail boom, with the sail as a lug, rnaives a sufficiently good mizen. If the bowsprit is sprung, let the jib-boom be eased in nearly to the bulwark. When a vessel is lying- to, and there is a heavy sea running, it would be prudent to have tackles up for steadying the foremast, as in the event of the bowsprit being struck, and either sprung or carried away, the mast would be saved. A jib-boom will answer well for making a topsail yard. Note. It is surprising how well vessels answer when jury rig- ged, and in many cases will sail nearly as fast as when they have there proper masts, yards, and sails. Sails may be reduced by taking out midship cloths, and by the head for depth. When vessels take the ground, from a falling tide, or any other sause, they ought to be prepared with three shores on a side, the lower ends a little off. The first abreast the foremast : The second amidships : The third abaft the main-sheet sheave. A measure should be previously taken of the exact depth from the bulwark to the ground. The lower end of the shores require some weight, and a flat piece for a shoe secured on each, if the ground is soft. On the upper end of each shore there should be a cleat on the fore side and after side, for securing the lashing to the bulwark. For small vessels, two shores on each side would be sufficient ; one might be under the fore, and one under the main channel. The preparation of shores will be found to be a very useful one ; many vessels fall over on the water leaving them, and then run considerable risk of filling, or not righting again. 4O2. GETTING AGBOUND. If a vessel gets aground (the weather being moderate), first get over the spare topmasts on one side, and the jib-boom on the other, as shores abreast of the mainmast, or a little before it ; secure some weight to the heel of each ; a few shot, or a light pig of bal- last will do for that purpose, and if the ground is soft, nail on a piece of plank as a shoe. Furl sails, out all boats, down topgal- lant yards, and send topgallant masts on deck ; start water, and pump it out; lay out a bower anchor; be sure that it is so laid that the ship does not ground on it. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 221 Every officer should make himself well acquainted with the readiest mode of hanging and carrying out a bower anchor, as far as relates to the weight of those belonging to his own vessel, and the description of boats he has to use. If he cannot heave off, he must then endeavor to lighten the vessel by discharging part of the cargo. Before heaving off, an examination ought to be made, so as to ascertain, as near as possible, the extent of the injury which the vessel has received since aground, if the shore be rocky, that it may be remedied before heaving off, if possible ; if the vessel has run on with much way, it is possible that she may not float, even if she were got off. In this case the lives of the passengers and crew become the first consideration. 4O3. THE BALLAST SHIFTING AT SEA. This frequently occasions losses at sea. To prevent its occur- rence, when iron ballast is stowed, let a few oak battens be nailed from the sides athwart ships, to secure it ; or when shingle bal- hist is used, place a light flooring over it, secured by a few bat- tins athwart ships. This would most probably prevent such a calamity, which usually occurs when a vessel is struck by a heavy sea, or when hove on her beam ends, and prevents the possibility of her righting again ; when the ballast is stowed, it ought to be secured at the same time from shifting ; this is of great moment, and a few strong battens will do it. Also have shifting boards amidships, nailed to the stanchions. 4O4. VESSELS SURPRISED ON OPPOSITE TACKS. In cases of surprise and danger, from the accidental meeting of two ships on opposite tacks, in the night, it too often happens that officers are more apt to give orders to the stranger, than to rake any measure of precaution themselves ; such as hailing to put the helm up or down, and to clear them, when they may be as much in fault, and possess the same means of extricating themselves from the difficulty. In situations of this sort, it is much better that both parties should put their helms down rather than up ; the ships will approach each other for a time, but will diminish in velocity, and afterwards separate. Obstinacy, or a want of judgment in the directing parties, fre- quently leads both vpsels to bear up at the same instant ; con- THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; sequently causing immediate collision. It is a universal rule with seamen, that where there is doubt, the vessel on the lar- board tack is to bear up or to heave about, for the vessel on the starboard tack ; were this prudent regulation strictly adhered to, and never violated by the obstinacy of parties, accidents would seldom occur; but it sometimes happens that incidental circumstances induce both parties to risk "a trial of skill," by one endeavoring to w r eather the other. In these cases doubt and hesitation generally prevail, and disaster is sure to follow 405. MEETING AT SEA. Bend on the ensign and pendant, if a private ship Hoist the ensign and pendant, when sufficiently near, if the vessel you are meeting be a ship of war. In hailing, the ordinary questions commence thus ; "What ship is that?" "Whence come you?" "Where are you bound?" &c., &c. 406. A HINT ON RUNNING TOO LONG. Tessels ought not to run too long, when the sea is high and breaking, but bring-to in time, and do so by daylight if possible OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. JJ23 4O7. A HINT ON ROUNDING-TO IN A GALE. An experienced seaman remarks, that when he wished to bring-to in a hard gale, when running before a heavy sea, he always watched for a heavy sea breaking abaft the main chains, and immediately after, he eased the helm down, and rounded-to at once, being previously prepared for doing so. In managing this way, he found he could avoid shipping a sea. 408. ON MAKING YOUR PORT. Never run for your port in very heavy gales, or thick weather. Jinless sure of the ship's position. Note. There are some ports, that may be entered with safety at night by sailing vessels, but there are many more where it cannot be attempted, without great risk of getting aground, or being wrecked. I do not know anything to compensate for running that risk, except an urgent necessity ; as, when anchored, nothing can be done until morning. Lay-to in preference, and carry a light at the main-stay at night. Gales do not last long, and finer wea ther follows. While lying- to in gales, always keep the ship steering with the helm nearly "amidships," n ever let it be kept "a lee" as the ship will not be under command without steerage-way, or be safe and easv. 409. LYING OFF, AND ON, TO ENTER A PORT. I have known so many vessels wrecked while lying-to with a topsail to the mast, with their head in shore, that I recommend (if it is moderate weather), to make short tacks, under easy sail, as then the ship's place can always be kept worked up ; whereas her drift while lying-to is uncertain. Let the tacks in shore be shorter than the ones off, to give the coast a good berth. It is better to be a mile further out than to get aground. 224 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 41O. TO ANCHOR AND VEER A LONG SCOPE OF CABLE. Whenever, and wherever you anchor, veer a long scope of ca ble at once, never lay snort unless when getting underweigh, No ship ought to lay at single anchor for more than a few hours. Moor with a whole cable each way, as soon as possible. All ves- sels ought to have swivels, and moor with one, to keep a clear hawse. Bend the sheet-cable, and see the anchor clear for let ting go as soon as you have moored. In the winter, be prepared for strik- ing lower yards and topmasts, if necessary. 411. PREPARATIONS FOR GOING INTO HARBOR. The paint work outside should be scrubbed, and, if the wea- ther permit, freshen up where most wanted for instance, under the bows. The masts should be scraped and properly stayed, the tips of studding-sail booms painted, and the rigging slightly touched with blacking, when brown or worn. The good order of the ratlines should be attended to, swinging-boom ladders and pendants got ready, and all the chafing-gear taken off. The boats' sails and awnings should be clean and ready for use, the masts and oars scraped, scrubbed, or painted, as required ; the Bmokesail clean, also the wind-sails. Clean hammocks may be slung, and neatly stowed. The cables (including the sheet, if it blows hard), should be bent in plenty of time, &c. &c. The ship's company clean and in uniform the accommodation lad- der got ready, and in good order for shipping when at anchor. 412. CAUTIONS AT NIGHT (LOOKOUTS). A good lookout should be kept at night. As soon as it is dark, every vessel should carry a light under the fore-top ; this should be a rule, and not even left optional. If this light were carried in a lantern with green glass, the distinguishing light of a sailing vessel would be known. Steamers on the coast, bays, or harbors, usually carry wheel-house lights, as well as a mast- head one. The sea-going steamers mostly carry two horizontal lights they are therefore easily distinguished. Sailing vessels on the OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 225 soast ought always to have a light kept on deck (in a tub OP bucket, for shading it), ready to be shown, as steamers sometimes come up astern. A musket loaded with blank cartridge is useful as a signal to call attention, and should be kept ready at hand. A vessel on the starboard lack should show a light at the lee- cathead. A vessel on the larboard tack should show a light on the weather cathead. 413. WHEN TWO VESSELS AKE IN COLLISION. If in a tide's way, and in less than ten fathoms, the headmost one should anchor either with a stream or bower, as most con- venient. If on soundings from thirty to ten fathoms, the headmost ves- sel should drop a kedge-anchor. If vessels get foul of each other in deep water (should the weather be sufficiently moderate), get a boat ahead of the head- most and another astern of the sternmost, and two apart in op- posite ways. If a vessel anchor too close in another's hawse, the one r.ext ahead of her should send her a tow-line, with which she mignt pass a hawser on board to enable her to warp clear. 41 4. SQUALLS (CAUTION). They usually give some notice by gathering up black in the horizon. If the darkness rises up and thins away at the bottom, it will not be strong ; but if it still continues thick in the horizon, expect wind. Shorten sail before it comes. Clouds high, with hard edges, denote dry and strong winds. A large halo around the moon betokens high wind. Be guarded when clouds pass overhead the strength of the wind is then very often most felt. 415. WATER SPOUTS (CAUTION). A water-spout appears like a speaking-trumpet, with the small ends downwards. (It is said the concussion caused by firing guns is likely to disperse it.) If one should be near, and iikely THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; to break on board, clew-up and furl all (see the topsail clew-lines are afterwards belayed) batten the hatches, have scupper clear and pumps ready, and spar-deck ports out. 416. PRESSURE OF WATER AT DIFFERENT DEPTHS. If a ship has the flattest part of her bottom lying sixteen feet deep (which is often the case), the water then presses sixteen times as much upwards against this flat part, as it does upon any part of the same ship about the waters' edge ; and so on any other part, according to the depth. For example, suppose this ship to have four leaks, or plug holes of equal size, that could be driven out occasionally the first at one foot under water, th second at four feet, the third at nine feet, and the lowest at six- teen feet, in the flat part of her bilge; that hole at four feet deep would leak or let in as much water again, in the same time, as that at one foot ; and that at nine feet, three times as much ; and that at sixteen feet, four times as much, though it run into the ship upwards ; and so on in proportion to the square root of the height of the water above the leak or plug hole. Therefore leaks in ships are more or less dangerous, according to theit depth under water. Note. On first springing a leak, it will rush in faster until the water inside is as high as the place where the leak is ; and will pour in less the higher it gets inside. 417. ON STOPPING LEAKS. If we reflect on the present mode, so constantly practiced, of watering, by means of a canvass hose from the shore, through the salt-water into the boat, we can have little doubt of the reten- tive power of canvass. When it can be at all ascertained where a leak is situated (provided it be not too near the keel, or too much in the run), if it be in any part where you can bring a sail in contact with it, so as to cover it, remember that a canvass hose, when once saturated, becomes tolerably water-tight. If part of a sail of No. 1 canvass be doubled and brought by ropes to cover the leak, though it may not stop it, there can be no doubt it will materially assist in reducing it. This canvass wmst be well and strongly roped and stitcher? OR YOUN<5 SAILORS' ASSISTANT. together, and it had better not be too large ; the smaller it is, (provided the purpose be answered), the better ; as it will be less likely to be torn away. In placing it, the rope ought to be out- wards. This double canvass may be placed in its position by ropes under the keel or out of the hawse-hole. A sail might be used for this purpose. 418. EXAMINATION OF CHAIN CABLES. The cables must be got on deck, pins and bolts driven out of the shackles, and well cleaned and white leaded ; every link sounded with a hammer by the armorer, and some of the lengths transposed. Splicing pieces and spare shackles should be re- membered at the same time, and treated in the same way. Note. Wooden pins are frequently used in connecting the shackles, not being liable to rust, and can always be taken out easy. Hickcry is the best wood to make them of. 419. MINUTE GUNS. If more than one ship be present, minute guns are not usually fired by all at the same time, as in a common salute, but one ship follows another, taking up the firing in succession. The interval between the firing of each two guns must of course be determined by the number of guns to be fired, and the time through which they are to be prolonged a point which is optional, and sometimes extended through the day. 228 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 420. HOISTING ON BOARD MONEY OR PLATE. In hoisting on board money, plate, or other valuables, a buoy and buoy-rope, corresponding to the depth of water, ought always to be attached thereto, that in case of anything giving way, or the money or plate going to the bottom, there may be a ready means of recovery at hand. For boxes of treasure, strong nets, hi place of slings, are most useful and 'most safe. Note. Money nets are made like a common wad-net, except- ing that the meshes are made smaller and the stuff larger, say of a two-inch rope. PART VIII. 421. STOWING HAMMOCKS. Nothing adds more to the smart and favorable appearance of a vessel of war than a neat stowage of hammocks. The superin- tendants of this necessary duty are often at fault, forgetting that negligence in the performance of this service is seldom permitted to pass unnoticed. In the stowage of hammocks, the officer should stand on the opposite side of the deck, a position which will enable him to preserve a symmetrical line, and guide and direct the stower in nis progress fore and aft the netting ; they are also enjoined to be careful that the hammocks of the men be properly lashed up. Defaulters in this particular should be reported to the First Lieu- tenant. Seven turns at equal distances, is the required number of turns with a hammock-lashing. Note. In piping-down hammocks, the officers are cautioned not to permit the men to throw them on the deck. I. \BHING UP HAMJHOCKS 230 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; 422. COCKBILLING YARDS (Mourning). The most appropriate time for cockbilling yards seems to be daylight, and dark the most proper time for squaring them again ; the day then looks as if it were issued in and closed with mourn Ing. At 8, or the hour of hoisting the colors half-mast, sway up the top-gallant yards, slip the lizard, parrel the yards, and cockhill them with the others previously reversed. To allow the lower yards to top up properly, the trusses must be slacked ; and if the topsail sheets are of chain and go with a whip, one of them must be unshackled from the clew, and to as- sist the lift in topping, a burton is required. To allow the topsail yards to top up properly, they must be hoisted two feet or so off the caps, the parrels and braces must be slacked, and paunch mats taken out ; if there are jaws on, slack the jaw-rope. Trysail and spanker gaff should be lowered well down, and swinging booms dropped into the water. The way of topping the yards ought to be governed by the side on which the top-gallant yards are sent up : for instance, if the main-top-gallant yard be sent up on the starboard side, the main and main-topsail yards should be topped to port. The squaring them, when topped, should be done with reference to lower yards ; which, in the first place, are topped as high as the top rims will allow ; then being squared by the braces, the top sail and top-gallant yards have only to be parallel. 423. DRESSING SHIP WITH FLAGS. Though in some particulars the following remarks on dressing vnth flags refer peculiarly to ships in general, they are applicable to all classes of vessels ; so much so indeed, that but little varia- tion will be found necessary in applying them to line-of-battle ships, and so on down to a schooner. One mode of dressing a ship with flags is to make an arch of them from the flying-jib-boom to the spanker-boom-end ; another is to trice the flags up by the signal halliards, stopping them out to the yard-arms : but the best way, perhaps, is to combine these two modes, if there be flags enough. Hoisted to the trucks ought to be the ensign, jack, or the flags of the nation in whose port the ship is lying, or whom it is wished particularly *.o honor ; and to give these room to display themselves, the rest of the flags should only be triced as high as the top-gallant mast-head. If it be determined to combine the two modes of dressing, as mentioned above, that is, with up and down flags, as well aa OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 31 with an arch, it will prevent confusion and superabundance, and produce an equally good effect to have up and down flags at the main only ; and to hoist them, whips or halliards should be placed for the purpose, through the top-gallant studding-sail hal- liard blocks, and taken outside the brace blocks. The flying-jib halliards will hoist the foremost part of the arch, viz. : that which extends from the flying-boom-end to the fore-top-gallant mast-head. To the mizen- top-gallant mast-head it must be hoisted by a whip placed for the purpose, and hauled out to the gaff-end by a whip. From the gaff-end the flags composing the arch drop to the water, being stopped out to the boom-end, and distended under it, as well as under the flying-boom, by small hand-leads : there ought also to be downhauls on the arch ; also whips with down- hauls between top-gallant mast-heads. Care and taste are ne- cessary in sorting and placing the flags. The ensigns should be in corresponding places for instance at the lower yard-arms. The square flags should all be together ; also cornets, pendants, &c., or else a square flag and cornet alternately, and so on. Bad feeling is sometimes occasioned, when foreign ships-of-war are assembled, by placing national colors injudiciously, in dress- ing ship. This ought to be studiously avoided. This fact has uiven rise to the practice, on " gala days," of hoisting nothing but the national flags at each mast-head, or, if in honor of another ration, the flag of that nation at the fore. One principal beauty, however, of the manoeuvre in question, 1,3 to have everything so prepared and foreseen, that immediately the yards are crossed, and decently squared, and the mast-head flags broke, all the others may be triced up so as to find their places readily and without confusion, hands previously prepared, Uying-out together at the same time to each yard-arm, stopping the up and down flag-halliards there : and then at the "word," laying-in together. At sunset, the best way, perhaps, is to haul the flags down ;ust before sending down the top-gallant yards. 424. KEEPING THE COPPER CLEAN. The good or bad condition of the copper on a ship's bottom above the water line, has a wonderful effect upon her appearance. If daubed over with blacking, or otherwise neglected, when pos- sible to attend to it, a slovenly appearance is communicated to the outside look which a ship of war ought to be exempt frorr . One way of managing is to scrub off all spots, and rub it oc- casionally with an oily cloth, when there is leisure ; and if this is constantly attended to, perhaps it is the best and simplest plan, although I have heard yachts find river mud better. 18 232 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Another way is to paint it with red ochre and oil, mixed to tht color of new copper. When well and effectually done, this will preserve a good appearance for a long time ; but the finest and calmest weather must he taken advantage of to lay it on, as the least ripple will wash all off in its way when wet. To clean the copper under the water line, seize on to a handy spar of sufficient length, half-a-dozen strong, coarse deck clamps, and apply them against the ship's bottom from a stage, if it can DC got ; if not, from the largest boat, previously keeling the ship, by running the guns in on one side, and out on the other. The copper of a small vessel may be completely cleaned in this way. If the copper on the trysail mast, and fore and main-masts of brigs and schooners be attended to and kept clean, it tends very much to the appearance of the vessel. The most common obsta- cle to this is grease, which generates verdigris excessively, but may be easily prevented by attention. 425. FURLING FROM A BOWLINE. The stress of the work here being on the bunt-lines and cle\v ropes, but few hands are required on the topsail clew-lines. WORDS OF COMMAND. Call "All hands furl sails." Man the bunt-lines and clew-lines (including the clew-ropers and head downhauls). "Aloft, top-men ; " stand by to furl sails. " Aloft, lower yard-men ; " haul taut shorten sail lay-out. Furl-away, gather up, and pass the gaskets ; lay in off the yards ; stand by the booms. Down booms rig them out to the mark ; square the heels. Square yards, stopping up gear at the same time. When the yards are squared by the braces, the boatswain ought to hurry ahead, to square them by the lifts. At the same time haul taut the bow-lines, jib and staysail-hal- liards, and see all the clew-lines close up. When the yards are squared by the lifts, haul taut topsail and top-gallant sheets, and reef-tackles, as well as all other slack ropes, (heels of the studding-sail square, &c. &c.) Note. The topsail and top-gallant sheets and reef-tackles ought not previously to be hauled taut, because they then inter fere with squaring the yards by the lifts. Remarks. The tacks and sheets are generally kept unrove in harbor, and the courses hauled up by the clew-ropes, one bunt- OR YOUJNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 233 line and leech-line of a side ; the topsails by the bunt-lines only, led through a lizard at the clews, or clew jiggers. The hauling down of the headsails is much facilitated by having the halliards racked and overhauled at the mast-head, and a hand there ready to cut the racking, when the word is given to shorten sail. 426. HIGH AND LOW BUNTS. Low, or rolling bunts, require bunt-gaskets, and are tedious in stowing and securing snug high, or French bunts, require no gaskets, but secure to the topsail-tye by a becket and stopped. Being larger, and more open abaft, the slack sail is more easily stowed in them than in low bunts ; neither is any time or labor lost about bunt-gaskets, a circumstance not to be overlooked, in competing with other vessels. The look is a matter of taste ; in general, however, topsail yards are thought neatest, with first or second-reefed earings hauled partly out, but neither reef-points tied, nor bun-t-gaskets on ; the bunt described is a French bunt, being secured to the tye by a midship-becket in the first reef band, and the sail furleJ in the skin of the first reef and back-cloths. Note. The proper place for the furling-glutt, is two-thirds of the depth of first reef. 427. TO CLEAR MAST-HEADS. Clear mast-heads form a distinguishing mark of a ship-of-war. To make them so, the eyes of the rigging ought to be carefully placed, boused down a-midships by the mast, and beat down at the mast-head with a commander, and the shrouds set up in their places with care. The eyes of the stays, and the slings of the lower yards, ought also to be sent down over all, and nothing more should be on the lower mast-heads, observable to the eye. Over topmast-heads the ginn-blocks ought to go first, with a span lashing to the pendants, so as to take them close up to the trestle-trees; rigging and stays, same as lower mast-heads standing parts of ties, through a score in the heel of topgallant- mast, inside of the trestle-trees, and taken abaft the mast-head and lashed together close down on top of the stays. It would be well to put a quarter-seizing on each side, around both stay and tye. This does away with the not uncommon, but slovenly practice, of hitching the standing part of the topsail-tye over the 234 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; rigging, and expending the end, by heaping it up with five 01 BIX turns half-way to the cap. Opinions are divided as to whether mast-heada painted white, or black, look the best. This is a matter of taste ; but it is a matter of certainty, that black shades and conceals, while white tends to display, what a seaman is proud of, the neatness and good order of his rigging, which should not be concealed by a white canvass mast-coat. The neatest mast-heads I ever saw were painted white, with the upper half of the top-rims and lower-half of the caps of the same color; the lower half of the top rims, and the upper half of the caps, being black; thus the large space of white was terminated and relieved above and below, by a neat, small, but distinct line of black. The topmast cross-trees, topmast-heads, and lower halves of topmast-caps were also white ; upper half of caps black. Topmasts scraped close up to the cross-trees, the eyes of the top- gallant and royal rigging covered with canvass, in place of ser- vice, and painted black no paint above topmast-head caps, nor outside of the bowsprit-cap. With clear mast-heads, ought to be combined neat tops, wherein the ropes are flemished, and kept low and snug. 428. PLACING BELAYING-CLEATS IN TOPS. If the belaying-cleats for studding-sail tacks and halliards, top- gallant and royal lifts, and royal sheets, are placed on the cross- pieces, or carlines of tops, and not on the shrouds or mast-heads, the rigging there will look much neater. 429. MAKING SWABS. Old rope, called junk, is unlaid into yarns. Make a grommet with a good strand ; then take some of the yarns of the junk, take the twist or lay well out, and middle them in the grommet, and continue to fill up (to the size required), close to the grom- met ; clap on a good seizing of spun-yarn, and then, if wished, snake it ; sometimes the handle, or grommet, is made by splicing both ends together, the splice laying in the head of the swab. In making the grommet, the ends of the strands should not be cut off, but seized-in with the rest of the swab. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 235 43O. STOWAGE OF SWABS. Swabs in the head are an eye-sore ; attention should be direct ed to the contrivance of some other stow-hole for them, to which they should be rigorously confined, except when in use. 431. JUNK. Junk is supplied for the purpose of working up into various uses such as into swabs, spun-yarn, knittle-stuff, lacings, seiz- ings, earings, gaskets, &c., &c., all of which the supply in proper kind is generally inadequate. Good junk is got out of such materials as condemned cables they having been necessa- rily made of the best stuff, and condemned before being much injured. Old messengers, old rigging, &c., make bad junk, not being condemned generally until much worn. Of the worst junk swabs and spun-yam should be made ; of the best, knittle and seizing-stuff, lacings, earings, &c. The seiz- ing-stuff is intended for blocks, ratlines, &c. ; the knittle stuff for making mats, as well as lacings and earings, for studding-sails, boats' sails, &c., and the spun-yarn for fitting and refitting. A sur- plus stock of all these ought constantly to be at hand, in siore, for the purpose of refitting or replacing anything that may hap- pen to be carried away, without loss of time. In order to effect this, the watch on deck, or part of them, ought to be constantly at work about the junk, when circumstances permit, drawing, knotting, and balling of yarns, and assisting the ropemaker in laving up the above mentioned small stuff, either till the junk is exhausted, or till there is an ample stock on hand. Large junk, such as lengths of cables, should be unlaid before being put below, that it may admit of being snugly stowed 432. MAKING MATS, AND CHAFING GEAR. The oreadth of mats for lanyards of rigging, is determined by the size of the dead-eye, which the mat ought nearly to cover ; the length by the distance from the upper to the lower dead-eye. For lacing, small beckets should be worked in each corner and side. The mats on the foremost swifters of the lower rigging and backstays, should be longer than the others, on account of the foot and clew of the courses, when reefed and hauled aft, grinding against them high up ; or shifting mats for that especial 236 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR , purpose should be kept, to put on at sea and take off in harbor. Thrum-mats are required for the paunch of lower topsail and topgallant yards, to prevent chafing. Those that follow are only required at sea ; so that for neatness and economy, they may al- ways be taken oil when going into harbor. To take the chafe off the rigging, when the lower yards are braced up, a large square hanging mat is required, thrummed on each side of the futtock-shrouds. This has a lanyard in each corner, and is clapped on thereby, with the upper half on the foremost futtock-shrouds, the lower half on the foremost swifters ; the middle part being in a line with the catharpens. On each side of the bunts of the courses, before all, a thrum- mat is requisite, to prevent the head of the sail chafing against the stay where they come in contact, when the yards are braced up. A breeches-mat is also required on the stay itself, for the same purpose. Small, square, neat mats, in the way of leech-lines, on each side, are also necessary, to prevent chafing. To prevent the topsail yards, when braced up, from chafing the foremost shrouds of the topmast rigging, a quarter mat abaf . the yards on each side, is required. A thrum-mat is necessary on the horn of each foremast crose- tree, to prevent their wearing holes in the topgallant sails. For the backstays, in the wake of the lower yards, when braced up, mats or platting, or some such substitute, is necessary as a protection. Merchant vessels use Scotsmen [slips of wood so called] ; but for ships of war, I think leather, snugly stitched an 3 kept on in harbor, as well as at sea, is the best. In a brig, the boom-mainsail will sometimes have a hole fretted in it, by chafing against the quarter boat's stanchions, or the be- laying cleats there ; these ought therefore to be protected by mats. 433. GASKETS. There is a great risk of gaskets marking and spoiling the looks of the sails, if not thoroughly dried before being used. The number of sea-gaskets must depend upon the size of the ship ; the smallest, however, such as a schooner 01 brig, requiring four for each side of lower yards, and the same for topsail yards. For topgallant and royal yards, half the number is enough ; for boom mainsail, six ; for jib and flying-jib, five each. Harbor-gaskets answer uest with one end tapered and the other woiked with an eye. By reeving and unreeving the taper- ed end through the eye, and round the jackstay, they are then easily put on or taken off. Their length ought to be sufficient for a round turn round the sail and vard, with enough of end tr OR YOQNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 237 lack in and secure between the sail and round turn abaft, or rather, on upper quarter abaft. Their breadth is a matter of fancy, but broad ones are generally preferred. They should be carefully placed upon the yards, as nearly as possible, at equal distances. Note. If any long gaskets are used, half the number is sufficient. 434. SCRAPING AND GREASING MASTS. When the blacking of the rigging is dry, the masts ought to be scraped and cleaned, then greased. For the men to stand upon when scraping the lower masts, rig triangles of capstan bars, with whips to the mast-heads ; for hoisting and lowering, with the topmasts, handspikes answer instead of capstan bars, and the royal and topgallant masts may be managed from a bow- line in the end of a girt-line, or a span from shroud to shroud. To prevent spotting the deck, the deck-cloths ought to be spread, and some hands kept constantly sweeping up the shavings. The topgallant and royal yard-arms should not be neglected- The studding-sail booms, except when new, ought to have the least possible shaving taken off them by a carpenter, and then varnished. This does not injure them more than scraping, and keeps them infinitely smoother. Before laying on the grease, the captains of the tops, &c., should report that everything is scraped and ready, and the boatswain should examine. Note. It is customary in some ships first to scrape masts, 'hen tar down the rigging, and lastly paint; but there is objec- tions to this, as the men are liable to daub the masts when tar- jing down, and they would have to be done over again. Studding-sail booms should never be greased, as they are liable to daub the sail. 435. MANNING YARDS. If previously aware that the yards are to be manned in the course of the day, clap on life-lines instantly ; the topgallant and royal yards are crossed in the morning, the hands laying out and in together ; then square yards. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Fewer men being required for manning yards than furling sails, those required for the former may be easily sized and se- lected from among the latter, keeping them always on their re- spective yards the tallest outside. The yard-arm men extend their outside arms straight, holding on by the studding-sail halliards, whilst they clap their inner arms over the life-lines, holding it fast under the arm-pit ; the next man in the same way extends his outer arm, and grapples the shoulder of the yard-arm man ; then passes his inner arm over the life-line, clasping it under his arm-pit, and so on to the bunt. The appearance of the boat, at whatever distance it may be, is the customary signal for manning yards ; yet it would be at times a preferable rule to endeavor to judge of the distance, and act so that the men may not be more than ten minutes or a quarter of an hour aloft. The men on the yards ought to face the boat ; that is, when the boat is abaft the beam, they ought to face aft ; when before the beam, forward : but in a ship, when the commodore* ascend') the side, the hand on the cross-jack and mizen- topsail yards ought to face forward all others as before, aft. 436. MAN ROPES (SIDE). If side or man-ropes be covered with canvass or baize, the stitches should be taken through the strands of the rope, to pre- vent the covering getting out of its place, and puckering ; and to take the chafe or nip in the wake of the eye-bolt, through which they reeve, a small bit oi leather should be neatly stitch- ed on. The handsomest and most durable man-ropes are those en- tirely pointed over with neat, small line. The job is a tedious one, but worth the expense and trouble. 437.- SPARE DEAD-EYES. A good plan for spare dead-eyes of rigging is to have them in two pieces, and with small bolts fixing them together, so that in the event of carrying one away, it can be easily replaced, with- out having to take chain, plate and all to a smiths' shop. * Or the personage whom it is intended to honor. OR YOUJNtt SAlLORb- ASSISTANT. 239 438. HIDE ROPE. Where there is much and continued friction, or a short nip, hide rope is found to have great advantage over hemp ; some say thirty per cent. Thus it is good for wheel-ropes, whip for hatchway, topsail-ties, trusses, topgallant and royal sheets and yard ropes, parrels, jib-pendants, lacings, reef-pendants and lash ing, studding-sail tacks and halliards. For preservation above deck, hide rope should have a coating of two parts of grease and one of tar ; below deck, a coat of iieats' foot oil. When not wanted, such as wheel-ropes in har- bor, it should be kept under cover. Note. Hide rope is now allowed by regulation for tailing all sheets, also for ties, truss, pendants, &c., (fee. (See rigging table.) 439. HAWSE-HOLE WINDSAIL. A windsail to carry the great draught of the hawse-holes down into the holds, &c., is a very useful thing, though not common. 440. FIGHTING LADDERS. Some ships have fighting ladders of rope always set up, ready, and the wooden ones for common use placed against them. Note. Iron Jacob's-ladders fitted amidships in hatchways are very useful in the morning when washing decks, or at quarter^ when the wooden ladders are unshipped. 441. HAWSE BUCKLERS. Bucklers are of two sorts ; half-bucklers, shipped when the cables are bent, and blind-bucklers when the/ are unbent. The object of the first is to prevent shipping water through the hawse- holes, while the cables are bent, and are put on, after filling with shakings the hawse-hole through which the cable runs they are secured by upright, iron bars, slipping on and off upor grooves above and below. 240 T]TE KEDGE-ANCHOR ; Blind-buckleis are put on after a plug (called hawse-plug, of the size of the hawse-hole) has been thrust in. They are secured the same way as the half-bucklers. When the cables are ordered to be clear for running, the half- bucklers should be unshipped. Note. Half-bucklers are made with a score to fit the cable. 442. MAKING FAST A WARP TO A VESSEL. The best place for making a warp fast to, is the bitts, after pass- ing through the spare hawse-hole : there it will not interfere with the side or paint work ; is perfectly clear, quite secure, and ready to let go in an instant. If made fast to the cables, which is next best, it is more difficult to let go. 443. FITTING QUARTER BOATS' GRIPES, Boats' gripes are made with spun-yarn or small rope, as a s ,vord-mat : one end is secured round the davit-head, the other, viien the boat is up, passed under her bottom, and secured in the chains with a lashing. 444. FITTING GIGS' SLINGS. Gigs' slings are made as sword mats. When sufficient is made t D take the boat's bottom and clear the gunwales, the spun-yarn, or rope between each part, is fitted as a stopper or selvagee, par- celed and served over, and a thimble seized in the bight, which the tackles hook to. The stretches, made of wood, are put be- tween both parts of the slings, long enough to keep them two or three inches off the gunwale. For the span, measure the length from the after ring-bolts to- the slings ; when in their place, leave six inches for splicing, and cut the rope ; measure from the after-slings to the fore ones, leaving about six inches and cut ; measure from the fore-slings to the ring-bolt in the stern and cut ; splice a hook and thimble in the ends, the other ends splice together, forming two cut splices, large enough to go over the thimbles in the slings, and seize them in their place. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. Note. Some prefer artificial eyes worked in trie ends of the slings, to go over the end of the stretcher ; this is not so safe 445. SCRUBBING A BOAT'S BOTTOM, ON LEAVING HARBOR. It frequently happens in preparing for sea, a large boat's Dot- torn, such as a launch, or any other boom boat, requires cleaning, and there happens to be no place at hand to haul her up on shore, in preference to hoisting her up and doing it aboard, and causing a great muss on deck ; hoist her out of the water by the cat, and another tackle to the bowsprit, and scrub her bottom from another boat (or catamaran). 446. CARRYING LIGHT BOATS ON LAND. The best way to cary a boat, is to upset her, and let the men, with their jackets on their shoulders, (or some such protection against the sharp pressure of the gunwale,) stand under and take the gunwales on each side on their shoulders ; some Lands may also be advantageously placed in amidships undei the thwarts, THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 447. MISCELLANEOUS NOTES ON WORKING BOATS. If a boat be crank, or if it be wished in working to windward to accelerate speed, all hands should sit down in the bottom of the boat. If in haste, working to windward, pull the weather oars. A boat with only one sail, such as a lug, should never attempt beating to windward, except when necessary to give the crew a spell. Let no one ever sit on the gunwale, but accustom the crew to sit in their places, and to make and shorten sail without stirring from their seats. Besides the due execution of this mauoeuvre, the safety of the boat is much implicated in the degree of atten- tion paid to this rule. In taking in a lug sail, lower the halliards and haul down on the weather-leach. Note. Keep boats out of the water as much as possible OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 243 448. DUTIES OF BOATS' CREWS. A SHIP OF WAR'S LAUNCH. Nothing sooner indicates the order and discipline ol a vessel af war, than the clean state and efficient condition of the boats, together with the personal appearance of their crews. In this par- ticular, sufficient care is not always observed in the service ; in well regulated ships, the coxswains are compelled to report to the senior lieutenant the state of their respective boats, and in the morning to ascertain from the officer of the boat, the man- ner he may require the crews to be dressed for the day &c, ; &c. 449. BOATS GOING ON DISTANT SEKVICE. Memoranda of articles required for distant service viz. : spy- glass, compass, pencil and paper, chart, watch, lead and line, tinder-box, grapnel and rope, stern-fast, hammer, nails, spike for guns, spare rope, (size of boat's gear,) spare tiller, spare oars, blue- lights, lanterns and candles, casks or kegs for water, arm-chest, flints, turn-screw, towing-nets, pea-coats, muffling for oars, fish- 244 THE KEDGE-ANCHOK; ing-lines, iron pot, fuel, each man a knife, an axe, a maul, a crow bar, needles, twine, colors, rations for the boat's crew at discretion. 45O. BOATS UNDER SAIL. A SHIP OF WAR'S CUTTER. Care should be taken that the halliards be coiled ap clear for running, that the sheets be not belayed, and that the crew, in shortening sail to a squall, do not shift their seats, or, as is too common a custom, stand upon the thwarts to gather in the shak- ing sail ; in lowering a lug, or lateen sail, haul down alone on the luff, (the fore-leech ;) the after one better be left untouched. Coxswains should also be cautioned of the danger of letting go the helm. This is often inadvertently done wrong some- times to secure the heel of the bumkin, or to get a pull of the main or mizen-sheet. By this thoughtless practice, boats are liable to fly up in the wind, the sails to be taken aback, be dim- cult to lower, and eventually to cant over and capsize to wind- ward. 451. GIVING A ROPE TO A BOAT. When a boat from a lee-tide, or running-sea, requires from the ship the aid of a rope, care' must be taken that the tow-line be passed as far forward as possible. The position of the fore-chan- OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 245 nels is too far aft, and causes too short a scope. The tow-line should be passed from the cat-head, with a slip-rope to the crown of the spare or sheet-anchor, which, if slacked when the bowman secures the tow-line, the boat will ride with a good scope, and with comparative ease. Caution. The tow-line should never be made fast to the ring in the bow of the boat ; it should be passed through the ring by way of a fair-leader, and eventually secured to the bottom of the boat or thwart. Mooring boats. Boats are best moored at the guess-swarp- boom. In this position they ride under the eye of the officer of the deck, and are less liable to be damaged than when secured alongside, or moored astern. Boat-keepers, unless especially called to assist in the execution of urgent or heavy service, should never be permitted to leave their boats. 452. CROSSING A BAR WITH SURF, IN BOATS As a boat will not rise over surf as over an unbroken wave, but on the contrary, the surf boils over and into the boat, the less surface there is presented, and the higher it is out of the water, the better. For this reason a boat ought to be kept stem on, or right before it, when the heaviest waves approach, waiting till they are past, to pursue her way edgeways across the bar Stem on is the safest, the smallest surface and the strongest and highest part of the boat being in that way presented to the surf, while the rudder and oars possess sufficient power to main- tain the position assumed. Right before it has the disadvantage of lowness of stern, which makes pooping more likely than tak- ing water over the bows protracted exposure to the wave, (for you must go along with it,) and the tendency to gripe and broach-to, which from the rudder being lifted and left out of the water, and rendered useless as soon as the broken wave passes it, is often irresistible and fatal, and can only be counteracted by the skill and steadiness of the crew, in steering the boat by their oars until the rudder ccmes again into play. If a boat broaches- to in these circumstances, she will most likely fill, and instantly upset, in which case, I believe the best plan is to cling to the boat (01 some of her gear), and endeavor to right her again, if oossible. 19 246 TI1< KEDGE- ANCHOR; 453. HAULING UP BOATS. A gig's crew may haul up their boat, but for all other boats, it requires at least double the number of their crews, assisted oy rollers and tackles. A line-of-battle-ship's launch may be hauled up by five-and- forty hands, in the following manner : run her bow on to the beach, and let a few hands on each quarter keep her in that position, by setting their oars against the ground ; next sweep her with a hawser, and guy it up at the stern to a proper height by several turns of the painter; to this hawser hook on the double block of a long tackle, the other end, or single block being overhauled to a proper length, and made fast as most convenient. Pass the bight of another hawser round the stern post, and having guyed it up on each side to the main thwart, there hook on, on each side, a quarter tackle also, overhauled to a proper length, and hooked on at the other end, as most convenient ; man these with the remaining hands : then having placed rollers in succession to take the boat's fore-foot and keel, proceed to haul away. When up, the loose thwarts set against the ground and wash streak will keep her upright. Smaller boats do not require quarter tackles ; a few hands on the quarters to keep them up- right, answer the purpose. Heavy boats especially should not be turned bottom up, it strains them so much. The loose thwarts might be placed for the rollers to roll on, if the ground is soft. 454. LOWERING BOATS. On lowering boats from the quarter or stern, care must be taken that the moment the boat touches the water, the after tackles be quickly unhooked from the slings or ring bolts. If in a tide's way the precaution be not observed, the probability is, the boat will immediately fill, and the men in the boat be exposed to imminent peril. 455. TURNING UP THE HANDS. In calling up the hands, or calling the crew to the performance of their duties, the boatswain too often indulges in piercing pipes, and drawling tones of superfluous length. Boatswains have a singular propensity to demonstrate the soundness of their lungs, by an endless protraction of a note on their piercing pipes. They should not be so fond of supplying the place of sea birds. This OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 247 is not the worst feature in their taste ; for when at last they utter the required summons, they give it forth in tones so drawl- ing, that the first words are often forgotten before the last are out Note. A-l I h-a-n-d-s a-b-o-u-t - s-h-i-p. This lengthy sum mons, and a longer-winded whistle, and each pipe and phrase three times repeated by the boatswain and his mates, the ship may be ashore before the leader of the band is convinced how dearly he has paid for his whistle. 456. INSPECTION OF RIGGING MORNING AND EVENING. In the morning the boatswain will be required to inspect as early as possible the state and condition of the standing and run- ning rigging, and to report the result of his examination to the officer of the morning watch. He should be particularly careful to see that the ratlines of the rigging are properly secure ; that the topsail sheet service is not chafed, and that all the quarter and paunch mats are properly placed. Evening-. The boatswain should inspect at evening quarters all the rigging, stoppers and necessary "gear required upon the occasion of clearing for action ; so that in the event of being surprised by an enemy at night, such gear may be placed at hand for immediate use. He should also see that the toggles fitted to the lower and topsail braces, be securely seized to their respective parts. 45 7. INSPECTION OF STOWED ANCHORS (AT SEA) In boisterous weather, and particularly if the ship be laboring or lurching heavily, the boatswain should inspect the several anchors, and see that they are securely stowed. In small vessels, where anchors, in a heavy sea, are constantly buried under water, it is necessary to take the precaution of passing preventer stocks and shank lashings. The quarter boats should also be inspected, and the boatswain should report to the officer of the watch the result of such inspection. 248 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 458. INSPECTION OF BOATS (AT SEA). Every evening after sunset, the boatswain will be required to inspect the boats on the booms, to see that they be perfectly clear, and that their sling-spans be severally hooked for hoisting out. In tropical climates it is strongly recommended to uncover the boats after the sun has set, in order that they may benefit by the dew and air. Each cover should be made up and placed in the bow of the boat. 459. GAMMONING THE BOWSPRIT The better way to gammon the bowsprit in a large ship, is to get a caulker's stage under the bows, fore and aft, under the bowsprit ; secure one end snug to the stern, then get a stout tackle from the extreme end of the bowsprit ; overhaul down and sling the outer end of the stage ; hook on your tackle to the slings, lead your fall down on the stage ; send the men down, and bouse well taut, so as to get the weight of the stage as much as possi- ble on the bowsprit. Now your stage being secured, you can proceed to gammon your bowsprit. Get two stout luff-tackles on the stage and voil block ; then get a span around the inner end of the stage to hook your voil block to ; having your voil hooked, clinch your gammoning round your bowsprit with a running clinch or a running eye; jam your turn well round the bowsprit, then reeve down through the gam- moning hole up over the bowsprit, then pass your end down through the scuttle on to the stage ; reeve it through the voil blocks on the stage ; clap on your luffs, and bouse away, leading your fall fore and aft the stage. Note. Leading your fall in this way has a tendency to lift up the inner end of the stage, and of course your pulling down, and the weight of the stage on the gammoning, must certainly bring the bowsprit snug down in its bed, and set your gammoning up very taut. Having got your first turn taut, rack it well ; pass another, and so on until you fill up your gammoning hole, jamming your last turn under all parts of the gammoning on the opposite side of the bowsprit from the way you have passed your gammoning. When you are setting up your gammoning, two men ought to attend with commanders, to beat it solid round the bowsprit. When they are setting up, some people use a great deal of tar and slush on gammoning, but the less the better. A piece of good leather under your gammoning is much better than tarred OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 249 parceling ; and when your gammoning is passed, turn your leather over aft and nail _t down to the bowsprit. Your gam- moning ought to be strapped with large strands in the room of rope, it being much softer and better to the gammoning, and all well covered to protect it from the weather. If you use parcel- ing, let it be dry and new, with a coat of tar over all when com- pleted. 46O. PRECAUTION IN REEVING RUNNING-RIGGING. In reeving running-rigging, the boatswain is recommended not to cut and reeve, but on the contrary, to reeve and cut. However correct the rigging list may appear, there will bo always found a difference of a few fathoms in rope ; and it so happens that the difference is invariably on the wrong side, the allowance being said to be shorter than the measurement per rope. Note. It were much to be desired that the running-rigging, previous to reeving, should be stretched to the capstan. The old practice of taking the end through the coil will in some measure relieve the rope of many of its kinks, but taking the mere turns out of a rope is not sufficient to facilitate its run through the blocks. Such ropes as topsail-sheets, topgallant-sheets and braces, and jib and staysail-halliards, should be all stretched before they are rove in their respective blocks. Moreover, if there be any time more than another that a vessel will require her ropes to run freely, it is upon the occasion of her first leav- ing port, with a green and undisciplined crew. 461. TOPSAIL TYES. Topsail tyes are now rove in some ships sufficiently long to send the yards down with, and when not wanted for that pur- pose, the surplus ends pertaining to the standing parts secured to the mast-head. In some ships a strop and thimble are fitted under the rigging, or a score cut in the heel of the topgallant-mast for the purpose of reeving through the standing part of the tye, which is secured breeching-fashion with two strong seizings, and then stopped down the topmast rigging. In shifting yards, this method will be found to save much time and trouble ; the surplus end will also answer to sling the top- sail-yard with, when going into action. 850 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR i 462. -PRECAUTION IN BLACKING THE RIGGING, In blacking the rigging, the first precaution that should be taken by the boatswain, is to cover with old canvass, or hammocks, the lower mast-heads, and particularly the caps. The blacking should be put on hot. Thin tar, with a certain portion of lamp- lack, hot salt-water, whisky, and a little litharge mixed together, nake an admirable mixture for blacking the rigging. It is not recommended to blacken the royal and topgallant rig- ging aloft ; this rigging may be previously blackened and triced up to dry. 463. FORE AND MAIN BUNTLINES. The buntlines of the courses are frequently found to jam aloft, and when rove on the bight, and led forward, constantly to be- come cable-laid. Buntlines will be found to lead fairer, and to haul the sails higher up, by fitting them after the following method. In the fore part of the top between the trestle-trees, cut two holes ; into these holes insert leaden pipes, backstay-fall fashion ; hook to the foremost bolt, on each side of the lower cap, a block, through which each buntline-leg is to be rove ; take each through the holes cut in the top, and pass them down before all, and tog- gle them to the foot of the sail, the hauling part to lead aft through the lubber's hole, and a block turned in at a proper dis- tance, to allow the after leg to act the part of a pendant. Through this block a whip purchase is rove ; by this method the buntlines will be always kept clear, and they will be found, on letting go the whips, to overhaul themselves. In port, when the ship is moored, the buntline-blocks, with the ropes rove, may be unhooked from the bolts in the cap, and placed in the top, imme- diately over the holes through which the foremost legs are rove in, find can be hooked in a moment, when wanted. 464. TOPGALLANT MAST ROPES. For expedition the mast-rope rove upon the bight, with lizards lakeo through the royal sheave, must be preferred to the old method of fidding masts, by the double operation of two mast ropes, namely the long and the short. If delay is desired, or in other words, people prefer going the longest way to work, the short mast-rope must be put in requisition. The mast rope, how OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 251 ever, rove upon the bight with lizards, is better calculated for harbor practice than for sea service. The mast rope which is here recommended is applicable to every purpose, may be fitted as follows : The rope is rove as usual, stopped to the topgallant mast-head, and royal sheave-hole, leaving a long end over the upper stop tc hitch to the bolt in the cap before cutting the stops. To prevent the ropes from slipping, rack both parts together above the sheave-hole in the heel of the mast. 465. FUTTOCK SHROUDS. In all vessels of war, futtock shrouds are too long. Ships whose lower yards are slung high, and braced sharply up, have their futtock shrouds considerably shorter than the established length. 466. TOPS AND HALF TOPS. Many seamen affect to disapprove of half tops, asserting that two halves can never be so well secured as the whole. This is mere prejudice ; for practical purposes a half top must be always preferred, especially in large ships. 467. STRIKING OR HOUSING TOPMASTS. The absence of forethought, or a little practical precaution on the part of the boatswain and petty officers, is sometimes the cause of this operation being one of no little labor. When the hands are turned up, strike topmasts. The lanyards of the after rigging, back-stays and topmast-rigging should be severally slack- ed, whilst the jib-stay, fore-topmast-staysail-halliards, topsail-hal- liards, topsail lifts, reef-tackles and topgallant-sheets ought to DR well overhauled. Steady hands should be placed to attend the spring and standing-stays. When blowing hard, head-to-wind, topmasts constantly bend in the cap, from the circumstance of letting go and overhauling too much of the stays. Should there be any unusual strain on the top-tackle-pendants, it is well to " stand-fast" the falls for a few seconds, in order that the people aloft may examine the vicinity of the trestle-trees ; and the mast may produce sufficient strain to cany away the 252 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; top-ttxkle-falls, if not the pendants. This precaution is mosl particularly directed during periods of striking topmasts in the dark. When the masts are struck, they should be kept on the right slue, and their heels securely lashed, in the event of the ship parting, or it becomes necessary to set close-reefed-topsails, with the mast down. The practice of sheep-shanking back-stays is not recommended ; the back-stays may be set up through the medium of good luff-tackles, and by such means the mast may be rendered sufficiently secure to support the strain of a close-reefed-topsail. 468. SWAYING UP TOPMASTS. In performing this heavy operation, every care should be taken to overhaul well, and to see that such of the standing and run- ning-rigging are perfectly clear, which are calculated to impede the ascent of the masts. The topsail-lifts, topsail-tyes. reef-tackles, jib and staysail-hal- liards should be well overhauled below and aloft, and the lan- yards of the topmast-rigging and back-stays be got ready for set- ting up, the moment the mast is ridded and stayed. The fore- castle men should have luffs led along the bowsprit, and tackles up and down the foremast ready for staying the fore and main- topmasts. No topmast should be ndded by a single top-tackle- pendant. It is true that small vessels are not allowed a second pendant, but such ships should reeve a hawser through the dead sheave for the purpose of acting the part of a preventer, in the event of the top-tackle-fall parting. The same precaution should be taken with respect to the position of the cross-trees overhead as has been already mentioned under the head of rigging top- masts. z. Such ships should be prepared with stoppers, with two tails and a toggle, so as to clap on the top-tackle pendants about a foot abaft, and under the top-block hooked to the cap. Topmasts ascend comparatively easy until the fid-hole comes within six inches of the trestle-trees ; then a heavy strain is Drought upon the pendants, particularly upon the falls. 469. UNMOORING. It frequently occurs in unmooring vessels of war that the veering-cable is not sufficiently veered. In weighing the firs* OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 253 anchor, a considerable strain has been felt at the capstan, in con- sequence of the ship not being permitted to bring the cable up and down. It is recommended to veer three or four fathoms al- ter the cable is said to be up and down. This can do no harm , it will put the whole strain of the ship on the anchor ; that is, in weighing, and thereby facilitate tripping it. 470. REEF LINES TO THE TOPSAILS. Few ships in the service are fitted with these lines. In some ships they are attached. In reefing topsails, when blowing fresh and particularly when steering a course, or going large, reef- lines assist materially to spill the sail and enable the men on the yards to get hold of the points, which are difficult to reach when the canvass is bellying to the breeze. Reef-lines are thus fitted : Take a piece of small rope, splice one end into an eyelet-hole in the head of the sail, seize it around the neck of one of the first reef-points, on the foreside of the sail, in a straight line with the eyelet-hole, leaving enough slack to prevent the sail girting ; then seize it under to the second, then the third reef ; splice an eye in the end and seize it to the neck of a close-reef point. In large ships there should be three reef- lines on each yard-arm ; in small vessels two will be sufficient. 471. REEFING COURSES. To execute this service with security as well as with celerity, the reef-earings should be formed of rope sufficiently strong to bear being boused out by the boom-jiggers ; by this method the inner turns of small rope may be passed with facility. The outer earing should be led through a block or cheek, fit- ted for the purpose ; this earing, it must be remembered, is not to be considered as a substitute for the reef-pendant; it should also be hooked and hauled out by a separate tackle. It is the general custom now, to fit all reef-earings on the bight, and on both ends. 254 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 472. TOPGALLANT-MASTS STliUCK "When topgallant-masts are struck, care should be taken that a, small mat be placed between the topmast and the heel of the topgallant-mast ; proper heel lashings should also be fitted for the purpose of securing the latter. 473. HAILING ALOFT. Hailing aloft, in well regulated ships, is much repressed by the boatswain ; for bluster is a general indication of but little work, or the truth of the adage, " All noise and no work" 474. PROPORTIONS FOR CABLES (Hemp). The sheet and bower-cable, one inch in circumference for every two feet of beam. The stream-cable and messenger, two- thirds of the sheet or bower chain-cables, which are used for bowers ; an allowance is made of one eighth of an inch for the diameter of the wire of the links, for every inch of circumference of the hemp-cables. The same rule applies in all cases where iron rigging is substituted for hemp. Note. Cable-yarns are spun two-fifths longer than the cable for which they are intended. The yarns for one hundred and twenty fathoms of cable, must be two hundred fathoms long ; for a shroud-laid rope the yarns are one-third longer i. e., ninety for sixty fathoms. (See table of cables.) t 5. PROPORTIONS FOR ANCHORS. For the sheet and bower-anchors, take two-thirds the numbei of feet which the ship draws with all her stores, &c., on board, and add it to the breadth of beam, allowing one hundred-weight for every foot. The stream-anchor one third of the sheet or bower. For ships smaller than frigates, an allowance of five hundred weight for every hundred tons burthen, should be made for sheet and bower-anchors. Representation of a Temporary Rudder. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. gob In stocking an anchor, add together the lengtl of the shank, and half the round of the ring, for the length of the stock. The stock is as many inches in thickness in the middle, as the shank is long in feet, and is tapered to half the size at the end. In puddening an anchor ring, cut the lengths three times the round of the ring. Note. This anchor is for hemp-cables ; if for chain-cables, the length of shank may be reduced one fourth, but not in weight. (See allowance table.) 476. WHAT LENGTH IS NECESSARY TO FORM A CLINCH. In bending cables, the length of rope necessary to form a clinch, is equal to the length of the shank of the anchor. 477. REFERENCES TO SKETCH OF TEMPORARY RUDDER. A. A piece of oak fitted with iron pintles, before launching oi while in dock, and supplied to the ship when going to sea ; B. A piece for the back, and provided for the same ; C. A spare topmast, cut off clear of the sheave-hole ; a jib- ooom might do, of the new regulation. D. Iron bolts ; E. Chocks; F. Iron-pig ballast (if necessary) ; G. Eye-bolt in quarter-deck beam, to be put in when required ; H. Rope-guys (through the heel-chock E), to assist in hang- ing the rudder. (See sketch of temporary rudder.] 478. TO SPLICE AN OLD CABLE TO A NEW ONR Take the old one to a. rope-walk, unlay the strands, and splice them to the strands of the new one with long splices, after which lay up the latter. It can be done in another way, but it requires a good and neat marlingspike-sailor to do it. g5G I'HE K EDGE- ANCHOR; 479. STRIP SHIP Begin aloft, and go down regularly, sending down by a reverse operation. Commence with the topgallant and royal-rigging, and rig in the flying-jib-boom : next send down topsail and low- er yards, topmast-caps ; unrig the topmasts, get in the jib-boom and spritsail-yards ; get off lower caps, tops and rigging ; unrig the bowsprit, and unrig all gaffs, booms and davits. Note. Tally and strop-up rigging as fast as unrove and sent down. 48O. PROPORTIONS OF SPARS FOR MERCHANT SHIPS, LENGTH OF SPARS, &c., &o. Main-mast equal to two-and-a-half times the ship's beam. Fore-mast equal to eight-ninths the main-mast. Mizen-mast equal to five-sixths of the main-mast. Bowsprit two-thirds of the main-mast, one-third of which ought to be in-board. Main-topmast three-fifths of the main-mast. Main-topgallant-mast one-half of the main-topmast, exclusive of the pole, which is generally one-h&lf the length of the top* gallant-mast or a little longer. Fore-topmast three-fifths of the foremast. Fore-topgallant-mast one-half the length of the fore-topmast, exclusive of the pole, which is half the length of the topgallant mast. Mizen-topmast three-fifths of the mizen-mast. Mizen-topgallant-mast one-half the length of the mizen-top- mast, and the pole one half the length of the topgallant-mast. Jib-boom the length of the bowsprit, two-thirds of which length is rigged without the bowsprit-cap. Main-yard twice the ship's extreme breadth. Main-topsail-yard two-thirds of main-yard. Main-topgallant-yard two-thirds of main-topsail-yard. Fore-yard seven-eighths of main-yard. Fore-topsail-yard two-thirds of fore-yard. Fore-topgallant-yard two-thirds of the fore-topsail-yard. Royal-yards two-thirds the length of the respective topgallant yards. Cross-jack-yard same length of main-topsail-yard. Mizen-topsail-yards the same length of the main-topgallant- yard. Mizen-topgallant-yard two-thirds of mizen-topsail-yard. Spritsail-yards five-sixths of the fore-topsail-vard. OR YOtHNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 257 Remark. Some have the spritsail-yard the length of the fore- topsail-yard, or nearly so ; if it should be much shorter, the jib- fcheets will chafe against the spritsail-braces. Spanker boom the length of the main-topsail-yard ; it is how- ever made sometimes longer, and sometimes shorter, according to fancy. Mizen-gaff two-thirds of the spanker-boom liable to the same variation. Topsail yard-arms to be long enough to haul out close-reef-earing. 481 THICKNESS OF SPARS MASTS. It has been customary to allow for every three feet of the main-mast's length, one inch of the diameter in the partners ; nine-tenths of an inch in diameter in the middle, between the partners and the extremity of the head, and two-thirds under the hounds, and all other masts in the same proportion ; and with these proportions masts have been usually made : I am however of opinion that one-quarter of an inch to the foot i? much better. 482. YARDS. For every four feet of their length, allow one inch of diameter in the slings, and half that diameter within the squares at the yard-arm. 483. DISTANCE FOR PLACING- LOWER MASTS, in vessels of two masts. Foremasts one-seventh the length of spar-deck from forward. Main two and five-sevenths as far from the foremast. Note. The above rule is not to be considered proper for all vessels; their places must be governed by the form of the vessel. 484. RULE FOR PLACING MASTS IN A SHIP. Take the ship's length from the after part of the stem to the fore part of the stern-post, and divide it into sevenths. Place the foremast one-seventh of this length from the stem, the main- mast three-sevenths from the fore-mast, the mizen and stern-post 258 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; This rule is for a full-built ship ; it must therefore be varied when applied to vessels that are sharp, and the stem and stem- posts of which rake ; the foremast must accordingly be placed farther aft, the mizen-mast farther forward, and the distance be- tween the masts proportionably regulated. W OQ I*. ~9 CJ *r 2 el| cj o> > O 53 > sgl ) cj bJD"S rj 52 .S S G *& "-> en a Is 2 o - s T OS ^ 2 b ELi <4 S t^ O Cu ^C :2 OR 1'OriNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 259 486. TO FIND THE TONNAGE OF A VESSEL, BY THE UNITED STATES' MEASUREMENT. The length is taken from the fore part of the main stern, to the after part of the stern-post. The beam is measured at the ex- treme breadth to the outside of the bends ; three-fifths this beair. is taken off the length, before the calculation is made. For a double decked vessel, half the breadth of beam, is called the depth of hold, and for a single-deck it is the same, except that the hold is measured at the fore part of the hatchway, from the deck down to the ceiling alongside the keelson. To proceed on in this calculation, after all the allowances have been made, the length must be multiplied by the breadth, and the product by the depth of the hold ; then divide the last product by 95, and the quotient will give the tonnage required. Formerly the British divided by 94, both for merchant vessels, and ships of war ; but I have been informed they now divide by 100, which is the reason that they make our ships' tonnage lees than we do. Notes on the tonnage of a vessel. The ship-carpenters' ton- nage in Philadelphia differs from the United States' measurement. A rule staff is laid under the keel, projecting ; a line is plumbed from the upper part of the stern to the rule staff; the keel is measured from its after part to the plumb line, and including the rule staff, this is called the length of keel straight rabbit. The beam is measured from skin to skin, on the inside ; three-fifths of the beam is taken off the keel straight rabbit, for the length, and the calculation, in other respects, is the same as in the United States' measurement ; so that the carpenters' tonnage in Phila- delphia will be less, according to the rake of the stern-post, &c. The dead rise of a vessel is found by having a staff half the beam from skin to skin, at the extreme breadth, which staff is laid even across on the ceiling of the fore part of the main hatch- way. One of the timber boards being taken up, a line is let fall from the staff to the skin alongside the keelson, and what it measures is the vessels dead rise ; so that in order to know how sharp a vessel is, it is customary to ask how much dead-rise she has. 48 7. STEPPING AND RAKING LOWER MASTS. Foremasts of all ships should be stepped plumb, or perpendic- ular, to a water-line. All mainmasts should rake one inch to every four feet above deck, and all mizen-masts should rake one inch to every three feet abr ve deck. All bowsprits should he 20 Tt[E KEDGE-AN-CHOR; wtepped in a direct line, drawn from the step of the mainmast to the lower part of the bowsprit b^d ; this line answers for the lower part of the bowsprit. It has been the opinion of many sea-officers, that a mast, by raking, will aid a ship in saiKng ; but it has been satisfactorily proved, that it has the contrary effect : for instance, a ship that has her masts perpendicular only, has to bear them in two posi- tions ; the one on the step, and the other on the side of support ; her yards hang free, brace easy, and bear no strain against them ; whereas a ship with her masts raking, has to bear them in three positions the one on the step, one on the side of support, and the other, which is very great, on the fore and aft stays ; her yards also hang very heavy against the mast, which adds also to the fore support. This must cause a great check in the pro- gressive movements in the ship. A sharp vessel or ship, with a lean harping, by raking her masts, frequently eases her in pitch- ing, but never adds to her sailing, the wind having less power on her sails, and the principal reason why a ship's main and mizen masts, should rake a little from her foremast is, that by separat- ing the masts in this way, the wind has a better chance of ef- fecting its full power on all the sails, and of striking that part of them, which otherwise would be of little or no advantage to the ship. 488. MOORING. It has been argued and proved, that if ships have room to lay at single anchor with chain-cables, they are more safe than when moored. The following example is given as an illustration. Let A be moored with 75 fathoms s. E. and N. w. and B be at single anchor, with the same scope of chain ; a gale commences from the s. w. ; the strain on each of A's cables is double the strain on B's. It blows harder, and B lets go her other bower, and veers 150 fathoms on the first, and 75 on the second cable. A also veers 150 fathoms on both cables, but B still keeps her advantage, the strain being only as 88 to 100 ; it is clear, therefore, that if either ship parts her cable, it must be A that will part first. If A had her mooring swivel on, she could not veer with any advantage, as the strain on that part of the cable between the swivel and anchor must remain constant ; for this reason, it is obvious that moorings should not be laid down across the pre- vailing winds. The above may be shown practically by stretch ing a small line between two points, and suspending a weight in the middle ; see what weight it will bear, and afterwards try what the same line will bear vertically ; the latter will be the ship at single anchor, the former the one moored. PART IX. 489. PREPARATIONS FOR HEAVING DOWN. CLEARING THE SHIP. The ship should be stripped to lower-masts and lower-rigging, cleared of everything excepting the spars and running-gear, which will be required for lashings ; top and gear-tackles, runners, luffs, pendant-tackles, and in fact all the tackles of every size. The hammock-nettings should be taken off, the loose bulk-heads re- moved, and everything that is not applicable to the operation to be performed, as it is desirable to have the ship as light as possi- ble. The lower yards should be kept aloft till the outriggers are placed. CHOICE AND POSITION OF THE OUTRIGGERS AND SHORES. If left to your own resources, and large, rough spars are not to be obtained, the following may be used for outriggers, three of which will be required for each mast ; i. e., fore and main. Mam-mast. Fore-mast. 1 Main-topmast. 1 Main-topsail-yard. 1 Half-yard (rough). 1 Fore-topmast. 1 Fore-topsail-yard. 1 Cross-jack-yard. Note. If you can get other spars, the yards should not be used The spars should be placed in the main-deck-ports before and abaft the masts. When they are placed, the lower-yards, caps, tops and cross-trees may be sent down and landed. The shores should then be placed with their heels resting in shoes or the spare fishes, close out to the water-ways, and their heads between the trestle-trees before and abaft the mast-heads. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; MAST-HEAD SHORES. Main-mast. Fore-mast. \ Main-topmasl. 1 Fore-topmast. 1 Spanker-boom. 1 Jib-boom. In preference to using belly-shores, I would recommend to fish the main-mast with the two mizen-topmasts, and the foremast with fore arid main-topgallant-masts ; if no other spars are to be had, the topgaliant-studdingsail-booms must be cut up for shores for the decks and outriggers. CARPENTERS' WORK. In the mean time the carpenters should be employed in shoring the outriggers' and decks under the beams, on which the mast- head-shores rest : good stages should also be prepared, the spare- shackle or gammoning-bolts got ready; the copper should be stripped where they are to be driven, viz. : before, abaft, and be- tween the outriggers, as low as convenient for driving, and fore- locking them on the inside, or as the water line will allow. Note. The holes should be bored slanting upwards, so that the martingales will rather tend to set them in than draw them out ; the shackles or rings of the gammoning-bolts should then be well parceled. SECURING THE OUTRIGGERS. In the meantime a party of riggers or seamen should be em- ployed to fit the martingales and outrigger-shrouds, and to strap the purchase-blocks. MARTINGALES. The size of the martingales must depend upon the angle which you are able to give them, as their size must increase as their angle becomes less. If the bolts are near the water-line, three parts of eight-inch for each outrigger will be found sufficient. The main outriggers should be cleated about eighteen feet from the side, for the rigging. The heels should be well shored down and securely lashed ; they should also be securely lashed down 01 gammoned to the breeching-bolts or scupper-holes, and shored by diagonal shores in the angles of the port-sills, that the spars in rising may bring an equal pressure on all parts ; otherwise it would probably strain the top sides : the outriggers should also nave a stout lashing to the train-bolts amidships. If the topsail- yards are used (which is not advisable when other spars can be obtained), the inner yard-arms must not be allowed to butt the ship's side, or water-ways ; they should have chain-snotters, and OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 263 must be shored in all directions. The fore-outriggers should be cleated about fifteen feet from the ship's side, and secured in- board as the main. In addition to the martingale, the three out- riggers for each mast may be connected by luffs boused well taut, and the stay-tackles may be used for fore and after-guys, which \vill bring all to a fair strain. Any farther security that may suggest itself at the time, according to circumstances, should not be omitted, as you will never err by being on the safe side STRAPS FOR PURCHASE-BLOCKS I would also recommend the straps for the purchase- clocks should be warped of new, three-inch rope, selvagee-fash ion, instead of the large rope-strap. The upper one will take about two coils, which will give about twenty-eight parts in the strap. The strap being middled, and the block seized in, the eyes or legs should pass round the mast-head, and lash on the same side as the block, and above it, which will give four times twenty-eight parts of three-inch rope in the neck of the strap. PIT-BLOCKS. The length of the lower strap must vary according to the pit you heave down to. It should contain at least thirty parts of three-inch, and also have four parts of the strap in the neck. If the pit is deep, it will be better to warp two separate straps of half the length for the lower blocks. The same way for the fore- mast, which may be securely lashed as most convenient, but nei- ther of the blocks should be lashed at the mast-head until the outrigger-shrouds are over, set up hand-taut, and matted over all Note. A second or preventer-purchase is required to each mast PREVENTIVE SHROUDS. For the main-mast, two lengths of the stream-cable (well par- celed) may next be put over the main-mast-head ; these may be set up through the lower-deck-ports, and kept clear of the chan- nels by short outriggers of hard wood, with grooves in the outer end to receive the cable resting in the channels, butting against the ship's side, and cleated round the heel, to form a step ; the outrigger-shrouds for each mast may then go over. They should be about eleven-inch-rope ; they must be well parceled : dead- eyes or blocks may be used to set them up, as convenient. Small sized chain-cable maybe used to a good advantage if it can be obtained 264 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; For further security, the following purchases may be used FOR THE MAIN-MAST, Two main-top-tackles lashed at the mast-head ; one set up a I the main-tack-bolts, the other to the after-quarter-deck-port ; two mast-head-runners to assist the main-stay ; two belly-stays of eleven-inch,* lashed one-third down the mast, and set up on the weather-side ; two main-yard tackles lashed one-third down ; one set up in the main-tack-bolts, the other, after-quarter-deck-port. FOR THE FORE-MAST. To assist the lower rigging, two threefold purchases lashed to the spare chain-plate-bolts ; two launches' purchases lashed to the mast-head, and set up, one to the cat-head, and the other to the after part of the fore-chains ; two runners lashed at the mast- head ; one set up to the cat-head, one to the chess-tree-bolts ; two belly-stays of eleven inch, one-third way down the mast, and set up half-way in on the bowsprit ; two fore-top-tackles one-third down the mast ; one to the cat- head, one to the chess-tree- water- ways, or scupper-holes, as most convenient. THE BOWSPRIT May be secured by the two fore-yard-tackles, hooked on the weather-side. THE MIZEN-MAST May be shored with one shore at the mast-head, and the mizen- pendant-tackles and burtons may be used to assist the rigging, if considered necessary. SETTING UP THE RIGGING. The wedges being taken out, and the masts drawn over to the opposite partners, the shores may be cleated and lashed above the rigging, and below the trestle-trees with good worn rope of three or three-and-a-half-inch ; the lashing should be passed on both, with racking turns, hove taut by a Spanish windlass, the ends frapped round all parts, and secured ; the heels should also be lashed to the side, so that they can have no play forward or aft. The outriggers' and martingales being well set up to the span- shackle bolts, and secured otherwise as before mentioned, the lower rigging and outrigger-shrouds may be set up to a fair and equal strain, respectively ; the outrigger-shrouds may be a little tauter than the rigging, because they have a longer drift, and are less Strained when offering the same support ; in proportion, the ad- ditional purchases may then be set up. * i. e.. Supposing the vessel to be one of the largest class of frigates. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 266 There is one point in the foregoing arrangements that merits peculiar attention ; having once measured the distance between the mast-heads, and the same between your lower blocks, you must be careful to preserve the same distance between the mast- heads whenever you may have occasion to set up afresh ; if you neglect this, your mast "spreads apart as the ship comes down and the stays and rigging are unfairly strained. The slack of the opposite rigging should then be taken in, and a swifter should be rove to keep it from hanging in a bight as the ship goes down. When the masts are thus secured, the purchase-blocks may be lashed, and the shores wedged under the heels until they have taken part of the strain off the rigging. Care should be taken that the shore-heads are clear of the trestle-trees ; the strain should not be wholly upon the shores and deck, but each shroud and purchase must bear its proportion. PURCHASE FALLS. Eleven-inch fall tailed with eight inch, is sufficient for the heaviest ship in the service. If you have only your own re- sources, use the large hawsers tailed with the smaller, or what- ever rope is convenient in the store-room, which may suit the purpose. Note. In reeving, use a small line for that purpose ; you will also save time and trouble by using the capstan* in reeving and overhauling the falls, which is a work of considerable time. Two-and-a-half-inch stuff is a good size for a reeving line. MAST-HEAD STOPPERS. Two good stoppers of eleven-inch rope should be fitted to each mast ; they may go with a clove-hitch round the mast-head, the ends being long enough to reeve through the strap of the lower purchase-blocks, to hitch and seize back ; a small jigger, and two balls of spun-yarn should be ready for each purchase ; the lead- ing block should also be lashed alongside of its respective pit- block with a long lashing, to allow the leader to rise high enough to clear the fall of the edge of the pit ; and stoppers must also be fitted for each leader-crab or capstan. The greatest attention is required to the leading of the falls, as the slightest chafe or rub, with so great a strain, might prove of serious consequence ; a sharp axe should be ready at each pit. If at the wharf or navy-yard, cattle might be clapped on to ree re the fall with greater facility. 266 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; THE PIT. The formation of the pit, or sleeper, in which your lower olock is secured, must vary so much in locality, that no general rule can be given. ANCHORS AND CABLES. The bowers may be landed, or used to moor the ship with, 5iead and stern ; the sheet-anchors may next be laid out a-beam as tripping-anchors, at such a distance according to the depth of the water, as may ensure their holding ; one should be abreast of the foremast, the other opposite the main-mast ; a stout haw- ser should be bent to the ring of each, and brought in at the second lower-deck port, abaft the main-mast, and first port abaft the foremast, on the same side as the anchors are laid out. The chains to these tripping-anchors should be tailed with a stream-cable, which is to pass under the ship's bottom and in at k he quarter-deck port, abaft the main channels and second port on the forecastle ; these ports should be well lined, and stoppers fitted ready for fleeting ; a three-fold purchase stretched across the deck, may be here applied, so that when you have tripped the ship off by the hawsers you may bouse the cables in taut, stopper and rack to the breeching-bolts. In tripping off, you must be careful to keep the ship parallel t ) the pits, or you may chance to bring one anchor home. CAULKING, &C. While the foregoing preparations are being made, the pumps should be shortened, to work on the lower deck. The caulkers and carpenters should be employed upon the side that is to be hove down, stopping the air-holes on all the decks, and thorough- ly caulking every seam or hole that will either be immersed, or exposed to the action of the water that may find admittance, particularly in the wake of the hammock-nettings that have been removed, and round the quarter-galleries. Water Liu* Arrangement >f the Pumps in heaving down. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 267 The caulking should be considered a very important point; the smallest hole that can admit water must be carefully stopped. The main-deck ports must be filled up in the centre with plank, well caulked,' and covered with tarred canvass ; the lower deck ports and scuttles thoroughly caulked in ; the holes for the port- pendants plugged, cross-caulked, and payed over, and the scup- pers made tight in the same manner ; and it must be remember- ed that want of attention to these particulars may cost you hours at the pumps, or perhaps oblige you to right the ship at a "moment when you might advantageously continue the repair; the hawse-holes and stern-ports need not be stopped, for they will not be near the water when the ship is keel out LADDERS, &C. Battens four inches deep, should be nailed fore and aft on each deck ; knotted ropes and Jacob's-ladders should be placed at con- venient distances, to secure ready access to every part of the ship, which is more difficult when she is down than would be ima- gined. Note. The hatchway ladders should all be lashed. ARRANGEMENT OF THE PUMPS. If the water must be raised more than thirty feet, two sets of pumps will be required ; the lower ones must throw the water into tubs or tanks placed on the lower deck the upper ones must be placed in these vessels, and raise it from them to the up- per deck ; for this purpose nine or ten pumps will be required ; they may be built square, of plank caulked in the seams, well parceled and woolded, or if timber can be had, may be formed by sawing straight spars in half lengthwise, and rejoining them after they are hollowed ; then parceling, tarring, and woolding all over. The number required being completed, the lower and orlop- decks must be scuttled, to allow the pumps to be placed at the required angle, so that their ends may rest a little below the orlop-wing gratings; the main and upper deck pumps may be sufficiently sloped in the hatchways with their beels in the ves sels, which are raised on platforms inclined at an angle, to pre serve their level when the ship is down. The pumps should have large holes in their nozzles, and troughs should be made to carry the water over the skids to lee ward on the upper deck. Substantial platforms must be secured at the same angle, at convenient positions, for the men to work the pumps. The pumps should be tried before you heave down, to see that they are tight, and also when in position to see that the brakes work clear of the beams and comings. 268 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Any fire engines that can be procured, should be worked m the hold on similar platforms, with their hoses led on deck. WEIGHT FOR HEELING AND TRIPPING SHIP. The rigging 1 being set up, the purchase falls rove, the pumps rigged and all the foregoing preparations made, fifteen or twenty tons of water in casks may be placed tn the side to be hove down, and lashed to the breeching-bolts, &c., on the quarter-deck and fore-castle. PREPARATIONS FOR HEAVING. The ship may then be hove off by the tripping-hawsers to the distance of seventy or eighty feet from the pits, and the tripping- cables boused well taut. The men required to work the pumps and engines, should be on board, with a proportion of carpenters to stop small leaks, clear the pumps, attend the masts in the partners, &c.; the hand-pumps should be used as long as they will act, so as to keep the ship perfectly dry ; the ' men ' should be to leeward on the upper deck, to assist with their weight the purchases ; at slack water you may commence heaving ; the ship will incline 15 before the slack of the falls is through, and will continue to close the pits until she is down to 35 ; she will then begin to go off. It must be remembered that the main-mast is to heave the ship down ; the fore purchase is only an assistant, and must not be unfairly hove upon ; avoid surging as much as possible ; the moment the pumps will draw they must begin to work. When the ship is down the falls must be stoppered and racked, the mast-head stoppers passed, boused taut and secured ; you may then walk back and reverse the falls upon the capstans, taking a turn round the bitts with the running part, which is to be hove off by the capstans as you ease up, and will cause less surging. STAGES. Substantial floating stages having been previously made b) the carpenters, should now be ready to haul in ; a large boa! containing tool-chests and the stores necessary for stopping the leak, should be in attendance ; when the ship is down, not a single second should be lost ; let your men sing out cheer at the pumps, and forego that part of your discipline for a short time, which might be a hindrance to your immediate object. Watch narrowly the purchases and be ready to ease-up at a moment's warning, if they slacken or any of the gear carries away. In easing-up, when the main-deck scuppers are out of water, hold on, take the lead or canvass off that secured them, and let the water escape from the deck ; you may get rid of several tons thus with- out much labor. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. The carpenters must be careful in clearing the injured part, not to increase the leak by undertaking more than they are able to perform ; as a general rule, make all as tight as possible before you think of easing-up for the night. 490. A DERRICK. What is termed a derrick, is a single spar rounded off at the heel to set in a shoe, (similar to a shear- leg;) the upper end is made with shoulders or cleats, to stop the pur- chase-block from working down, also the guys ; the derrick may be used for many purposes instead of shears to great advantage, espe- cially on board of merchant ships when discharging, it being so easily- swung from a perpendicular posi- tion to rake over the ship's side, the heel resting in its shoe, and the head canted in any position by the guys ; any kind of a purchase may be used at a derrick-head, but the most general, is the single and double-burton. On the subject of providing means few ships go to sea with- out a spare topmast or a spar to make one, which spar is in every way calculated for a derrick, if it will make a topmast. The rigging, (that is the various guys and ropes necessary to sustain it in its position,) and the purchase-blocks for lifting the weight, may be secured to the spar any height above the deck to suit the particular purpose in hand, without either cutting the spar, or nailing on cleats as by a well managed arrangement of lashings, all slipping or shifting of position may certainly be prevented. Note. The more a derrick appi caches a perpendicular position, the less will be the strain upon the guys. 270 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR } GENERAL CAUTIONS. In any very intricate Navigation, Anchor at night or when in doubt. Take frequent and short departures. Pay particular attention that the proper course is steered. Hand in the chains, and lead kept going. Good look out. Anchors ready, and cables clear. Canvass well regulated and be ready for bringing- up. Boats ready, tackles at hand. Stream cable and hawsers ready. Top-gallant-mast-ropes rove. Taken in a Squall. A vigilant look out, will usually prevent your being taken by a squall in an unprepared state. If taken in a squall with the wind on the beam, before it, 01 close hauled, keep your luff, and lower away, and clew up all as fast as you can. In doing so the ship will be relieved, and the canvass got in better than if the helm had been put up. But if taken in a squall with the wind abaft the beam, putting the helm up, and running away from it, as well as shortening sail, will then be the readiest mode of easing a ship. (Remember this.) On Good Order (Merchant Service}. In a man-of-war, discipline is productive of the greatest good the energies of all are called for, and employed as most requir- ed ; but even without martial law good regulations might, and ought to be established in every ship, at all times, and in all places. The greatest assistance to the promotion of good order, would be SOBRIETY in seamen. The few shades in the sterling qual- ities which belong to them, many of their irregularities and acts of insubordination, may be traced to intemperance. They might abstain, perhaps, but they cannot refrain. If owners would give $1 a month in lieu of spirits, and have a mutual agreement respect- ing its use abroad, with a stipulated penalty for drunkenness, ships might be managed much more safely, and with greater ease and economy than at present ; half the work of discipline would then be effected. Where the men are sober, have entire confidence in their offi- cers, and are well treated, not harrassed unnecessarily, and see that the comforts they ought to have are properly attended to I think it would be found in most instances, that effective good order would establish itself. Where it does exist, the vessel's ser- OR YOUNG SAILORb' ASSISTANT. >71 vices are rendered in every way more effective and beneficial tc her employers, as well as more agreeable to the officers, crew, and passengers, if any, and her chances of casualties considerably lessened. The remedy, too, is in a great measure in the hands of ship- owners and captains themselves ; for if they required certificates of sobriety before they would ship men, drunken ones would either remain unemployed or become sober, for even a sober landsman, is more useful than a drunken sailor. On Cleanliness, as regards the Preservation of Life in Vessels. Nothing is toe trifling for an officer's attention, that tends to the health and benefit of those dependent on his care and fore- thought. Every vessel should be pumped out morning and evening. A clean, sweet, and dry hold is essential to the health of the crew. Nothing can be more injurious than for men to sleep over oilge-water, which must be the case if any water is left in the aold at night. The hold ought to be cleared often, and when it is, it should be white-washed ; and also the between-decks frequently white- washed. On Painting. In tropical climates, avoid painting as much as possible, pai- ticularly in-board. On the Health of Men, in the Merchant Service. In port, in tropical climates, give the men a little coffee before they go to work in the morning. The inconsiderate indulgence in new rum, has been one grea^ means of increasing the numbers attacked with yellow fever. Do not allow the men to lay about in night dews ; and partic- ularly not to wait about at wharfs. Allow the men the use of fresh water whenever it can be spared for washing clothes, and also for themselves. 21 PART X. 491. EXPLANATION OF SEA TERMS. Aback. A sail is aback when its forward surface is acted upoD by the wind. Abaft. The hinder part of the ship. Behind, thus abaft the foremast, means anything nearer to the stern than the foremast. Aboard. In the ship ; as the cargo is aboard. A ship is said to fall aboard when she runs foul of another. To get aboard the main-tack is to bring the clew of the mainsail down to the chess-tree. About. A ship is said to be going about, when in the act of backing ; the order for which is " ready about there" Abreast. Opposite to. Adrift. Broken loose from the moorings. Afloat. Swimming ; not touching the bottom. Afore. That part of the ship nearest to the stem or head. Aft. Behind ; as stand farther aft stand nearer to the stern. After. Hinder, as the after ports those ports nearest the stern after sails, after hatchway, &c., &c. Aground. Not having water enough to float the ship, which rests on the ground. Ahead. Before the ship. A-lee. The helm is a-lee when the tiller is put to the lee-side. " Hard-a-lee," when it is put as far as it will go. All in the wind. When the wind blows on the leeches or out- vard extremities of the sails, and causes them to shake. 274 THE KEDGE-AJNCHOR; All hands, ahoy. This word given by the boatswain and his mates at the hatchway to assemble the ship's company. Aloft. Up above; in the rigging ; on the yards ; at the mast- head, &c. Alongside. Close to the ship's side. Amidships. In the middle of the ship. The helm is amid- ships when the tiller is not put over, either to one side or the other. To anchor. To let the anchor fall overboard, that it may hold the ship. To foul the anchor. To let the cable be twisted round the up- per fluke, &c. To drag the anchor. When the ship pulls it with her, from the violence of the wind. Anchorage. Ground fit to anchor in. The anchor is a cock bill. It is hanging by the stopper tit the cat-head. The anchor is a-peak. Near to the ship. Thus at different distances it is called a long peak, a stay peak, a short peak. The anchor is a-weigh or a-trip. Loosened from the ground by heaving in the cable. The anchor is backed. Another anchor is placed at a certain distance before it, and attached to it by the cable of the former being fastened to it, which fixes it firmly in the ground. The anchor is catted. Drawn up to the cat-head. The anchor is fished. Its inner arm is drawn up by the fish- pendant. To weigh the anchor. To heave it up by the capstan or wind- lass. The sheet-anchor, is of the same size and weight of the two bower anchors, and the spare anchor ; it is a resource and de- pendence should either of the bowers part, for which purpose the cable is always kept ready bent with a long range, that it may be let go on an emergency. Best bower or small bower anchors, are the two anchors which are stowed the farthest forward, or near the bows. The stream-anchor, is used to bring the ship up with occasion- ally, or to steady the ship when she comes to a temporary moor- ing. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 5^75 The hedge-anchor. The smallest of the anchors, to which a hawser or cable is generally bent, and used for warping ship. An end. Any spar or mast placed perpendicularly. The top- masts are an end ; they are swayed up and fidded above thelowe* masts. All an end. All the masts are up in their proper stations A-peak. (See Anchor.) Ashore. On land ; aground. Astern. Behind the ship. Athwart. Across. Athwart hawse, across the stem ; athwart ships, anything lying in a direction across the ship ; athwart the fore-foot, a shot fired by another ship across the bows. Atrip. (See Anchor.) Avast. To cease hauling ; to stop. Aweigh. (See Anchor.) Aweather. The helm is said to be aweather, when the tiller is put over to the windward side of the ship ; hard aweather, when it it is put over as far as it will go. Awning. A canvass canopy, placed over the deck when the sun is powerful. To back the sails. To expose their forward surfaces to the wind, by hauling in the weather braces. Back-stays. Ropes fixed at the topmast and topgallant-mast heads, and extended to the chains on the ship's sides. To bag-pipe the mizen. To bring the sheet over to the weather-mizen-shrouds, in order to lay it aback. To balance the mizen. Rolling up a portion of it at the peak. Ballast. A quantity of iron, stone, gravel, &c., placed in the hold to give a ship proper stability when she has no cargo, or but a small quantity of goods, &c< Bands. Pieces of canvass sewn across the sail, called reef- bands also a piece stuck on the middle of the sail, to strengthen .t when half- worn. Bar. A shoal running across the mouth of a harbor. Capstan bars. Pieces of timber put into the holes in the drum- head of the capstan, (where they are secured with iron pin?,) to Jieave up the anchor, &c. Bare poles Having no sail up. 276 THfi KEDGE- ANCHOR ; Battens. Slips of wood nailed on the slings of the yard, which are eight square also over the tarpaulings of a hatchway to keep the water out in stormy weather. Bays. In men-of-war, the starboard and larboard sides between decks, before the bitts ; in small vessels, amidships. Beams. Strong pieces of timber across the ship, under the decks, bound to the side by knees. They support and keep the ship together. On the beam. When the wind blows at a right angle with the keel. Before the beam. When the wind or object bears on some point less than a right angle, or ninety degrees from the ship's head. Abaft the beam. When the wind or object bears on some point which is more than a right angle of ninety degrees from the ship's course. Bearing. The point of the compass on which any object ap- pears ; it is also applied to an object which lies opposite to any part of the ship ; thus the buoy, &c., bears on the beam, the bow, the quarter, &c. Beating to windward. Tacking, and endeavoring to get to windward of some head land. Becalmed. Having no wind to fill the sails. The ship being deprived of the power of the wind, by the intervention of high land, a large ship, &c. Beckets. Short straps, having an eye in one end and a double walled knot on the other for suspending a yard, &c., till wanted ; such as the beckets for the royal-yards, for the bights of the sheets, &c. To belay. To make fast. Bend. A kind of knot as a sheet-bend, &c., or a seizing, such as the bends of the cable. To bend. To make fast as to bend the sails, the cable, &c. Bends. The streaks of thick stuff, or strongest planks in the ship's sides, on the broadest part ; these are also called the wales. Between decks. Any part of the ship below, betwen two decks. Bight. Any part of a rope between the ends, also a collar 01 eye formed by a rope. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 277 Bilge. The flat part of a ship's bottom. Bilge water, that which rests in the bilge, either from rain, shipping water, &c. Binnacle. The frame or box which contains the compass. Berth. A place of anchorage ; a cabin or apartment. Bitts. Large, upright pins of timber, with a cross piece, over \vhich the bight of the cable is put, also smaller ones to belay r opes. such as topsail-sheets, &c. To bitt. To place a bight of the cable over the bitts. Blocks. Instruments with sheaves or pulleys, used to increase the power of ropes. Block and block. When the two blocks of a tackle are drawn so close together that there is no more of the fall left to haul upon ; it is also termed chock-a-block. To make a board. To tack. To make a stern board. To drive a ship stern foremost, by laying the sails aback. Boarding. Entering an enemy's ship by force ; the men are called boarders. Boarding netting. Net work triced round the ship to prevent the boarders from entering. Boats. Small vessels. Those belonging to ships are the long boat, the launch, the cutter, the yawl, and the jolly-boat. Boatswain. The officer who has charge of the cordage, boats, rigging, &c. Bobstays. Ropes rove through the cutwater, and set up with dead-eyes under the bowsprit, to act against the power of the fore stays. Sometimes one of these is taken to the end of the bowsprit to act against the fore-topmast stays. Bolsters. Pieces of wood or canvass stuffed, placed on the lower trestle-trees to keep the rigging from chafing. Bolts. Iron fastenings by which the ship is secured in her hulL Bolt-ropes. Ropes sewn round the edges of the sails. Booms. Large poles, used to extend the studding-sails, spanker, jibs, &c. Boom-irons. Iron caps fixed on the yard-arms for ttae studding- iail-booms to rest in. Boies. The round part of the ship, forward. To bouse. To haul upon. THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Bower. (See Anchor.) Bowlines. Ropes made fast to the leeches, or sides of the sails to pull them forward. Bowsprit. A mast projecting over the stem. Box-hauling. A method of waring or turning a ship from the wind. Boxing-off. Turning the ship's head from the wind by back- ing the head sails. Braces. Ropes fastened to the yard-arms to brace them about, also a security to the rudder, fixed to the stern-post. Brails. Ropes applied to the after leeches of the mizen, and some of the staysails to draw them up. To break bulk. To begin to unload. To break the sheer. To swerve from the proper direction in which a ship should be when at anchor. Breaming. Burning the stuff which is collected on the ship's bottom during a long voyage. Breast-hooks. Pieces of timber placed across the bows of a ship to keep them together. Breast-work. Railing on the fore part of the quarter deck, where ropes are belayed. Breeching. A stout rope fixed to the cascable of a gun, fasten- ed to the ship's side to prevent its running in. Bridles. The upper part of the moorings laid in harbors for men-of-war ; also ropes attached from the leeches of the square sails to the bowlines. To bring up. To come to an anchor. To bring to. To make a ship stationary, stopping her way by bracing some of the sails aback, and keeping others full, so as to counterpoise each other. To bring by the lee. When a ship is sailing with the wind very large, and flies off from it so as to bring it on the other side, the sails catching aback, she is then said to be brought by the lee; this is -a dangerous position in a high sea. To broach-to. Flying up in the wind, so as to bring i on the other side when blowing fresh. Bulk-heads. Partitions in the ship. BuWs-eye. A wooden thimble. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 279 Bumkin. or boomkin. A short boom fitted to the bows of a ship for the purpose of hauling down the fore tack to it is supported on each side by a shroud. Bunt. The middle part of a square-sail, also the fore leech of a quadrangular staysail. Buntlines. Ropes attached to the foot of a square-sail, to haul it up. Burton pendants. The first piece of rigging which goes ovei the topmast-head, to which is hooked a tackle to set up the top- mast-shrouds. Bush. Metal in the sheaves of blocks which have iron pins. Butt-end. The end of a plank in a ship's side. Buttock. That part of a ship's hull under the stern, between the water-line and wing- transom. By the board. Over the side. A mast is said to go by the 6oard when it is carried or shot away just above the deck. By the head. When a ship is deeper in the water forward than aft. By the stern. The reverse of by the head. By the wind. When a ship is as near to the wind as her head can lie, with the sails filled. Cabin. A room or apartment ; also a bed place. Cable. A large rope by which the ship is secured to the anchor. Cables take their names from the anchor to which they belong ; as the sheet-cable, the best bower-cable, &c. They are generally 120 fathoms in length. To bitt the cable. (See Bitts.) To heave in the cable. To pull it into the ship by the windlass or capstan. To pay out the cable. To pass it out of the hawse-hole. To veer away the cable. To slacken it so that it may run out, as in paying out. To serve the cable. To wrap it round with rope, plait, or horse- hide, to keep it from chafing. To slip the cable. To let it run clear out. Cable tier. That part of the orlop-deck where the cables are soiled. To coll the cable. To lay it on the deck in a circular form. 280 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; Caboose. The place where the victuals are dressed in mer chantmen. Call. A silver pipe or whistle used by the boatswain and his mates, by the sounding of which they call up the hands, direct them to haul, to veer, to belay, &c., &c. Canted. Anything turned from its square position. Canvass. Strong cloth, of which the sails are made. Cap. A block of wood which secures the topmast to the lower mast. Capsize. To turn over. Capstan. A machine for drawing up the anchor by .he mes- senger, which is taken round it and applied to the cable by the nippers. Careening. Heaving a vessel down on one side, to clean 01 repair her bottom. Carrick bend. A kind of knot. Cast. To pay a ship's head off by backing the head sails wheu heaving up the anchor, so as to bring the wind on the side required. Cat-block. A large, double or threefold block, used for drawing the anchor up to the cat head. Cat-head. A large piece of timber or crane, projecting over the bow, for drawing up the anchor clear from the ship's side. Cat-harpings. Short legs of rope seized to the upper part of the lower shrouds and futtock-staves, to keep them from bulging out by the strain of the futtock-shrouds, and to permit the bracing up of the lower yards. Cafs-paw. A light air, perceived by its effect upon the water, but not durable ; also a twist made on tne bight of a rope. To Caulk. To drive oakum into the seams of the sides, decks, &c. Chains. Links of iron bolted to the ship's sides, having dead- eyes in the upper ends, to which the shrouds are connected by the lanyards. Channels. Strong, broad planks, bolted to the sides to keep the dead-eyes in the chains from the side, to spread the rigging farther out. Chapeling. A ship is said to build a chapel, when by neglect in light winds she turns round so as to bring the wind on the same part it was before she moved. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. Chase. A ship pursued by another. Bow-chase. A gun in the fore part of the ship. Stern-chase. A gun pointing astern in the after part of the ship To chase. To pursue ; to follow. To cheer. To huzza. What cheer-ho ! a salutation. Chock-a-block. (See block and block.) To clap on. To make fast ; as, clap on the stoppers, &c. To claw off. To beat to windward from a lee-shore Cleats. Pieces of wood to fasten ropes to. Close-hauled. Asanighthewind as a ship can lie. Club-hauling. Tacking by means of an anchor. Clues or Clews. The lower corners of the square sails. Coamings. The borders of the hatchways which are raised above the deck. Colling. Laying a rope down in a circular form. Companion. A wooden covering over the cabin hatchway. Course. The point of the compass on which the ship sails ; the mainsail, foresail and mizen are also called courses. Crab. A small capstan. To cun the ship. To direct the helmsman how to steer. Cutwater. The knee of the head. Davit. A crane of timber used for fishing the anchors. Dead-eye. A block with three holes in, to receive the lanyard of a shroud or stay. Dog-vane. A small vane made of cork and feathers, and placed .,a the weather side of the quarter deck. Dolphin. A wreath of rope placed round a mast. (See Pudding.) To Douse. To let fly the halliards of a topsail ; to lower away briskly, &c. Downhauler. A rope to pull down the staysails, topmast, stud- dingsails, &c. Drift. Driving to leeward ; driving with the tide. Drifts are also those parts where the rails are cut off an end with scrolls. Driver. A large sail suspended to the mizen-gaff. Dunnage. Wood, &c. laid at the bottom of a ship to keep the cargo dry. Earings. Small ropes to make fast the upper corners of square- sails, &c. 282 rHE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Ease-off. To siacken. End-for-end. To let a rope or cable run quite out. End-on. When a ship's bows and head sails are only eee/j. Ensign. A national flag worn by ships at their gaff-ends. Fag-end. The end of a rope which is untwisted. Fake. One circle of a coil of rope. Falling-ojf. When a ship moves from the wind farther than she ought. Fid. A tapered piece of wood, or iron, to splice ropes with ; also a piece of wood which supports one mast upon the trestle- trees of another. To Fill. To brace the yards so that the wind may strike the sails on their after surfaces. Flukes. The broad parts or palms of the anchors. (See Anchor.) Fore. That part of the ship nearest to the head. Fore and aft. The lengtkway of the ship, or in the direction of the keel. Fore-castle. A short deck in the fore part of the ship. Forging-ahead. Forced a-head by the wind. Foul hawse- When the cables are twisted. To founder. To sink. Full and by. (See close-hauled.) Furling. Making fast the sails to the yards by the gasketa. Gajf. The spar or yard, to which the mizen of a ship, or the mainsail of a brig or cutter is bent. Gang-way. A deck reaching from the quarter-deck to the fore- castle ; also the place where persons enter the ship. Gasket. A piece of plat to fasten the sails to the yard. Girt. A ship is girted when her cables are too tight, which prevents her swinging. Goose-neck. An iron hook at the end of a boom. Goose-wings. The outer extremities of a main or foresail, when loose, the rest of it being furled. Goring. Cutting a sail obliquely. Gripe. A piece of timber that joins the keel and the cut-water Griping. When a ship carries her helm much to windward. Gunnel. The upper part of a ship's side. Guy. A rope to steady a boom. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 283 Gybing. When (by the wind being large), it is necessary to shift the boom of a fore and aft sail. Halliards. Tackles or ropes to hoist up the sails. To Hand. (The same as to furl.) Hatchway. A square hole in the deck, which communicates with the hold, or another deck. To Haul To pull. To Hail. To call out to another ship. A clear Hawse. When the cables are not twisted. Afoul Hawse. When the cables lie across, or are twisted. Hawse-holes. The holes through which the cables pass. Hawser. A small cable. To Heel. To incline to one side. Helm. A wooden bar put through the head of a rudder ; also railed a tiller. To Hitch. To make fast. Tlie Hold. The lower apartment of a ship, where the provisions and goods are stowed. To haul Home. To pull the clew of a sail, &c. as far as it will go. Horse. A rope made fast to the yard, on which the men stand. Hull. The body of a ship. Jewel-blocks. Blocks at the topsail-yard-arms for the topmast- Btudding-sail halliards, Jigger. A purchase used in merchant ships to hold on the cable. Junk. Pieces of old cable, out of which mats, gaskets, &c. are made. (See article on Junk.) Jury-masts. Temporary masts, when the others are carried or shot away. Redding. Old rope passed round the cable at short distances. Kink. A twist or turn in a rope. To Labor. To pitch and roll heavily. Land-fall. Discovering the land. Larboard. The left side. Launch-ho. To let go the top rope when the topmast is fldded Leeward. That point which the wind blows. Lee-lurch. When the ship rolls to leeward. Lee-tide. When the wind and tide are the same way. rHE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Lizard. A small piece of rope with a thimble spliced into a Larger one. Looming. The appearance of a distant object ; such as a biiip. the land, &c. Lubber. A sailor who does not know his duty. Luff. A direction to the steersman to put the helm to leeward. Luff-tackle. A large tackle consisting of a double and single block. Lying to. (See To bring-to.) To man the yards. To send men upon them. To moor. To secure a ship by more than one cable. Moorings. The place where a vessel is moored ; also anchors tvith chains and bridles, laid in rivers for men-of-war to ride by. Neap-tides. Those tides which happen when the moon is in her quarters, and are not so high as the Spring-tides. Neaped. A ship is said to be neaped, when she is left on shore by these tides, and must wait for the next Spring-tides. To Near the land. To approach the shore. To Near. A direction to the helmsman to put the helm little " a-weather ; " to keep the sails full ; to let her come no nearer to the wind. Nippers. Plaiting or selvagees, to bind the cable to the mes- senger. Off-and-on. Coming near the land on one tack, and leaving it on another. Offing. Out to sea from the land. Orlop-deck. The lowest deck in the ship, lying on the beams of the hold. The place where the cables are coiled, and where other stores are kepi. Overboard. Out of the ship. Overhauling. To haul a fall of rope through a block till it is slack also examining a ship. Painter. A rope by which a boat is made fast. To Pass. To hand anything from one to another, or to place a rope or lashing round the yard, &c. Pay. To rub tar, pitch, or anything, with a brush. To pay off. To make a ship's head recede from the wind, bv packing the head-sails. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 285 To Peak up. To raise the after end of a gaff. Plying. Turning to windward. Pooping. A ship is said to be pooped when she is struck by a heavy sea, on the stern or quarter. Port. To the left side. This term is used for the helmsman to put the helm to the left, instead of the word Larboard, to make a distinction from the affinity of sound in the word Star- board. Preventer. Anything for temporary security, as a preventer- brace, &c. Pendant, or Pennant. A sort of long, narrow banner. Pendant (broad}. A sort of flag terminating in two points. Pendant. The name of a piece of rope applied to different objects on ship-board; i. e., fish-pendants, rudder-pendants, &c. Quarter. That part of a ship's side between the main-chains and the stern. Racking a Fall. Seizing the parts of a tackle-fall together by cross-turns. Rake. The projection of a ship at the stem and stern, beyond the extent of the keel also the inclination of a ship's masts, either forward or aft from a perpendicular line. Range of Cable. A sufficient length hauled up to permit the anchor to drop to the bottom. To Rattle down the Shrouds. To fix the ratlings on them. To Reef. To reduce a sail by tying it round the yard with points. To Reeve. To put a rope through a block, &c. To Ride. To be held by the cable; to ride easy, is when a ship does not labor much ; to ride hard, is when a chip pitches with violence. To Rig. To fit the rigging to the mast. To Right. A ship is said to right when she rises to her up- i ight position, after being laid down by a violent squall. To Right the Helm. To put it a-midships, or in its fore and aft position parallel to the keel. To Round-in. To haul in a brace, &c., which is not very tight To Rouse-in To haul in the slack part of the cable. THE KEDGE-ANCHOR ; To Run down. When one ship sinks another by running ovei her. To Scud. To sail before the wind in a storm. To Scuttle a Ship. To make holes in her bottom to sink her. To Serve. To wind anything around a cable or rope, to pre- vent its being chafed. To Seize. To make fast or bind. To Sheer. To go in and out, and not in a direct course. To Ship. To put anything on board ; to ship a sea, when a sea breaks into a ship. To Shiver. To make the sails shake. The Slack of a Rope, $*c. That part which hangs lc/ose. To Slip a Cable. To let it run out to the end. To Slue. To turn anything about. To Sound. To find the bottom by a leaden plummet. To take a Spell. To be in turn on duty at the lead, the pump, &c. To Spill. To take the wind out of the sails by the braces, &c., in order ro reef or to hand them. To Splice. To join two ropes together, by uniting the strands. Spoon-drift. A continued flying of the spray and waves over the surface of the sea. To Spring a Mast. To crack or split it. A Spring. A rope made fast to the cable at the bow and taken in abaft, in order to expose the ship's side in any direction. Spring-tides. The highest tides at the full and change of the moon. To Stand-on. To keep in the course. To Stand-by. To be ready. Starboard. The right side. To Steer. To manage a ship by the movement of the helm. To Stopper the Cable. To keep it from running out by fasten- ing short ropes to it, called stoppers. Strand. One of the divisions of a rope. Stranded When one of the divisions of a rope is broken also when a ship is run on shore, so that she cannot be got off, Bhe is said to be stranded. To Stretch. To stand on different tacks, under a press of sail OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 28? To Strike. To beat against the bottom also to lower the flag in token of submission. Lowering the topmasts, is commonly termed striking them. To Surge the Messenger. To slack it suddenly. To Sway. To hoist up the yards and topmasts. To Swing. To turn a ship from one side of her anchor to another, at the change of the tide. To Tack. To turn a ship by the sails and rudder against (he wind. Taut. A corruption of tight. Taunt. Long, lofty. Tending. The movement of a vessel in swinging at anchor. Tier. The place where cables are coiled. Traverse. To sail on different courses. When a rope runs freely through a thimble, &c., it is said to traverse. Trying. Laying-to in a gale of wind under a small sail. Turning to Windward. Tacking. Twice-laid stuff. Rope made from the yarns of a cable, &c., which has been half-worn. To Veer and Haul. To pull a rope, and then slacken it. To Unbend. To cast loose. To Unmoor. To reduce a ship to a single anchor, after riding oy two. To Unreeve. To pull a rope out of a block. To Unrig. To deprive a ship of her rigging. To Unship. To take anything from the place in which it was rixed. Waist of a Ship. The part between the main and fore-drifts ; also a term sometimes used for the spare or waist-anchor, from its being stowed near the fore-drift, or fore part of the waist. Wake. The track left by the ship on the water which she haa jassed over. Wales. (See Bends). To Wear. To turn a ship round from the wind. To Warp. To move a ship by hawsers. Watch. A division of the ship's company, who keep the deck for a certain time. One is called starboard, and the other the larboard watch. 22 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; Water-logged. The state of a leaky ship, when she is so full of water as to be heavy and unmanageable. Way of a Ship. Her progress through the water. To Weather a Ship. To ge* to windward of her. A Weather Tide. A tide or stream which runs to windward. Weather- Beaten. Anything worn or damaged by bad weather, To Weigh. To heave the anchor out of the ground. To Whip. To bind the end of a rope with yarn to prevent its nntwisting ; also to hoist anything by a rope which is rove through a single block. Winds-eye. That point from which the wind blows in a di- rect line. Between Wind and Water. That part of the ship's bottom which is just at the surface of the water, or what is called the water-line. To Wind a Boat, $*c. To turn it round from its original position. Wind- Rode. When a ship is kept astern, &c., of her *\nohor, solely by the wind. To Windward. Towards that point from which the wind blows. To Work to Windward. To make progress against the wind by tacking. PART XI. TABLES RELATING TO RIGGING, BLOCKS, SPARS ANCHORS CABLES, T u (( ( (( 20 18 16 13 12 10 1 3 1 17 26 6 IG 18 19 120 6 II 9 12 HAWSERS OF 130 FATAOMS. 120 5* " 7 3 7 120 5 ** G 2 1 130 Fathoms of 6* inch weighs 13 1 11 120 4* " 5 23 130 6 < 11 1 13 120 4 ti 4 18 130 5* ' 9 2 2 120 3* " 3 1 2-2 130 5 ' 7 3 19 120 3 M 2 2 11 130 4* < 6 1 22 120 2* 1 3 130 4 ' 5 14 120 " 2 1 1 4 130 3k ' 3 3 7 6O5. A Table showing the comparative Strength be- tween Iron Chains and Hemp Cables, Also the Size required agreeably to Tonnage, with the Weight equal to Cable. SIZE OF CHAIN. Vessel's Tonnage. Size of Rope. Weight of Anchor. Proof required. Weight pel Fathom. Five-sixteenths of an inch - - - _ 2* _ I ton. 5* % Three-eighths " ... 3* .. n 8 Seven-sixteenths ' ... _ 4 2k 11 One-half ' - - - 20 4| licwt. 3 14 Nine-sixteenth ' - - - 30 5i 2 4* 18 Five-eighths ' ... 40 6* 2k G 24 Eleven-sixteenths ' ... 50 7 3 7 28 Three-quarters ' ... 60 7| 4 9 32 Thirteen-sixteenths ' - - - 75 Sk 4i 11 38 Seven-eighths ' . _ _ 95 91 5J 13 44 Fifteen-sixteenths ' ... 120 10 6 15 50 One inch. -. . . 150 10? g KC One and one-sixteenth inch - - 180 L\Jf iH 9 19 oo 6'J One and one-eighth inch - - - 210 12 10* 21* 70 One and three-sixteenths inch 240 12| 12 24 78 One and one-quarter inch - - - 280 13 13* 27 86 One and five-sixteenths inch - - 320 14* 15 30 96 One and three-eighths inch - - 360 15 16k 33 108 One and seven-sixteenths inch - 400 15| 18 36 115 One and one-haJ* in"h - - - 450 16 20 40 125 23 300 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 301 5 o 7. Cordage Table, showing the Weight of one Fathom Rope, from 1 inch to 24 inches inclusive, plain laid 3-strand, such as used for running rigging, &c. Size Rope. ibs. oz. Size Rope. Ibs. 02. 1 inch weighs- - - - .3$ 9 inch weighs- - - 18.1 Of 1* " " - - - -5$ 1* " .-- - .81 9* " " ... - 2o!l3i 1-3. H " - 114- 14 * 4 9$ Ct .... 21.141 2 < - - - - .14$ 10 .... 23.1* 21 . - - 1.21 101 n it .... 24.3* 2* " ... - 1.7 10* " .... 25.7 2$ .... l.ll^ 10$ " .... 26.111 3 - - - - 2.1* 11 " .... 27.14* 31 " .... 2.7 111 l: U .... 29.1* 3* " ... - 2.13* 11*- " .... 30.9 3$ " .... 3.2f 11$ " " .... 31.14 4 < .... 3.11 12 " .... 33.3 4* " " ... - 4.1$ 12i " it .... 34.9^ 4* " " -..- 4.10f 12*- " " .... 36. 4$ ...- 5.3$ 12$ " " .... 37.8 5 " - --- 5.12} 13 ..-- 38.15 51 " " - - - - 6.51 13i " .... 40.8t 5* " " ...- 7. 13* " .... 42. 5$ " " ..-. 7.9^ 13$ " .... 43.9 J- 6 " " . - - - 8.4$ 14 " .... 45.4$ 6i ...- 9. 15 " " .... 52.0* 6* " " - - - - 9.11$ 16 " - - - - 59.5 6$ " .... 10.8 17 " .--- 66.10 7 " ... - 11.41 18 " .... 74.10 71 " " .... 12.2 19 " " .... 83.2 7* " - - - - 13.0$ 20 .-.. 92.11 73. " " - - - - 13. 131 21 " .-.. 102.1 8* " " - - - - 14.12* 22 - - - - 112. 8i " " .-. - 15.11* 23 " .... 122.3 8* " ..- - 16.10* 24 " " . - - - 134.6 ?J '< .... 17.10* /?wk to find the weight of any sized Rope. A rope of 1 inch circumference re- quires 486 fathoms to make one hundred weight. The superficial part of all cir- cles being in proportion to the square of their diameters, consequently the square of their circumference. Therefore, a rope of 1 inch in circumference, whose square is one, has 486 fathoms to a cwt. ; and, therefore, 486 being divided by the sonare of the circumference of any rope, the quotient will give the number of fathoms. For instance, 9X9 = 81)480(6. The number of fathoms in a cwt. 486 Rule to find the weight of 120 fathoms oj any sized Cable. Multiply the circum- ference by the circumference, and divide the product by 4, and the quo jent will be the number of "^ts. in 1*20 fathoms. 302 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; bo -Q -j, spnoiqg -9 -j. tejsijOBa -K J. spnoiqg -HI -j spnoiqg q q q q q q q q q T}< CO lO * l^ Ci CO t^* *O CO CO O t^* ^-^ r-( O O t-H ^-i Ci Ci 00 Ci Ci Ci Ci CD 00 qqqqq qqqqqcqq qq c3SS S^^^S^i & ooooo cooococooq q.. ?i 8SS 3 OOOOO OOOOCOCOO 000 qqqcoq qqqqqcpcp qqco co o' 2 CO "S 2 x o spnwqg -9 -j. q q q cq q q q q q q q q q q q q a qqqqo ooocoocio ooo qqqqq qqqcocoqo SSJcttSSS g^^.^cioco spnojqg ^ - ooooo -9 -j. spnojqg '9 'X re !, ooooo ooooooo ooooooo q q q CO' l-H "^ spnoaqg'ivr-x' fi 8SS8S spnojijs OOOOOOO 000 OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. Madonna O O C O Tf ** CO iqawAi 00 i-i J> '-' W^SAV JOJ3J3UIBIQ 00 -H -H coi^aoci CO t^ 00 C5 < O CO TjJ OJ C llliild 3 |S co ci ci -I S 22 * 00 CO CO tO ifj CO C? -H' i i i i i i ' i i S t- ' ' 1 7 o o THE KE DGE- ANCHOR ; 51O. A Table showing the Quantity of Provisions, Slop Clothing and Small Stores, for 200 men, for four mouths, in the U, S. Navy, SMALL STORES. Tobacco (plugs) .... Soap (bars) Mustard (bottles) - - Pepper (bottles) - - - - Knives (I each") - - - - Spoons (1 each) ..... Fine Combs (1 each) ... Coarse Combs (1 each) - - Tin Pots (1 each) .... Tin Pans (1 each) .... Scrubbing Brushes (1 each) Ribbon (pieces) Tape (pieces) Needles (papers) - - - - White Thread (pounds) ~ - Blue Thread (pounds) - - Thimbles (1 each) .... Beeswax (cakes) .... Blacking (boxes)' ... - Scissors (1 pair each) - - - Shoe Brushes (1 pair each) - Mittens (1 pair each) - - - Cotton Handkerchiefs - - SLOP CLOTHING. Mattresses (1 each) - ... Blankets (2 each) - - - - 1,000 800 100 100 200 200 200 200 200 200 200 100 100 100 50 50 200 100 200 200 200 200 50 200 400 Pea-jackets 100 Trowsers (1 pair each) - - - 200 Duck Frocks (1 each) - - - 200 Duck Trowsers (2 pairs each) - 400 White Flannel Shirts (2 each) - 400 Blue Flannel Shirts (2 each) - 400 Drawers (2 pairs each) ... 400 Hats (1 each) 200 Shoes (1 pair each) ..... 200 Stockings (2 pairs each) - - - 400 Black Handkerchiefs (1 each) - 200 Boots (1 pair each) .... ^00 PROVISIONS. Bread (pounds) 22,320 Beef (pounds) 14,652 Pork (pounds) 10,914 Flour (pounds) 1,819 Raisins (pounds) ..... 910 Tea (pounds) 400 Sugar (pounds) 3,210 Rice (pounds') 3,636 Beans (pounds) 5,460 Pickles (pounds) 1,819 Vinegar (gallons) 222 Spirits (gallons) 750 Allowing per cent age for waste-. N. B. All recruits, when received on board of receiving-ships of the U. S. Navy, are required to have an outfit in slop clothinj-, &e ., of one blue clcth jacket, o ne pair of blue cloth trowsers, 2 duck frocks, one pinr of clack trowsers, two blue flannel shirts, one pair of drawers, one hat, one pail of shoes, two pairs of stock- ings, one black silk handkerchief, two pounds of tobacco, two pounds of soap, one knife, one tin pot, pan and spoon ; the greater part of which they have when transferred to vessels for sea-service. This being the case, there is no necessity for having the full amount, as above stated, in slops and small stores in the pur- ser's department, for issue in the course of four months. QUANTITY OF WATER FOR EACH CLASS. Ships of the Line Three Decks, 110,000 gallons ; Two Decks 1st Class, 82,000 gals. ; 2d Class, 78,000 gals. ; Razees, 55,000 gals. ; Frigates 32 Pounder, 48,000 gals. ; 24 Pounder, 43,000 gals. ; 18 Pounder, 34,900 gals. ; Sloops 32 Pounder, 21,000 gals. ; 24 Pounder, 19,000 gals. ; Sixteen 32 Ib. Carronades, 15,000 gals. ; Brigs, 8,000 gals. ; Brigantines and Schooners 7,900 gals. ; Steamers 1st Class, 23,500 gals. ; 2d Class, 10,000 gals.; 3d Class, 5,000 gals.; Receiving Vessels Ships of the Line, 14,600 gals. OR YOUNQ SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 305 511. Exhibit of the Navy Ration, Showing the component parts for each day of the week, and the value at which they are to be computed, under the 2d } kth and 5lh Sections of the Act of Congress, " To establish and regulate the Navy Ration," ap proved 29th August, 1842. Days of the Week. Pounds. Ounces* Pints. 1 1 j i i .i K 1 Raisins or dried fruits. s| 1! 0.0 i i | 14 14 14 14 14 14 14 f. jS o 5 Either. i = c c _C I 1 1 1 3 X i I i 1 i i i 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 i i i i i t i 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 2 i i - _ Monday ------ 1 i 1 1 1 4 1 1 i ~ i Priil a v " , _ . 2 2 i * i Weekly Quantity - - - 1 * i 93 14 if F 4 4 U i i if VALUATION OF THE WEEKLY QJJANTITY, &c. 14 ? 4 U 3 pounds of Pork Beef Flour Rice Raisins, &c. - , Pickles, &c. - 98 ounces of Bread - - - 4 Sugar ... 8 Tea ) Coffee > of same val. 80 Cocoa ) Butter - - - 23 Cheese - - - 16 14 pints of Beans - - - 24 Molasses - - 64 Vinegar - - - 20 Spirits - - - 64 7| cents per pound, 6 4 cc u 3 13 " " 12* gallon Averaging 20 cents per day, or weekly - - 22 cents. - 24 . 4 - 3 8! - 4 - 4J - If - 14 $1.40 THE foregoing exhibit of the component parts, &c., of the Navy Ra- tion, has been compiled in pursuance of the act of Congress, and will be strictly observed by commanders of vessels and by pursers, as a regulation of this Department, prescribing the daily issue of provisions, and the valuation at which they are to be commuted. All persons " attached to vessels for sea -service," are entitled individually to one ration per day. Every commissioned or warrant-officer, of, or over, twenty-one years of age, may, at his option, commute the entire ration, or only the spirit 306 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; portion of it : provided the commutation, in either case, be made foi not less than three consecutive months. And every other person, of the above-named age, entitled to a ration, may commute the spirit component, under the limitation of time, unless sooner detached, or entitled to a discharge. No officer or other person, under twenty-one years of age, shall be permitted to draw the spirit part of his ration. Its value in money, as estimated by the foregoing table, will be credited to him by the purser, and paid whenever ihe commander of the vessel, to which such officer or person may belong, shall direct. The messes of a ship's crew may, with the sanction of the command- ing officer, commute, daily or weekly, one or more entire rations, for not less than three months (unless sooner detached, or entitled to a discharge) j the commutation to be paid by the purser, at such times as the said commanding officer shall deem fit. Pursers having the delivery of rations, will make out and transmit, monthly and otherwise, by the earliest opportunities, to the Bureau of Provisions and Clothing of this Department, abstracts of provisions, agreeably to such forms as may be furnished to them from that bureau, approved by the Second Comptroller of the Treasury ; their provision accounts, as heretofore, will be rendered to the Fourth Auditor's office. A. P. UPSHUR, Secretary of the Navy. AN ACT TO ESTABLISH AND REGULATE THE NAVY RATION. SEC. 1. .Be it enacted by the Senate and House of Representatives of the United States of America, in Congress assembled. That the navy ration shall consist of the following daily allowance of provisions for each person: One pound of salted pork, with half a pint of peas or beans ; or one pound of salted beef, with half a pound of flour, and a quarter of a pound of raisins, dried apples, or other dried fruits ; or one pound of salt beef, with half a pound of rice, two ounces of butter, and two ounces of cheese ; together with fourteen ounces of biscuit, one quarter of an ounce of tea, or one ounce of coffee, or one ounce of cocoa, two ounces of sugar, and one gill of spirits ; and of a weekly allowance of half a pound of pickles or cranberries, half a pint of molas- ses, and half a pint of vinegar. SEC. 2. And be it further enacted, That fresh meat may be substituted for salt beef or pork, and vegetables or sauer-kraut for other articles usually issued with the salted meats, allowing one and a quarter pounds of fresh meat for one pound of salted beef or pork, and regulating the quantity of vegetables or sauer-kraut, so as to equal the value of those articles for which they may be substituted. SEC. 3. And be it further enacted, That, should it be necessary to vary the above described daily allowance, it shall be lawful to substitute one pound of soft bread, or one pound of flour, or half a pound of rice, for OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 307 fourteen ounces of biscuit ; half a pint of wine for a gill of spirits; half a pound of rice for half a pint of peas or beans ; half a pint of beans or peas for half a pound of rice. When it may be deemed ex- pedient by the President of the United States. Secretary of the Navy, commander of a fleet or squadron, or a single ship, when not acting under the authority of another officer on foreign service, the articles of butter, cheese, raisins, dried apples (or other dried fruits), pickles and molasses may be substituted for each other and for spirits ; pro- vided the article substituted shall not exceed in value the article for which it may be issued, according to the scale of prices which is or may be established for the same. SEC. 4. And be it further enacted. That in cases of necessity the daily allowance of provisions may be diminished or varied, by the discretion of the senior officer present in command ; but payment shall be made to the persons whose allowance shall be thus diminished, according to the scale of prices which is or may be established for the same ; but a commander, who shall thus make a diminution or variation, shall report to his commanding officer, or to the Navy Department, the necessity for the same, and give to the purser written orders, specifying particu- larly the diminution or reduction which is to be made. SEC. 5. And be it further enacted, That no commissioned officer, or midshipman, or any person under twenty-one years of age, shall be allowed to draw the spirit part of the daily ration ; and all other per- sons shall be permitted to relinquish that Dart of their ration, under such restrictions as the President of the United States may autho- rize ; and to every person who, by this section, is prohibited from drawing, or who may relinquish, the spirit part of his ration, there shall be paid, in lieu thereof, the value of the same in money, accord- ing to the prices which are or may be established for the same. SEC. 6. And be it further enacted, That the provisions of this act shall go into effect, in the United States, on the first day of the succeeding quarter after it becomes a law ; and in vessels abroad, on the first day of the succeeding quarter after its official receipt ; and any acts, 01 parts of acts, which may be contrary to, or inconsistent with, the pro- visions of this act, shall be and are hereby repealed. BERTH-DECK, OR SAILORS 7 MESS-TABLE. 308 I'HE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 512.-TABLE For finding the Distance of an Object by two Bearings, ami the Distance run between them. 1"=? Ill DIFFERENCE BETWEEN THE COURSE AND FIRST BEARING IN POINTS 111 OF THE COMPASS. ! COM 2 ^ 3 34 4 44 5 54 6 64 7 74 8 4 9 | 9* 10 54 I 4 1.00 44 0.81 1.23 5 0.69 1.00 1.45 54 0.60 0.85 1.17 1.66 6 0.54 0.74 1.00 1.35 1.85 64 0.49 0.67 0.88 1.14 1.50 2.02 7 0.46 0.61 0.79 1.00 1.27 1.64 2.17 7J 0.43 0.57 0.72 0.90 1.11 1.39 1.77 2.30 8 0.41 0.53 0.67 0.82 1.00 1.22 1.50 1.87 2.41 84 0.40 0.51 0.63 0.76 0.92 1.09 1.31 1.58 1.96 2.50 9 0.39 0.49 0.60 0.72 0.85 1.00 1.18 1.39 1.66 2.03 2.56 94 0.38 0.48 0.58 0.69 0.80 0.93 1.08 1.25 1.46 1.72 2.08 2.60 1 10 0.38 0.47 0.57 0.66 0.76 0.88 1.00 1.14 1.31 1.51 1.76 2.11 2.61 104 0.38 0.47 0.56 0.65 0.74 0.84 0.94 1.06 1.19 1.35 1.55 1.79 2.12 2.60 11 114 12 0.39 0.40 0.41 0.47 0.48 0.49 0.56 0.56 0.57 0.64 0.63 0.64 0.72 0.71 0.71 0.81 0.79 0.78 0.90 0.87 0.85 1.00 0.95 0.92 1.11 1.05 1.00 1.24 1.15 1.08 1.39 1.27 1.18 1.57 1.41 1.29 1.80 1.58 1.41 2.11 1.79 1.57 2.56 2.08 1.76 2.50 2.03 2.41 124 0.43 0.51 0.58(0.65 0.71 0.77 0.830.90 0.97 1.03 1.11 1.20 1.291.41 1.55il.72 1.96 The Table is to be entered with the number of points con- tained between the ships head and the first bearing of the object, at the top, and with the number of points, reckoned the same way, between the ship's head and the second bearing, at the side ; the number in the table at the intersection of the two col- umns being multiplied by the distance run, is the distance from the object at the time the last bearing was taken. EXAMPLE. A Light-house bears N. W., and after running W. by S. 8 miles, it bears N. N. E. ; the number of points be- tween W. by S. and N. W. is 5, and that between W. by S. and N. N. E. is 11 ; then under 5 points at the top, and abreast of 11 points at the side, stands the number 0.9, which being multi- plied by 8 gives 7.2 miles, the distance at the time of the last (N. N. E.) bearing. If the bearings are observed to quarter points, the numbers ma)' be taken out accordingly ; this needs no example. OS. YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 309 513. Dimensions of the Masts and Spars of the U, Si Steam-ship Princeton. Above Deck. 49 ft. 2 in. Fore-mast, 70 ft. Head, 12 ft. Diameter, 24 in 53 ft. Main-mast, 74 ft. " 12 ft. " 25 in, 46 ft. 8 in. Mizen-mast, 54 ft. 6 in. " 10 ft. " 18i in. Fore and Main Top-mast, 42 ft. " 7 ft. 6 in. Cap, 14-J- in. Do. Top-gallant M., 22 ft. Hoist, 14 ft. 6 in. Royal 9 ft. Pole-cap, 8-J- in. Mizen Top-mast, 33 ft. Head, 5 ft. 6 in. Cap, 1 1 in. " Top-gallant Mast, 18 ft. Hoist, 12 ft. Royal, 7 ft. Pole, 6f in. Fore and Main Yard, - - - Top Yard,- - Ft. In. 68. -.-. 54. .... FL In. Inch. Arms, 4. Sling, 15 " 4.6 13 " Top-gal't Yard, " Royal Yard, - 37. .... 25.6 - - - - 2.6 7* 1.3 " 5$ Mizen Yard, - 54. .... " 4.6 " 13 Top Yard, ... - 39. - - - - " 3.6 " 9 " Top-gallant Yard, - - 26.6 - - - - " 1.9 " 6i " Royal Yard, - - - - 19. --- - < 1. ".4 Bowsprit (Outboard), - - - 25.6 -..- - Bed, 25 Jib-boom " - - - 24. Inb'd, 20 ft. Head, 3. Cap, 13$ Flying " ... 19. .... " 5. " 8 Spanker-boom, . - - . . 47.6 - - - - " 2. Slings, 9 Spanker-gaff, 39. -..- " 8. 7 Swinging-booms ----- 45.6 .... ... "8 Top-mast Steering-sail Booms, 35. .... ... "7 T. G. M. 28. -..- ... "5$ Royal " 19. --.. ... 3| Lower Yards, 17. - - - - ... "5 Top-mast " " 21. - - - - ... "5 T. G. M. " " 16. .... ... 4 Royal " 10. --.- --. 3 Mizen Try-sail Mast, - - - 38. .... - - 7i Ft In. The Fore-mast from top of deck to top cf kelson is buried, - 20. 4 The Main-mast " " - 20. 7 The Mizen-mast " - 7.10 Which leaves the Fore-mast just - - 69. 8 And the Main-mast, 73. 7 Length between perpendiculars, - . 156. Length of Spar-deck, 165. 2 Length of Keel, - 142. 9 Extreme breadth of Beam, 30. Depth of Hold to Spar-deck, 21. 8 Dead rise at half breadth, ... 2. 3 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; i !- j- M QJ .^ r OH g | . O ?.s *M S3 10 . c5 != * -e "be 1 c d fee J "- 1 ^3' "3 2 O K.2 .s f- $3 y^^ QJ OS 1 S ts a ^ g ^ B K d ? d s 3 | O l^ Ha .^ 5 ^ 5 S3 E 3 .j 8 M KW KW (* ^j 3r5 * j o Id 1- .9" 5 O !~ "53 ^ u . g Sd |d Is w -g^ tv( KfcO ^ ^ Ut-w * "W ^^ s o*^ S3 p rt d 3 h w "" " " l.g Id '3 5.2 | a, 5 |^? -^ |,i e^T 93 'do o b cc *0 35 c8 g a> H O o 4 h g t 1 i 3 * . "S ^! ^ 1 S I i 1 P 1 rf ^ 7 02 1 ** J3 gi.i 'OS ^"""MW 9 i5 ^ "s a^^^w t^irt w ! v* 5 ig 8 6 s^l^ ^ bJ0 wOS|w ogg^o 02. 2^ ^.SSP^cjH H ^ 1 1 I . S 1 A ^ 1 r 1 1 1 1 1 1 s s t 5fO^ W02O? M Preventer Slings for Yards Guys for duarter-boat's Dav Topping-lifts to Cluaner Da 1 OR YOUNG SAILORS ASSISTANT. 311 2 -d :- , 8 H ^3 ' *^ ^^ i BLOOPS. jl * a S %Z *" .S 5 < w 5 o ^= ^. -a ) 5 q ID | : 2 2 r . " ** JD 1 2 dHJ ^ *o rf S 5 K .s t s "* ^ 5-J V ^3 tiT 1 ' rt "2 o ^O -* ^O ( 1 9 03 3P i 3 H 2 J 13 J _ "^ rl "** J H ?3 1. "s ** : 5 i p fc O ^ ^r .=-3 . | * - - 3- * 03 CH i * ^ 1 } ; i 1 1 l-->| ' ^ ' ' ' V - X : 1 : i i i 1 - ^ ? ^ > s j i > * 1 rt ^ &| S JH 5 3 j g S ' o ^ S S | S > I i | i 2 fco 1 s ! 1 ! ! 1 ! ! ! 1 = ! i 1 ^ S g S 1 ' 1 | I > i 1 . 1 . 1". I 03 C2 r/> bO flj ^ ^ cj* ^ O 1 1 i i ^ ^ ^ ' 5 i i I a d I .9 I a o 1 "8 o c O 312 5 15.- -A Table showing the Dimensions of the Masts FRENCH SHIPS AS PUBLISHED, AND Three-deck Ships. Two-deck Ships. AMERICAN. ENGLISH. FRENCH. First Class. AMERICAN. ENGLISH. i i i | i 1 i 1 i I J 3 1 Q 3 5 3 1 3 Q Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. Inch Ft In. Inch Ft In. Inch. Ft. In. Inch Length of Lower-deck - - _ _ 205. _ 206.6 _ _ 193.10 _ Breadth Extreme - - - - 54.6 - 59.6 - 51.5 - Main Mast to the hound - 132. 41, 106.7 41 109.8 41* 124.6 40. 101.7 39i Main Mast head - - - - 22. _ 20.7 _ 18.1 20. _ 19.8 MainTop-mast to the hou jd Main Top-mast head - - 70. 12. 21.5 64.11 10.1 22 68.5 9.4 23f 70. 12. 21.5 59.8 9.7 20| Main Top-gallant Mast to thp HnnnH 41. 12. 33. 1 O 1 35.2 1 ^3. 41 12. 30.5 1 1 1 Main Top-gallant Mast s 5 !(* 11 j -i _ 24. 9.5 23. iq o 24 q z. 91 fi Fore Mast to the hound 120. 37. 98.11 38 &r*4B 102.2 39| <0% 115. S7t) 36.5 10.1 .0 92.6 37 Fore Mast head - - . - 20. _ 19.1 _ 17. 18. _ 18.6 _ Fore Top-mast to the hound Fore Top-Mast head - - 63. 10.6 21.5 52.2 9.2 22 62.10 8.6 23| 63. 10.6 21.5 53.10 8.8 20| Fore Top-gallant Mast to 0,76 12. 30.1 Qfl 1 1 . 376 12 264 in Fore Top-gallant Mast O /.U OU.I 1 * ' ' ' ll/ 22. 87 1 21. 22. 8.7J 20. Mizen Mast to the hound - 110. <->. i 2 27. 73.4 25 76.7 37i 105. 26.5 71.2 25! Mizen Mast head - - - 17. _ 12.9 _ 11.8 _ 16. _ 12.10 MizenTop mast tothe hound Mizen Top-mast head - - 55. 9. 16.5 46.6 7.4 14J 48. 6.4 14f 55. 9. 16.5 43.9 7. 14 Mizen Top-gallant Mast to the hound * 33.6 9.5 22. Q jl 07 11 Q * 33.6 Q ^ 21 7 Q 1 Mizen Top-gallant Mast * & i . 1 1 ? J0J. 4 20. 7. 15. U1 1 Qfl 7 17 fi 24. 109.3 . JL 1 m 1 &\J 107 fi /. OQ K i / .0 Fore Yard ------ 100. 23! 22! . 106.6 251 lv/ / .O 96. KftSf 21.5 89.9 21 i Cross-Jack Yard - - - - 80. 16. 18.8 92. m 80. 16. 74.3 16 Main Top-sail Yard - - 82. 18. 78.8 16 8-2.4 17 78. 17.5 74.3 16 Fore Top-sail Yard - - - 75. 16. 69. 78.6 17 71. 16. 64.8 13| Mizen Top-sail Yard - - 52. 11. 52.6 11 60.8 52. 11. 49. 10J Main Top-gallant Yard - 5S, 10. 51.10 10* 54.4 m 52. 10.5 46. 91 Fore Top-gallant Yard 48. 9.5 46.3 9 1 48.11 9 46. 9.5 38.10 8 Mizen Top-ga.lant Yard - 33. 6. 36.3 7| 42.7 8* 33. 6.5 34. 7 81. 75.1 37 74.6 40! 78. 71.11 36 Sprit-sail Yard - - - - 52. 11, 69. 14| 72.5 16-L 52. 11. 64.8 13J Spanker Boon. - - - - 60. '13. 74.4 14| _ _ 60. 13. 70.2 13J /~f_ Of QQ q f%P^ Q 1 9l oo A Q GO. fin. 7. Cap 4fi 3 qi fiM 1 1 17 fin U1 141 and Yards of American, English and French Ships* 313 REDUCED TO ENGLISH MEASURE. Two-deck: Ships. Frigates. 1st Class. 2d Class. AMERICAN. ENGLISH. FRENCH. FRENCH. AMERICAN ENGLISH. FRENCH. 1st Class. 3d Class. 5 j j J ^ ~ J j o gj j j 5 4 +3 jj 3 i % I * | ? 1 M I c 1 1 | g 1 a a 3 a a a a - Q 1 a | 3 a 3 ~ 3 a Fu In. Inch Fu In. Inch. Fu In. Inch Fu In. i^I Fu In. Inch. Fein Inch. Fu In. Inch Fu In- neb 191.8 _ _ _ 176. 179.11 _ _ _ _ _ 151.5 _ 151.2 50. - - - 47.6 - 47. - - - - 40.1 38.4 105.5 33} 117. 36.5 93. 36 95.8 36f 105. 34.6 95. 31.5 77.6 28 81.2 29} 17. 20. _ 18. _ 15.11 18. _ 16. _ 15. 13.1 65.5 21! 70. 21.5 56.2 19} 60.2 20} 63. 19.3 56. 17. 46.10 16} 52.10 I7i 9. 10. - 9.1 9. 9.7 - 9.6 - 7.6 - 7.11 34.2 11! 41. 12. 29.0J 11 33. 11} 37.6 11. 33.6 10. 23.8 9 30.11 101 18.1 - 24. 9.5 21. - 13. - 22. 8.8 20. 6.6 19. - 17. 95.11 36? 105. 33. 84.9 88.5 3g t 95. 31.5 86. 28. 71.1 25 7-2.1 265 15.11 18. _ 16.6 _ 14.11 _ 16. _ 14.6 _ !?.9 _ 12.1 59.11 21! 63. 21.5 50. _ 57.11 56. 19.3 51. 17. 41.6 16} 48.1 17^ 8.2 10.6 - 8. - 7. 9.6 - 8.4 - 6.8 7.2 29.10 I0i 37.6 12. 25.3i 9f 29.10 Hi 33.6 11. 30. 10. 20.5 7! 27.8 101 \ 15.11 - 22. 8.7i 19.6 - 10.7 - 20. 7.5 18. 6.6 17.6 - 14.11 67.11 24| 93. 26. 66.7 23f 57. 19 84. 24. 76. 20. 57. 19 57.6 19} 10.7 16. _ 11.1 9.11 _ 12.4 _ 11. 9.11 9.6 46.5 13! 53. 16. 41.4 13 45.10 13! 46.4 13.5 41. 12. 35.6! Us 38.5 12! 5.11 5.9 - 6.8 - 5.4 6.8 - 6. - 5.8! - 6.4 29.10 33.6 9.5 21.0| 8 29.7 7f 24.6 8.5 21. 6.5 17.11J 65 21.4 7| 10.7 - 20. 7. 17. - 9.6 - 16.6 14. 4.6 15.6 - 10.7 106.6 26| 105. 23.5 96.8 22f 97.11 27! 95. 20. 86.6 19. 81.9 18| 85.2 20! 96.6 90. 21. 84.8 89.5 24 84. 18.5 76. 18. 71.5 L6| 74.6 17i 96.9 I8i 80. 16. 70.6 14f 89.5 66. 14. 65.1 13. 59. 12] 58.6 12} 79.10 17 77. 17. 70.6 14! 74.6 15 71.6 16. 65. 15. 59. 12} 61.9 12* 6-2.11 15S 67. 15. 61.6 12j 66. 14 r 62. 14.7 57. 13. 53.4 Hi 54.4 11} 55.4 91 49. 11.3 46.1 19f 66. 13! 45. 10. 40. 9. 40.8 8} 47.11 8} 50. 8} 51. 10.5 45.10 9} 47.9 7! 45. 9.5 40. 8. 37.6 7i 40.5 71 44.8 7i 45. 9.4 40. 8J 4-2.7 7| 41. 9. ,38. 7.5 32.11 6} 35.4 6J 38.4 61 32. 7. 32. 6| 36.6 30. 6. 126. 5.2 28. 5i 30.10 6f 69.2 37} 72. 61.6 12! 66. 24| 66. - 60. _ 53.4 Hi 55.4 271 71.4 U6j 49. 10.5 61.6 12f 64.11 44.6 10. 140. 9. 53.4 Hi 53.6 HI 48.11 6|. 60. 13. 66. I2f 47.11 5! 50. 11. 45. 10. 55.8 11 - - 33. 9. 50.2 in - 32. 8. 30. 7. 4-2.5 10 56.5 13| "Cap 51. 16.3 40. 84 53.2 13} 50. Cap. 14.3 145. Cap. 13. - _ , 58.6 12| 314 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; 5io. A Table showing the Complement of Officers and Crew allowed to Vessels of each Class, U.S.N, Remarks. 1^ 11 si 15 4 3 F C S' S 111 HiNOwaaj AVjl ^Xqpa^n^sv 00 C5 C5 Ci | Receiving 1 Vessels. U81P2UIS uapio juioads Xg ' ' c MplHi japjo jinoads ig ' ' 1 1 S cS Steamers. VPOPI 1 till 1 -<^ 1 1 1 1 rH rH | r-t | rH^H 2 9 , w i ^CQ^ | _ | ^ | _H^ | ^, S | 6SU13 JSl , Q -^l ,H^^^^ S| gjatiooiios 'jy | | sani^uisSiJfi | ^ '- '?, ' ' '- rH | rH | Ol rH a s -.SHB i ^H (M -H 1 rH | ^CO 1 1 1 1 rH r- 1 rH | (?} rH 3 J | Sloops. qf 28 '91 ' 1 """ |rHOr.r.rHrHr. Jj uapunoj K; i _CO-HrHrH i _ i> r-, rH rH rH rH ^^ o M w uapunoj se rH ' | Frigates. jopunoj gi l-H rH 60 *S Mapunoj K 11 & & T3 (3 uapunoj gs l-H o S 8 aaz H 5 o O Jj 1 'BSTJIO PS - [25 -g C J r? 316 "Q J25 5 u3 OB J2 w rfS OR "3 $ > 5 d a? THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; *|t| Kill HXNOWHadAYJ ^^ Xq sy I W 1 H * uapio . J9pjo TT auiq i i r t i i i i 8ST3JO PC Gg I I ~ ~ CT - . 1 -KM 1 1 1 1 1-1 d O< CQ 00 00 -"Ill --o te 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 J 1 1 1 1 1 1 japunoj J5 o O ^o i-( CO CO T-I I-H O l-ll iCO '88^0 PS |0 -H GO CO 1 1 1 1 1 1 o i i i i i rt 1 w 1 OJ ! i J> Q^ ffi ^ I II . M* Total Total OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 317 c |0 O s S.S~ ? S a TO g i- cj ^ 2|J 5^ I S' 5 o .g 1 a .- ^ ^ S S-H O g So .15 O g S o 2 2 o S'^'5 | ^J O ,_ C -3 g..Sj8 g ^ O TO 'S .S "^ G.2 S S o .22 d ' 2"^ OQ nd .G c3 sf >> ^ 4 p .^ *r3 SH g* -C ON M ^ W . TO .2 ^ J jf 13 | o fe 1 Si S*s ^ S * TO c i rf CU g -3 IS __ b) ^ 15 rt S ^ 1 e ' < o o v-, ^ o O r *xs 00 * rr\ nZ* 1 *** -" It I &W S I a O - - - II s 6 ,2 6 TO .2 c Uf 318 517. A Table of Spars, &c., fof Names of the Ships of the Line. Razees. THREE DECKS. TWO DECKS. 1st Class. 2d Class. different Spars. 4 1 1 4 ', 1 _a J 1 | . 1 1 i g M B 1 i 1? 1 a 3 .22 5 1 3 P 1 3 3 1 3 p } Ft. In. neh \. In. Ft. In. Inch. "\. in. Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. rt [ n Inch. Ft. lu Main Mast - - - 32. 12.7 22. 24.6 10.2 20. 117. 36.820. 13. 36.820. Main Top-mast, - - 70. 21.5 12. 70. 21.5 12. 70. 21.512. 70. 21.5 12, Main Top-gallant Mast - - - - 35. 12. _ 35. 12. - , 35. 12. _ 35. 12. . Main Royal Mast - 23.6 - - 23.6 _ - 23.6 _ _ 23.6 _ . Main Flag Pole - 9.1 4. ~ 9.f 4. - 9.f 4. - 9.! 4. - Fore mast - - - 120. 38.8 20. 115. 36.8 8. 105. 34. 18. 101. |34. 18. Fore Top-mast - - 63. 21.5 10.6 63. 21.5 10.6 63. 21.5 10.6 63. 21.5 10.6 Fore Top-gallant Mast .... 32. 12. 32. 12. _ 32. 12. _ 32. 12. _ * ore Royal Mast - 21.4 _ _ 21.4 _ _ 21.4 _ _ 21.4 _ Fore Flag Pole - - 8.6 4. - 8.6 4. - 8.6 4. - 8.6 Mizen Mast - - - 110. 27.5 17. 105. 26.5 16. 98. 26. 16. 94. 26. 16. Mizen Top-mast - 55. 15.8 9. 55. 15.8 9. 53. 15.3 9. 53. 15.3 9. Mizen Top-gallant Mast - - - - 29. 9.8 _ 29. 9.8 _ 29. 9.8 _ 29. 9.8 _ Mizen Royal Mast 19.4 _ _ 19.41 - _ 19.4 _ _ 19.4 _ Mizen Flag Pole - 7.9 3.7 - 7.9 3.7 7.9 3.7 - 7.9 3.7 - Yard Yard Yard Yad Arm Arm. Arm Arm Main Yard - - - 110. 26.4 5. 107.6125.7 5. 105. 25.3 5. 105. 25.3 5. Main Top-sail Yard 82. 20.5 7. 78. 19.5 6.6 77. 19.2 6.6 77. 19.2 6.6 Main Top-gallant Yard .... 52. 11.8 2. 52. 11.8 2. 49. 11.2 2. 49. 11.2 2. Main Royal Yard - 36. 7.2 1.6 36. 7.2 1.6 35.1 7. 1.6 35.1 7. 1.6 Fore Yard ... 100. 24. 5. 96. 23. 5. 90. 21.6 4. 90. 21.6 4. Fore Top-sail Yard 75. 18.8 6.6 71. 17.8 6. 67. 16.8 5.6 67. 16.8 5.6 Fore Top-gallant Yard .... 48. 10.9 2. 46. 10.7 2. 45. 10.5 2. 45. 10.5 2. Fore Royal Yard - 33. 6.6 1.6 33. 6.6 1.6 30.5 6.1 1.3 30.5 6.1 1.3 Cross-jack Yard - 80. 16. 7.6 80. 16. 7.6 76. 15.2 7.6 76. 15.2 7.6 Mizen Top-sail Yard 53. 11.1 4.1 53. 11.1 4.(j 49.6 10.2 4. 49.6 10.2 4. Mizen Top-gallant Yard .... 33. 6.6 I.C 33. 6.6 I.C 32. 6.4 1.6 32. 6.4 1.6 Mizen Royal Yard 23. 4.6 1. 23. 4.6 1. 21. 4.2 .1 21. 4.2 .1 Sprit-sail Yard - - i i Bow-sprit ' - - - 80. - i 78. i 72. 72. . Jib-boom - - - 60. m _ 60. 17.8; - ' 54. lie. m 54. 16. _ Flying Jib-boom 61 12. - 61. 12. - 56. 11. - 56. 11. _ Pole .... 9. - - i 9 9. - - ' 9. _ - all Classes of Vessels, I, S. 3. 319 Frigates. Sloops. 1st Class. 2dC*s, 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. j Diameter. Masthead. i j 1 3 Masthead. Diameter. j I 1 Masthead. i 1 o | Ft In. Inch. Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch. ft. In. 105. 34. 18. 95. 30.8 16. 80. 25.8 14. 75. 24.2 12. 72. 24.2 12. 63. 19.3 9.7 56. 17.4 9.6 47. 14.8 7. 45. 14.5 6.9 45. 14.5 6.9 32. 11. __ 29. 10. _ 24. 8. _ 22. 7.5 _ 22. 7.5 21.81 - 19.4 _ _ 16. _ 14.8 _ _ 14.8 _ _ 6.81 4. 7.9 3.5 - 6.5 3.5 - 6. 3. - 6. 3. - 95. 30.8 16. |86. 27.9 14.6 72. 23.3 12. 67.6 21.8 11. 64.6 21.8 11. 56. 19.3 9.6 51. 17.4 8.4 43. 14.6 6.9 42. 14.5 6.4 42. 14.5 6.4 29. 11. _ 25.8 10. _ 23. 8.3 _ 21. 7. _ 21. 7. _ 19.4 _ 17.1 _ _ 15.4 _ 14. _ _ 14. _ _ 7.9 4. - 6.10 3.5 - 6. 3.5 - 5.7 3. - 5.7 3. - 87. 24.8 12.4 79. 21. 11. 18. 10. 63.9 16. 10. 60.9 16. 10 46.4 13.3 6.8 41. 11.8 6. 11. 6. 32. 9.9 5. 3-2. 9.9 5. 24.6 8. _ 21. 7. _ 20. 6.5 _ 16. 5.3 _ 16. 5.3 _ 16.4 _ _ 14. _ _ 13.4 _ 10.8 _ _ 10.8 _ _ 6.6 3.6 - 5.7 3.3 - 5.2 3.3 - 4.3 2.8 - 4.3 2.8 - Yard Yard Yard Yard Yard Arm. Arm. Arm. Arm. Arm. 95. 22.6 4.9 86.6 20. 4.4 75. 17.5 3.9 67.6 15.9 4. 67.6 15.9 4. 71.6 17.8 6. 65. 15.5 5.5 56. 13.4 5. 52.2 12.6 5. 52.2 12.6 5. 44. 10:2 2. 40. 9. 2. 37. 8.4 2. 34. 7.6 2. 34. 7.6 2. 30. 6. 1.6 27. 5.4 1.3 25. 5. 1. 22.9 4.5 .9 22.9 4.5 .9 8-4. 20.2 4.6 76. 17.9 4. 65. 15.2 3.3 60.9 14.1 3.8 60.9 14.1 3.8 62. 15.5 5.3 57. 13.6 5. 49. 11.5 4.8 46. 11.1 5. 46. 11.1 5. 41. 9.3 2. 38. 8.5 2. 32. 7.3 1.9 30.6 6.8 1.9 30.6 6.8 1.9 27. 5.4 1.3 25. 5. 1. 22. 4.4 .9 20.6 4.1 .8 20.6 4.l| .8 66. 13.2 7. 64. 12.8 M j* 53. 10.6 4.9 51.10 10.4 4. 51.10' 10.4 4. 46. 9.5 4. 41. 8.5 4. 36.6 7.6 3.6 34.8 7.3 3.3 34.8 7.3 3.3 3C. 6. 1.626. 5.2 1.4 22.6 4.5 1.4 22. 4.4 13 22. 1 4.4 1.3 19 3.8 .9 16. 3.2 .8 15. 3. .6 14. 28 .6 14. 2.8 M 66. 60. 50. 48. 46. -1- 50. 14.8 _ 45. 13.5 _ 38. 11.2 _ 34.6 10. _ 34.6 10. - 54. 10.8 _ 45. 9. _ 40. 8. _ 38.9 7.8 _ 38.9 7.8 - S8 - - 7.9 - - 6.5 - - 6. - - 6. - 320 A Table of Spars, &c., for all Ships of the Line. Names of the THREE DECKS. TWO DECKS. Razees. 1st Class. 2d Class. different Spars. s "o s "3 3 1 "3 t 1 tl 1 1 fg ,c 1 1 ff ff s 5 s** 3 ^ 1 Q Jo, 3 I |a, Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch. FU In. Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In Main Gaff - - - 33. 8.2 _ 33. 8.2 30. 7.4 30. 7.4 M'n Top-mast Stud- ing-sail Boom - 55. 11.5 53.9 11. 52.6 11. 52.6 11. Yard for Main Top- mast Studding- sail 24. 4.8 _ 24. 4.8 _ 23.6 4.7 _ 23.6 4.7 Main Top-gallant Studd'g-sail Boom 41. 8.6 _ 39. 8.2 _ 38. 6.8 _ 38. 6.8 Yard for Main Top- gallant Studding- sail - - - 24. 4.8 ""* 24. 4.8 23.6 4.7 23.6 4.7 Fore Gaff- - - - 37. 9.2 37. 9.2 36. 8.8 36. 8.8 Lower Swinging Boom --- - 65. 13. _ 60. 12. _ 58. 11.6 58. 11.6 Yard for Lower Stud- ding-sail - - - 32.6 6.5 _ 30. 6. _ 29. 5.8 _ 29. 5.8 ^ Fore Top-mast Stud- ding-sail Boom - 50. 10.5 _ 48. 10. _ 45. 9.4 _ 45. 9.4 Yard for Fore Top- mast Studding- sail ... *J1 90 O OQ K P f Fore Top-gall't Stud- OX* ' &J.J . Jo. o.u ~ 28. o.o " ding-sail Boom - 37.6 7.8 _ 35. 7.4 _ 33.6 7. _ 33.6 7. Yard for Fore Top- gallant Studding- sail - - - - - 22. 4.4 21. 4.2 20.6 4. - 20.6 4. Spanker Boom - - Ring-tail Boom - - 60. 30. 12.5 6. - 60. 30. 12.5 6. - 57. 28.6 11.8 5.7 - 57. 28.6 H.8 5.7 - MizenGaff ... 38. 9.4 5. 38. 9.4 5. 35. 8.6 5. 35. 8.6 5 Square-sail Boom - Yard for Square- i sail .... Jack Gaff. - - . 17. 6. _ 16. 5.5 ^_ 16. 5.5J - 16. 5.5 _ Dolphin Striker - - 22. 9. 3. 20. 8.5J 3. 20. 8.5l 3 20 8.5 a Classes of Vessels, U. S. N. Continued. 321 Frigates. Sloops. 1st Class. 2d Class. 1st Class. 2d Ckss. 3d Clara. ! K~nr 98.6 47.6 1 I 3 5 1 5 Ft. In. 27. 43.3 1 5 "3 * i 5 1 .3 Q 3 If $*- 4 S 1 Q "3 tf cp S* i I 1 1 3 FTIT Inch. 7.1 9.9 Ft. lu. Inch. 6.8 9. Ft. In. Ft. In. 19.5 37.6 Inch. 5. 7.8 Ft. In. Ft. In. 17. 33.9 Inch 4.4 7. Fl. !n. Ft. In. 17. 33.9 Inch. 4.4 7. ao. 4. - 18. 3.6 - 16.6 3.3 - 15. 3. - 15. 3. - 35.9 7.4 - 32.6 6.8 - 28. 5.8 - 26. 5.4 - 26. 5.4 - 20. 4. - 18. 3.6 - 16.6 3.3 - 15. 3. - 15. 3. 33.6 8.3 _ 33. 8.2 _ 26. 6.4 _ 25. 6.2 _ 25. 6.2 _ 51.3 10.2 - 46.3 9.2 - 42. 8.4 - 40.9 8.2 - 40.9 8.2 - 25.6 5. - 23. 4.6 - 21. 4.2 - 20.4 4. - 20.4 4. - 12. 8.8 - 38. 8. - 32.6 6.8 - 30.3 6.4 - 30.S 6.4 - 25.9 5.2 - 23.6 4.7 _ 19.10 4. _ 18. 3.6 - 18. 3.6 - 31. 6.5 - 28.6 6. - 24.6 5.2 - 23. 4.9 - 23. 4.9 - 18.6 3.7 - 17. 3.4 - 14. 3.3 - 13.6 2.7 - 13.6 2.7 - 50. 25. 32. 10.5 5. 7.8 4.6 45. 22.6 30. 9.5 4.5 7.4 4.6 35. 17.6 28. 7.7 3.5 6.8 4. 34. 17. 26. 7.4 3.4 6.4 I 34. & 7.4 3.4 6.4 i _ 14. ia 4.2 7.5 i 14. 18. 4.2 7.5 2. 13. 15. 3.7 7. 2. 11. i 3.2 14. i 6.3 1.8 11. 14. 32 63 Ib 322 A Table of Spars, &c. Conducted. Names ot the Brigs. Irigautines. Schooners. different Spars. 5 1 1 % I 1 i 1 1 3 a g 5 c i a S g Ft. In. nch. Ft. In. Ft. In. Inch. X In. Ft. In. Inch. Ft. In. Main Mast - - - 72.2 22.6 12.2 76. 20. 8. 78.8 20.3 8. Main Top-mast - - 40.6 126 6.9 21. 6.3 _ 26.2 7.5 Main Top-gallant Mast .... 20.3 7.2 _ 14. 5.2 _ 13.1 5. Main Ro)^! Mast - 3.4 _ _ 6.6 Main Flag Pole - 5.4 2.5 _ 5.4 _ _ 6. 2.5 _ ( Diameter at the Fore Mast - - - 64.8 22. 11.3 55. 18.7 9.2 75.8 21.3 8. ( Truck. Fore Top-mast - - 40.6 12.6 6.9 32.6 10.4 5.6 26.2 7.5 Fore Top-gall't Mast 20.3 7.2 _ 18.3 6.8 _ 13.1 5. Fore Royal Mast - Fore Flag Pole - - 13.6 5.4 2 5 - 12. 5. 6. 2.5 ^ Diameter at the \ Truck. Mizen Flag Pole - \ Diameter at the i Truck Yard Yard Yard Arm. Arm. Arm. Main Yard - - - 59.6 14. 3. 35.6 8. 2.9 Main Top-sail Yarc 44.7 10.6 3.8 24.6 5.5 1.4 Main Top-gal't Yard Main Royal Yard - 28.4 18.11 6.5 3.6 L 9 16.3 3.2 g Fore Yard - - - 59.6 14. 3! 45. 10.1 2.9 50. 11.3 2.6 Fore Top-sail Yard 44.7 10.7 3.8 33.6 7.7 3. 33.4 7.4 2.6 Fore Top-gall't Yard 28.4 6.5 1 1 22. 4.5 1.6 22.2 4.5 1. Fore Royal Yard - Sprit-sail Yard - - 18.11 4. .i 14.9 3. Q Bow-sprit- - - - 42. _ _ 17.6 Out b'rd. 29.1 18. Jib-boom - - - - 32.5 9.51 - 14. Out b'rd. 37. 11. Flying Jib-boom - 34.5 6.8! _ 12. Out b'rd. Pole ..... P. A q 4. O.I L'gth Pole O.4 L'gth Pole. L'gth Pole. Poles to the M'n Gaffs of B;T8. Main Gaff - - - 39.8 9.8 5. 25. 8.5 5. 25. 8.5 5. Brigantines aiia Sch'ners are not M'n Top-mast Stud- ding-sail Boom Yard for Main Top- mast Studding-sai Main Top-gallant 29 12.10 6. 2.6 included in the lengths given Studd'g-sail Boom 22.3 4.6 Yard for Main Top gal't Studding-sai 12.10 2.6 Fore Gaff- - - - 25. 6.2 _ 24. 8. _ 25. 8. i Lower Swinging Boom .... 31.6 6.4 _ 22. 4.6 _. 22. 4,6 Yard for Lower Stud 1 ding-sail - - - 15.3 3. _ 11. 1 2.6 _ 11. i *.6' Fore Top-mast Stud i ding-sail Boom - 29.9 6.2 22.6 4.8 25. 5.3, Yard for Fore Top- mast Studding-sai 18.7 3.8 13.9 3. _ 14.2 3. Fore Top-gall't Stud ding -sail Boom - 22.3 4.7 _ 16.S 3.6 16.8 3.61 Yard for Fore Top gall'nt Studd'g-sai 12.10 2.6 9.6 2. _ 10.1 2.2' Spanker Boom - - Square-sail Boom - 59.6 13. - 50. 11. - 50. 11. i 97 Yard for Square-sai 22'.6 / I !R 9. 3. 9. a. 9. J. 3. ("Length tor Brijra ! and Schooners Dolphin Striker- - - - - { ffov'd by Steevo I of Bowsprit OR YOCNGr SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 323 A Cordage Table of Feet and Fathoms* Fwt.l Fath. Feet.1 Fath. IFect.1 Fath. IFeet Fath. Feet. Fath. Feet. Fath. Feet Fath. 1 30 5 155J25 5 280 46 4 405 67 3 530 88 2 655 109 1 780 130 35 5 5 160 26 4 285 47 3 41068 2 535 89 1 660 110 785 130 5 40j 6 4 165 27 3 290 48 2 415 69 1 540 90 665 110 5 790 131 4 451 7 3 170 28 2 295 49 1 420 70 545 90 5 670 111 4 795 132 3 50 8 2 175 29 1 300 50 425 70 5 550 91 4 675 112 3 800 133 2 55 9 1 180 30 305 50 5 430 71 4 555 92 3 680 113 2 805 134 I 60 10 185 30 5 310 51 4 435 72 3 560 93 2 685 114 1 810 135 65 10 5 190 31 4 315 52 3 440 73 2 565 94 1 690 115 815 135 5 70 11 4 195 32 3 320 53 2 445 74 1 570 95 695 115 5 820 136 4 75 12 3 200 33 2 325 54 1 450 75 575 95 5 700 116 4 825 137 3 80 13 2 205 34 1 330 55 455 75 5 580 96 4 705 117 3 830 138 2 85 14 1 210 35 335 55 5 460 76 4 585 97 3 310 118 2835 139 1 90 15 215 35 5 340 56 4 465 77 3 590 98 2 715 119 1 840 140 95 15 5 220 36 4 345 57 3 47U 78 2 595 99 1 720 120 845 140 5 100 16 4 225 37 3 350 58 2 475 79 1 600 100 725 120 5 850 141 4 105 17 3 230 38 2 355 59 1 480 80 605 100 5 730 121 4 855 142 3 110 18 2 235 39 1 360 60 485 80 5 610 101 4 735 122 3 860 143 2 115 19 1 240 40 365 60 5 490 81 4 615 102 3 740 123 2 865 144 1 120 20 245 40 5 370 61 4 495 82 3 620 103 2 745 124 1 870 145 125 20 5 250 41 4 375 62 3 500 83 2 625 104 1 750 125 875 145 5 130 21 4 255 42 3 380 63 2 505 84 1 630 105 755 125 5 880 146 4 135 22 3 260 43 2 385 64 1 510 85 635 105 5 760 126 4 885 147 3 140 23 2 265 44 1 390 65 515 85 5 640 106 4 765 127 3 890 148 2 145 24 1 270 45 395 65 5 520 86 4 645 107 3 770128 2 895 149 1 15025 275 45 5 400 66 4 525 87 3 650 108 2 775129 1 900 150 1 Weight of Cables of I'M) fathoms from 3 to 25 inches. Three inch cable weighs 252 pounds ; 3j inch, 336 pounds ; 4, 448 ; 4 , 560 ; 5,700; 5J, 840; 6, 1008; 6|, 1176; 7, 1340; 7|, 1568; 8, 1792; 8i, 2016; 9,2268; 9i, 2520 ; 10, 2800 ; 10*, 3080 ; 11, 3388 ; 11 J, 3696 ; 12, 4032 ; 12 J, 4368 ; 13, 4732 ; I3J, 5056; 14,5480; 14, 5880; 15, 6328; 15J, 6720; 16, 7168; 16^,7616; 17, 8092; 17J, 8568; 18, 9072; 18J, 9520; 19, 10108; 19 J, 10640; 20, 11200; 20*, 11760; 21, 12348; 21J, 12936; 22, 13452; 2?J, 14168; 23, 145*0; 23J, 15456; 24, 16128; 25, 17500. 324 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; c^ <> I ce 2 H ops ructing mensons Materials, used Cross-trees, and Caps, U. $ of showing the 5 is 9) Q ft 01 peaadBj, j sgqoui o o? co | ssainjoiqj, AND MAIN TOP. AND TOP. 1 1 1 1 - 1 (N 1 | o o CN co | 1 1 1 CO ssgujjojqj, -H (N CM I | Ci 1 1 1 1 - 1 co saqoui OJ p9J9dT?X | I CM | CO -H "-i CN CM CO I | i 00 CO FOKE AND MAIN TOP. I | | | CM 1 CO T-I -H ^ CM CM i o oo co -* i oj pga 1 1 1 CM 1 ^ i CM CO CO 1 | CO Oi CO 1O I Plank in two White Pine) Plank in two Oak - - - of White Oak hite Oak - - Pine White board of W Yello Rim of Lubber- Battons Iron Plates Upper Cros %o H r-=! /^ ^^ r g o ^ o o 3 o " ""O o "^ r ~ S sag OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT 32', 02 3 55 CQ CQ CQ O CQ f3 W rt H ei i-5 H CQ W P5 H CQ PH O H P2 C P=< M 2; o hH H P^ O PH O & o 1 fl r rf'j SJ ^H u t op-mast-. T3 to i< H li HliIlHf11!l: S e3 *^ -^ ^ _. " ? ^ r^ ^, .' --^ .-- . . (-1 s f f O r ir ir n o o S 2 o feJtJ IlJI^lHi Htiif;-iirg s th. One-half the mould s of Main Top. fths of Fore Top. n length two-thirds of fayed down on the Ba Lengt The le Depth. hree-fi Jlmidl r T/iick s.n.gih. eadth readth. read h or ickne ^^sjiln^^gsfe t 7^ rJ- K^ M V '^ , ^ e o To b Sev Sev H ard Brea H i**fe 1? i, p . ne-tent our-fift t be in ones, E-TREES r in Fo t 11 lili PH 02 " ej O CM Or~3 O ^3 C^ , K 3 Len re Dept ength a ength f readth. 326 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR ; J5 5 1 5 s I .5 xO 00 ^ ad I i> o cj to o 00 r-J T-I cc I c 1{J3U91 3 s I t W o qiSuai q;pBOjg ^ CO C} C* 1 1 1 tO O if) 00 Cl ci od i^ o co I I O O (J5^^l^r ^t 09 C9 09 01 1 1 qiSuai qjpTiaje n2uai q;d9Q qi3uaq - * T*t (M (N o ^ <<**' eo co at cJ i rj Tj co co c c I fc CO CO CO C Ci Ci CJ Ci Ci ^ O O O CO CO CO O O C fo Iso to be made of copper. be made sufficiently strong for the tes. ir, and Launches for second and tlird 1 1 rt o ,2 2J ~ ^ i 2 Sg'S.S- 1 1 asl" "S, | -| o -3 rt | "llf t cd M S - .3 ! w ts ~ ^ v ^ o r^ P3 O> *- *^ rt w"- g SV> O rQ i . jg o| s *^ rt ^ *M , o 2 =3 rt rt ^ ^s ,0 *S 'a N JvT ^ EH ^ ^ *w ^ ^ BrH bn "S ^ S c 3 | M ^.s^ fi Id irf q;5u9T - ^ __; , ' ' ' IS 1 O vft O 1 1 1 i co" I I I I ' ' ' qtfuaq L J O (?) CN i CO* 1 OJ (N CO ^-(^HI i oj | c T c 1 5 ! Weight. 000000 oooo oo OOOOOO lOOCO^O OlO 10 CO 00 I- CD ^ ^H ^ 55 irT wT -r -O'^' ^-11 i , i ^^-'S'S'S'S ^^ P 4 1 OiOJ'-H^H ^ ______ (^ t * D u s 5 * Weight. OOOOOOO OOOO OO ooooooo oxoooo 1000 o o^ o^ o^oo co xo ot - -^ "- ocT cxT <^T ^-T OOOO 00 1 1>- *O - tO (N ~H ' "-< -^ cT cT of i-T 4_( M tM f-l W *-! OOOO O 2 i % 8- | fy O O OOOOOO OOOOLOOOO O O OOOOOO OOlOOir^iOiOQO O^ O^ O^^CO^-^O fc-^ CO CM "^ ^H I-H o" o" co^'-^'-T-^' " " ^ _(<^tMSwW <-(4-i OOOOO 00 &. J tl J~*~ -J-^ Y- <^^^_ I- i A 6 w ^ t i O OQ PQ 02CQ W M OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 329 1 i 3 fl oooo CM O O CM .2 .2 .2 m .3 oWoo j V-3 S . ^ * AjJ fi | ^T^ *i i i j -..^ 000 ^ r 1 2 1 ^ ^ ^ !^CC S ^ '41 <3 ^ ^ ~ CM - ^ 1-1 CM i 1 1 5 |i CM O O CM 2 2 .2 od -fe2 * (0*000) jg ^ "* S o o o o o 1 T3 rt o B ^ !^ 4^ CM CM CM -^ >FH ' *-* .2 s 03 | ^H ^-i CM ' CM ^ ">>* k r B o o o o a a a .^ a a ^w Is i o JN O? O O CM b- J3 ^ i$ 4-l 4-l <_( O *-! f-l o o o d oo g ^ 1 ic(-.3 icj-j HT< c* j nh . co C^ 2 ^ * 0^ S g i i i i CM I-H O ~- ' CO -^ ^ s Fathoms each. oooo CM <> CM .2.2.2 -g ^ 00 ^ rt 'S'o'o -2 ^ U d ^1 i i 1 CM CM CM CO CO "^ J 3 I CM -H CM - o ^ ^ i d Class. Fathoma each. oooo C^ GO CO CM .2.2.2 -g d 00 | g 5 t} i CM ^*-* O * o o o d "S d 1 c . o 00 O Jj; D CO CM CM ^ CM CN CM * e fl ^3 Q . CM ^ CM ^ - ^ feC 3 11 e O s- 1 Fathoms each. OOOO CM GO GO CM O CO O g 3 S'S? 1 J * 9 X 1 o -^ CM CM O CM CM CM d d o J 1 CM ^ CM ^ to -^ ^* i f> *S "TS fe '/! 93 1 Q Fathoms each. OOOO 0? 00 00 CM d d d r3 r^ a 5 a | o oT CM" o CM CM CM *^ d d 5^5 H 1 CM * CM - o - o - bo 1 4 Names of Articles. CABLES. Sheets (hemp) - - - Sheets (chain) - - - Bowers (chain) - - - Stream (hemp) - - 1 III "2 j ^ e 2 E ^ 1 1 ! ^ 1 II j 330 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 8? I 1 0,22 >> I! ** i 2 II OS -al 1 |lf|f"f|lfl a ! 1 i X o o 1 O- O O SO "=* CO OOO CO 00 XO o o CO "* o .? cc CO -< *g *+ *g 1 *o 'c? n3 ^-< I" 1 ( I _ ( . S v J ^N/-^_> h V g 1 1-1 CM "^ CO '''''-' 1 CM (* o O O ooo ooo o o o o O ooo O xo VI ? CD 00 CD ^ ^-1 r-< JS | XO XO ^4 ti_, CH-, CM <*-! *4H o to c*cc/ v^v-^ b | 11 CM *"* CO r > 1 ^-1 "~ l CM o O O o o o o . o O o O xo OO Tf XO CM 2 *j XO ^ CM V p ,-T ,-T 1 1 *o *o 1 v^-v^/ C^L 1 "* CM *"^ CM , ( ^H | 1 CM o o O O O o o o o o o o XO O 00 ^ XO 0? 1 i 1 xo ^ CO +H C-M O 1 1 'S'S M v^^wx v^v-^ X ^H CM 4 CM ^ H | 1 CM PQ & o o o o o o o o o o 00 T^ XO CM +* XO CD XO CO it M Jf p-T e^-i +-< 1 1 *0 *0 'S f i ( -H H ^v^ v-^v^ | *-' CM ^ CM ^ 1- 1 1 CM . g o OOO 000 000 O xo <* o o o co fH oo OO GO xo ^ co O 'S CM 01 ooo 1 1 d 8 v-^N^-^ v^-v-vx c/2 ^ CM CM 11 CO *-H 1-^ T * 1 CM d , , , , 1 1 1 , t 41 *3 $ i Names of Arti ANCHORS, to 1 CO Bowers IM s fcJO T5 O w BOAT ANCHORS Ills III! 02 1 OR YOUNQ SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 331 1 Remarks. i ~5 a 11=3 1Mb. at the dis- cretion of the commander. Siliil j f 8 a c-c 5 d I - O O CM .2 .S .S 2 a o S O fc* 000 O "^ g w g 1 * * s CM < - v^-v-^ .2 S3 2 & | 1 ' CM ' * - 1 CM o?*~^ a i O o S3 O P p p d si VI 1 6 P 1 ' ' CD CO Ci *O O *O ^P O c o o 10 \ 1 1 1 $ H- CO CM i v^-v-^. ' 7- I* fe | I 11 (M 11 ^ *~ ' CM 11 JS i i^ S s 1 O o a , a CO ShN \ I g 1 S ^ ^ 3^/ .S *">- ^g \ i 1 1 f-H CM '' CM 1 CM II "2 >- I : OJS 1 2 O P P 1O O ^0*0 1 "S CO ^ ri i 1 1 * * fc 3UZL .2 3 wa S i a 1 1 ^ H 01 ~ H CM 1 CM ^^ cs s x be J! 1 O o 10 *o 'o , O i 1O CO li t M 2 1 1 * * oo 0^ * Js 1 1 ~* CM -^ CM 1 CM ^ Sjg CO 8 ]4 gl O CM O O o o CM P P P 10 co ^ o a* S 1 * $ C^C P o^ V^JZL * *g I H 1 "* *^ CM 1 1 CO ' CM 1 1 ii Fnthoms each. O CM o O 10 o CM .2 .S .2 10 t^ *o *o *o S P sl o i? g I -H H- ^v^/ o ^~ p co o "^ ^^ CM 11 CO *" CM *^ s OR H IVaiucs of Articles. CABLES. Sheets (hemp) - a 1 Z/2 a> DC 1 | Stream (hemp) - Hawsers (hemp) 2* g^ T 9 p o S Towlines( Manilla) S-i o 25 332 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR, 4 1 R Q 3 1 I 3 9 9 M D ^ a ^ 3 a 5 5 . S^ s* 3 I-f ?8 ?^ 2 ? f 3 u a 3 M9 a 4 I H 4 H * c^cM CM CO P^H CTCM* ^TrH* C^CM* rM'rH' CM rt* r^T CJ? 2? SBAUBQ -OM| CM CM CO 00 CM CM CO 00 CO l^ 00 t^ CO siigjo-OM| CMCMCMCM CMCOCMCM CMCMCM <7* Frigates. SECOND CLASS. Size Rope. -, S ,OH 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 III II qo 3ai TJ4 CMCM **Tf CMCM CO CM I-H CM CM 100J OOCOCM -^OCOCM T^oTr^ CM* CM PWH CM*5? ^^' SfSf -- < ^^ ct S 1 SBAUBQ'OM| .-HI-. 01" (H.-H 0*> CO COCO 00 s[U3gJO'ON| CMCMCMCM CMCOCMCM CMCMCM CMCM FIRST CLASS. Size Rope. 1OH i i i i i i i i iii it '^090! iC T}< CMCM iO * CMCM CO CM -H CM CM jooj ^n vri co CM o o* co 9) TJ? CM'^) CM CM* p B9H COCO CM ^ COCO CM ^ CM* ^^T CM* 2* SBAUBO'OM| TH r-i ift 1- CMi-iknt- CO 000 CO Sl!BSJO-ON| CMCM CMCM CMCOCMCM CM CMCM CMC* Razees. Size Rope. ItfOfl 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 III II qo99T to TH O^CM O*TJ? cJ ^!J jj- CM J!lT CM" CM* JOOj Otfi rtI| i-Hr-i^i.^ CM 1-1 rt< I CMiOOO COtft S|IT3gJO'OM| CMCM CMCM CMCOCMCM CM CMCM CM CM 1 Ships of the Line. Size Rope. ;sjo H 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 III II M099T W3? 5?C^ S'^ CM* CM CO CM- Si C> ? oo d CO CO TJH ST ifTco ^5? vO C^CM C^" C?5T pB9 H (fo CO CM ~ CO CO CM ^T C? ^^ CM" O> fc't'AUKQ O\[ I i ii t ^i^ i 1 i ( rjt - CM OOO O >O s l! B SJ 'N |CMCMCMCM CMCOCMCM CMCMCM CMC* Names of Sails. is it it 1 fefeS g^ ^ SS 3c OR YOUMG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 333 QQ I- H 1 ~f. SECOND CLASS. to w 1 1 CMCOCT5? -N- ^n CM CM CO CO CO CO qooa-l 2J CM W* CM CM CM CM CM CM CO CO CM CO -JOOJ ^r CM S" CM CM CM CM CM CM CO CO CM CO P^H -H. ^ ^T 1 I III 1 SBAUBO 'OX 00 -o 00 t- Tt< CM CM CM^CMCMCM T^ CM CM (X^^^r* CM 8|IBgJO-OM| CM CM CM (MCM ^(X*~^ CM Frigates. i SECOND CLASS. Size Rope. | Wl 1 1 1 CM CO CO CM CM CM CO CO CO CO q J331 o? CM CM CM CM CO CM CM CM CO CO CO CO jooj CM ~f CM CM CMC^COCM" CMCMCOCOCO CO P B?H - 2T ^ 1 1 CMCM CM- 1 1 1 1 SBAUBO 'OX! I" ei 1^ ^^^ - ^^^.""H 1-1 >-[IB S JO-OX| CM CM CM-- CM CM FIRST CLASS. Size Rope. 1MB 1 i 1 CM CO CO CO CM CO COT* CO CO qo 3ai CM CM* CM CM CO CO CO CM CO CO CO CO CO '300J CM H'S CM CM CMCM CO CO CMCMCOCOCO CO | s ^H* 1 1 CM CM CMCM 1 1 1 1 SEAUBO-OMj t- ^ O^^r-H *" SIJBSJO o.vi j . CM CM CM CMCM CM CM Razees. Size Rope. -, S? o H 1 1 1 CO CO* CO* CO* ro ro TfT^co CO qoaaq c CM* GsT CM CO CO CO CO CO CO CO CO co" ?oojj c? sr CM CM CO CO' CO* CO CM CO CO CO CO PB9H ^y CM ^T 1 1 CMCM CMCM 1 1 1 1 SBAUBO OX | t- i^ iS CO ""^ *"* '-' s[regjo-ox| CM CM CM CICM ^HOJ^^^ *"" j .Ships of the Line. Size Rope. J8IOH 1 1 1 CO CO* CO* CO" co tn^^iR co" ***! CM" cT CM CM CO CO CO CO CO CO CO CO CO jooj CM 57 CM o? co" co* co" CO CM CO CO CO HOI CO P^H ^? ^? 2? 1 1 CMCM CMCM 1 1 1 1 SliAUBJ-OXI t~* o t~~ ^>co-^ CO "^ SltBSJO-OM| CM CM CM C? CM CM c* Names of Sails. ^ B ^ c 02 .1 | 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 g ' OQOTM . j; g | g ^Q 1 ^CC J ^rt 72 334 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR-. I g a' 1 I O p^ QC I B < 11 I 1 Size Rope. | JSJOH qoa ai *& (M rji < (M CM 100J *>'* CO -^ 5r CM* CM* 'PB9H &s* 5? Sr:? 5? r SBAUBQ '0^ (NCM oco (NO o n sireg jo -OM| i| - O GOOD CM I> 00 00 OP SI;BSJO - O>J| CM CM CM rH CM f-i t-i CM CM I H Size Rope. I S! OH 1 1 1 1 CO 1 1 I 1 qoao^ CO* C?^ CM ^ 5Sr s- CM CM looj COCO CM CM CO 00 t^ O 'SIPS JO 'ON) > fa i s ' ~ a w pj n3 RJ fl bo ' co bo OB g &, , % 5 P, , -13 KiOS* P^ O * l>^ ^ PHC| >^ C L_i o In^ii H i U^t _OJ 1 1 fHC^C riflri'jSfH cju'S'U S-lfegTl .S-S^.S S S S S S S S T -ower Studding-sails Fore Top-mast Stud- dins-sails - - - Scale of 16 feet. Representation of Masts, Yards Sails, &c OR YOUNG SAILORo ASSISTANT. 5 99 OR JT3 w 1 3 | %M "Q S s3 "- 3 - i! f! 0* I .2 1 ^ H N i Size Rope. ^ O) TO CO CO Ol Gft CO f^ | s 5? rr cSSfcoco 5T3KO- CO 100J -i CM -H CM CMCOCO CM CM CO n TH * - - 1 !<* ^T2T i i ST3AUBQ 'O^l 00 O 00 *3 ^ T-* i-t CMCO- CM sireSJO-OM CM CM CM CMCM-H- I-H CM 1-1 (M Schooners. Size Rope. OH! I 1 I coco" i i 1 1 1 1 qoaaq 1 1 CM CO 1 1 1 1 1 1 CM 100J ^ i i oTfo 1 i i 1 1 1 1 CM P^H ~ 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 ~* SBAUBO "OM X 1 1 O 1-1 1 1 1 1 1 1 r S|tBSJO -ox , 2* 1 i CM CM 1 1 1 1 1 l ^ } Size Rope. i-ral i i i *T5r5f , 1 1 CO a?, qoaoi - 1 1 CMCMCS 1 1 1 CM CM 1 nooj - 1 1 (McScSl , i ST. pBan! - i i .i-. i i i i i 8BAireo'o>ij 3C 1 1 X O CO 1 1 1 CM CO 1 SJIBSJO -ox 51 1 1 CM S* 1 1 1 i * CM 1 1 B Si/e Rope. ISIOHJ I 1 1 C^STcM^CO 1 1 1 CO CO c? . qoaaq > i G>J i i CM CM CM CO 1 1 CM CO sr i jixjj _ j ^H CM CM CM CM 1 1 CM CO ST. P^H - - - 1 1 ~ 1 1 1 1 i i 8TUUBO-OX X t- X I- O CO CO 1 1 CM CM CM 1 SIIBSJO-OXJ CM CM ^ CM 1 | -H i 1 CM 1 .Sloop*. THIRD CLASS. Size Rope. | WB 1 1 1 CMCMCMCM CM CM CO CO CO CO 1 CO 1 qoa^ ~ CM ~ CM crTc^TcM 1 CM CM CO CO CM ;ooj CM - ? CM CM CM ^ CM co co :M CO 1 pB3H 1 1 -i -i I I i 1 1 RBSJO-OMI COrH rH Ci C3 O O co o o JO C* o o co X o -H CT X o OGO CO ?O r-4 COCO 00 > OX t^O OO i^O O jo 'H^S jo xpoa ox o o CO O JSIOH II II -q099T > o^ WCX) O-i CJQO 000 'loo j 00 O rH 00 O 1> O 1 1 "iras Smu\i \ O OO CO O CO Names of th different Sail ^ ' >, 1 * 1 'I- 1 ' S - JH 45 js rt rt d 42 d . . 1 .3 - ^ ' OB 02 2 "8 m 337 qoaaq l coo o JO *UIUI1 'jreg I 00 OO O 'IP'S s i ei=i i i s s I S !OH| i i i i 00 OO'-'O O 100J o cs o O* 1-1 t- O ..... X '(res ^O O O CO ^H CO OT} o o co i- ^ C o-ot^ooo I I I 1 I jo 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 spm('|m s -| oco tr -H M o ^ o oo co ^ r^ C I i I I I o 00 c C 1-^00 CO CO 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 spjBl 'ires jo/poa -* O CJ CO cs c* t. CJ rj< OO -<* xO O co cj l^ ^H ^H 1 1 | | | jo Suiuiq 1 1 1 1 jo O Ci OOOO O CO *-?< Ci 100 j 1 Ci -7 I 1 1 (^co -o co "SiS.3!? i . i i 5 a e 1! - i _ ' - i _ -' ~ w ) C i ?l 340 523. A Table showing the Length and Size of Stand- Names of Rigging. Ships of the Line. Razees. Frigatesi 1 3 DECKS. - 2 DECKS. 1st C las?. 1st Class. 2d Class. 1 1 J 6 pc 2 108 o 4 34 106 2 34 103 2 34 103 2 3 ? 86 JIB-BOOM GEAR. Jib Stay- - ... i ._ i AA 1 ._ 4.9 1 71 _ Jib Guys (pairs) - - i 2 6 75 1 2 6 72 1 2 6 72 2 6 68 1 2 '5 54 G8 Jib Falls - ... 4 3 40 4 3 40 4 3 40 4 3 40 4 2? 40 Foot Ropes - - - - 2 4 18 2 4 18 2 4 18 2 4 17 2 3f 16 Martingale Stay - - 1 8 10 1 8 9 1 8 8 1 8 8 1 74 ; 7! Martingale Backropes ( (pair)- - ... 1 P^l on p , 1" e i K I 1 c ! Tfi Martingale Fa as - - J. 2 3 2 16 c 3 3 16 2 04 3 16 2 3* 16 2 O ', i C 2fj 16 Halliards - ... 1 70 1 3f 70 1 64 1 3i 67 1, 31 62 Downhaul - - - - 1 3* 42 1 3 40 1 2f 35 1 36 1 24 35 Sheets - - . o m 44 80 2 44 70 2 44 3f 62 2l 34 68 Pendants - ... 2 6 8 2 6 8 2 6 7 2 5f 7 21 5f 6J Brails 2| 2| 68 2 Os 60 2 2| 57 2 25 58 2i 24; 56 FLYING JIB-B )OM GEAR. j Flying- Jib Stay - - Flying-Jib Guys - - 1 2 5 4 52 52 1 2 5 4 50 50 1 2 5 4 47 44 1 2 44 3! 48 44 1 2 44 43 3|t 40 Flying-Jib Falls - - Foot Ropes .... 2 2 3 3 24 11 2 o fl 3 3 24 10 2 2 3 3 24 10 2 2 2? 3 24 10 o 2 2f' 20 3 9 Martingale Stay - - 1 5 24 1 5 20 1 5 20 1 20 1 44 18 Halliards - ... 1 34 60 1 34 58 1 34 53 1 3 8 54 1 3 51 Downhaul - - - . 1 2J 46 1 2f 46 1 2| 39 1 24 40 1 24 36 o C9 c fLf) *s* /to j rv Hfel-rope - - . . & 1 , 3 f OxS 34 1 3* ou 32 1 3* 30 1 3j -o 3 i 30 I 2! 30 NOTE. -The Lar^ards 8 2 2! 7 9 2! 7 2 21 7 2 24 7 2 21 6 22* 6 "2 2 3 &\, 8 l! 4* 17 1 4 15 1 4 13 1 12 1 11 1 34 104 13! 10 1 : 4* n L : 2f 45 1 2i 39 1 2* 37 1 37 1 2 37 1 34 12 33 2! 46 L! 2* 34 1 2 30 , 1 I|i30 1 If 26 1 1*26 1 1* 22 11! 26 I 2* 34 I 3 38 2 24 30 2 2i|30 2 24 28 22*20 2 2* 24 22 24 2 3 38 L, 21 26 1 2*,20 1 2*|20 1)2 |19 1 I!ll8 1 1415 14 1 2! 26 342 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Ships of the Line. Razees. Frigates. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. Names of Rigging. t ' ' JS t t 5 d g 1 1 fc 'I 1 6 1 J i 00 t I I PORE-MAST AND YARD GEAR. Pendants (pairs) - 2 104' 10 2 104 10 2 10 10 2 10 10 2 10 10 Shrouds (pairs)* - - Lanyards for Shrouds (four-stranded) - - Stays 10 20 2 J 54 15 (124 (134 200 40 10 20 2 104 54 15 $120 $134 160 40 10 20 2 10 5 U14 160 38 10 20 2 10 5 144 U23 ^128 160 39 9 18 2 10 5 14 ^ 92 153 46 Collars for Stays - - 2 9 19 2 9 18 2 9 2 18 2 84 18 Futtock Shrouds - - 12 30 12 30 12 30 12 6 30 10 5f 25 Slings Proper (to go over Cap) Chain for all vessels - - Slings, Preventer 1 12 11 1 12 10 1 11 10 1 104 10 1 10 9 Lanyard for Slings - 1 5 21 1 5 21 1 4f 21 1 4f 21 1 4* 21 Pendant Tackle Falls 2 4 118 f 4 114 2 94 2 3f 98 2 3| 98 rj __.- 1 Q 1 A. i u 14. H" 1 -j 7 14 Falls for Runner - - I 1 O 4 45 j 1 o 4 i^t 45 1 4 : 39 A 1 3| 39 1 31 42 Jeer Falls - - - - 2 51 130 2 5| 130 c 108 2 112 2 5 104 Jackstays (bending) Iron _ - - - - Jackstays (reefing) - Foot Ropes - - - - 2 2 50 c 48 2|2 48 _ _ 2 76 26 .' 2^ 24 2 2i 24 .' 24 2 . 20 22 20 2 2 i20 2 2J 26 S 2] 30 2 2 24 2 2 24 X 2 24 o U 24 2l If 18 - 2 O i 32 2 24 52 2 24 46 S s 40 9 38 o H 36 211 _ _ 2 24 58 t 2 18 2 14 1 2 14 ] 9 14 ] H 12 1 IT 12 _ _ _ 1 2 20 i 1 7 11 64 c 1 64 9 I 6 84 I (3 10 1 6 10 1 74 14 1 7 14 1 3} 29 3 25 1 o 24 ; 2! 24 21 28 1 2| 26 1 3 33 1 34 37 I 2^ i 16 24 14 1 2 13 1 2 12 1 2 12 1 9 12 1 2| 15 1 24 18 J 2 3^ ; 82 i 3} 66 S 3 64 a 3 62 2 2? 60 S 21 56 2 2! 53 2 34 82 2 21 48 a 24 4C s J 24 34 9 32 2|2 36 S 9 34 - - 2 24 52 n*tern lengths for each gang of Standing Rigging. 344 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing ana Names of Rigging. Ships of t lie Line. \ Razees. Frigates. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. d 5 | 02 5 j a g S 3 ! I j 'n J3 S | 1 i a flO 1? PORE-MAST AND YARD GEAR. Con. Lower Studding-sail Sheets - ... 2 4| 32 2 4* 32 2 4 ' 30 2 3f 30 2 3J 30 Lower Studding-sail Outhaul - - - - 2 4 58 2 4 56 2 4 50 2 3! 50 2 3|j 52 Swinging-boom Top- ping-lifts - - - - 2 54 44 2 5* 40 2 5i 38 2 5 40 2 44 38 Palls and Lizard for Topping-lifts - - After Guys- - - - 2 2 34 3 108 76 2 (T 3* 3! 104 70 2 2 3f 3f 100 66 2 2 3i 34 100 66 9 2 3 34 94 60 Forward Guys - - 2 3f 128 c 31 120 2 3f 108 2 34 108 2 34 106 Gear Tricing-lines - 2 3 44 c 3 42 2 3 42 2 3 42 2 21 40 FORE TOP-MAST & YARD GEAR. flhrouds and Pendants (pairs') .-. - Lanyards for Shrouds G 7 123 6 7 123 6 7 123 6 6J 123 5 6 86 and Pendants - - 12 34 84 [2 34 84 12 3J 84 12 34 84 10 3 70 C fro ire C Qi 70 o qi 65 2 Ql 64 2 Ql 65 2 9 62 Breast Backstays(prs) 2 /2 8 / v 82 9 v> 2 8 80 2 ^2 74 78 2 ^2 74 81 2 7 72 E'alls for Breast Back- , 4 Qs p>2 A 33 52 4" 33 RO 4 Q3 KO 4 Ql 52 Standing Backstays "4 050 \ <>4 9i6 >5 O& H (pairs) - - - - 2 10 88 2 10 86 9 10 84 2 10 86 2 94 78 Lanyards for Standing Backstays - - - 4 5 40 ^ 5 40 4 5 40 4 5 40 4 4f 40 Cat-Harpen Legs - 2 44 4 c 41 4 2 4i 4 2 4i 4 2 44 4 Top-Burtons - - - f 3i 176 ( 34 170 e 3| 158 9 2 34 162 2 3i 150 o 41 8 t 41 8 c 4.1 8 '2 41 8 2 4 7 Top Tackle Pendants Top Tackle Falls - o t "i 9 5 53 160 9 e ^; 9 5 52 150 2 t O5 vO 45 130 2 2 9 41 47 135 2 S 84 44 44 130 Jackstays (bending) Iron Foot Ropes - - - - t 6 4 3 15 6 c 6 4 3 15 6 t 6 4 3 12 6 2 6 4 3 12 6 2 6 3| 2f 13 6 Flemish Horses - - 2 3 6 2 3 6 2 3 6 9 4 3 6 2 3 5 7 7 6 j 7 ( 1 7 g 1 6i 5 Top-sail Ties (all 1 i i * W 2 hide) - - - - t 7 QQ ^ 7 36 9 7 ,fi 2 7 36 2 6i 31 Halliards for Top-sai I oo / OC I "8 c ion 2 116 2 4 qc 2 4 106 2 33 106 Rolling Tackle - - 1 3 l-w\J 18 3 18 rr 3 i/C 18 1 TC 3 J.UL) 18 1 "4 3 16 r ift<* . c 7 of; f 3 c 7 Q^ o fii ^4 2 g 31 Braces - * J 4" OO 11 Q ji t if J i Al_ O*: n |G O Oa 41 01 2 4 104 Stay-sail Halliards - ; 3 I'lO 68 4a 3 1 1U 68 1 ^2 3 t 68 Ic 1 *1 3 70 1 2| 6tf Stay-sail Dovnhaul- 24 40 24 40 ] 24 40 1 2^ 42 1 24 38 Stay-sail Sheets - - 2 3 60 ] 3 60 c 3 60 2 3 62 2 3 58 Sheets 2 6* 82 2 64 80 f 6| 71 2 64 72 2 6 68 Clew-lines - - - - $ 3 ? 96 2 3| 95 2 3! 88 2 34 90 2 34 80 Bow-iines - - - - S 3 72 2 34 70 c 34 64 2 34 64 2 3* 60 Bunt-lines - - - - S 3 71 i 3| 70 c 3| 65 2 3 67 2] 34 62 Reef Pend'ts (all hide $ 4f; 15 2 4* 14 2 4! 14 2 4| 14 2l44 13 Run'g Rigging for all Classes of Vessels, U. S. N.-Con. 345 rigates. Sloops. Brig- Scliooii d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. Brigs. a nt i lies ers. Steamers* i 1 . i 5 J3 t t j I ; ^ 1 j It 1 = 1 02 J lJ I J .1 I CO ' J d JL d 1 = 6 3 J ! 28 2 3 26 2 21 26 2 2! 24 2 24 18 2 ^ 18 2 24 12 2 3 30 < ! 34 48 2 34 34 2 3 32 a 3 31 2 31 30 2 - 30 2 2! 36 2 34 46 44 36 2; 4 32 2 3! 30 2 3? 30 2 34 28 2J34 26 2 34 36 2 44 42 2| 90 2J 24 76 2 24 74 2 24 73 2 2 68 2'2 66 24 30 2 2! 90 34 54 2 3 50 2 2* 44 2 ^ 42 2 24 40 2J24 38 2 3 30 2 34 64 34 94 2 3 76 2 2* 72 2 2f 70 2 2; 64 2J24 62 2 3 36 2 O^ 100 24 36 2 24 30 2 2 28 2 2 27 2 H 26 2 M 26 2 24 42 54 82 4 44 58 4 44 57 3 44 45 3 4 39 3 4 39 2 31 24 5 54 106 2| 70 8 24 56 8 24 56 6 24 42 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 10 2f 70 84 54 2 74 45 2 7 44 2 43 2 54 42 2 54 42 1 44 24 2 84 64 7 64 1 7 28 1 64 27 1 6 26 1 54 25 1 54 23 - - 2 7 80 34 52 2 34 24 2 3 22 2 3 21 2 2| 16 2 16 - - - 4 34 52 9 68 2 8 60 2 74 58 2 7* 56 1 64 28 1 6i 26 1 44 OS 2 9 84 44 40 4 4 36 4 3^ 36 4 3! 36 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 4 44 40 4 3 2 34 3 2 34 3 2 34 3 2 3 o 2 3 2 2 24 2 2 3 34 134 2 3 112 2 3 104 2 2f 100 2 >i 98 2124 90 _ _ 2 34 160 4 7 2) 3| 2 3f 6 2 3| 6 2 34 6 2 34 5 _ _ _ 2 4 7 8 40 2! 64 35 2J 64 32 1 64 18 1 5 18 1 5 16 L l m'st 4 a 2 8 46 4 116 - : - - - - - - - - - 2 4 134 34 11 2 34 9 2 34 9 2|3 9 2 2f 8 2 2} 8 2 2i 8 2 34 12 24 6 4 24 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 2 2" 4 6 24 6 3 5 2l 24! 4 2 24 4 2 24 4 22 4 22 4 2! 2 3 2 3 5 64 44 ll 6 44 1 54 4 1 54 4 15 4 1 5 4 1 34 3 64 5 64 30 2l 6 23 1 2 54|22 2 54 22 1 ! 54 9 1 5. 8 1 44 7 2 64 41 34 1 90 2 34 82 2 34 70 2 3 68 13 30 1 3 30 1 2| 41 2 3i 100 2| 15 1 24 14 1 24 13 1 24 12 12 12 ] 2 12 1 2 5 1 21 15 54 29 2 5 26 2 5 25 2 5 24 244 21 2 U 21 2 4 20 2 54 35 34 94 2 34 76 2 34 74 2 3 72 22f 60 22f 64 2 24 64 2 34 124 2| 65 I 24 60 1 24 60 1 24 56 48 104 4* _ _ 1 2f 60 2J 36 1 2 34 1 2 32 1 32 1 2 30 ill*! 30 _ _ 1 2 34 5! 56 64 2 24 2 54 52 54 2 2 24 5 50 48 2 2 241 50 5 ! 46 2 2 24 4 48 46 2 2 24 4 48 46 2 3| 46 2 2 24 5! 50 71 34 74 2 3 62 2 3 60 2 2f 59 2 24 58 2 2i 56 2 24 36 2 34 86 34 50 2 3 48 2 3 44 2 2|' 42 2 2^ 40 2 24 40 2 2 32 2 34 60 34 54 2 3 50 2 3 46 2 2f| 45 224 42 2 24 42 2 24 44 2 34 66 144 11 2 4 10 2 4 10 2 3|i 10 234 7 2 34 7 2 3 7 2 44 1? 26 346 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Names of Rigging. Ships of the Line. Razees. PI Is 6 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 C X; i 2 1 9 4 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 i riga t Cl i 34 24 2| 2f 2 3! 34 3* 24 34 31 44 4 44 24 54 54 54 2| 2 34 34 24 2! 31 2 2 24 2 24 24 21 3 24 1 34 2 9 test ass. I 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 2d Class. 6 2 I 02 3i 24 3 4 3 24 4 3 3} 3 3 4 5 5 5 2| 6 Gi 5f 3 2J 4 3| 2 ? 3i 4i 2 Si 2f 24 2* 2? 3 3k 2J 4 2 * j= I 1 a c Z, 2 2 2 1 1 o f t ( o 2 2 2 c i c S 02 1 6 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 1 1 f 1 1 1 2 c 1 2 c ( ( t c i 2 c '1 sj I 74 92 24 10 30 26 96 80 45 60 60 40 63 41 49 24 51 52 12 8j 2 3 50 116 52 60 81 88 44 24 20 24 84 27 54 37 10 w 6 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 A X 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 i 35 ja FORE TOP-MAST & YARD GEAR. Con. Whips for Reef Pen- 2 2 2 1 1 2 o 2 f o it f 1 1 2 79 102 24 11 30 30 104 94 56 70 60 40 66 46 52 24 56 58 12 9 2 3 52 128 57 66 90 96 48 24 22 29 94 32 64 38 10 F><3 3* 24 3 4 3 24 4 31 34 3 34 4 5 5 5 2! 6 6| 5f 3 24 4 3f 2* 3J 44 2* 2^ 2| 24 2f 2? 3 3 2f 4 2 9 78 96 24 10 30 26 100 86 48 68 60 40 64 45 51 24 54 58 12 9 2 3 50 120 56 65 84 94 48 24 21 26 88 28 58 38 10 ft7 3i 2* 3 4 3 2 4 3 3* 2f 3i 4 5 5 5 2 6 6 5 3 2i 4 3i 2* 3 4i 2i 2 2* 2i 2i 2* 3 3i 2f 4 2 TI 3j 2i 3 4 3 2 3f 3* 3i 2! 3| 4 5 5 5 2* 6 5f 5J 2* 2i 4 3i 24 3 4i 2i 2 2 2i 2t 2 3 3* 2 4 2 1 74 94 24 10 30 26 100 84 47 62 60 40 63 42 50 24 53 54 12 84 2 3 50 118 53 62 83 88 44 24 20 , 25 86 27 54 37 10 M 66 86 24 8 25 22 92 84 46 60 50 35 56 39 46 20 48 49 10| 8 2 3 44 112 48 56 78 84 40 20 18 24 84 24 54 33 8 Ai\ Clew Jiggers - - - Lift Jiggers ... Bunt-runner - - - Jigger for Bunt-runner Boom Tricing-lines - Studding-s'l Halliards Studding-sail Tacks Studding-sail Sheets Studding-sail Down- Studding-sail Boom Studding-sail Top- ping-lifts .... FORE TOP-GAL'NT M'ST& YARD GEAR Shrouds (pairs) - - Qt av Breast Backstays(prs" Falls for Breast Back- stays - - - - - Standing Backstays (pairs) - - - - Long Yard, or Mast Short Mast Rope - - Jackstays (Iron) - - c i Parrpl Lifts Halliards ... - CUppfe Clew-lines - ... Bunt-lines - - - - Lift Jiggers - - - Bunt Jiggers - - - Tripping-line - - - Studding-sail Hall'rd Studding-sail Sheets Studding-sail Tacks F'RE ROYAL MAST AND YARD GEAR. bhrouds (pair) - - Falls for Shrouds - I Run'g Rigging for all Classes of Vessels, U. S. N,-Ow. 34? Frigates. Sloops. Brigs. Brig- ant i lies i Schoon- ers. st earn J GO ersi 2d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. J I 1 _e 3 00 1 = z j 1 J X ; 1 li 02 2 I g 5 j = z 03 I -2 3 60 2 2| 56 2 21 50 -2 24 48 2 24 46 2 2 46 2 2 50 2 3 76 2 24 80 2 2 66 2 2 62 22 60 g If 60 2 If 60 2 U 46 2 24 94 n 2| 24 2 21 22 2 21 20 221 18 2 4 16 2 24 16 2 24 12 2 21 24 1 31 8 1 3 ~ 1 3 6 13 6 1 3 6 1 3 6 _ _ 1 10 1 24 22 1 2 18 1 2 16 12 16 1 2 12 1 2 12 _ _ _ 1 21 32 2 2" 20 2 M 20 2 11 20 2 U 20 2 14 18 2 14 18 2 14 14 2 2 30 2 31 82 2 34 68 2 3 64 2 3 63' 2 2f 62 2 2f 60 o 36 2 31 98 2 3 79 2 3 62 2 2j 56 o 2* 54 2 24 50 2 21 48 2 24 72 2 3 98 a! 3 42 2 3 40 2 3;> 2 2f 37 2 2* 30 2 2| 30 2 32 2 3 44 a 24 54 2 24 42 2 2 41 2 2 40 2 If 36 2 if 36 2 U 40 2 24 58 i 2 3i 50 2 3 40 2 3 40 2 3 40 - - - - - - - 2 3i 60 2 31 35 2 3i 30 2 34 30 2 34 30 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 31 40 i i 2 4 52 2 31 44 a 3* 42 2 3 41 2 2f 36 2 2f 36 1 24 15 2 31 68 1 4 35 1 31 31 i 34 30 1 3 29 1 2| 27 1 2| 26 1 2* 2o 1 4* 40 1 4 42 1 31 37 i 34 35 1 3 33 1 2| 31 1 2f 29 "" 1 4 53 2 2 20 2 2 16 2 2 14 2 2 14 2 11 14 2 U 14 - - 2 2 20 1 5 44 1 41 39 1 4 37 1 4 36 1 3* 33 1 31 30 I 3 34 1 5 54 I 54 44 1 41 41 1 44 36 1 H 35 1 3f 34 1 3f 34 1 3 35 1 5? 55 - 91 1 81 1 3| 8 1 3f 1 31 7 1 31 7 - - - 1 4! 12 2 21 8 2 24 7 a 24 7 2 24 1 2 2 6 2 2 6 2 2 6 2 24 8 2) 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 -2 2 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 2 2 5 34 3 1 3 21 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 2i o -. 1 21 c 1 2 2 1 31 3 2 3 42 2 2! 36 2 21 34 2 21 33 2 24 30 2 24 30 2 2 2-3 2 3 45 2 24 102 2 80 2 2 75 '2 2 ' 74 2 48 o 24 48 2 2 52 2 Ol 132 1 2f 45 1 21 35 1 24 32 1 2 30 1 2 25 1 25 - - 1 2| 54 a 34 50 o 34 46 2 3 42 2 3 41 2 2f 40 2 2f 38 2 2 44 2 31 60 2 2 74 g H 60 2 U 56 2 11 54 2 U 42 2 li 42 2 li 48 2 2 80 2i 2 74 2 If 62 2 U 58 j U 54 2 n 53 o 4 14 52 2, li 54 2 2 84 2} 24 36 1 24 17 1 2 15 1 2 14 1 u 14 1 if 14 J _ _ 2 24 46 2) 2 20 c ** if 16 2 U 15 2 U 14 2 14 12 x 14 12 _ 2 2 20 1 2 17 1 If 16 1 15 1 15 1 14 13 1 14 13 _ _ _ 1 2 22 l||4 22 l 2 20 1 If 19 1 If 18 1 u 17 l 11 17 l H IS 1 24 26 74 C 4 24 62 2 24 58 2 24 56 2 24 54 2 24 52 2 2 70 2 21 92 i 2} 22 c SI 21 20 2, 24 20 2 24 20 2 a 16 2 2 16 2 2 36 2 2* 28 2] 24 46 c A 2 38 2 2 37 o 2 36 2 if 32 2 If 32 2 If 32 2 24 46 i 1 i i I 1 34 30 1 3 28 1 3 26 1 21 24 1 21 22 1 2i 21 228 11 2{| 40 2 U 1 2| 8 34 2 1 1? 21 8 34 2 1 H 8 21 1 33 2 1 14 24 32 s*i ^ 348 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Names of Rigging. Snips of the Line. Razees. Frigates* 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 1. 1st Class. 2d Class. I 1 I c 00 1 t S 02 f a 1 .i I * ,01 .2 1 F'RE ROYAL MAST & YARD GEAR. Con. Backstays (pair) - - Yardrope - - - - 1 1 4 3f 62 62 1 1 4 3f 60 60 I 1 4 34 57 58 1 1 4 34 60 60 1 1 CO CO 54 54 Jackstays (Iron) - - Foot Ropes - - - - Parrel - - - - - 2 1 21 14 7 2 2 1 2f 14 7 2 2 1 2* 14 7 2 1 2f 14 7 2 2 24 14 6 2 T ift 2 24 60 2 64 1 2 31 i 14 30 I L4 28 1 li 28 1 H28 2 U -0 2 2 76 pen. 3 , . 3 36 1 ai 34 1 2! 28 1 -; 28 1 34 28 1 24 28 -li-'i- 1 3 38 W IP 2 21 40 24 30 1 9 28 1 2 26 1 2 26 1 if 25 1 U 25 1 2i 28 1 24 34 2J 32 1 9 28 1 2 26 1 a 26 1 2 25 1 2 25 1 1 24 36 66 2 3 54 2 3 50 2 3 46 2 3 36 2 3| 36 2 44 '54 2 78 9 9 2 8 9 2 74 8 a 74 8 -2 G 7 1 6 4 1 6 4 2 9 9 9 h?3 7 B 140 7 74 129 G 74 108 5 G 82 3 G 67 3 G Go 9 9 c 90 44 124 153 44 14 4 104 112 40 14 o 3| 10 112 36 12 2 3J 94 96 34 10 2 3 S 70 34 9 64 30 ;;, 30 18 2 44 1-34 153 58 51 25 __ ron Iron 12 51 30 C i/5 8 92 5 j 2J 6 4 2* 4 4 2 4 4 9 4 4 9 4 2 22 9 61 24 : f > 3 5 32j 4 2 2\ 4 o 2] 4 2 9 4 jjJKJ 4 22 4 213 f 6| 4* 6 4 1 6 4 1 6 4 1 3 4 f 3 1 4 3 1 6* f bi 32 6 25 2 5i 24 9 5J 23 15J 9 15 S 14J 7 2[ 6J 41 352 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Names of Rigging. ! Ships of the Line. Razees. Frigates. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st C.ass. 1st Class. 2d Class. i 8 0 a 22 2 11 20 a U. 20 2 lo 2 i -J u 9 2* 4*4) ? 88 84 2 3i 3 74 72 9 3 2| 70 64 9 9 1 4 68 62 1 4 2| 2^ 64 60 - - - I - 2 9 34 3 ! 3i 46 9 3 44 9 3 40 9 3 39 9 2^ 32 - 9 34| 44 24 60 2 24 50 9 2 48 2 2 46 2 2 38 - - - - - - 9 24 ; ' 4 56 9 31 48 9 34 46 9 3 45 9 2f 38 1 -H 15 1 Ol 15 2 3! r>3 44 22 i 3! 19 1 18 1 H 17 1 i 14 1 2 A 16 1 2i 12 1 4? 31 14 j/ ^ 40 1 O i 38 I 3 QC l > 3 i 4 flO v i *rV/ * OO ^t 2j 20 -2 2 16 9 2 15 2 2 15 2 14 _ 2 2 J 'T) , 5 48 1 44 42 1 4 39 1 4 38 1 34 1 3i 34 1 2! 34 1 5 M i 5? 48 1 44 43 l 44 40 1 41 39 1 1 36 1 2^ 36 _ _ _ 1 5} 55 4? 11 1 9 l 4 9 1 4 n 1 7 - - - - - 1 4f 12 2i| 9 2 2? 8 9 2? 7 224 7 2 2 6 9 2 5 _ 2 24 8 2 2 2 2 ' 2 2 2 2 9 2 2 H _ _ _ _ 9 2 g 3 3 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 3 2 1 2i 9 1 2 1 2 _ 1 3i 3 3 46 9 2! 40 2 2j 38 2 24 36 9 2i 31 2 3 24 _ 2 3 45 2? 88 2 2 76 2 2 66 2 2 65 2 2 50 9 9 48 _ _ _ 2 2? 94 24 48 1 34 40 i; 2f 38 1 2 36 1 2 26 _ _ _ _ _ 1 2ff 54 3| 56 2 31 50 2, 34 46 2 34 44 9 2f 41 2 24 44 _ 2 3| 60 2 78 2 l| 66 2| 14 58 2 H 55 9 14 44 2 li 46 _ _ _ 2 2 80 2 68 9 2 64 2| If 56 9 if 53 9 1! 48 _ _ _ _ 9 2 86 24 38 l 2f 18 1 24 16 1 16 1 2 30 _ _ _ _ 2 2? 46 2 Oft 2 1 * 16 2* I 1 16 2 11 1 ^ o 12 2 2 on 2 19 1 11 17 ij i: 14 15 1 1 u u 15 1 14 13 _ _ _ _ 1 2 4\j 23 2i 24 1 2 22 ll U 20 1 u 19 1 14 19 1 l 18 _ _ _ 1 2 1 26 ! 2| 80 2 2| 70 2) 24 64 9 aj 60 2 24 58 - _ 1 _ 22i 93 354 1 Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Ships of the Line. i Privates. 2 DECKS. Razees. 1st Class. 2d Class. Names of Rigging. JS ^ .c ^ . o 8 in bjQ | a a s g 02 a | (0 00 S o S I MAIN TOP-GAL'NT i M. &Y'DGEAR. Con Studding-sail Sheets Studding-sail Tacks 2 2 CO CO 33 70 2 3i 2 3 30 64 2 2 3} 3 28 64 2 2 3* 30 64 2 2 3 24 28 60 MAIN ROYAL M'ST & YARD GEAR. Shrouds (pair) - - Falls for Shrouds 1 2 4 2 42 10 1 2 4 2 40 10 1 5 4 2 40 10 1 2 4 2 40 10 1 2 34 2 36 8 1 3~ 34 1 3x 31 1 3~ 30 1 3~ 30 1 3 28 Backstays (pair) - - Yardrope - - - - 1 1 4 69 71 1 1 4 3! 68 70 1 1 4 65 64 1 1 4 34 67 66 1 1 3! 3i 60 62 Jackstays (Iron) - - Foot Ropes - - - - 2 1 H 8 2 2 1 H 8 2 2 1 21 H 7 2 1 2! H 7 2 2 1 24 H 6 2 9 3 62 2 3 60 o 3 60 9 60 24 54 9 72 9, 70 64 9 94 64 o 56 Halliards .... 1 24 43 1 24 42 ] 2i 37 1 2} 38 2i 35 9 3} 48 g 3* 46 c Ol 44 3 44 o 42 Clew-lines - - - - 2 24 53 2 24 52 o 24 50 2 2} 50 2 2i 48 Bow-lines - - - - 2 2* 72 2 2? 64 2 2} 58 2 2 64 2 2 60 B ant-lines - - - - 1 24 28 1 24 27 1 25 1 2 27 1 2 24 Tripping-line - - - Main-boom Topping- 1 2 34 1 2 33 1 2 31 1 2 32 1 2 29 lilts - - - - - Falls for Main-boom MAIN TRY-SAIL M'ST & GAFF G'AR Peak Halliards - - 1 34 63 1 34 63 1 34 59 1 34 63 1 3} 48 Throat Halliards 34 48 i 34 48 ] 3* 42 1 3^ 46 1 3 43 *T 3 68 9 3 HO 2 58 v s 60 r MI 96 Peak Brails (pairs) - Throat Brails (pairs) 24 34 42 46 1 1 24 34 38 43 24 37 42 1 1 ?t 38 43 i i 3 36 38 Middle Brails (pairs) Foot Brails (pairs) - o 2* 3 4 38 36 62 1 1 9 22 3 4 34 34 60 1 3* 34 34 60 1 1 2 24 21 34 34 60 i i 24 24 32 34 54 .., - 8 Boom Tackle for Out Reef Pendants for Out Reef Tackle for Out hauler - - - - ' - - - - , - - - M1ZEN-MAST&CR JACK YARD GEAR Shrouds and Pendants (pairs') - - - - Lanyards for Shrouds 6 8 144 6 8 143 G '74 136 6 74 136 c 7 136' and Pendants - - 12 4 96 12 4 96 12 3! 84 12 3| 84 12 34 84 3tav ....-- " 9J 19 1 941 18 1 9 17 1 9 ! 18 1 9 Rim'g Rigging for all Classes of Vessels, U. S. N.-Cojt. 355 rigatfs. Sloops. Brig- at tines Schoon- ers. iteaiuer* d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. Brigs. 3d Class. JL d A 1 i a j. . i 7. * | J. j J 1 j * K J. j 1 J 2i 26 2 2i 22 '2 2? 20 2 20 2 2 18 2 2? 28 84 50 2 2 42 '2 2 40 2 2 38 2 If 33 "* - ~ - 2 24 32 3} 32 1 3 30 1 3 27 1 2', 26 1 21 22 8 2 H 8 2 l| 8 2 1 A 8 2 7 3 25 1 2j 23 1 , : 20 1 2 L 19 1 2? 17 54 1 3? 48 1 3 42 1 3" 42 1 3 37 3 54 1 2f j 46 1 43 1 2i 42 1 2* 39 24 6 2 2 1 5 2 2} 5 o 24 5 2 2 5 2 1 14 2 1 14 2 1 U 2 1 H li 50 2 24 42 2 38 2 2 37 22 32" 2i 52 2 2 42 2 2* 39 2 2 37 22 38 2 32 2f 38 2 34 2 2? 32 2 2 30 212 28 2 44 2 li 38 2 4 36 2 H 34 2H 30 U 52 2 U 44 2 H 42 2 H 42 2 1 38 2 22 U 26 1 li 23 1 u 22 1 IS 21 1 M 19 2 4 30 2 5 40 o 5 40 2 0? 30 n j 36 2 3 QC -4 A ro 3 40 j 21 34 T 2t 31 1 ? 30 1 34 44 1 >f 54 1 3f 54 1 3 41 2| 38 1 2| 33 1 31 1 30 1 34 28 1 34 34 38 1 2| 44 2i 52 2 2 48 2 1? 46 2 If 44 2 2i 42 2 24 ")6 -2 24 30 2 58 2 34 1 2 32 1 U 30 1 if 28 2 li 64 1 2 42 1 2 40 1 2 ? 40 2 2 36 1 2f 32 1 30 1 28 1 34 34 1 ^i 40 1 34 38 1 2| 36 24 30 1 2 28 1 If 26 1 1 1 24 1 If 31 1 2* 34 1 2 34 1 24 38 24 3| 28 44 1 2 2 3 26 1 34 2 2 3 24 32 1 2 2 3 22 31 1 2 3* 30 60 1 1 ? 38 35 1 1 24 36 35 1 2 34 32 52 1 ji 22 i 25 1 4 26 j _ 4 01 . -i i 60 o- Bv ^ 2 -2 %1 ** o i *r 2 -4 -jl 1 1 J 5 3 15 i Q 1C 1 1 3 1C i O 1 C i 1C 6| ) 34 ft 98 70 Ifi 5 10 i 6 3 74 80 70 i/l 5 5i 10' 2| 1 7i 785 7010 13 i 5i 21 74 76 1 12 - - - - - 5 10 1 6i ST M 103 81 11 356 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Names of Rigging. Ships of the Line. Frigate*. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. Razees. 1st C C .* X 02 lass. 5 v 1st Class. 2d Class q B 5 J c 02 f 5 8 02 1 1 1 1 s z \ 2 MIZEN-MAST&CR. JACK Y. GEAR. Con. Puttock Shrouas - - Slings (Chain for all vessels) - - - - Pendant Tackle Falls Foot Ropes - - - - g i c c o ( 5 3 3 3 6 3 5 3 51 2| 6 6 3 7 3| 3k 3" 3 6 3* 2| 2* 5i 5 3 2f 4 2* 5 3 2| 3 3* 2i 2 21) 24 110 16 4 8 20 26 88 74 56 15 38 20 39 20 3i 150 7 26 11 4 5 4 15 56 15 31 96 52 82 58 64 12 68 88 20 & 2 2 o f f 1 2 4 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 5J 31 3^ 3 6 3 5 3 5 2 5 6 6 3 7 5 3f 3i 3 3 6f 3} 22 2* 5i 5i 3 2f 4 2* 5 3 a 25 3i 2* 2 2| 20 106 16 4 8 20 26 86 69 56 14 38 20 38 20 3 150 7 26 10 4 5 4 14 55 15 30 96 50 78 52 58 12 64 82 20 c 2 i. 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 5 3 3 3 6 3 5 3 5 2| 6 6 3 7, 3| 3i 3 3i 6 3* 2f 2t 5* 5* 3 2f 4 2* 5 3 3 2i 3* 2* 2* 2| 20 90 14 4 8 20 22 76 69 56 13 35 20 36 20 3i 132 7 23 10 4 5 4 13 50 15 29 84 46 76 50 55 12 64 78 20 '<- t 4 1 , 1 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 i 3 3 6 3 5 3 5 2 6 6 3 7 3f 3i 2| 3J 6; 3i 2| 2J 5i 5^ 3 2f 4 2! 5 3 2| 3 3i 2^ 2J 2* 20 94 14 4 8 20 22 80 69 56 13 36 20 38 20 3J 140 7 25 10 4 5 4 13 52 15 29 86 48 78 52 57 12 64 80 20 8 5i 2 3 2 3j 4 3 1 5 1 2| 2 5 2 3 4 5 8 2 1 5 1 5- 2 2- 1 7 2 3 2 3 2 2-1 2 3 1 6 2 3 4 2J 2 2 1 5 1 5* 1 2f 1 2* 2 3| 2 2^ 2 4f 2 2f 2 2* 2 2^ 2 3 2 2i 2 2* 2 2* 20 92 12 4 7 20 20 68 62 56 12 32 20 34 20 3 130 7 22 9 4 4 3 13 49 14 27 8ff 46 72 50 54 10 60 74 20 Truss Pendants (all hirlM Fall for Truss Pen- dants ----- Lifts ------ Braces - - - - - MIZENTOP-M'ST& YARD GEAR. Shrouds and Pendants (pairs) - - - - Lanyards for Shrouds and Pendants - - Stay - - - - - Breast Backstays (pr.' Falls for Breast Back- Standing Backstays (pairs) --- - Lanyards for Standing Backstays - - - Cat-Harpen Legs Top-Burtons - - - Top Tackle Pendants' Jackstays (Iron) - - Foot Ropes - - - - c 2 1 1 1 1 2 O Flemish Horses - - Parrel Top-sail Tye (all hide) - - - - - Halliards for Top-sail! Tye ----- Rolling Tackle - - Lifts - - - - Sheets Clew-lines - - - - Bow-lines - - - - Bunt-lines - - - - Reef Pend'ts. (all hide) Whips for Reef Pen-, dants - ' 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 Clew Jiggers - - - Lift Jiggers - - - : Rim'g Rigging for all Classes of Vessels, U. S, N.-Cbrc. 357 rigates. Sloops* Brigs. Brig- autiiies Schoon- ers. Steamers* -d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. 8 X Iron 3 3* 3 Pat. 4! 2J 4| 24 5 54 2* 7 34 3 '2k 3 54 2* 2* 4* 5 2* SH 34 24 I* 8 ? 2* 2 2* 74 11 4 16 62 54 56 12 28 20 30 20 3 118 7 19 8 4 3 3 13 40 13 22 70 40 62 44 46 9 52 66 18 1 2 2 2 2 3 6 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 4 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 Iron 21 3 - I 3 t J 05 .e 1 62 9 % 2 2 j In 2f 2f ! t 1 jj 1 i J d M 1 i j. J j 2 2 4 i 80 11 4 1G 64 36 56 13 28 24 36 20 3 120 5 20 9 4 3 31 16 45 15 25 90 48 72 58 50 9 58 73 9,0 68 10 2 -2 Iron 2* 3 60 9 - Iron 3 34 3 Pat 41 2! 44 24 5 5 2* 7 34 3 24 3 54 2! 24 2 44 5 2 24 34 24 4 21 24 24 3 1* 9,* - Pat. 44 2! 44 84 4| 61 8i tii Pnt 15 54 38 39 10 25 16 28 2 ~2 3 6 1 1 2 1 4 2* 44 24 4 5 24 64 15 52 34 36 9 23 16 26 g 2 3 6 l 1 2 1 4 2^ 4 2 14 5 * H 15 50 31 30 9 22 16 1 - _ 2 S 4 8 1 1 2 1 2 2 -2 2 1 2 4 v> 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 _ - - - - - - - - - - - - Oi 24 3 54 24 2 2 4 54 2^ 2 34 2 3| 84 2 24 2| 2 2 9 3 98 6 18 7 4 3 3 9 33 12 21 58 38 58 38 42 8 50 56 16 2 2 -2 I 2 4 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 9 2 2 1 24 24 3 5 24 2 2 4 54 24 2 3 2 34 24 2 2 24 2 ?, 3 88 6 17 7 4 3 3 8 30 12 20 56 36 52 36 38 8 48 52 14 2 2 2 1 -2 4 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 9 9 2 2 1 24 24 3 5 34 2 4 34 V 3 2 2 2 34 2 2 14 t 4 3 3 J ! 34 48 36 36 8 46 50 14 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - II - - - _ i - - - - - - 358 l Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Ships of the Line. Razees. Frigates. Names of Rigging. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. d 8 3 | 3 a 'S. 8 31 21 3* 3i 31 2 41 4 31 2i 2* 3 3 21 2f 3 21 2 2 If If 1| 3 If 2f 3 3 2 1 2f If 2 2i 1 10 17 58 17 47 20 49 53 12 7 2 2 48 78 48 56 66 78 22 20 20 25 35 12 22 56 57 5 2 53 60 33 38 42 56 23 29 41 1 1 2 I 1 2 1 1 1 o c 1 c ( c c . ( ( .' f 3i 21 31 31 31 2 41 4 3f 21 2i 3 3 21 2f 3 21 2 2 If 1^ If 3 If 2f 3 3 2 1 2f If 2 2i If li 11 H 51 9 16 55 15 46 20 48 52 11 7 2 2 44 76 45 54 60 76 21 20 19 24 34 12 21 54 56 5 2 52 50 30 36 40 48 22 29 40 i i 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 t i 1 i 2 c t c ; 2 1 2 2 2 1 1 2 3i 21 3i 31 3i 2 4i 4 31 21 2i 3 3 21 2f 3 21 2 2 If If If 3 If 2f 3 3 2 1 2f If 2 2i If H U li 51 9 16 53 15 43 20 45 47 10 7 2 2 44 72 42 49 56 72 19 20 18 21 32 12 20 50 52 5 2 46 46 29 36 40 44 22 26 40 1 1 2 I 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 9 2 i 2 2 r 1 9 2 i i i 9 ij i i i 2 1 o 3! 2 1 2 r r 1 1 2 3i 21 3i 31 3i 2 4i 4 3f 21 2* 3 3 21 2i 3 21 2 2 If If If 3 If 2f 3 3 2 1 2f If 2 2i If li H li 51 9 16 53 15 44 20 46 48 10 7 2 2 44 74 43 50 58 74 19 20 18 22 32 12 20 52 54 5 2 48 46 30 36 40 44 22 27 40 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 4 1 2 1 1 1 o 4 1 1 1 2 1 2 2 1 9 2 2 2 1 1 2 3 2i 3 3i 3i 2 4 3f 31 2i 2 21 2f 2i 21 2f 2 If 2 11 H H 21 U 21 21 2f 2 1 21 U 2 2 11 1 H li 5i Breast Backstays (pr.) Falls for Breast Back- Standing Backstays (pair) - ... Long Yard, or Mast Rrvnp Short Mast Rope - - Jackstays (Iron) - - Foot Ropes - - - - r ifts - Halliards - ... Shfipte Clew-lines - - . - Bunt-lines - - - - Lift Jiggers - - - Bunt Jiggers - - - Tripping-line - - - MIZ. ROYAL MAST & YARD GEAR. Shrouds (pair) - - Falls for Shrouds - 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 1 9 4 1 2 2 1 c Backstays (pair) - - Yardrope - - - - Jackstays (Iron) - - Foot Ropes - - - - Parrp] T ift o5_ 3 2i 21 2f 2* li 3| 3i 3 2 2 2 2i If 2i 1! li li H r 2 2i 2i 2 1 2 li If 1 1 1 1* k 6 12 39 11 32 14 34 33 n.) 50 29 38 44 50 14 16 12 18 24 8 14 38 38 4 2 36 32 24 28 30 20 28 c f. 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 : i 2 -2 1 2 2 o 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 2 2 9 2 2 1 2 S 02 3 21 2i 2i 2i li 3i 3 3 2 2 2 2 H 2 2i H 1 li li 1 1 2 1 1! 2i 2 1 2 li If 1 1 1 41 i ^ I , : a V. ' J. 6 12 33 10 27 14 29 30 P-. i 5 2 2 26 45 26 35 40 48 12 14 10 15 19 8 12 31 32 4 2 30 28 20 24 28- 16 25 J J /. A j ;< _* I |J J .S DO 1 j 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 1 ] 2 8 JL 3 2i 3 3 3 2 3f 3i 3i 2 2 2i 2^ 2 2i 2f 2 li If li li li 5 I 7 14 46 14 40 18 44 45 8 7 2 2 40 64 40 45 45 62 18 18 15 20 % 7 14 41 13 36 18 38 38 8 6 2 2 36 60 34 42 46 56 16 18 14 20 25 8 17 42 43 4 2 38 42 25 28 34 42 16 22 32 1 1 2 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 '2 1 2 I 1 i 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 . 6 12 34 10 29 14 31 32 7 5 2 2 27 46 28 36 42 48 12 14 10 16 19 8 13 34 34 4 2 32 30 22 26 28 18 27 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 3 2 2i 2i 2i H 3* 3 3 .3 2 2 If ^ U 1 H H 1 2 1 If i '21 2 2 1 60 -6 ^3 9 Q 72 ^ rrx * Qj) ** 1 - 1 a Qfl o *"'^ 2 80 i .6 ll 3 36 & 32 24 Ov' 28 1 1 1 4 24 ou 28 ~ _ _ _ ~_ _ _ 3 38 li 2 30 2* 28 1! 26 1 if 24 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 32 01 2(5 2 24 I 2 22 21 34 1 ^i i ** 4 Q 37 1" i 9 2b o 3 29 "1 ~ 2 '21 26 2 2 1 28 * -4 *-"* 2 20 i ~-i i 21 34 108 2 3 106 2 3 100 2 3 100 2 2i 95 1 31 45 1 24 45 2 34 108 2 2f 108 2' 2| 96 2 24 90 2 24 90 2 24 88 1 2} 42 , 24 42 2 2| 100 )6'| 30 - _ 30 _ _ 30 _ _ 2't _ _ is 1-2 , 36 _ - 1 31 - _ 3 _ _ 3 _ _ 3 _ 2 _ _ 2 _ - 2 _ _ 2 - 9 - _ 6 _ _ 6 _ _ 6 _ 4- _ 4 _ 4 _ _ 6 Q 5 } 100 2 44 95 2 4i 90 2 44 90 23f 60 2 3 - 56 2 34 40 2 5 100 j, 120 2 6 8 2 51 8 2 P 1 8 i, -. 2 14 7 2 4 6 2 4 120 2 3 52 2 2i 48 2 2f 46 o 46 4 J 2 3; 40 2 24 40 2 3 52 4 3i 140 4 3 135 4 3 130 4 3 4 130 421 120 4 116 4 2f 112 4 34 140 I 3! 60 1 3! 58 1 34 56 1 3^ 56 1 3} 5'2 1 34 52 1 34 50 1 3f 60 2 34! 56 2 3 52 o 3 48 o 3 48 o 2| 44 4 24 44 2 24 42 2 34 56 B 3i 280 24 3 i 240 24 34 240 24 34 240 '12 3 1-20 1-2 } 120 123 1-20 28 3J 280 4 100 4 3^ 100 4 34 100 4 34100 43 100 2 3 50 23 50 4 3-j. 100 b ^ 160 b 2| 160 8 2^ 160 b 24 160 n 120 6 24 120 6 120 & 24 160 IS 18 18 18 1-2 10 I 8 18 7 1 Q Cr's Da vit. 4 7 18 1 1 54 23 1 5 22 1 4f 21 1 41 21 1 44 20 I 44 18 1 44 18 1 54 23 U 3 | 85 ; 2 2,' 801 2 2f 7G 2 2| 76 2 24 74 o - 24 70 2 2J 70 c 3 95 362 A Table showing the Length and Size of Standing and Names of Rigging. Ships of the Line. Razees. Frigates. 1st Class. 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 2d Class. I 8 m J 6 in A 1 1 t J 1 8 (B 1 c z J 00 ! MISCELLANEOUS GEAR. Con. Girt--ines,Main Mast- ].o ; . 2 2 10 2 1 1 1 2 1 52 6 4 1 2 1 2 2 6 8 4 3 4 4 4 1 2 ? 6 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 I 3i 3 3i 2 8 12 108 88 640 2 18 20 2 2 10 2 1 1 1 3* 3 3i 2 7* 11 108 88 640 2 16 18 2 2 8 2 1 1 3i 3 3 2 7* 11 108 88 512 2 16 18 2 2 8 2 1 1 1 3 3 3 2 7 10 108 88 512 r 15 17 2 2 6 2 1 1 1 3 2| 3 2 6* 10 104 86 360 2 14 16 Girt-lines, Miz. Mast- head - - - - - Girt-lines, Hammock Hooks, Can (Iron) - Hawse Pend. & Hook Hawse R'pe& Shackle Halliards, Signal (set) Hooks, Fish (fr anch.) Jacks, Iron (sets) - - Lines,Clothes(Manil.) Lines, Tricing, Ham. Nippers (dozens of) - Rungs for Jacob Lad- ders (set) - - - - Ropes, Buoy - - - Ropes, Ridge, Awn- ings (set of) - - Ropes, Old (for lash- ings) as much as may be required - Ropes, Back ("for Cat- Blocks) - - - - Rudder Pendants and Chains as may be required) - - - Stoppers, Cat-head - Stoppers, Ring - - Stoppers, Deck (chain claw} 1 24 3i 1560 144 52 6 /\ 2* 3* 1560 144 50 6 /\ 2* 3 1500 144 48 6 Si 3 1440 144 44 6 2* 3 1230 132 1 7 40 2 7 40 2 7 40 2 61 40 2 1 2 2 G 8 4 3 4 6 24 9 54 3* 4} 94 40 25 6 16 4fi 32 100 9 3 10 G 3* 5 10 30 7 18 4 feet. 32 100 9 2 2 6 8 4 3 4 \ 3 10 6 3* 5 10 30 7 18 4ft. 32 100 9 2 2 G 8 4 3 4 3 91 51 3* 5 10 30 7 17 4ft. 32 100 9 2 2 6 8 4 3 4 3 94 54 3* 5 94 25 6 17 4ft. 32 100 9 Stoppers, Boats - - Stoppers, Fighting,doz Stoppers, Bit - - - Strap Selvagees (doz.) Swabs (dozens) - - Seines - - 9 4 7 4 4 7 4 8 4 80 5 chain chain chain 90 8 60 108 8 60 20 80 1 2 6 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 9 j 4 4 7 4 8 4 80 5 90 8 60 108 8 60 20 80 1 2 6 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 84 4 7 4 4 7 4 8 4 80 5 90 8 60 108 8 60 20 80 1 2 6 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 84 4 7 4 4 7 4 7* 4 70 4 JO 8 60 108 8 60 20 80 1 2 6 2 2 1 2 2 1 1 1 8 3| 6f 3| 3| 6| 3| 3 7 f 6C 4 88 8 5i ios ft 55 19 78 Shank Painters (a part (Chain) - - - - Spare, Gluarter Davit Spare, Waist Davit Travelers, iron, for Top-sail Tyes - - Topping-lifts fr Quar- ter Davits ... Tackle, Fore-yard - Tackle, Pendants - Tackle, Fore-stay* - Tackle, Main-yard - Tackle, Pendants - Tackle, Main-stay* - Triatic Stay - - - 'Quarter and Stay - * Or Triatic Stay-tackle. Run'g Rigging for all Classes of Vessels, U. S. N,- Con. 3fi3 ritrates. Sloops. Brig. Schoon- d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. Brigs* autiiies ers. Steamers* i S r i I i J_ c 1 1 = j 1 j i j; J j X f 6 z. vz J. J 4 i i 3 100 2 2} 96 2, 2| 1 92 2 2| 92 2 24 92 2 24 92 2 24 92 2 3 100 Oi Q \ 2 ! Ol 80 2 9i 78 2 U 78 - Ol Q < 3* 325 "8 2! 200 4 2| 180 4 2] 180 4 Ol 170 3 01 120 324 120 & 5 "I 3 325 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 J 2 2 0~ 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 13 1 6 10 1 54 9 1 5 8-- _ _ _L _ 1 64 13 9 15 1 8 11 1 1 8 10 1 7 9 7 - 1 - 4- - 1 9 15 - - - 2 - - 2 -2 - 2 - 2- - 2 - 2* 1100 34 2 '900 30 2 750 30 2 75020 2 500 16 2 400 122 300 40 2* 1100 3 125 tj 2| 120 6 2! 120 6 21 120 4 2i 85 4 24 24 85 6 3 125 2 2 2 _ ft Q i 54 40 2 5 40 2 5 40 2 4i 40 2 4 40 2 4 40 2 4 40 2 54 40 25 2 2 20 2 2 20 2 2 J 2 2 15 '2 2 15 - - 1 2 24 25 64 6 2 6* 5 2 6 5 2 6 j 2 34 3 2 34 3 2 5 2 64 6 5 14 4 4f 12 4 44 10 2 4^ 10 | 2 4 10 2 34 8 2 3A 8 4 5 14 _ 4ft. 4 _ 4ft 4 4ft 4 4 fJ 4 _ 4ft 4 4ft 4 _ 4ft 6 4ft 3i 26 4 3 26 4 3 24 4 3 24i| 4 - 1 ! 22 4 3* 20 4 21 20 4 34 28 44 100 2h 4 80 24l4 80 24 4 60 2 3^ 60 2 N 60 2 3! 60 3 44 100 64 8 3 74 8 3 7 7 3 7 7 3 64 7 3 6 7 3 6 7 4 84 8 _ 2 2. - _ 2 _ _ 2 _ 2 _ 2 _ 3 _ _ .} o 2 2 - 50 1 - 40 1 - 40 1 - 40 9 1 35 - 35 9 l - 35 1 - 50 6 4 2 51 3 2 54 3 2 3 J 5 2 2 5 2 2 44 2 2 6 4 - - 6 - - 6 - - 6 - 2 - 2 - - 4 - - 31 84 2 34 76 2 3* 72 2 3i 70 1 3 33 1 3 33 2 3! B4 64, 74 2 6 6 2 5| 6 2 5 6 1 5 3 1 3 3 _ . _ 2 74 3| 54 1 34 50 1 34 48 1 H 46 1 3 40 1 3 40 _ 1 3$ 54 31 100 2 34! 86 2 3* 84 2 34 84 1 3 10 _ _ _ _ 2 3! 100 64 74 2 6 6 2j 5| 6 2 54 6 1 5 3 _ 1 _ 2 74 3i 54 1 34 50 I 1 34 48 1 34 46 1 3 40 1 3 40' _ 1 3| 54 7 18 1 64' 18 1 64 18 1 54 18 116 17 1 ~) 15 - _ 1 7 .3* 70 1 3| 65 1 62 1 3 62 Il3 60' 1 - - - - 1 3? 70 364 524. A Table showing the Size and Description of ! Ships of the Line. Frig- Descrip- 2 DECKS. Razees. ates. Names of tion, of j O DECKS. IstClass. 3d Class. IstClassi Blocks. 1 i 1 | 1 * i Block. S* I S" 13 = S" ~j o o fe 6 c HI 6 lljE CO 02 | X M GO X 00 1 00 2 OB 03 j FLYING JIB-BOOM. Downhaul Royal Bow-lines - S. S. 1 2 7 G 1.0 .8 1 2 7 G 1.0 .8 1 2 7 G 1.0 .8 1 2 7 6 1.0 .8 2 7 6 1.0 .8 Halliards F. T. Gal- lant-mast-head - s. 1 7 1.3 1 7 1 3 1 7 1.3 1 7 1.3 1 7 1.3 JIB-BOOM. Downhaul Brails on Stay s. s. 1 2 8 6 1.3 .1 1 c 8 6 1.3 .9 1 2 8 1.3 6, .9 1 1 2 8 G 1.3 .9 1 2 8 1.3 6] .9 Brails leading on s. - 2 p c o * 7 c 2 6 C 2 6 .9 Martingale back-ropes Martingale back-ropes Top-gallant Bow-lines Guy Tackles - Guy-Tackles - Jib-stay Tackle Jib-stay Tackle Sheets in Clew of Sail D. S. s. D. S. D. S. S. 2 2 2 4 4 1 1 A 10 10 p 12 1C 12 12 13 1.6 1.6 .9 1.2 O 4 .1 f o A* 2 2 4 /: 1 1 2 10 10 7 12 12 12 12 13 I!G c l'.5 .] .5 2 2 2 4 4 1 1 2 10 10 7 12 12 12 12 13 1.6 1.6 c L2 c ;] A ] 1 2 10 10 12 12 12 12 12 L6 1.6 c L2 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.5 2 2 2 4 4 1 1 2 9 9 6 12 12 11 11 12 1.5 1.5 .8 1.2 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.4 Hall'rds in head of Sail s. 1 12 X 1 12 /_ 1 12 4 1 12 1.4 1 11 1.2 Halliards on top-mast Trestle-trees S. Iron b'd. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 SPRIT-SAIL YARD. Lifts leading to Bow- sprit Cap - Brace on Yard-arm S. S. 2 2 12 11 1.5 1.3 o 3 2 12 11 1. 1. 2 2 12 11 1.5 1.3 2 2 10 10 1.3 1.2 2 2 10 10 1.3 1.2 Brace on Fore-stay Brace on Trestle-trees s. s. 2 2 11 11 1.3 1.3 2 2 11 11 1. 1. 2 2 11 11 H f 10 10 1.2 1.2 2 2 10 10 1.2 1.2 BOWSPRIT. Fore-top Bow-lines Fore Bow-lines s. s. 2 2 12 12 1.5 1.5 2 2 12 12 1. 1. 2 2 12 12 1 5 L5 2 2 12 12 1.5 1.5 2 2 12 12 1.5 1.5 Fore Top-mast Stay- sail Downhaul - s. 1 8 1.3 1 8 1. 1 8 1.3 1 81.2 1 8 1.2 Fore top-mast Hall'rds in head of Sail - s. 1 12 1.6 1 12 1.6 1 12 1.6 1 11 1.4 1 11 1.4 F. T. Mast Hall'rds on 1 top-mast trestle trees S. Iron b'd. 1 12 1.6 1 12 1.6 1 121 1.0 1 11 1.4 1 11 1.4 F. T. Mast Stay-sail sheets in clew of sail S. 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.5 2 121 1.5 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.5 F. Storm stay-sail stay on Bowsprit S. Clump. 1 14 2.8 1 14 2.8 1 1 14 2.8 1 id 2.4 1 12! 2.4 F. Storm Stay-sail 1 Downhaul - S. 1 8 1.2 1 8 1.2 1 8 1.2 1 8 1.2 1 8 1.2 F. storm stay-sail hal- 1 liards in head of sail S. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 11 1.3 P.S. stay-sail halliards on Trestle-trees - S. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 11 1.3 Bumkin Blocks, (fore tacks) - - (S.Should'r. 2 15 2.3 c 15 2.3 2 15 2.3 2 14 2.2 2 14 2.2 FOREM'ST&YARD. Runner - S. 1 17l 3.0 1 17 3.0 1 17 3.0 1 !6 28 116 2.8 the Different Blocks of all classes of Vessels, U. S. tf. 365 Frig- ates. Sloops of "War. Brigs. Brigan tines. School ers. Steam* era. W Class 1st Class 2d Class. 3d Class | j Swallow. | 6 \ z, 1 Swallow. i i, 7 Swallow. t ^ i j I i j f Swnllow. 1 / jswallow. I j : 'f i if 1 7 1.0 1 6 .9 1 I .9 1 C i G i 1 1 i 71.0 2 G .8 2 6 .8 2 1 .8 2 5 ( 2 i / - - - 2 6 .8 1 7 1.3 1 -- 1.3 1 ( 1.1 1 6 1.1 1 1.1 1 i 1. 1 ( 1. 1 70 i 1 8 1.3 1 8 1.3 1 1.2 1 j 1.2 1 b 1.0 1 i 1.0 1 | 1. j 81.3 2 6 .9 2 .9 2 b _e 2 b .9 2 b .9 2 5 J 2 ; 2 G .9 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 b c 2 t i 2 ( < 2 : j 2 5 2 6 .9 2 c 1.5 2 8 1.4 2 8 A 2 f 1_< 2 1.2 2 1 L2 2 [ . 2 91.5 2 c L5 2 8 1.4 2 8 A 2 t l.< 2 - 1.2 2 1.2 2 ** 2 91.5 2 b .8 2 G .8 2 .8 2 I .8 2 i 2 5 .' -2 ^ 2 6 .8 4 10 1.2 4 10 1.2| 4 1C 2 4 11 1.2 4 ( i!i 4 j 1.1 4 8 [ m 4 ] 01.2 4 10 1.2 4 10 1.2 4 10 _o 4 1C 1.2 4 i 1.1 4 ( 1.1 4 8 ( 4 1 01.3 1 10 1.1 1 10 1.1 1 10 .1 1 ( 1.1 1 i 1.0 1 ( l.< 1 8 1 1 01.1 1 1C 1.1 1 10 1.1 1 1C .1 1 c 1.1 1 r 1.0 1 ( 1.0 1 S 1 1 01.1 2 10 1.2 2 9 1.1 2 q .1 2 c 1.1 2 i 1.0 2 \ l.( 2 8 2 1 Oil. 3 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 t .1 1 i 1.1 1 8 l.C 1 8 l.( 1 1 1 01.2 i| u 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.0 1 10 1.0 1 10 1.0 1 li 1.0 1 10 .0 1 1 214 o 1ft 1.3 9 1.2 2 () 1.2 o g 1.1 21 n t q * \j 2 U L2 10 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 b l.( _ _ _ _ _ _ _, _ _ i 2 1 U A O 012 2 10 1.2 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 a 8 1.0 2 1 1 2 2 10 1.2 2 9 l.l 2 (j 1.1 2 s 1.0 2 1 U 1 v n i o 2 11 1.5 2 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 q 1.3 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 ( 2 1 J J. o 115 2 11 1.5 2 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 9 1.3 2 8 1.2 2 S 1.2 - 2 1 115 1 8 1.2 1 7 1.0 1 7 1.0 1 / 1.0 1 G .9 1 6 .S - - - 1 31 2 1 11 1.4 1 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 9 1.1 1 8 1.1 1 8 1.0 - - - 1 1 ll.i 1 11 1.4 1 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 9 1.1 1 8 1.1 1 8 1.0 - - - 1 1 I .4 2 11 1.4 2 1.3 2 10 1.3 2 9 1.2 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 - - - 2 1 11.4 1 12 2.4 1 2.0 1 10 2.0 1 9 1.8 1 8 1.6 1 8 1.6 _ _ m 1 15 J|2.4 1 i I 8 1.2 1 7 1.0 1 7 1.0 1 G .9 1 G .9 1 6 .9 _ _' - 1 i *1.2 1 11 1.3 1 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 9 1.1 1 8 1.0 1 8 1.0 - - - 1 1] ljl.3 1 11 1.3 1 1.2 1 1.2 1 9 1.1 1 8 1.0 1 s\ i.o' - - - 1 1] 1.3 2 11 2.2 2 2 2.0 2 2 2.0 2 11 1.8 2 9 | 1.6 2 9 1.6 _ _ - 2 U 12.2 * i : 1 '5 2.6 i i i " JQ R 360 A Table showing the Size and Description of the IMF* Ships of the Line. Frig- Descrip- 2 DECKS. itazeea. ates. Names of tion of O DECKS. IstClass. 2d Class. IstClas* Blocks. Block. .2 3 J2 a . ' J2 "3 . = 1 tZ i 1 1 CC 9 fc .2 72 QQ i 1 1 1 1 FOREM'ST&YARD. T Continued. 1 Tackle for Runner Tackle for Runner Pendant Tackles - Pendant Tackles - Truss Tackles - - D. S. D. D. D i i 2 2 2 17 17 17 17 10 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.3 1 1 2 2 2 17 17 17 17 10 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.3 1 1 2 2 2 17 17 17 17 10 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.3 2 2 o 17 17 17 17 10 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.3 1 1 2 c. g 17 17 16 16 10 1.G 1.6 1.5 1.5 1.3 Truss Tackles - - S. T. 2 2 10 22 1.3 2.4 2 2 10 22 1.3 2.4 2 2 10 22 1.3 2.4 g 10 22 1.3 2.4 2 10 20 1.3 2.1 D. 2 22 2.4 2 22 2.4 2 22 2.4 2 22 2.4 f 20 2.1 Jeer Leaders - - S. X 20 2.2 2 20 2.2 2 20 2.2 9 4 20 2.1 c 20 2.1 duarter Blocks - - S. Iron b'd. 2 16 2.3 2 16 2.3 2 16 2.3 C\ & 16 2.3 2 14 2.1 Clew Garnet - - S. Iron b'd. 2 14 1.7 2 14 1.7 2 14 1.7 $ 14 1.7 (T 13 1.6 Clews of Sail - - S. 2 12 1.7 2 12 1.7 2 1.7 2 12 1.7 g 11 1.6 Bunt-lines under Fore T 1 D. 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 g 9 1.3 B ant-lines under Fore Shoe. 2 18 1 3 2 id 1.3 2 18! 1 3 2 18! 1-3 2 1G 1.2 Leech-lines on Yard S. 4 8 1.2 4 b 1.2 4 8 1.2 4 8 1.2 4 8 1.2 Leech-lines under Top Leech-lines After - D. D. 2 2 8 8 1.4 1.3 2 2 8 S 1.4 1.3 2 2 8J1.4 8 1.3 2 2 8 8 1.2 1.2 2 2 8 8 1.2 ] 2 Leech-lines After - S. 4 8 1.3 4 8 1.3 4 8 1.3 4 8 1.2 4 8 l * Braces on Yard-arms S. 2 15 1.6 2 15 1.6 2 15i 1.6 2 15 1.6 2 15 1.6 Braces leading under Main Trestle-trees Lifts on Cap - - - 8. D. 2 2 15 16 1.6 2.2 2 2 15 16 1.6 2.2 2 2 15 16 1.6 2.2 '2 2 15 16 1.6 2.2 2 2 15 16 1.6 2.2 Lifts on Yard-arms S. 2 16 2.2 2 16 2.2 2 16 2.2 2 16 2.2 2 16 2.2 Lift Jiggers - - - D. 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 Lift Jiggers - - - Boom Jiggers - - S. S. 2 4 10 9 1.1 1.1 2 4 10 9 1.1 1.1 2 4 10 9 .1 .1 2 4 10 9 1.1 1.1 2 4 10 8 1.1 1.0 Boom Jiggers (in and S. 6 1.1 6 9 l.l 6 9 l 6 9 1.1 6 8 1.0 Clew Jiggers - - S.' 4 17 8 l.l 4 8 I.I 4 8 .1 4 8 4 8 1.1 Bunt Jiggers - - S. 3 8 1.1 3 8 1.1 3 8 .1 3 8 1.1 3 8 1.1 Reef Tackles on Yard S.d'blesc'e 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8, 2 12 1.8 Fore Tacks in Clews of Sail --- - S. 2 15 2.3 15 2.3J 2 15 2.3 2 14 2.2 2 14 2.2 Sheets in Clews of S. 2 15 2.3 2 15 2.3 2 15 2.3 2 14 2.2 2 14 2.2 Swinging-boom Top- ping-lifts, - - - S. clamp. 2 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 Swinging-boom Top- ping-whips, - - D. 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 10 1.0 Swinging-bocm Top- ping-whips, - - S. sin 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 10 1.0 Pendants for o Her Halliards,- - - S. 2 16 1.8 2 16 1.8 2 16 1.8 2 15 1.7 2 14 1.6 Outer Studding-sail Halliards on Boom S. 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8 2 12 1.8 2 11 1.7 Inner Studding-sail Halliards on Yard S. 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 Inner Studding-sail ' | i Halliards on duarter 1 S. Trinping-line - - H S. 2 2 9 9 1.3 l.l 2 2 9 9 1.3 2 1.1 2 9 9 1.3 l.J 2 9! 1.3 21 9 1.1. 21 91 1.3 2 9, U ferent Blocks of all classes of Vessels, U. Nt Ubn'A 36? Frig- ate a . Sloops of War. Brigs. Brigan- Sclioon- Steam* 1 3d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class, i tiiies. era. ^ ^ i i i > J' g | Q O jg _o '5 ijl I J. J 02 03 -i 00 07 A. j OQ OQ 6 1 I i J i OQ A 1 5 OQ 1 8 JS -^ 1 16 if* 1.6 i e - 1 1 16 1G 1. 1.6 ID 1.0 15 1.5 2 14 1.4 2 13 1.4 2 13 1.4 2 12 1.3 2 12 1.3 2 10 1.2 2 15 1.5 2 15 1.5 2 14 1.4 2 13 1.4 2 13 1.4 2 12 1.3 2 12 1.3 2 10 1.2 215 1.5 p't - p't - p't - p't p't - - p't - - p't - P, 10 9 fl 21182.0 1O 1 ft I0.V 1 2 182.0 Lo 10 9 fl 2 182.0 lo 14 iii.\j 2.1 2 13 2.0 2 13 2.0 2 12 1.8 2 10 1.6 2 10 1.6 2 9 1.4 2 2 13 1.6 2 12 1.5 2 11 1.4 2 11 1.4 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 81.1! 2 13 l.G 2 10 1.5 2 10 1.5 2 9 1.4 2 g 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 - 1 li 2 10 1.5 2 9 1.3 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 7 1.0 2 * 1.0 - J 2 jl 9 1.3 2 16 1.2 2 14 1.1 2 14 1.1 2 12 1.0 2 12 1.0 2 12 1.0 _ 1 2 1G 1.2 4 7 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 6 .9 4 6 .9 4 5 .8 4 X .6 _ _ _ 4 7 1.0 2 7 1.0 2 7 1.0 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 5 .8 2 5 .8 _ _ _ 2 7 1.0 2 7 1.0 2 7 1.0 2 G .9 2 G .9 2 5 .8 2 5 .8 _ _ _ 2 7 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 G .9 4 6 .9 4 5 .8 4 5 .8 - 4 7 1.0 2 14 1.5 2 14 1.5 2 13 1.4 2 12 1.3 2 10 1.2 2 10 1.2 2 9 1.1 2 14 1.5 2 14 1.5 2 14 1.5 2 13 1.4 2 12 1.3 2 10 1.2 2 10 1 * 2 9 1.1 2 14 1.5 14 2.0 28. 12 1.8 23. 12 1.8 23. 11 1.7 2S. 9 1.5 23. 9 L5 28 8 1.2 2s. 14 2.0 2 2 14 9 2.0 1.0 2 2 12 8 1.8 .9 9 2 12 8 1.8 .9 2 2 11 8 1.7 .9 7 i I 14 9 2.0 1.0 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 s 9 1.0 2 8 .9 2 8 .9 2 8 2 7 .8 2 j .8 2 7 .8' 2 9 1.0 4 6 8 J 1.0 1.0 4 6 7 7 .9 .9 4 6 7 7 .9 .9 4 6 7 7 3 9 2 6 G G .8 .8 2 6 G G .8 .8 j 4 G 8 8 1.0 1.0 4 3 1.1 4 7 1.0 4 i 1.0 4 7 l.C 2 6 .9 2 6 c _ _ - 4 8 1.1 3 7 1.0 3 1.0 3 G .9 3 G .S 1 6 .9 1 6 c _ _ -fl 3 7 1.0 2 11 1.7 2 10 1.6 2 10 1.6 2 10 1.6 2 8 1.4 2 8 1.4 - - -: 2 U 1.7 2 14 2.2 2 12 2.0 2 12 2.0 2 11 1.8 2 9 1.6 2 c 1.6 - - 2 14 2.2 2 14 2.2 2 12 2.0 2 12 2.0 2 11 1.8 2 9 1.6 2 r 1.6 - - 2 14 2.2 2 10 1.4 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 9 1.3 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 10 1.4 2 10 1.0 2 g cj 2 r .9 2 8 g 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 10 1.0 2 10 1.0 2 9 .9 2 9 .9 2 8 g 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 10 1.0 214 1.6 2 12 1.4 2 12 1.4 2 11 1.3 2 9 1.1 2 i 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 14 1.6 3 10 1.6 2 g 1.5 2 g 1.5 2 9 1.5 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 10 1.6 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 .9 9 f .9 2! 7 .9 2 8 1.2 i i 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 .9 2 7 g 2 1 7 .9 2 8 1.S 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2' 7i .8.' 2 8.1.0 368 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dif- II jr Ships of the Line. Frig. Descrip- 3 DECKS 2 DECKS. Razees. ates. Raines of tion of IstClass. 2d Class. IstClass; Blocks. ^ ^ Block. -2 _e . j a ,0 X 1 * d . o S 6 si 1 (^ CO <^ '7. OQ ^ 03 03 ^ 00 00 ^ 00 02 FOREM'ST&YARD. 1 Continued. Lower Studding-sail Downhaul - - S. c 7 1.0 " t 1.0 2 7 1.0 2 ^ 1.0 2 7 1.0 After Guys - - - S. Iron b'd. X 11 1.5 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 2 10 1.2 2 10 1.2 Forward Guys (Cheek on Bowsprit) - - S. 9 11 1.5 2 11 1.5 w 11 1.5 2 10 1.2 2 10 1.2 Tacks on Boom-end S. 5 A 11 1.6 2 11 1.6 c 11 1.6 n 9 9 2 ?0< " " o 1 1\ 9 A Leaders for Lifts - S. Clump. 212 2^2 2 '* i . -t 4 4.rr 12 *->.-i 1 Q 12 l.C i ^ 1 fi > -I 2 it) is L5 2 .-r 16 1.4 2 14 I.O 1.4 12 I.O 1.4 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 2 1 U ^, h* 181 Ji 2 18 1.5 2 16 1.4 2 14 1.4 12 1.4 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 2 18 15 2 18 1.5 2 16 1.4 2 14 1.4 12 1.4 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 1 10 1.2 2 18 1 5 2 15 1.6 2 14 1.5 2 13 1.4 2 12 1.4 2 10 1.2 2 10 1.2 2 8 l.C 2 15 Iti 2 10 1.6 2 9 1.5 2 9 1.4 2 8 1.4 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 - - - 2 10 1.6 I 2 14 1.6 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.2 2 ID 1.2 2 10 1.2 2 14 1G 2 18 2.0 2 16 1.9 2 15 1.8 2 14 1.8 2 13 1.7 2 12 1 * 2 10 1.4 2 182.0 2 10 2.0 2 10 1.9 2 9 1.8 2 8 1.8 2 8 1.7 2 7 1/7 2 7 1.4 2 1012.0 2 9 1.0 2 8 .9 2 S .9 2 8 .9 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 7 - 2 91.0 2 9 LO 2 8 .9 2 8 .9 2 8 .9 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 7 .6 2 9 1.0 2 12 1.6 2 11 1.6 2 10 1.5 2 10 1.4 2 9 1.3 2 .9 1.3 2 S 1.2- 2 12 1.6 S 10 1.5 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 10 1.5 S .10 1.5 2 9|L4 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 10 1.5 2 llO 1.5 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 10 1.5 2 11 1.6 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 9 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 11 1.6 i 11 1.6 4 9 1.4 4 9 1.4 4 9 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 4 11 1.6 n 2.0 2 Q 1 9 o 10 1.9 2 10 1 Q 2 2 [J on 1 9 L2 1 8 LO 1 8 1.0 1 6 1 .t7 LO 1 8 .9 1 8 .9 1 6 .9 1 9L2 I 7 1.1 1 7 LO 1 7 LO 1 7 LO 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 71.1 I 7 1.1 1 7 LO 1 7 LO 1 7 1.0 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 7 1.1 4 8 1.1 4 8 1.1 4 8 1.1 4 7 LO 2 7 1.0 2 7 LO 2 6 .9 4 8 1.1 2 7 .9 2 7 .9 2 7 .9 2 7 .9 2 6 .8 2 6 .8 - - - 2 7 3 i 2 2 1.6; 2 11 1.6 2 11 1.6 2 10 1.5 2 10 1.5 2 10 1.5 2 9 1.4 2 12 1.6 i -2 1.6 2 11 1.6 2 11 1.6 2 10 1.5 2 110 1.5 2 10 1.5l| 2 9 1.4 2 12 l.C 370 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dif- Ships of the Line. Frig. Descrip- 2 DECKS. j DECKS Razees. ates. Names of tion of IstClass. 2d Class. IstClass. Blocks. I i 1 1 =: h Block. a .3 ,2 .3 ;2 I G | 03 i 1 03 | I i a 00 CO o a 73 00 FORE TOP-MAST AND YARD.Contin. Studding-sail Tacks on Boom ends - S. 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 1.1 Studding-sail Down- haul in sails - - S. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Leaders for Boom- 1 braces in Main Rig- S. o if 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 1.1 ging - - - - - F'RE TOP-GAL'NT MAST AND YARD. Top Block - - - S. Iron b'd. i 14 2.2 1 14 2.2 1 14 2.2 1 14 2.0 1 13 2.0 Breast Backstays - S. 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 Breast Backstays in Channels - - - D. Iron b'd. 2 11 1.1 2 11 1.1 o 11 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 Halliards - - - - D. 2 12 1.3 2 12 1.3 X 12 1.3 2 10 1.3 210 1.3 Braces on Yard-arms S. 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 i 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 Braces on Collar of Main Top-m'st Stay S. 2 7 1.1 2 1.1 X 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 Braces on Main Top- mast-head - - - S. 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 S. 2 10 i.fi 2 10 1.6 10 1.6 2 9 1.5 2 9 1.5 Lifts in Top - - - S. Clamp. 2 6 1.6 2 6 1.6 6 1.6 2 6 1.5 2 6 1.5 Lift Jiggers - - - D. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Lift Jiggers - - - S. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Gluarter Blocks - - D. 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 Bunt-lines - - - S. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 i 8 1.0 g 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Span Blocks, Top-gal- lant Studding-sail Halliards - - - S. 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Jewel Blocks - - S. 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Studding-sail Tacks on Boom Ends - S. 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 F'RE ROYAL MAST AND YARD. Breast Backstays - S. 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 1.0 2 7 1.0 Breast Backstays in Ton N r 1_? J 2 8 1.1 O 8 i i 10 1 -I o 7 In 2 7 1 ft Royal Braces M'nT'p- gallant Mast-heaa J .Li UI1 U 11. S. 2 6 .9 m 2 6 1.1 .9 !c 2 o 6 .9 IB 2 i 6 .U .9 2 I G l.VJ .9 Gluarter Blocks S. 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 Bunt-line Blocks - S. 1 6 .9 1 G .9 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 FORE TRY-SAIL MAST & GAFF. Peak Halliards - - D. Iron b'd. 1 U 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 Peak Halliards - - S. 212 1.5 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.5 2 12 1.5 Throat Halliards - D. 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 Throat Halliards - S. Iron b'd. 1 12 1.5; 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 1 12 1.5 Peak Brails - - - Cheek. i Throat Brails - - S. 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2| 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 Middle Brails - - S. 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.11 2 10 1.1 2 1 9; 1.0 2 9 1.0 Foot Brails - - - S. 2 8 1.1 2 8 l.l 1 2 8 1.1 2' 8, l.li 2 8 i.: Sheets - Q 4 \'\ 17/1 1Q 1 1\ iq -I 7 4\ii)\ i d. 373 * 2d~ i 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 a 4 EH. 13 3 4 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 'ri Lte "ci j 15 15 15 15 15 p't 19 19 19 15 13 11 9 16 8 8 8 8 18 18 15 13 9 9 8 8 8 7 10 14 14 14 9 9 8 20 18 18 17 10 10 g- s. ass. CO 2.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 2.3 2.3 2.3 2.1 1.5 1.5 1.2 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.9 1.9 2.2 2.1 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.7 2.2 2.2 2.2 1.2 1.2 1.1 3.0 2.4 2.4 1.4 1.4 26 Sloops of War. Brigs. Brigan- tines. Sohoon- ers. Steam- ers. 1st Class. 2d 1 Class. 3d Class. 1 1 JE 1 J 73 8 X i CO d 7. 1 1 ffl g % 00 d | 1 02 d 15 15 15 15 15 p't 19 19 }3 9 16 6 8 8 8 IS 18 15 13 9 9 8 8 8 7 10 14 14 14 9 9 8 20 18 IS 17 10 10 * T. 2.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 1.6 2.3 2.3 L5 1.5 1/2 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.9 1.9 2/2 2.1 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.7 2/2 2/2 2/2 1 0* 1/2 1.) 3.0 2.4 2.4 1.4 1.4 Ofi 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 4 2 2 23. 2 2 2 4 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 9, 1.3 1.3 2 2 14 14 vt 1.5 2 2 13 13 p't 1.5 1.5 2 2 13 13 p't 1.5 1.5 2 2 12 12 1.4 1.4 2 2 12 12 p't 1.4 1.4 2 2 10 10 p't - - 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 4 2 2 23. 2 2 2 4 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 2 14 1-2 10 8 14 7 7 7 7 16 16 12 1-2 8 8 7 7 7 7 9 12 12 12 8 8 7 18 16 16 16 9 a 2,0 1.4 1.4 1.2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1.8 1.8 2.0 LO 1.0 .9 .9 .9 1.0 1.6 2.0 2.0 2.0 1.2 1/2 1.0 2.5 1.8 1.8 1.4 1.4 9,5 I 2 2 4 2 2 4 2 2 23. 2 2 2 4 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 2 9, 12 11 9 8 14 7 7 7 7 15 15 11 10 7 7 7 7 7 6 9 11 11 11 6 6 7 18 16 16 15 9 8 1.9 1.4 1.4 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1/2 1.8 1,8 1.9 l.b .9 .9 .9 .9 .9 .9 1.6 2.0 2.0 2.0 1/2 1/2 1.0 2.5 1.8 1.8 1.4 1.4 9,4 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 2 4 2 2 23. 12 11 9 8 14 7 7 7 7 14 14 11 1.9 1.4 1.4 1.2 1/2 1.2 1.2 1/2 1.2 1.7 1.7 1.9 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 4 2 10 9 8 7 12 6 6 6 6 10 1.6 1.2 1.2 1.1 .1 .1 .1 .1 .1 1.2 2 8 1.2 - 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 23. 8 1.6 23. 7 1.2 - 2 2 4 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 2 9 7 7 7 7 7 6 9 11 11 11 6 6 7 1(3 14 14 15 8 fi .9 .9 .9 .9 .9 .9 1.6 2.0 2.0 2.0 1/2 1/2 1.0 2.2 1.5 1.5 1.4 1.0 94 2 2 2 6 4 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 6 6 6 6 6 6 8 8 8 10 5 5 6 14 .9 .9 .8 .8 .8 .9 1.4 1.6 1.6 1.8 1.2 1.2 .9 2.0 - - - - - - - - - - - - - - ; - 1 10 2.0 1 10 2.0 2 2 i 9 14 7 7 1.0 .9 00 374 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dif Names of Descrip- tion of Ships of the Line. Razees. : Frig- ates. IstClasa 3 DECKS 2 DECKS. IstClass 2d Class. Blocks. i J"' ^ f Block. jj _o ji 1 I V. 1 < c jj S a "3 E M | j 02 02 i S in 1 c z, 5 0} MAIN TOP-MAST & YARD Continued. Breast Backstays - D. 4 IE 1.4 15 1.4 4 15 1.4 4 14 1.4 4 14| 1. 4 Breast Backstays - T. Iron b'd 415 1.4 15 1.4 4 15 1.4 4 14 1.4 4 14 1.4 Stay leading in Fore Ton S. 1 15 3.6 1 15 3.6 1 15 3.6 1 14 3.6 1 14 3.6 Spring Stay leading in Fore Top - - s. 1 15 3.6 ] 15 3.6 1 15 3.6 1 14 3.6 1 14 3.6 Gin Blocks (To be fit- j ted with band over Trestle Trees - S. 2 18 2.7 2 18 2.7 r 18 2.7 2 18 2.7 2 17 2.7 Tye Blocks - - - S. Iron b'd. 2 20 2.7 f 20 2.7 C i| 20 2.7 2 18 2.6 2 18 2.6 Fly Blocks - - - D. 2 24 1.6 2 241 1.6 2 24 1.6 2 24 1.6 2 22 1.5 Fly Blocks - - - S. 2 24 1.6 2 24 1.6 2 24 1.6 2 24 1.6 222 1.5 Leaders for Fly Blocks Braces on Yard-arms S. s. 2 2 22 18 1.6 1.8 c t 2 '22 18 1.6 1.8 2 2 2-2 18 1.6 1.8 2 2 20 18 1.6 1.8 220 216 1.6 1.7 Braces on Mizen M'st s. 2 14 1.8 o 3 14 1.8 2 14' 1.8 2 14 1.8 2 14 1.7 Qicfpr* D. 2 20 2.3 2 20 2.5 2 20 2 3 2<>n 2 3 1Q 2 2 Leaders for Lifts - S. Clamp. 2 12 2^3 c 12 2.3 2 12| 2.3 ^ 10 2^3 <6li^ 210 22 Lift Jiggers - - - D. o 10 1.0 c 10 1.0 2 10 1.0 2 10 1.0. 2|lO 10 Lift Jiggers - - - S. g 10 1.0 e 10 1.0 2 10 1.0 f 10 1.0 2 10 10 Gluarter Blocks - - D. Iron b'd. 2 12 1.7 o 13 1.7 2 13 1.7 c 13 1.7 O 4 13 I.-* Clew-lines in Clews of sail - - - - S. 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 Hi Rolling Tackle - - D. 1 11 1.6 1 11 1.6 1 11 1.6 1 11 1.6 1 11 U Rolling Tackle - - S. 1 11 1.6 1 11 1.6 1 11 1.6 1 1] 1.6 1 11 l. Bunt-lines - - - S* Iron b'd. 2 13 1.6 2 1 ^ LO 1.6 2 13 1.6 2 13 1.6 2 121 1 '5 Reef Tackle Whips S. 4 9 1.3 4 9 1.3 4 9 1.3 4 9 1.3 4 9 1.3 Sheets in Clews of 1 Sail lO 23 o iq 9 ^ 10 9 3 9 19 2 2 9 1900 Bunt-runner - - S. m i 1O 10 1.2 li 1 -O 10 /w.o 1.2 1 .O 10 i0.O 1.2 1 L& 10 L2 ,0 1 Li6 9 -w w 1 1 Jigger for Bunt-runner D. I 8 1.4 1 8 1.4 1 8 1.4 1 8 1.4 1 8 14 Jigger for Bunt-runner S. 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 2 7 11 Clew Jiggers - - S. 4 9 1.2 4 9 1.2 4 9 1.2 4 9 1.2 4 8 11 Boom Tricing-lines S. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 10 Bow-lines in Fore Ton - q 9 10 1C 9 q i e q i i 9 iq 1 C 9 1 9 i ^ Span for Studding-sail o. tm 10 .0 X .0 I.u lO 1.1 2 1O l.O A lie l.O Halliards - - - s. 2 13 1.7 2 13 1.7 2 13 1.7 2 13 1.7 2 12 1.6 Jewel Blocks - - s. 2 13 1.7 2 3 1.7 2 3 1.7 2 13 1.7 2 12 1.6 Studding-sail Tacks on Boom ends - s. 2 10 1.6 2 1.6 2 10 1.6 2 9 1.5 2 8 1.4 Studding-sail Down- hauler in Sails - s. 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 2 7 .9 Leaders for Boom- braces on Bumkin s. 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 Q 1.1 2 8 1.1 2 7 1.1 MAIN TOP-GAL'NT MAST AND YARD. Top Block - - - S. Iron b'd. 1 14 2.2 1 4 2.2 1 14 2.2 1 14 2.2 1 13 2.0 Breast Backstays - S. 2 11 1.1 2 1 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 10 1.1; 2 10 1.1 Breast Backstays in j Channels - - - D. Iron b'd. 2 11 1.1 2 1 1.1 2 11 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1 1.1 Halliards- - - - D. 212 1.3l 2 2 1.3 2 12 1.3 2iJ2 1.3 3)101 1 3 Cerent Blocks of all classes of Vessels, U. S, N. Oont'd. 375 Frig- ates. Sloops of War. Brigs. Brigaii- tines. Schoon- ers. Steam* ers. 2d L 4 4 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 9 2 2 2 1 1 2 4 2 1 1 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 I 2 2 2 Ci 1 ass. 1 1.4 1.4 3.4 3.4 2.5 2.4 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.7 1.7 2.2 2.2 1.0 1.0 1.6 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.2 2.0 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 .9 1.5 1.6 1.6 1.4 .9 1.1 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.2 1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. 1 a M f Js CC 1.3 1.3 3.2 32 2.4 2.2 1.4 !:1 1.6 1.6 2.0 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.2 1.8 1.0 1.1 1.0 1.0 .9 1.4 1.5 1.5 1.3 .9 1.0 1.8 ,0 ^ z g X : _2 '/3 1 J X 1 i | X E .2 I 55 | X | K 1 B t] J lJ 13 13 13 15' 16 22 22 18 15 It I 9 12 i! 11 ll 8 11 9 7 6 8 7 12 12 12 8 7 7 12 9 9 10 | 1.4 1.4 3.4 3.4 2.5 2.4 1.5 :.5 IJ5 1.7 1.7 2.2 22 10 10 16 15 1.5 1.5 1.5 1.2 2.0 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 .9 1.5 1.6 1.6 1.4 .9 1.1 2.0 1.0 l.C ILS 13 13 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 4 a 1 1 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 12 12 12 12 14 14 20 20 16 14 14 16 9 9 9 11 10 10 10 10 & 10 6 6 11 11 11 6 6 11 9 9 & 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 4 2 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 I- 11 12 12 14 13 16 16 14 14 14 15 8 8 8 11 10 10 10 10 7 10 8 7 6 7 7 10 11 11 6 6 6 11 8 8 8 1.3 1.3 3.2 3.2 2.4 2.0 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.6 1.6 1.9 1.9 .9 .9 1.5 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.0 1.8 1.0 1.1 1.0 1.0 .9 1.2 1.5 1.5 1.2 r> 1.0 1.8 1.0 1.0 1.1 2 2 1 1 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 4 2 1 1 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 i a 10 10 11 11 12 12 16 16 12 13 13 14 8 8 8 10 10 10 10 10 7 9 8 7 6 6 7 10 10 10 K 6 6 10 8 & |8 1.2 1.2 3.0 3.0 1.8 1.9 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.5 1.5 1.8 1.8 .9 .9 li4 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.0 1.7 1.0 1.1 1.0 .9 c 1.2 1.4 1.4 1.1 q 1.0 1.6 1.0 1.0 1.0 2 2 1 1 9 9 9 9 1.0 1.0 2.8 2.8 - ! - i 4' 4 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 4 2 1 1 2 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 16 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 I 1 2 2 2 1 1 10 12 12 10 12 12 13 7 7 1C 9 c c c 6 8 b 1.8 1.3 1.3 1.2 1.4 1.4 1.5 1.5 .8 .8 1.4 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 c 1.6 c t 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2-2 2-2 IS 15 14 18 9 9 9 12 11 11 11 8 11 9 7 6 8 / 12 12 12 S 12 r 9 10 .- ^0 2 16 c 9 c 6 1.3 1.3 1.2 1.4 1.4 1.2 1.5 .8 .8 l.L 1.1 1.1 r 1 1 1 2 12 12 10 10 1.3 1.3 L2 8 6 _( t 1 1 6 6 t ji 4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 6 6 c 9 c 5 5 6 r 7 7 7 _c '.8 1.1 1 4 2 6 6 c 3 - : - 1.1 1.0 I - - - - -1 - 376 A Table showing the Size and Description of the DIf- Ships of the Line. Frig- Descrip- 3 DECKS 2 DECKS. Razees. ates. Names of tion of lstClass.|2d Class. IstClass. Blocks. Block. | I 1 | . 1 1 i a ho CO i 1 00 z (K 6 1 1 o 1 s 'i f, GO CO 6 s * JO. 00 MAIN TOP-GAL'NT MAST & YARD. Con. I i Braces on Yard-arms S. 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 101 1.1 2 9 1.0 2 8 1.0 Braces on Collar of 1 Miz. Top-mast Stay s. 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 7 1.2 2 7 1.0 6 1.0 Braces at Mizen Top- mast-head - - - s. 2 7 1.2 2 7 1.2 7 2 7 1.0 6 1.0 Sister - - - - - s. 2 10 1.6 2 10 1.6 10 1.6 2 9 1.5 9 1.5 Lifts in Top - - - S. Clamp. 2 9 1.6 2 9 1.6 9 1.6 2 9 1.5 9 1.5 Lift Jiggers - - - D. 2 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 8 .9 Lift Jiggers - - - S. 21 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 8 .9 Q,uarter~B locks - - D. 210 1.4 2 10 1.4 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 10 1.4 Bunt-lines - - - S. 2 8 .9 2 8 .9 8 .9 2 8 .9 7 .8 Span Blocks, Main Top-gallant Stud- ding-sail Halliards S. 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 Jewel Blocks - - s. 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 Studding-sail Tacks on Boom ends - s. 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 G 1.0 MA'N ROYAL MAST AND YARD. Breast Backstays - s. 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 9 1.1 2 8 1.0 2 8 1.0 Breast Backstays in Ton [). Iron b'd. 2 9 1.1 2 9 l.l 2 q 1.1 2 Q 1 2 Q 1.0 Royal Braces Mizen j O l.U Top-gallant Mast- head - --- s. 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 71.1 duarter Blocks s. 2 7 .9 2 7 .9 2 7 .9 2 G .8 2 61 .8 Bunt-line - - - - s. 1 G .9 1 G .9 1 6 .9 1 6 .9 1 6! .9 Bow-lines leading to 1 F. T. G. Mast-head s. 2 G .8 2 G .8 2 6 .8 2 G .8 2 G .8 MAIN TRY-SAIL MAST & GAFF. 1 Peak Halliards - - D. Iron b'd. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12] 1.4: 1 12 1.4 Peak Halliards - - S. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12) 1.4 1 12 1.4 Throat Halliards - D. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4! 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 Throat Halliards - S. Iron b'd. 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 1 12 1.4 Peak Brails ... Cheek. Throat Brails - - S. 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 Middle Brails - - S. 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2; 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 Foot Brails - - - s. 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 Sheets s. A 10 i ^ A 10 1 ^ A 10 1 ^ 4 10 1 d' A o 1 A Sheets on Booms of I J-U l.O l\J Tb LU ' 1U 1 .Tl ^t .\j two-masted vessels D. Vangs S. 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 MIZEN MAST AND , 1 CROSS-JACK Y'RD. j Pendant Tackles - D. 2,14 1.6 2 14 1.6 2 14 1.6 2 13 1.5 2113 1.5 Pendant Tacklos - S. 2114 1.6 2 14 1.6 2 14 1.6 2 13 1.5 2 13) 1.5 Truss Tackles - - D. 1 9 l.ll 1 9 1.1 1 9 1.1, 1 8 1.0; l| 8)1 ferent Blocks of al! classes of Vessels, U. S. N. Confd. 377 Frig, ates. Sloops of War. Brigs. Brigaii- Schoon- Steam- 2d Class. 1st Class. 2d Class. 1 3d Class. tines. ers* ers. i | I | k _o J I o j 1 1 1 | 8 X 3 do 8 s CO I 1 a> 1 I CO 1 g X "5 i 1 | 1 9 8 1.0 2 r* .9 2 6 .9 2 6 .9 2 8 1.0 1 A q 5 1 9 q r. 1 G l.U 1A .y q 2 O .J 5 a 2 .y q U G 1 .V 1.0 9 8 .U 1.4 2 7 i/ 2 7 1.3 2 G .*/ 1.2 2 5 1.1 _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 8 1.4 2 8 1.4 2 8 L4 2 8 1.4 2 8 1.4 _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 8 1.4 8 .9 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 2 G .8 2 G .7 _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 8 .9 g O 2 * g 2 r Q 2 r. r 8 .9 2 10 L4 2 9 .O 1.3 2 / 8 L2 2 8 .O 1.2 2 O 8 1.2 2 7 1.0 _ _ _ 2 9 L3 2 7 .8 2 7 .8 1 G .8 1 G .7 1 5 .6 - - - - - - 2 7 .8 7 I! 2 7 1.1 2 1.0 2 (3 10 2 f\ .9 Q 7 1.1 2 1 7 .1 1.1 2 / 7 LI 2 6 LO 2 G ,.U 1.0 2 \t G - - - - - - 9 2 7 l.'l ft 1 , q 2 , a . q 2 r; Q 6 10 O 7 i.v .9 2 G j .8 2 G .*/ .7 9 2 G *u .7 2 O 6 G .6 2 7 .9 8 7 .9 2 G .8 2 G .7 2 G .7 2 G .6 - - - - - - 2 7 .9 2 G 1.0 2 6 1.0 2 G 1.0 2 6 1.0 2 5 .9 . _ 2 6 1.0 2 5 .7 2 5 .7 2 5 .7 2 5 .7 2 4 .6 _ _ _ _ _ _ 2 5 .7 i c Iq 6 Iq i i; O 5 9 .7 2 5 .7 2 5 .7 2 5 .7 2 4 .6 - - - - - - 2 5 *7 .7 i 11 1 10 1.3 1 10 1.3 , 8 I 8 1.1 1 14 1.6 1 14 l.G 1 11 1.4 i 11 Li 1 10 1.3 ] 10 1.3 1 8 1 8 1.1 2 14 1.6 2 14 l.G 1 11 1.4 i 11 1.4 1 10 1.3 1 10 1.3 1 8 1 8 1.1 1 14 1.6 1 14 l.G 1 11 1.4 i 11 1.4 1 10 1.3 1 10 1.3 1 8 1 8 1.1 1 14 1.6 1 14 1.6 1 11 1.4 2 8 1.2 2 1 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 2 6 1.0 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 7 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 2 G 1.0 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 i 1.1 2 7 1.1 2 7 L 2 G 1.0 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 2 8 1.2 4 9 1.4 4 8 1.2 4 8 1.2 4 8 1.2 2 2 12 10 1.5 2 2 19 1.5 1 P, 2 12 12 1.5 1.5 4 9 1.4 2 71.1 2 ** 1.1 2 6 1.0 2 G 1.0 2 1 G I'.C a L2E 6 i .0 1.0 & 2 LAf 6 LO 2 r 2 191 A. 2 U 1.3 2 U 1 ^ 1 1 1.3 2 12 1.4 2 'l2i 14 2 1 ' 2 , , i .0 ** i q o 11 2 12 14 - ip'tl pi 1 .0 < ' p t i . *i 28 378 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dif- Ships of the Line. Frig. Descrip- 2 DECKS. Razees ates. Names of tion of o DECKS IstClass 2d Class IstClass. Blocks. * i i $ |j Block. _s J2 j : .2 ;2 i 02 1 & a CO 1 1 i 1 a i as 1 .S 7 7 10 10 10 p' 10 10 8 10 f c 14 1G 10 10 12 12 8 14 14 10 10 [5 8 7 7 9 8 7 7 9 6 9 8 7 7 7 i 10 10 10 1.8 1.3 1.3 1.7 1.2 1.2 2/9 1.0 1.D 1.4 1.2 12 20 1.2 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.5 1.5 .8 .8 1.3 1.3 .0 .0 .1 .0 .8 .0 .0 .8 .8 1.4 1.4 i .1 1.8 j j 13 1.7 1.2 1.2 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.4 1:2 1.2 2.0 1.2 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.5 1.5 .8 .8 1.3 1.3 1.0 1.0 1.1 1.0 1.8 1.0 1.0 .8 .8 1.4 1.4 1,4 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 9 B 8 8 b 8 14 1-1 9 9 11 11 8 12 12 10 10 13 7 7 7 8 7 1 8 7 6 7 7 9 9 9 1.7 1.2 1.2 1.5 1.1 1.1 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 2.0 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.5 1.5 .8 .8 1.3 1.2 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.7 .9 .9 .8 .6 1.3 1.3 1 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 & r 6 8 8 13 14 9 9 11 11 8 1-2 1-2 9 9 13 6 6 G 8 / 6 6 8 (3 8 7 (i 6 G 8 8 R 1.6 1.2 1.1 1.5 1.1 1.1 1.8 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 2.0 1.1 1.1 1.0 1.0 1.4 1.4 .7 .7 1.3 1.2 .9 .9 1.0 1.0 1.7 .9 .9 .7 .7 1.3 1.3 1 3 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 9, 8 8 8 8 8 13 14 r c 11 11 & 11 11 & 8 13 G G 6 8 6 6 6 7 G 8 7 G G G 9 8 S 1.6 1.1 1.1 1.5 1.1 1.1 1.8 . g - 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 1 2 9 - - - - - - - - - - ~ - - ~ - 1 ~ 1 ~ - 2.0 1.0 1.0 .9 c 1.4 1.4 . i . / 1.3 1.1 .9 .9 .9 1.0 1.7 .9 .9 .7 .7 1.3 1.3 1 3 - - - - ~ - - - - - ] 380 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dif- Names of Blocks. Descrip- tion of Block. Ships of the Lino. Razees. Fri S - ates. IstClass 3 DECKS 2 DECKS. lstClass.|2d Class S | 00 o g OS 1 03 & 1 !| 02 I S ' OD | o I #' J2 JL i.y 1.2 1.0 1.3 MIZEN TOP-GAL'T MAST & YARD. Con Halliards ... Halliards - - - Braces on Yard-arms Braces on Main Top- mast Backstays - D. S. D. S. S. D. S. D. S. D. S. D.Ironb'd. S. S. S. S. S. D. S. D. S. D.Ironb'd. S. D. S. Iron b'd. : Cheek. S. S. S. S. S. S. D. 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 t 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 8 8 G 8 1.2 1.2 1.0 .M 1 8 8 6 8 1.2 1.2 1.0 1.4 1 1 2 c o S 8 G 8 1.2 1.2 1.0 1.4 1 2 2 8 8 G 1.2 1.2 1.0 1.3 1 1 2 2 8 8 G 7 Lifts in Top (Bull's Eyes) - - - - Lift Jiggers - - - Lift Jiggers - - - duarter Blocks Bunt-line - - - - Bow-lines at Main Top-mast head - MIZ. ROYAL MAST AND YARD. Breast Backstays - Breast Backstays in 7 / i 7 7 7 G G G G 13 12 12 12 12 14 13 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 .8 .8 .8 1.0 1.0 1.0 2.7 1.2 1.2 1.7 1.7 1.4 1.4 1 2 o ^ 2 9 m i 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 r+ t* / f* i 7 7 G G 6 G 13 12 12 12 12 14 13 1.0 l.C 1.2 1.2 1.2 .8 .8 .8 1.0 1.0 1.0 2.7 1.2 1.2 1.7 1.7 1.4 1.4 i S t I o 2 o 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 7 7 7 7 7 7 7 6 G 6 G 13 12 12 12 12 14 13 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 , .8 .8 1.0 1.0 1.0 2.7 1.2 1.2 1.7 1.7 1.4 1.4 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 ~ T 7 6 G G G G G 13 12 12 12 12 13 12 13 13 9 8 8 13 8 8 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 .8 .8 .8- 1.0 1.0 1.0 2.7 1.2 1.2 1.7 1.7 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4. .2 .1 1 7 2 1.2 o f x 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 i il 7 7 7 7 7 6 G 6 G 6 G 12 11 11 11 L3 12 1.0 1.0 1.2 1.2 1.2 .8 .8 .8 1.0 1.0 1.0 2.5 1.2 1.2 1.5 1.5 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.4 1.1 1.0 1.0 1.5 1.1 l.l Quarter Blocks - - Braces Main Top- mast-head - - - Bow-lines leading to M'n Top-masi head Bunt-lines ... SPANKER BOOM AND GAFF. 1 opping-lifts - - Tackles for Topping- lift <5 Tackles for Topping- lifts: Peak Halliards - - Peak Halliards - . Throat Halliards - Throat Halliards - Peak Brails - - Throat Brails Middle Brails - - Foot Brails - - - Outhauler ... 14 9 8 8 13 8 8 1.4 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.7 1.2 1.2 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 14 9 8 8 13 8 8 1.4 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.7 1.2 1.2 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 14 9 8 8 13 8 8 1.4 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.7 1.2 1.2 13 8 8 8 12 7 7 Vangs leading on Quarter - - - Dasher Block (En- sign Halliards) - ferent Blocks of all classes of Vessels, U. S. N. Cont'd. 381 Frig- ates. 3d Class. Sloops of War. 1 Brigs. Brigau- tinea. Schoon- ers. | Steam- ers. '1st Class. 2d Class. 3d Class. A A | .(. OJ i ! j 02 c 2 | X 1 1 | i =5 1 | i OQ jt 00 A Z S X 02 1 g X \ X : | BO 7 7 5 7 6 6 6 6 G G G 6 5 5 5 12 10 10 10 10 12 11 12 12 S 8 8 12 7 7 | M 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 I 2 I I 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 7 7 5 7 6 6 6 G G 6 6 6 5 5 5 12 10 10 10 10 ]2 11 12 12- 8 8 8 12 1.0 1.0 .9 1.3 .9 .9 1.1 1.1 .8 .8 .8 .9 .9 .9 2.5 1.1 1.1 1.4 1.4 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.1 1.0 1.0 1.5 1.1 1.1 - 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 7 7 5 G 1.0 1.0 .9 1.2 1 ] 2 2 6 6 4 G .9 .9 .8 1.2 1 1 2 2 6 G 5 5 .9 .9 9 LO 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 1 1 2 1 l\ 2 f 1.0 1.0 .9 1.3 .9 .9 1.1 l.< l.l 8 8 8 9 9 9 25 11 1.1 1.4 1.4 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.3 1.1 1.0 1.0 1.5 1.1 l.l : 6 G 6 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 11 9 ,8 10 11 10 11 11 8 7 7 10 7 7 .9 .9 1.1 1.0 1.0 .8 .8 .8 .9 .9 .9 2.0 1.0 1.0 1.4 1.4 1.2 1.3 1.2 1.2 1.1 .9 .9 1.4 1.1 1.1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 11 S S 10 10 10 10 10 10 7 7 7 9 7 7 .8 .8 1.0 1.0 1.0 .8 .8 .8 .& .8 .8 2.0 .9 .9 1.4 1.4 1.1 1.2 1.1 1.1 1.0 .9 .9 1.2 1.1 1.1 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 2 2 2 2 o j 1 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 1 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 11 S 8 10 10 10 9 10 10 7 7 7 9 G 6 .8 .8 1.0 .9 .9 .8 .8 .8 .8 .8 .8 2.0 .9 .9 1.4 1.4 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.1 1.0 .9 .9 1.2 .9 .9 2 2 2 10 6 S 1.8 .9 .9 2 4 2 10 10 10 1.8 1.1 1.1 2 4 2 11 11 11 2.0 1.2 1.2 _ : ] j 1 - -, 1 1 3S2 A Table showing the Size and Description of the Dii- Names of Des. of Ships of the Line. Razees. Frig- ates. 1st Class, 3 DECKS. 2 DECKS. 1st Class. 2d Class. Blocks. ^ i ' > i Bl'clt. Js o .2 J2 -2 1 a "5 f (0 1 02 | 3 cc ' OQ 1 < 1 03 1 a ! MISCELLANEOUS BLOCKS. Cat Blocks - - - T. 2 20 2.6 2 20 2.6 2 20 2.6 2 20i2.5 2 18 23 Cat Backropes - - Fish Tackle - - S. D. 4 4 9 20 1.2 2.2 4 4 9 20 1.2 2.2 4 4 9 20 1.2 2.2 4 4 911.2 202.2 4 4 8 20 1.1 2.0 Fish Leaders - - S. u 18 2.2 3 18 2.2 3 18 2.2 3 1&2.& 3 16 1.8 1 -i Clear Hawse Pend'nts Bull's Eyes for clothes- linps - . . 1 100 100 100 100 J 80 r Vit 2 2 2 _! 2 Cap Bobstay Hearts mj Jl _ . J T TT? A- Li. V It. LVit A 4 dole ana inner 1 rts Bowsprit Shr'ds H'rts . Vlt. L.Vit. 1 8 - _ 8 - _ & _ _ 8 _ -| 8 _ - Iron-strapped Bull's Eyes (in head), size and number as req'd Luff Tackle Blocks S. 60 12 1.4 60 12 1.4 60 12 1.4 60 12 1. 40 12 1.4 Luff Tackle Blocks for Stays - --- D. 16 15 1.8 16 15 1.8 16 15 1.8 16 14 1.6 16 14 1.6 Leading Rigging on Fo'castle and Gang- ways - - - - Assort 12 _ 12 _ _ 12 _ 12 _ _ 12 _ __ Fife-rail Leaders - S. d.sc 56 _ 56 _ _ 56 _ 56 _ _ 56 _ _ Bide Leaders - - 100 - _ 100 - _ 100 _ 100 - "i 100 - _ Snatch Blocks - - Assort 20 _ 20 _ 20 _ 20 J 20 _ _ Hammock Girt-lines S. 20 1-2 1.8 20 12 1.8 20 1-2 1.8 20 12 1.8 16 11 1.5 Ham'ck Tricing-lines S. 12 10 1.4 12 10 1.4 12 10 1.4 12 10 1.4 12 9 1.0 Relieving Tackles - D. 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 Relieving Tackles - S. 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 10 1.4 Awning Jiggers D. 8 10 1.4 8 10 1.4 8 10 1.4 8 10 1.4 8 9 1.2 Lower Yard Whips S. 4 9 1.1 4 9 1.1 4 9 1.1 4 9 1-1 4 8 1.0 Crow-foot Halliards for Awnings - - S. 12 7 .9 12 7 .9 12 "^ .9 12 7 .9 12 7 .9 Stern, Gluarter and I Waist Davit Blocks D.Irb. 20 10 1.4 20 10 1.4 20 10 1.4 20 10 1.4 12 10 1.4 \eading Trucks D. 30 - - 30 - _ 30 - - 30 - _ 30 - - Leading Trucks - S. 30 - _ 30 _ 30 _ _ 30 _ _ 30 - Fore Yard - - - Fiddle 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 Fore Yard - - - S. 2 18 1.7 2 18 1.7 2 18 1.7 2 1G 1.7 2 1G 1.7 Fore Stay - - - D. 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 1G 1.7 1 16 1.7 Fore Stay ... S. 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 1G 1.7 1 16 1.7 Main Yard - - - Fiddle 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 2 }3 1.7 2 33 1.7 2 33 1.7 Main Yard - - - S. 2 18 1.7 2 18 1.7 2 18 1.7 2 1G 1.7 2 16 1.7 Main Stay - - - D. 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 16 1.7 1 16 1.7 Main Stay - - - S. 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 17 1.7 1 1G 1.7 1 1G 1.7 Gluarter and Stay - S. 4 16 1.6 4 16 1.6 4 16 1.6 4 15 1.6 4 15 1.6 Dead Eyes (set) - Stock and Bill Tackle D. 1 2 12 1.6 1 2 I _ 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 212 1.6 Stock and Bill Tackle S. 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 2 12 1.6 Trucks for Jaws of Gaff (set) - - - 1 _ _ 1 _ _ 1 _ _ 1 _ _ 1 _ _. Masthead Trucks(set) - 1 - - 1 - - 1 - - 1 - - 1 - - F. T. Studding-sail Boom Burtons - D. 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 210 I.I F. T. Studding-sail 1 Booin Burtons - S. 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 2 10 1.1 210IU ferent Blocks of all classes of Vessels, U. S N. Conc'd. 383 F*rig- ates. Sloops of War. Brigs. Brigan- Schoou Steam- 2d Class. 1st Class.) 2d Class. 1 3d Class. tines. ers. j j | j j 1 J j i 1 j n i 1 i 00 6 1 1 i | r a 6 4 02 o 1 I fZ* 1 .* 3 17 2.1 2 16 2.0 2 15 1.9 2 14 1.8 2D 13 1.7 2D 12 1.6 2D 11 1.5 17 2.1 C' 1 I 4 ^ 1 7 i n 4 8 1 i 4 1 O ."1 A ' 4 18 4 lo 1 ft 1 o 3 16 i y 3 li fiO _ 40 40 -J40 20 20 20 60 - 9, _ 2 _ _ 2 _ -. 2 _ __ 2 _ _ 2 _ _ 2 _ _ 2 _ - > A 4 "* 1 Q 40 11 1.4 24 10 1.2 24 10 1.2 24 10 1.2 20 10 1.2 20 9 1.1 20 9 1.1 40 11 1.4 IG 13 1.5 8 12 1.4 8 12 1.3 8 11 1.3 8 11 1.3 4 10 1.2 4 10 1.2 16 13 1.5 9 g g g 1 40 I -36 _ _ 36 _ _ 36 _ _ 20 _ _ 20 _ _ 20 -1 - 40 _ _ 100 _ -80 _ _ 80 _ _ 70 _ _ 40 - _ 40 - - 20 -I _ 100 - - 90 _ - 15 15 _ _ 15 _ 10 _ _ 10 _ _ 8 _ - 15 _ 16 19 10 9 1.4 12 1.0 12 10 9 1.4 12 1.0 12 9 8 1.2 1.0 12 12 9 8 1.2 1 8 8 9 7 1.2 .9 8 8 9 7 1.2 .9 8 8 9 7 l i 16 12 101.4 91.0 2 10 1.4 -2 10 1.4 2 9 1.2 2 9 1 :> 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 2 10 1.4 210 1.4 2 10 1.4 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2 2 9 1.2. 2 9 1.2 2 10 1.4 8 9 1.2 8 8 1.1 8 8 1.1 8 7 9 6 7 .9 6 6 .8 G G .8 - 9 1.2 4 8 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 7 1.0 4 G .8 4 G .8 2 G 4 8 1.0 <9 G .8 6 6 .8 6 G .8 6 6 .8 4 5 .7 4 5 .7 4 5 .7 6 6 ,8 /2 10 1.2 10 9 1.1 10 9 1.1 10 8 1.0 10 8 1.0 10 8 1.0 10 8 1.0 12 10 1.2 30 _ -20 _ _ 20 _ _ 20 _ V2 _ _ 12 _ 12 _ - 30 _ 30 _ - j:> _ 20 _ _ 20 _ 12 _ _ 12 _ _ 12 _ _ 30 _ _ r> 30 1.6 2 24 1.5 2 22 1.5 2 22 1 4 20 1.4 1 20 1.3 1 20 1.3 2 30 1.6 2 IG 1.5 2 14 1.5 2 13 13 2 13 1 3 12 1.2 1 12 1.2 1 10 1.1 2 16 1.5 1,15 1.6 1 13 1.5 1 13 .5 1 13 1.5 12 1.3 1 10 1.2 _ _ _ 1 15 1.6 1 15 1 G 1 13 1 5 1 13 5 1 13 1 5 12 1.3 1 10 1.2 _ _ _ 1 15 l.G 3 2 30 16 1.6 1.5 2 2 24 14 1.5 1.5 2 2 22 13 .5 .3 2 2 22 13 1.4 1.3 20 12 1.4 1.2 1 1 20 12 1.3 1.2 1 1 30 10 1.3 1.1 2 2 30 IG l.G 1.5 1 15' 1.6 1 13 1.5 1 13 .5 1 13 1 5 12 1.3 1 10 1.2 - _ - 1 15 l.G 1 15! 1.6 1 13 1.5 1 13 .5 1 13 1 5 12 13 1 10 1.2 _ _ _ 1 15 l.G 4 141.5 4 13 1.5 4 12 .4 4 12 1.4 4 10 1.1 - - _ - 4 Hll.5 ' 1 1 1 J - 9 1114 1 4 10 1 9 10 U 7 ,J 11 1 4 1 4 in i 19 in 1 \ 1 4 1 i 1 _! : 1 ajlOJl.1 2 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 2 9 1.0 210 l.G 2ilO 1.1 2 9 1 2 9 1 9 Q i n 2lloll 384 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 625. A Table showing the projective Distances from Spar-deek of U. S. Ship North Carolina. From Night-head to Bowsprit Cap 53 feet. to Jib-boom - 91 " " to Flying Jib-boom 109 " to Jib of Jib-Truck - - 128 " From Spar-deck to Fore Cap " toF. T. M. Cap - 122i " h " to F. T. Gallant Cap - 145* " " " to F. Royal Cap 170* " " " to F. Sky-sail Truck - 187* " " " to Main Cap 90 " to M. T. M. Cap - 141 " " " to M. T. Gallant Cap - 166 " to M. Royal Cap - 193| " " " to M. Sky-sail Truck 21H " toMizenCap 75f " " " to M. T. M. Cap - 116 " " to M. T. Gallant Cap - - 136 " " to M. Royal Cap - 158 " " to M. Sky-sail Truck - - 173 " Length on Spar-deck 209 >' Main Gun-deck ------ - 207 " Lower Gun-deck - - - - 201 Extreme length from Night-head to Taffrail - 210 " i Ft. In. Breadth of Beam ------ 53.6 Depth from Taffrail to False Keel 53.4 Height from Water to Port-sill 7.6 Height between deck from Spar to Main Gun-deck 7.1 " " " from Main to Lower Gun-deck 7.3 from Lower to Orlop - Size of Spar-deck Beam - 10 " of Main Gun-deck Beam - ... 1.3 " of Lower Gun-deck Beam - - - - 1.3 Height from Port-sills to Spar-deck - .7 " " to Main Gun-deck 1.11 " to Lower Gun-deck - - 2.2 OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 385 Distance between Ports No. 1 and 2, Spar-deck It 11 2 u 3, u It tl 3 tt 4, u - It It 4 u 5, u It tt 5 ti 6, u u It 6 u 7, I u 11 7 ii 8, It - " " 8 " *" J tt a 9 u 10, u tt u 10 tt 11, 11 tl it 11 u 12 tt . u tt 12 u is; u tt it 13 a 14, tl - " u 14 u 15, " tt 15 tt 16 " . 16 n 17, " <; It 1 T u 1 Q u m j- 1 5 11 After Port and Counter - U Bridle Port and No. 1 Main Gun- deck ... " All the other Ports " After Port and Counter Ft Iiv 8.1 12.5 7. 6.10 8. 8. 8. 7.9 7. 7.10 5.10 7. 10.3 6.8 10.2 9.9 6. 7.6 11. 8. 12.6 Between Poi is on Lower Gun-deck the same. Size of Spar-deck Ports *' Main Gun-deck do. " Lower Gun-deck do. Length. 3.1 3.6 3.2 Depth. 3.6 2.11 2.11 386 THE KEDGE-ANCHOR; I - H| J o CO r-^^4 CO-H>- ra fc s bpi j -^ ~' CO* 00 Ct irf CO i-^ iii'" f^O ^^ 00 CO C^ i"^ *~^ 55 iL JO 00 l^^ 00 * -H CO* CJ 3^ O O t: JJ8 rr^ I' 1 1 ei 10 ' 1 r-^ i-^ 1 . "~I . o o ^ S w o i! J i i 35 i i S i i i i # ^ . o CM ^0 Ol 3 = CO o O a J 00 ^ ^H ill Tf O O O co' cri M 1 Usfl*; J 00 O O O o CO ^1 s Jo 2 ^-1 CO' ^ H 'E-^ j irf H*0^ 1 1 1 1 II II 1 l-i 3 - < 5> 05 tj ^H i ^ ^ s S g l 'j o ci -H o* O ',3 J3-.JM * 3 ""* _ J|S . - S s ^ H S o" o" |i J 1 1 1 CO 1 1 1 1 I' 1 1 1 1 CO g f * i 00 00 ffsj I ill 511 a * !3 i i ' i i i n i ii i i i i 1 2 fl* is r ~ l ^ CO js a I __ |1| - S S^ S "i H Z3e> ^ ^ CO JgMJ 511 i i o,- i i i i N -o ' ' id ||| CO CO ^ CO CO CO Is j C? 00 O CO rj< ~ ci IS 2 ^ ^ C? Ci ^Q rt Q ^ ^-Q Js rt rt Q "5 *S - SS Q S|22 2s sSif Is all Ilis 11 11 11 foc/2 Hfcfei cccoHS Hy nHfofa i OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 387 tm ee Weight of Offi- cers and Crew, & their eilectii. ton. cwt. \r. It*. 0* -^ co'o co'od 3 a* pi 4 O O ww T^T*. 0? jo 3 9 * ft u 1 CO OJ oco' 1 cicio 0* ' 1-H o Crj 00 i 3 *a 1 C S 04 C M n ^ N* O i^= :l^ s s e ? H <=? CO CO O O 2 ~~ a""Saj a 3 8 s - COCNCOCO s M ^ i I!li s I li . s| 00 s : 1 1 0*0 o* o E lis ^ 3 O t- i-^ ^ C *- H i ** i- gi^ 111 r 2 ! S ? O 0(N ^nCO 0* 00* -* o' o <-*o ^ ^f Oonl, Paints, 1'iiint Oil, mid Naval Stores. J 1 1 co c l~ 'I ' 00 ci co* ^ s -" 0* o* \ c g^ IS" x Galley. Forpe, ami their Ap- purtenances Spare Iron. ton. cwt. qr. lb. 00 t-; ii ?j i 2 1 1 1 1 3 I! 2 e f* "** X *-i ton. cwt. qr. Ibs. C5 i ii 1 5 1 ' ' S 0* H -^ -i M CS3 I i ** i IWM. j S TT^D 89^'cs 1 1 1 1 i r 5 = Boats and their BqoipflMnte. A i " ' ' i 00 od ' o ' 0* 0* 11 1 2^ w S 2 2 !2 S 2S3 4 pQ E -" 2 0* 0* 0* C* CO CO O O CO fee .*|3 s ^Jco'cO* rt^?OO ^3 2n2 ' ^ ^ ^ c "o I O' rj" O* C: -H O* OC O* 000 3 o ^= 1 1 1 1 1 1 OB ^ DATE WHEN ON HOARD. <.g ll foCQ iSiilif Slit "rt 388 u M o s ss 5C ti g QB "*^ 25 ^^ *3S O Ii 'a sS ll a? ** f| s- ii j i 1 1 Draft of Water ait ending each day. I _: THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; ooto o i ' o o i i c$ -^ i~- to co TJ< n in oono 050 to co t- 1- Draft of Water forward ending each day. j r-oc^ i-< co o 50 oo o 1-1 " OS Hospital Stores. j c* d 3 1 1 III till II ^111 CO Master's Stores. I J I ii lit I i i i ii 3; i i oo ro Sailmaker's Stores. i I ii iii i i i i i [H i i 1 2 O 1~4 Carpenter's Stores. ton. cwt qrs. Ibs. i i 111 i i i i ii i S S t-J 0* 1 Gunner's Stores. ton. cwt. qrs. Ibe. S ^ c5 ii 111 2 i i i Si J3 i i C$ i-I O s 1 Boatswain's Stores. ton. cwt. qrs. Ibs. O O t ii 111 itii i S i iS CO' rH Purser's Stores 4 I CO 5O ll III I I I i ii 1 1 e 3 00* CO < 1 CO Small Arms & Arm-chest. Iton. cwt qrs. Ibs. 3! II III 1 1 1 1 II 1 1 ^ 1 o" o' g| ffio f 1 1 1 ^Q ^Q ^ ^JS> ^ Q Q-5-? S| **& &^ | |||| OR YOUJSG^ SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 389 RECIPES. 5 2 7. FOR BLACKING SHIP'S STANDING-RIGGING. To a half barrel of tar add 6 gallons of whiskey, 4 pounds of litharge, 4 pounds lamp-black, 2 buckets of boiling beef-pickle, or hot salt water out of the coppers, if the other cannot be had conveniently ; mix well together and apply immediately. 528. FOR BLACKING GUNS. Six pound of beeswax mixed with one gallon of spirits of tur- pentine, one paper of lamp-black, mixed well together, for twenty 24 pounders. Note. The beeswax to be cut fine, and dissolved in spirits of turpentine before being mixed with the lamp-black. 529. FOR BLACKING HAMMOCK-CLOTHS, YARDS, AND BENDS. First scrub the cloth well with salt water, and while wet put on the first coat of priming, which should be well-ground paint, with one and-a-half pounds of beeswax added to each gallon of paint ; after the first coat is dry, put on second, mixed as follows, viz. : one pound lamp-black mixed for paint, one pound red lead, one gallon paint oil, half pound litharge, and half an ounce of indigo, boiled for half an hour, and stirred at intervals. Care should be taken that the composition boils that length of time. After it has cooled a little, add one pint of spirits of turpentine ; apply when warm, and it will dry in a short time with a beauti- ful gloss, and be perfectly limber. This last mixture has been found very suitable for yards, and also the bends ; but it must never be used too warm, particularly on canvass, in which case it will lose its gloss. The priming, or first coat, is not put OD cloths that have been blacked before. 390 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 53O. FOR MAKING LIQUID-BLACKING. Four ounces of ivory black, five or six table-spoonsful of mo- lasses, one and a-half ounce oil of vitriol, one and a-half ounce sweet oil, and six gills of vinegar. After mixing the ingredients together well and stirring them frequently, the blacking will be fit for use. 531. FOR BLACKING GUNS. Six ounces of lamp-black, three pints of spirits of turpentine, and three ounces of litharge to be put in after the lamp-black and turpentine are well mixed ; add one ounce of umber to give it a gloss, and one gallon bright varnish. 532. COMPOSITION FOR BLACKING GUNS. Six pounds of beeswax cut up fine, then add seven quarts spirits of turpentine; let it stand until it is well dissolved, then add one pound lamp-black, and mix it well together. 533 FOR MAKING BLACK-VARNISH, NO. I. Two pounds of gum shellac, two pounds umber, one gallon linseed oil, and quarter pound of lamp-black ; boiled together foi four hours over a slow fire. 534. COMPOSITION FOR BLACKING HAMMOCK CLOTHS, NO. I. Twenty pounds of beeswax, four pounds rosin, two gallons spirits of turpentine, one gallon paint oil, and six pound of lamp- black. Boil them well together, and keep it warm while put ting on. Note. To be primed first with lead-colored paint. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 391 535. COMPOSITION FOR HAMMOCK CLOTHS, NO. II Forty-eight pounds of yellow ochre, eight pounds black paint, half pound soap, and three pints of fresh water. 536. FOE, HAMMOCK CLOTHS, NO. III. Half a pound of black paint, three pounds yellow ochre, half pound of soap, three-quarters of a gill of fresh water. 537. FOE HAMMOCK CLOTHS, NO. IV. Eighty pounds black paint well ground, ten gallons linseed oil, ten pounds of beeswax, five pounds litharge, and one gallon of spirits of turpentine. For blacking bends, add two gallons of tar. 538. FOE MAKING BLACK-VAENISH, NO. IL One gallon of the spirits of turpentine, one pound and four ounces of rosin, one pound and four ounces lamp-black, and one quart of linseed oil ; to be boiled on a slow fire for half-an-hour then used or laid on when cold. 539. SOLDEE FOE COPPER. Nothing is necessary here, but good tough borax and brass, well mixed together with water, to the consistence of paste. 29 392 THE KEDGE- ANCHOR; 5 4O. SOLDER FOR LEAD. Take two parts of water-lead, and one part of tin ; its good- ness is tried by melting it, and pouring the size of a half dollar piece on a table ; then if it be good there will arise small, bright stars or beads on it. Apply rosin when you use it. 541.- TO MAKE THE BEST DRYING OIL. Mix one pound of litharge of gold to every six gallons of oil ; ooil it over a slow fire, but riot too much, least it prove too *hick, and be unserviceable. 542. FOR BLACK STAIN. Four ounces of copperas ; iron rust, or a few pieces of old iron noop ; one gallon of vinegar ; half pound lamp-black, and a small quantity of oak shavings. 543. BLACKING GUNS, SHOT, &o. Coal tar alone, or mixed with a little salt water, is a good thing for blacking guns and shot. It should be -laid on quite warm, and if the day be cold, a hot shot may with advantage be put into the, guns to warm the metal, and make it take the black- ing better, due attention being previously paid to unloading. Lay the stuff on as thin as possible, with paint-brushes, using hot loggerheads or bolts to keep it warm. If well laid on, and wiped afterwards with an oil-cloth oc- casionally, this process will prevent rust, and preserve the good look of the guns for a length of time, without having recourse to washing with water. OR YOUNG SAILORS' ASSISTANT. 393 544. FRENCH RECIPE FOR BLACKING GUNS, &c. To one gallon of vinegar, put ten ounces of lamp-black, and one pound and a-half of clear sifted iron-rust, and mix them well together. Lay this on the guns after a good coat of black paint, and rub it occasionally with a soft oil-cloth. IMPORTANT SCIENTIFIC WORKS. I. APPLETONS' CYCLOPAEDIA OF APPLIED MECHANICS. A Dictionary of Mechanical Engineering and the Mechanical Arts. Illustrated by 5,000 Engravings. Edited by PARK BENJAMIN, Ph. D. 2 vols., 8vo. Sheep, 15.00; half morocco, $17.00. APPLETOXS' CYCLOPAEDIA OP APPLIED MECHANICS of 1879 is a new work, and not a revision of the former Dictionary of Mechanics of 1850. It presents the best and latest American practice in the mechanical arts, and compares the same with that of other nations. It also exhibits the extent to which American inven- tion and discovery have contributed to the world's progress during the last quarter century. The contributors include many of the most eminent American mechani- cal experts and engineers. Several of their contributions contain the results of original research and thought never before published. Their efforts have in all cases tended to simplify the subjects treated, to avoid technicalities, and so to render all that is presented easily understood by the general reader as well as by the mechanical student. Examples are appended to all rules, explanations to all tables, and in such matters as the uses of tools and management of machines the instructions are unusually minute and accurate. II. Arnott, Neil. Elements of Physics ; or, Natural Philosophy. Seventh edition. 12 mo. Cloth, $3.00. III. Bourne, John. A Catechism of the Steam-Engine. New revised edition, with Illustrations. 12mo. Cloth, $1.75. rv. Bourne, John. Hand-Book of the Steam-Engine. Constituting a Key to the " Catechism of the Steam-Engine." Illustrated with 67 Woodcuts. 12mo. Cloth, $1.75. V. Bourne, John. A Treatise on the Steam-Engine in its various Applications tc Mines, Mills, Steam Navigation, Railways, and Agriculture ; with Theoreti- cal Investigations respecting the Motive Power of Heat, and the Proper Proportions of Steam-Engines, Elaborate Tables of the Right Dimensions of every Part, and Practical Instruction for the Manufacture and Manage- ment of every Species of Engine in Actual Use. Being the seventh edition of " A Treatise on the Steam-Engine," by the " Artisan Club." Illustrated with 37 Plates and 546 Woodcuts. 4to. Cloth, $12.00. IMPORTANT SCIENTIFIC WORKS. I. APPLETONS' CYCLOPAEDIA OF APPLIED MECHANICS. A Dictionary of Mechanical Engineering and the Mechanical Arts. Illustrated by 5,000 Engravings. Edited by PARK BENJAMIN, Ph. D. 2 vols., 8vo. Sheep, $15.00; half morocco, $17.00. APPLETOXS' CYCLOPAEDIA OF APPLIED MECHANICS of 1879 is a new work, and not a revision of the former Dictionary of Mechanics of 1850. It presents the best and latest American practice in the mechanical arts, and compares the same with that of other nations. It also exhibits the extent to which American inven- tion and discovery have contributed to the world's progress during the last quarter century. The contributors include many of the most eminent American mechani- cal experts and engineers. Several of their contributions contain the results of original research and thought never before published. Their efforts have in all cases tended to simplify the subjects treated, to avoid technicalities, and so to render all that is presented easily understood by the general reader as well as by the mechanical student. Examples are appended to all rules, explanations to all tables, and in such matters as the uses of tools and management of machines the instructions are unusually minute and accurate. II. Arnott, Neil. Elements of Physics ; or, Xatural Philosophy. Seventh edition. 12mo. Cloth, $3.00. III. Bourne, John. A Catechism of the Steam-Engine. Xew revised edition, with Illustrations. 12mo. Cloth, $1.75. IV. Bourne, John. Hand-Book of the Steam-Engine. Constituting a Key to the ' Catechism of the Steam-Engine." Illustrated with 67 Woodcuts. 12mo. Cloth, $1.75. V. Bourne, John. A Treatise on the Steam-Engine hi its various Applications tc Mines, Mills, Steam Navigation, Railways, and Agriculture ; with Theoreti- cal Investigations respecting the Motive Power of Heat, and the Proper Proportions of Steam-Engines, Elaborate Tables of the Right Dimensions of every Part, and Practical Instruction for the Manufacture and Manage- ment of every Species of Engine in Actual Use. Being the seventh edition of " A Treatise on the Steam-Engine," by the " Artisan Club." Illustrated with 37 Plates and 546 Woodcuts. 4to. Cloth, $12.00. IMPORTANT SCIENTIFIC WORKS. (Continued.) VI. Carpenter, W. B. Principles of Mental Physiology, with their Application to the Training and Discipline of the Mind, and the Study of its Morbid Conditions. 12mo. Cloth, $3.00. VII. Chauveau, Professor A. The Comparative Anatomy of the Domesticated Animals. By A. CHAUVEAU, Professor at the Lyons Veterinary School. Second edition, revised and enlarged, with the Cooperation of S. Arloing, late Principal of Anatomy at the Lyons Veterinary School. Translated and edited by James Fleming. With 450 Illustrations. 8vo. Cloth, $6.00. VIII. Deschanel, A. P. Elementary Treatise on Natural Philosophy. By A. PRI- VAT DESCHANEL, formerly Professor of Physics in theLyceeLouis-le-Grand, Inspector of the Academy of Paris. Translated and edited, with Extensive Additions, by J. D. EVERETT, Professor of Natural Philosophy in the Queen's College, Belfast. In Four Parts. Part I. Mechanics, Hydrostatics, and Pneumatics. Part II. Heat. Part III. Electricity and Magnetism. Part IV. Sound and Light. Copiously illustrated. 8vo. Flexible cloth, per Part, $1.50. With Problems and Index, complete in one volume, Svo, cloth, $5.70. IX. Gore, G. The Art cf Electro-Metallurgy ; including all known of Electro-Depo- sition. Illustrated. 16mo. Cloth, $2.50. X. Gosse's Evenings at the Microscope ; or, Researches among the Minuter Organs and Forms of Animal Life. 12mo. Cloth, $1.50. XI. Harris, George, F. S. A. Civilization considered as a Science. 12mo. Cloth, $1.50. XII. Helmholtz, H. Popular Lectures on Scientific Subjects. Translated by E. ATKINSON, Ph. D., F. C. S. With an Introduction by Professor TYNDALL. 12mo. Cloth, $2.00. XIII. Ilia ton, James. Physiology for Practical Use. With an Introduction by Professor E. L. YOUMANS. 12mo. Cloth, $2.25. IMPORTANT SCIENTIFIC WORKS. (Continued.) XIV. Hoffmann, Frederick. Manual of Chemical Analysis, as applied to the Ex- amination of Medicinal Chemicals. A Guide for the Determination of their Identity and Quality, and for the Detection of Impurities and Adulterations. For the Use of Pharmaceutists, Physicians, Druggists, and Manufacturing Chemists, and Students. Svo. Cloth, 3.00. XV. Johnston, Professor James F. W. The Chemistry of Common Life. A new edition, revised, enlarged, and brought down to the Present Time, by ARTHUR HERBERT CHURCH, M. A., Oxon., author of " Food : its Sources, Constituents, and Uses." Illustrated with Maps and numerous Engravings on Wood. 12mo. Cloth, $2.00. XVI. Le Conte, Professor Joseph. Elements of Geology. A Text-Book for Colleges and for the General Reader. Svo. Cloth, 4.00. XVII. Lyell's Principles of Geology ; or, the Modern Changes of the Earth and its In- habitants, considered as illustrative of Geology. Illustrated with Maps, Plates, and Woodcuts. A new and entirely revised edition. 2 vols., large Svo. Cloth, $8.00. XVIII. Nicholson, H. Alleyne. Zoology (Text-Book of), for Schools and Colleges. 12mo. Half roan, $1.50. XIX. Nicholson, H. Alleyne. Manual of Zoology, for the Use of Students, with a General Introduction to the Principles of Zoology. Second edition, re- vised and enlarged. With 243 Woodcuts. ]2mo. Cloth, $2.50. XX. Nicholson, H. Alleyne. Geology (Text-Book of), for Schools and Colleges. 12mo. Half roan, $130. XXI. Nicholson, H. Alleyne. The Ancient Life-History of the Earth. A Com- prehensive Outline of the Principles and Leading Facts of Palaeontological Science. 12mo. Cloth, S2.00. IMPORTANT SCIENTIFIC WORKS. (Continued.) XXII. Prescott, G. B. Electricity and the Electric Telegraph. 8vo. Cloth, $5.00. XXIII. Prescott, G. B. The Speaking Telephone, Electric Light, and other Recent Electrical Inventions. New edition, with 200 additional pages, including Illustrated Descriptions of all of Edison's Inventions. 214 Illustrations. 8vo. Cloth, $4.00. XXIV. Roscoe, H. E., and Schorlemmer, C. Treatise on Chemistry. Illustrated. Volume L The Non-Metallic Elements. 8vo. Cloth, $5.00. Volume II., Part I. Metals. 8vo. Cloth, $3.00. Volume II., Part II. Metals. 8vo. Cloth, $3.00 (completing the work). XXV. Rutley , Frank. The Study of Rocks : an Elementary Text-Book on Petrol- ogy. 16mo. Cloth, $1.75. XXVI. Thurston, R. H. A History of the Growth of the Steam-Engine. With 163 Illustrations. 12mo. Cloth, $2.50. XXVII. Wagner, Rudolf. Hand-Book of Chemical Technology. Translated and edited from the eighth German edition, with extensive Additions, by WIL- LIAM CKOOKES, F. R. S. With 336 Illustrations. 8vo. Cloth, $5.00. xxvni. Webber, Samuel, C. E. Manual of Power, for Machines, Shafts, and Belts. With a History of Cotton Manufacture in the United States. 8vo. Cloth, $3.50. XXIX. Wellington Arthur M., C. E. Methods for the Computation, from Dia- grams, of Preliminary and Final Estimates of Railway Earthwork, with Diagrams, giving Quantities of Inspection and Irregular Sections direct from Ordinary Field- Works. 2 vols. Cloth, $5.00; or, separately : Text, 12mo, cloth, $1.50 ; Plates, folio, cloth, $3.50. For sale by all booksellers. Any work mailed, post-paid, to any address in the United States, on receipt of price. D. APPLETON & CO., Publishers, 1, 3, & 5 BOND STREET, NEW YORK. ' 14 DAY USE RETURN TO DESK FROM WHICH BORROWED LOAN DEPT. This book is due on the last date stamped below, or on the date to which renewed. Renewed books are subject to immediate recall. 23Jul'C2K JN S ACKS AU62l'69 REC'D LD JUL1819B2 &j an > 63 n 3fiV NtC ^ L DEC 1C 1962 ,J C O 4: W ^ ^ ^^1^ ttC^^ LD 21A-50m-3. THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA LIBRARY